Exit code of exited inferiors in -list-thread-groups
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @c @item -xdb
1239 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1240 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1241 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1242 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1243 @c systems.
1244
1245 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1246 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1247 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1248 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1249 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1250 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1251
1252 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1253 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1254 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1255 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1256 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1257 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1258
1259 @item -write
1260 @cindex @code{--write}
1261 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1262 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1263 (@pxref{Patching}).
1264
1265 @item -statistics
1266 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1267 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1268 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1269
1270 @item -version
1271 @cindex @code{--version}
1272 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1273 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1274
1275 @item -configuration
1276 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1277 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1278 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1279 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1280
1281 @end table
1282
1283 @node Startup
1284 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1285 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1286
1287 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1288
1289 @enumerate
1290 @item
1291 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1292 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1293
1294 @item
1295 @cindex init file
1296 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1297 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1298 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1302 @item
1303 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1304 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1305 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1306 that file.
1307
1308 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1309 @item
1310 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1311 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1312 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1313 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1314 gets loaded.
1315
1316 @item
1317 Processes command line options and operands.
1318
1319 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1320 @item
1321 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1322 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1323 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1324 This is only done if the current directory is
1325 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1326 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1327 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1328 @value{GDBN}.
1329
1330 @item
1331 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1332 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1333 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1334 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1335
1336 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1337 you must do something like the following:
1338
1339 @smallexample
1340 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1341 @end smallexample
1342
1343 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1344 off too late.
1345
1346 @item
1347 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1348 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1349 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1350
1351 @item
1352 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1353 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1354 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1355 @end enumerate
1356
1357 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1358 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1359 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1360 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1361 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1362 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1363
1364 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1365 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1366
1367 @cindex init file name
1368 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1369 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1370 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1371 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1372 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1373 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1374 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1375 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1376
1377
1378 @node Quitting GDB
1379 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1380 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1381 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1382
1383 @table @code
1384 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1386 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1387 @itemx q
1388 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1389 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1390 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1391 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1392 error code.
1393 @end table
1394
1395 @cindex interrupt
1396 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1397 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1398 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1399 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1400 until a time when it is safe.
1401
1402 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1403 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1404 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1405
1406 @node Shell Commands
1407 @section Shell Commands
1408
1409 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1410 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1411 just use the @code{shell} command.
1412
1413 @table @code
1414 @kindex shell
1415 @kindex !
1416 @cindex shell escape
1417 @item shell @var{command-string}
1418 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1419 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1420 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1421 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1422 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1423 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1424 @end table
1425
1426 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1427 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1428 @value{GDBN}:
1429
1430 @table @code
1431 @kindex make
1432 @cindex calling make
1433 @item make @var{make-args}
1434 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1435 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1436 @end table
1437
1438 @node Logging Output
1439 @section Logging Output
1440 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1441 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1442
1443 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1444 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1445
1446 @table @code
1447 @kindex set logging
1448 @item set logging on
1449 Enable logging.
1450 @item set logging off
1451 Disable logging.
1452 @cindex logging file name
1453 @item set logging file @var{file}
1454 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1455 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1456 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1457 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1458 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1459 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1460 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1461 @kindex show logging
1462 @item show logging
1463 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1464 @end table
1465
1466 @node Commands
1467 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1468
1469 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1470 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1471 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1472 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1473 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1474
1475 @menu
1476 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1477 * Completion:: Command completion
1478 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1479 @end menu
1480
1481 @node Command Syntax
1482 @section Command Syntax
1483
1484 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1485 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1486 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1487 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1488 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1489 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1490
1491 @cindex abbreviation
1492 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1493 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1494 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1495 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1496 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1497 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1498 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1499
1500 @cindex repeating commands
1501 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1502 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1503 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1504 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1505 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1506 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1507 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1508
1509 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1510 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1511 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1512
1513 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1514 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1515 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1516 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1517 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1518
1519 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1520 @cindex comment
1521 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1522 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1523 Files,,Command Files}).
1524
1525 @cindex repeating command sequences
1526 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1527 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1528 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1529 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1530 for editing.
1531
1532 @node Completion
1533 @section Command Completion
1534
1535 @cindex completion
1536 @cindex word completion
1537 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1538 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1539 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1540 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1541
1542 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1543 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1544 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1545 enter it). For example, if you type
1546
1547 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1548 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1549 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1550 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1551 @smallexample
1552 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1553 @end smallexample
1554
1555 @noindent
1556 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1557 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1561 @end smallexample
1562
1563 @noindent
1564 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1565 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1566 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1567 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1568 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1569 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1570
1571 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1572 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1573 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1574 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1575 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1576 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1577 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1578 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1579 example:
1580
1581 @smallexample
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1583 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1584 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1585 make_abs_section make_function_type
1586 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1587 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1588 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1589 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1590 @end smallexample
1591
1592 @noindent
1593 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1594 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1595 command.
1596
1597 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1598 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1599 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1600 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1601 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1602
1603 @cindex quotes in commands
1604 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1605 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1606 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1607 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1608 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1609 @value{GDBN} commands.
1610
1611 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1612 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1613 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1614 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1615 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1616 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1617 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1618 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1619 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1620 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1621 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1625 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1626 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1627 @end smallexample
1628
1629 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1630 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1631 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1632 place:
1633
1634 @smallexample
1635 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1636 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1637 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1638 @end smallexample
1639
1640 @noindent
1641 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1642 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1643 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1644
1645 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1646 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1647 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1648 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1649
1650 @cindex completion of structure field names
1651 @cindex structure field name completion
1652 @cindex completion of union field names
1653 @cindex union field name completion
1654 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1655 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1656 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1657 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1658 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1659 left-hand-side:
1660
1661 @smallexample
1662 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1663 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1664 to_data to_isatty to_write
1665 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1666 to_flush to_read
1667 @end smallexample
1668
1669 @noindent
1670 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1671 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1672 follows:
1673
1674 @smallexample
1675 struct ui_file
1676 @{
1677 int *magic;
1678 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1679 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1680 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1681 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1682 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1683 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1684 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1685 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1686 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1687 void *to_data;
1688 @}
1689 @end smallexample
1690
1691
1692 @node Help
1693 @section Getting Help
1694 @cindex online documentation
1695 @kindex help
1696
1697 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1698 using the command @code{help}.
1699
1700 @table @code
1701 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1702 @item help
1703 @itemx h
1704 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1705 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1706
1707 @smallexample
1708 (@value{GDBP}) help
1709 List of classes of commands:
1710
1711 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1712 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1713 data -- Examining data
1714 files -- Specifying and examining files
1715 internals -- Maintenance commands
1716 obscure -- Obscure features
1717 running -- Running the program
1718 stack -- Examining the stack
1719 status -- Status inquiries
1720 support -- Support facilities
1721 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1722 stopping the program
1723 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1724
1725 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1726 commands in that class.
1727 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1728 documentation.
1729 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1730 (@value{GDBP})
1731 @end smallexample
1732 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1733
1734 @item help @var{class}
1735 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1736 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1737 help display for the class @code{status}:
1738
1739 @smallexample
1740 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1741 Status inquiries.
1742
1743 List of commands:
1744
1745 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1746 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1747 info -- Generic command for showing things
1748 about the program being debugged
1749 show -- Generic command for showing things
1750 about the debugger
1751
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757
1758 @item help @var{command}
1759 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1760 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1761
1762 @kindex apropos
1763 @item apropos @var{args}
1764 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1765 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1766 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1767
1768 @smallexample
1769 apropos alias
1770 @end smallexample
1771
1772 @noindent
1773 results in:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 @c @group
1777 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1778 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1779 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1780 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1781 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1782 @c @end group
1783 @end smallexample
1784
1785 @kindex complete
1786 @item complete @var{args}
1787 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1788 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1789 command you want completed. For example:
1790
1791 @smallexample
1792 complete i
1793 @end smallexample
1794
1795 @noindent results in:
1796
1797 @smallexample
1798 @group
1799 if
1800 ignore
1801 info
1802 inspect
1803 @end group
1804 @end smallexample
1805
1806 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1807 @end table
1808
1809 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1810 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1811 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1812 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1813 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1814 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1815 Index}.
1816
1817 @c @group
1818 @table @code
1819 @kindex info
1820 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1821 @item info
1822 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1823 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1824 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1825 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1826 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1827 @w{@code{help info}}.
1828
1829 @kindex set
1830 @item set
1831 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1832 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1833 @code{set prompt $}.
1834
1835 @kindex show
1836 @item show
1837 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1838 @value{GDBN} itself.
1839 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1840 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1841 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1842 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1843
1844 @kindex info set
1845 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1846 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1847 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1848 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1849 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1850 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1851 @end table
1852 @c @end group
1853
1854 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1855 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1856
1857 @table @code
1858 @kindex show version
1859 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1860 @item show version
1861 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1862 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1863 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1864 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1865 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1866 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1867 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1868 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1869 @value{GDBN}.
1870
1871 @kindex show copying
1872 @kindex info copying
1873 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1874 @item show copying
1875 @itemx info copying
1876 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1877
1878 @kindex show warranty
1879 @kindex info warranty
1880 @item show warranty
1881 @itemx info warranty
1882 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1883 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1884
1885 @kindex show configuration
1886 @item show configuration
1887 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1888 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1889 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1890 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1891 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1892 your report.
1893
1894 @end table
1895
1896 @node Running
1897 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1898
1899 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1900 debugging information when you compile it.
1901
1902 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1903 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1904 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1905 kill a child process.
1906
1907 @menu
1908 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1909 * Starting:: Starting your program
1910 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1911 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1912
1913 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1914 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1915 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1916 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1917
1918 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1919 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1920 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1921 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1922 @end menu
1923
1924 @node Compilation
1925 @section Compiling for Debugging
1926
1927 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1928 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1929 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1930 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1931 and addresses in the executable code.
1932
1933 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1934 the compiler.
1935
1936 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1937 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1938 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1939 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1940 executables containing debugging information.
1941
1942 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1943 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1944 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1945 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1946 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1947
1948 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1949 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1950 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1951
1952 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1953 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1954 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1955 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1956 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1957 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1958
1959 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1960 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1961 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1962
1963 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1964 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1965 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1966 format in @value{GDBN}.
1967
1968 @need 2000
1969 @node Starting
1970 @section Starting your Program
1971 @cindex starting
1972 @cindex running
1973
1974 @table @code
1975 @kindex run
1976 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1977 @item run
1978 @itemx r
1979 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1980 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
1981 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1982 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
1983 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1984
1985 @end table
1986
1987 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1988 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1989 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1990 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1991 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1992 message like this one:
1993
1994 @smallexample
1995 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1996 Try "help target" or "continue".
1997 @end smallexample
1998
1999 @noindent
2000 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2001 first (@pxref{load}).
2002
2003 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2004 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2005 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2006 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2007 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2008 divided into four categories:
2009
2010 @table @asis
2011 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2012 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2013 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2014 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2015 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2016 the arguments.
2017 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2018 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2019 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2020 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2021 below for details).
2022
2023 @item The @emph{environment.}
2024 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2025 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2026 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2027 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2028
2029 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2030 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2031 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2032 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2033
2034 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2035 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2036 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2037 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2038 set a different device for your program.
2039 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2040
2041 @cindex pipes
2042 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2043 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2044 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2045 wrong program.
2046 @end table
2047
2048 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2049 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2050 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2051 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2052 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2053
2054 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2055 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2056 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2057 your current breakpoints.
2058
2059 @table @code
2060 @kindex start
2061 @item start
2062 @cindex run to main procedure
2063 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2064 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2065 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2066 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2067 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2068 procedure, depending on the language used.
2069
2070 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2071 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2072 the @samp{run} command.
2073
2074 @cindex elaboration phase
2075 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2076 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2077 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2078 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2079 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2080 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2081 will remain to halt execution.
2082
2083 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2084 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2085 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2086 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2087 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2088
2089 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2090 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2091 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2092 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2093 elaboration code before running your program.
2094
2095 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2096 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2097 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2098 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2099 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2100 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2101 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2102 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2103 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2104 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2105 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2106 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2107
2108 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2109 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2110 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2111 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2112
2113 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2114 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2115 environment:
2116
2117 @smallexample
2118 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2119 (@value{GDBP}) run
2120 @end smallexample
2121
2122 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2123 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2124
2125 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2126 @item set startup-with-shell
2127 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2128 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2129 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2130 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2131 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2132 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2133 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2134 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2135 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2136 startup failures such as:
2137
2138 @smallexample
2139 (@value{GDBP}) run
2140 Starting program: ./a.out
2141 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2142 @end smallexample
2143
2144 @noindent
2145 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2146 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2147 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2148 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2149 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2150 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2151
2152 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2153 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2154 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2155 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2156 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2157 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2158
2159 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2160 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2161 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2162 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2163 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2164 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2165
2166 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2167 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2168 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2169
2170 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2171 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2172
2173 @smallexample
2174 (@value{GDBP}) run
2175 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2176 @end smallexample
2177
2178 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2179 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2180
2181 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2182 @code{target native} command. For example,
2183
2184 @smallexample
2185 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2186 (@value{GDBP}) run
2187 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2188 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2189 (@value{GDBP}) run
2190 Starting program: ./a.out
2191 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2192 @end smallexample
2193
2194 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2195 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2196 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2197 disconnect.
2198
2199 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2200 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2201 proc}, @code{info os}.
2202
2203 @kindex set disable-randomization
2204 @item set disable-randomization
2205 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2206 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2207 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2208 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2209 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2210
2211 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2212 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2216 @end smallexample
2217
2218 @item set disable-randomization off
2219 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2220 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2221 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2222 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2223 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2224 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2225
2226 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2227 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2228 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2229 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2230 a code at its expected addresses.
2231
2232 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2233 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2234 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2235 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2236 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2237 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2238 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2239 a randomly chosen address.
2240
2241 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2242 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2243 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2244 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2245 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2246
2247 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2248 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2249
2250 @item show disable-randomization
2251 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2252 the virtual address space of the started program.
2253
2254 @end table
2255
2256 @node Arguments
2257 @section Your Program's Arguments
2258
2259 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2260 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2261 @code{run} command.
2262 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2263 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2264 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2265 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2266 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2267
2268 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2269 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2270 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2271 the program, not by the shell.
2272
2273 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2274 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2275
2276 @table @code
2277 @kindex set args
2278 @item set args
2279 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2280 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2281 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2282 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2283 it again without arguments.
2284
2285 @kindex show args
2286 @item show args
2287 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2288 @end table
2289
2290 @node Environment
2291 @section Your Program's Environment
2292
2293 @cindex environment (of your program)
2294 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2295 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2296 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2297 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2298 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2299 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2300 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2301
2302 @table @code
2303 @kindex path
2304 @item path @var{directory}
2305 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2306 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2307 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2308 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2309 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2310 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2311 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2312
2313 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2314 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2315 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2316 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2317 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2318 @var{directory} to the search path.
2319 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2320 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2321
2322 @kindex show paths
2323 @item show paths
2324 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2325 environment variable).
2326
2327 @kindex show environment
2328 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2329 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2330 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2331 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2332 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2333
2334 @kindex set environment
2335 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2336 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2337 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2338 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2339 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2340 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2341 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2342 null value.
2343 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2344 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2345
2346 For example, this command:
2347
2348 @smallexample
2349 set env USER = foo
2350 @end smallexample
2351
2352 @noindent
2353 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2354 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2355 are not actually required.)
2356
2357 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2358 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2359 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2360 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2361 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2362
2363 @kindex unset environment
2364 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2365 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2366 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2367 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2368 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2369 @end table
2370
2371 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2372 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2373 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2374 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2375 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2376 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2377 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2378 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2379 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2380 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2381
2382 @node Working Directory
2383 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2384
2385 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2386 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2387 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2388 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2389 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2390 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2391
2392 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2393 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2394 Specify Files}.
2395
2396 @table @code
2397 @kindex cd
2398 @cindex change working directory
2399 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2400 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2401 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2402
2403 @kindex pwd
2404 @item pwd
2405 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2406 @end table
2407
2408 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2409 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2410 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2411 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2412 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2413 current working directory of the debuggee.
2414
2415 @node Input/Output
2416 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2417
2418 @cindex redirection
2419 @cindex i/o
2420 @cindex terminal
2421 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2422 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2423 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2424 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2425 running your program.
2426
2427 @table @code
2428 @kindex info terminal
2429 @item info terminal
2430 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2431 program is using.
2432 @end table
2433
2434 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2435 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2436
2437 @smallexample
2438 run > outfile
2439 @end smallexample
2440
2441 @noindent
2442 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2443
2444 @kindex tty
2445 @cindex controlling terminal
2446 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2447 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2448 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2449 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2450 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2451
2452 @smallexample
2453 tty /dev/ttyb
2454 @end smallexample
2455
2456 @noindent
2457 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2458 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2459 that as their controlling terminal.
2460
2461 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2462 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2463 terminal.
2464
2465 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2466 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2467 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2468 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2469
2470 @cindex inferior tty
2471 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2472 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2473 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2474 program.
2475
2476 @table @code
2477 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2478 @kindex set inferior-tty
2479 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2480
2481 @item show inferior-tty
2482 @kindex show inferior-tty
2483 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2484 @end table
2485
2486 @node Attach
2487 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2488 @kindex attach
2489 @cindex attach
2490
2491 @table @code
2492 @item attach @var{process-id}
2493 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2494 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2495 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2496 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2497 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2498
2499 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2500 executing the command.
2501 @end table
2502
2503 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2504 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2505 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2506 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2507
2508 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2509 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2510 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2511 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2512 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2513 Specify Files}.
2514
2515 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2516 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2517 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2518 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2519 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2520 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2521 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2522
2523 @table @code
2524 @kindex detach
2525 @item detach
2526 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2527 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2528 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2529 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2530 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2531 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2532 executing the command.
2533 @end table
2534
2535 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2536 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2537 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2538 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2539 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2540 Messages}).
2541
2542 @node Kill Process
2543 @section Killing the Child Process
2544
2545 @table @code
2546 @kindex kill
2547 @item kill
2548 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2549 @end table
2550
2551 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2552 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2553 is running.
2554
2555 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2556 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2557 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2558 outside the debugger.
2559
2560 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2561 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2562 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2563 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2564 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2565 breakpoint settings).
2566
2567 @node Inferiors and Programs
2568 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2569
2570 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2571 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2572 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2573 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2574 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2575 from multiple executables.
2576
2577 @cindex inferior
2578 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2579 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2580 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2581 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2582 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2583 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2584 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2585 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2586 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2587 threads running in it.
2588
2589 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2590 inferiors}}:
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @kindex info inferiors
2594 @item info inferiors
2595 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2596
2597 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2598
2599 @enumerate
2600 @item
2601 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2602
2603 @item
2604 the target system's inferior identifier
2605
2606 @item
2607 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2608
2609 @end enumerate
2610
2611 @noindent
2612 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2613 indicates the current inferior.
2614
2615 For example,
2616 @end table
2617 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2618
2619 @smallexample
2620 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2621 Num Description Executable
2622 2 process 2307 hello
2623 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2624 @end smallexample
2625
2626 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2627
2628 @table @code
2629 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2630 @item inferior @var{infno}
2631 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2632 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2633 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2634 @end table
2635
2636
2637 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2638 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2639 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2640 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2641 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2642 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2643
2644 @table @code
2645 @kindex add-inferior
2646 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2647 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2648 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2649 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2650 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2651 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2652
2653 @kindex clone-inferior
2654 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2655 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2656 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2657 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2658 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2659
2660 @smallexample
2661 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2662 Num Description Executable
2663 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2664 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2665 Added inferior 2.
2666 1 inferiors added.
2667 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2668 Num Description Executable
2669 2 <null> helloworld
2670 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2671 @end smallexample
2672
2673 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2674
2675 @kindex remove-inferiors
2676 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2677 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2678 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2679 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2680
2681 @end table
2682
2683 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2684 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2685 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2686 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2687
2688 @table @code
2689 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2690 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2691 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2692 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2693 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2694 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2695
2696 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2697 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2698 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2699 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2700 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2701 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2702 @end table
2703
2704 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2705 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2706 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2707 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2708
2709
2710 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2711 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex set print inferior-events
2715 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2716 @item set print inferior-events
2717 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2718 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2719 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2720 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2721 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2722 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2723
2724 @kindex show print inferior-events
2725 @item show print inferior-events
2726 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2727 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2728 @end table
2729
2730 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2731 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2732 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2733
2734
2735 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2736 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2737 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2738 info program-spaces}} command.
2739
2740 @table @code
2741 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2742 @item maint info program-spaces
2743 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2744 @value{GDBN}.
2745
2746 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2747
2748 @enumerate
2749 @item
2750 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2751
2752 @item
2753 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2754 the @code{file} command.
2755
2756 @end enumerate
2757
2758 @noindent
2759 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2760 indicates the current program space.
2761
2762 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2763 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2764 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2765
2766 @smallexample
2767 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2768 Id Executable
2769 2 goodbye
2770 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2771 * 1 hello
2772 @end smallexample
2773
2774 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2775 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2776 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2777 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2778 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2779
2780 @smallexample
2781 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2782 Id Executable
2783 * 1 vfork-test
2784 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2785 @end smallexample
2786
2787 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2788 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2789 @end table
2790
2791 @node Threads
2792 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2793
2794 @cindex threads of execution
2795 @cindex multiple threads
2796 @cindex switching threads
2797 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2798 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2799 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2800 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2801 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2802 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2803 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2804
2805 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2806 programs:
2807
2808 @itemize @bullet
2809 @item automatic notification of new threads
2810 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2811 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2812 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2813 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2814 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2815 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2816 messages on thread start and exit.
2817 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2818 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2819 isn't compatible with the program.
2820 @end itemize
2821
2822 @quotation
2823 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2824 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2825 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2826 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2827 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2828 like this:
2829
2830 @smallexample
2831 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2832 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2833 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2834 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2835 @end smallexample
2836 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2837 @c doesn't support threads"?
2838 @end quotation
2839
2840 @cindex focus of debugging
2841 @cindex current thread
2842 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2843 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2844 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2845 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2846 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2847
2848 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2849 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2850 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2851 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2852 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2853 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2854 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2855 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2856 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2857 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2858
2859 @smallexample
2860 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2861 @end smallexample
2862
2863 @noindent
2864 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2865 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2866 further qualifier.
2867
2868 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2869 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2870 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2871 @c program?
2872 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2873 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2874 @c threads ab initio?
2875
2876 @cindex thread number
2877 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2878 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2879 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2880
2881 @table @code
2882 @kindex info threads
2883 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2884 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2885 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2886 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2887 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2888
2889 @enumerate
2890 @item
2891 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2892
2893 @item
2894 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2895
2896 @item
2897 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2898 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2899 program itself.
2900
2901 @item
2902 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2903 @end enumerate
2904
2905 @noindent
2906 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2907 indicates the current thread.
2908
2909 For example,
2910 @end table
2911 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2915 Id Target Id Frame
2916 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2917 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2918 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2919 at threadtest.c:68
2920 @end smallexample
2921
2922 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2923 Solaris-specific command:
2924
2925 @table @code
2926 @item maint info sol-threads
2927 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2928 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2929 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2930 @end table
2931
2932 @table @code
2933 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2934 @item thread @var{threadno}
2935 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2936 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2937 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2938 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2939 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2940
2941 @smallexample
2942 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2943 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2944 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2945 8 printf ("hello\n");
2946 @end smallexample
2947
2948 @noindent
2949 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2950 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2951 threads.
2952
2953 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2954 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2955 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2956 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2957 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2958 information on convenience variables.
2959
2960 @kindex thread apply
2961 @cindex apply command to several threads
2962 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2963 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2964 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2965 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2966 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2967 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2968 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2969 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2970
2971 @kindex thread name
2972 @cindex name a thread
2973 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2974 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2975 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2976 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2977
2978 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2979 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2980 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2981 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2982 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2983
2984 @kindex thread find
2985 @cindex search for a thread
2986 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2987 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2988 matches the supplied regular expression.
2989
2990 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2991 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2992 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2993 is the LWP id.
2994
2995 @smallexample
2996 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2997 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2998 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2999 Id Target Id Frame
3000 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3001 @end smallexample
3002
3003 @kindex set print thread-events
3004 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3005 @item set print thread-events
3006 @itemx set print thread-events on
3007 @itemx set print thread-events off
3008 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3009 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3010 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3011 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3012 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3013
3014 @kindex show print thread-events
3015 @item show print thread-events
3016 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3017 have started and exited.
3018 @end table
3019
3020 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3021 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3022 programs with multiple threads.
3023
3024 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3025 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3026
3027 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3028 @table @code
3029 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3030 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3031 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3032 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3033 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3034 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3035 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3036 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3037 macro.
3038
3039 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3040 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3041 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3042 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3043 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3044 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3045
3046 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3047 refers to the default system directories that are
3048 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3049 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3050 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3051
3052 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3053 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3054 was loaded in the inferior process.
3055
3056 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3057 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3058 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3059 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3060 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3061 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3062 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3063
3064 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3065 only on some platforms.
3066
3067 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3068 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3069 Display current libthread_db search path.
3070
3071 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3072 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3073 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3074 @item set debug libthread-db
3075 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3076 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3077 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3078 @end table
3079
3080 @node Forks
3081 @section Debugging Forks
3082
3083 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3084 @cindex multiple processes
3085 @cindex processes, multiple
3086 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3087 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3088 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3089 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3090 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3091 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3092 will cause it to terminate.
3093
3094 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3095 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3096 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3097 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3098 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3099 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3100 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3101 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3102 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3103 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3104
3105 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3106 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3107 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3108 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3109
3110 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3111 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3112
3113 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3114 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3115
3116 @table @code
3117 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3118 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3119 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3120 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3121 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3122
3123 @table @code
3124 @item parent
3125 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3126 unimpeded. This is the default.
3127
3128 @item child
3129 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3130 unimpeded.
3131
3132 @end table
3133
3134 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3135 @item show follow-fork-mode
3136 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3137 @end table
3138
3139 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3140 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3141 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3142
3143 @table @code
3144 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3145 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3146 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3147 retain debugger control over them both.
3148
3149 @table @code
3150 @item on
3151 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3152 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3153 independently. This is the default.
3154
3155 @item off
3156 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3157 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3158 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3159 is held suspended.
3160
3161 @end table
3162
3163 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3164 @item show detach-on-fork
3165 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3166 @end table
3167
3168 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3169 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3170 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3171 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3172 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3173 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3174
3175 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3176 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3177 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3178 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3179 and Programs}.
3180
3181 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3182 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3183 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3184 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3185 the child process's @code{main}.
3186
3187 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3188 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3189
3190 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3191 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3192 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3193 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3194 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3195 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3196 command.
3197
3198 @table @code
3199 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3200 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3201
3202 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3203 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3204
3205 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3206
3207 @table @code
3208 @item new
3209 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3210 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3211 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3212 original inferior.
3213
3214 For example:
3215
3216 @smallexample
3217 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3218 (gdb) info inferior
3219 Id Description Executable
3220 * 1 <null> prog1
3221 (@value{GDBP}) run
3222 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3223 Program exited normally.
3224 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3225 Id Description Executable
3226 * 2 <null> prog2
3227 1 <null> prog1
3228 @end smallexample
3229
3230 @item same
3231 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3232 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3233 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3234 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3235 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3236
3237 For example:
3238
3239 @smallexample
3240 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3241 Id Description Executable
3242 * 1 <null> prog1
3243 (@value{GDBP}) run
3244 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3245 Program exited normally.
3246 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3247 Id Description Executable
3248 * 1 <null> prog2
3249 @end smallexample
3250
3251 @end table
3252 @end table
3253
3254 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3255 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3256 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3257
3258 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3259 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3260
3261 @cindex checkpoint
3262 @cindex restart
3263 @cindex bookmark
3264 @cindex snapshot of a process
3265 @cindex rewind program state
3266
3267 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3268 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3269 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3270 later.
3271
3272 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3273 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3274 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3275 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3276 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3277
3278 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3279 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3280 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3281 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3282 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3283 start again from there.
3284
3285 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3286 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3287
3288 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3289
3290 @table @code
3291 @kindex checkpoint
3292 @item checkpoint
3293 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3294 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3295 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3296
3297 @kindex info checkpoints
3298 @item info checkpoints
3299 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3300 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3301 listed:
3302
3303 @table @code
3304 @item Checkpoint ID
3305 @item Process ID
3306 @item Code Address
3307 @item Source line, or label
3308 @end table
3309
3310 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3311 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3312 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3313 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3314 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3315 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3316 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3317
3318 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3319 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3320 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3321 the debugger.
3322
3323 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3324 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3325 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3326
3327 @end table
3328
3329 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3330 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3331 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3332 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3333 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3334 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3335 previously read data can be read again.
3336
3337 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3338 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3339 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3340 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3341 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3342 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3343
3344 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3345 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3346 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3347 different execution path this time.
3348
3349 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3350 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3351 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3352 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3353 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3354 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3355 potentially pose a problem.
3356
3357 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3358
3359 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3360 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3361 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3362 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3363 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3364 next.
3365
3366 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3367 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3368 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3369 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3370 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3371
3372 @node Stopping
3373 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3374
3375 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3376 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3377 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3378
3379 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3380 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3381 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3382 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3383 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3384 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3385 explicitly request this information at any time.
3386
3387 @table @code
3388 @kindex info program
3389 @item info program
3390 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3391 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3392 @end table
3393
3394 @menu
3395 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3396 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3397 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3398 Skipping over functions and files
3399 * Signals:: Signals
3400 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3401 @end menu
3402
3403 @node Breakpoints
3404 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3405
3406 @cindex breakpoints
3407 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3408 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3409 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3410 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3411 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3412 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3413 program.
3414
3415 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3416 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3417 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3418 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3419 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3420 call).
3421
3422 @cindex watchpoints
3423 @cindex data breakpoints
3424 @cindex memory tracing
3425 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3426 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3427 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3428 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3429 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3430 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3431 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3432 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3433 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3434 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3435 same commands.
3436
3437 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3438 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3439 Automatic Display}.
3440
3441 @cindex catchpoints
3442 @cindex breakpoint on events
3443 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3444 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3445 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3446 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3447 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3448 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3449 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3450
3451 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3452 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3453 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3454 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3455 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3456 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3457 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3458 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3459 enable it again.
3460
3461 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3462 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3463 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3464 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3465 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3466 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3467 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3468
3469 @menu
3470 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3471 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3472 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3473 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3474 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3475 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3476 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3477 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3478 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3479 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3480 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3481 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3482 @end menu
3483
3484 @node Set Breaks
3485 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3486
3487 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3488 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3489 @c
3490 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3491
3492 @kindex break
3493 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3494 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3495 @cindex latest breakpoint
3496 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3497 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3498 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3499 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3500 convenience variables.
3501
3502 @table @code
3503 @item break @var{location}
3504 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3505 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3506 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3507 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3508 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3509
3510 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3511 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3512 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3513 that situation.
3514
3515 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3516 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3517 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3518
3519 @item break
3520 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3521 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3522 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3523 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3524 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3525 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3526 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3527 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3528 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3529 inside loops.
3530
3531 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3532 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3533 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3534 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3535 existed when your program stopped.
3536
3537 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3538 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3539 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3540 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3541 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3542 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3543 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3544
3545 @kindex tbreak
3546 @item tbreak @var{args}
3547 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3548 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3549 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3550 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3551
3552 @kindex hbreak
3553 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3554 @item hbreak @var{args}
3555 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3556 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3557 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3558 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3559 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3560 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3561 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3562 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3563 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3564 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3565 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3566 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3567 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3568 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3569 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3570 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3571 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3572 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3573
3574 @kindex thbreak
3575 @item thbreak @var{args}
3576 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3577 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3578 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3579 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3580 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3581 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3582 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3583 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3584
3585 @kindex rbreak
3586 @cindex regular expression
3587 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3588 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3589 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3590 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3591 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3592 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3593 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3594 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3595 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3596
3597 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3598 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3599 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3600 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3601 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3602 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3603
3604 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3605 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3606 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3607 classes.
3608
3609 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3610 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3611 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3612
3613 @smallexample
3614 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3615 @end smallexample
3616
3617 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3618 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3619 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3620 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3621 every function in a given file:
3622
3623 @smallexample
3624 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3625 @end smallexample
3626
3627 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3628 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3629
3630 @kindex info breakpoints
3631 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3632 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3633 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3634 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3635 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3636 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3637 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3638
3639 @table @emph
3640 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3641 @item Type
3642 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3643 @item Disposition
3644 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3645 @item Enabled or Disabled
3646 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3647 that are not enabled.
3648 @item Address
3649 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3650 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3651 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3652 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3653 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3654 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3655 @item What
3656 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3657 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3658 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3659 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3660 @end table
3661
3662 @noindent
3663 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3664 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3665 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3666 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3667 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3668 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3669
3670 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3671 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3672 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3673 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3674
3675 @noindent
3676 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3677 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3678 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3679 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3680 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3681
3682 @noindent
3683 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3684 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3685 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3686 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3687 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3688 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3689
3690 @noindent
3691 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3692 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3693
3694 @end table
3695
3696 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3697 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3698 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3699 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3700
3701 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3702 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3703 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3704 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3705
3706 @itemize @bullet
3707 @item
3708 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3709
3710 @item
3711 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3712 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3713
3714 @item
3715 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3716 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3717
3718 @item
3719 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3720 several places where that function is inlined.
3721 @end itemize
3722
3723 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3724 the relevant locations.
3725
3726 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3727 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3728 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3729 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3730 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3731 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3732 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3733
3734 For example:
3735
3736 @smallexample
3737 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3738 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3739 stop only if i==1
3740 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3741 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3742 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3743 @end smallexample
3744
3745 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3746 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3747 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3748 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3749 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3750 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3751 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3752 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3753 that belong to that breakpoint.
3754
3755 @cindex pending breakpoints
3756 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3757 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3758 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3759 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3760 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3761 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3762 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3763 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3764 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3765 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3766 is not yet resolved.
3767
3768 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3769 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3770 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3771 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3772 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3773 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3774
3775 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3776 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3777 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3778 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3779
3780 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3781 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3782 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3783
3784 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3785 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3786 address specification to an address:
3787
3788 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3789 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3790 @table @code
3791 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3792 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3793 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3794
3795 @item set breakpoint pending on
3796 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3797 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3798
3799 @item set breakpoint pending off
3800 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3801 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3802 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3803
3804 @item show breakpoint pending
3805 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3806 @end table
3807
3808 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3809 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3810 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3811
3812 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3813 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3814 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3815 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3816 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3817 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3818 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3819 breakpoints.
3820
3821 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3822
3823 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3824 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3825 @table @code
3826 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3827 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3828 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3829 breakpoint must be used.
3830
3831 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3832 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3833 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3834 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3835 @end table
3836
3837 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3838 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3839 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3840 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3841 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3842 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3843 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3844 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3845 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3846
3847 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3848 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3849 @table @code
3850 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3851 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3852 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3853 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3854
3855 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3856 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3857 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3858 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3859 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3860 @end table
3861
3862 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3863 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3864 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3865
3866 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3867 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3868
3869 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3870
3871 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3872 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3873 @table @code
3874 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3875 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3876 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3877 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3878 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3879
3880 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3881 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3882 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3883 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3884 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3885 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3886 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3887 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3888 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3889 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3890 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3891 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3892 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3893
3894 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3895 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3896 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3897 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3898 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3899 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3900 @end table
3901
3902
3903 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3904 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3905 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3906 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3907 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3908 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3909 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3910 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3911
3912
3913 @node Set Watchpoints
3914 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3915
3916 @cindex setting watchpoints
3917 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3918 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3919 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3920 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3921 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3922
3923 @itemize @bullet
3924 @item
3925 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3926
3927 @item
3928 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3929 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3930 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3931
3932 @item
3933 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3934 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3935 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3936 @end itemize
3937
3938 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3939 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3940 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3941 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3942 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3943 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3944 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3945 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3946 the expression changes.
3947
3948 @cindex software watchpoints
3949 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3950 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3951 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3952 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3953 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3954 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3955 culprit.)
3956
3957 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3958 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3959 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3960
3961 @table @code
3962 @kindex watch
3963 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3964 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3965 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3966 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3967 to watch the value of a single variable:
3968
3969 @smallexample
3970 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3971 @end smallexample
3972
3973 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3974 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3975 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3976 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3977 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3978 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3979
3980 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3981 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3982 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3983 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3984 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3985 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3986 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3987 error.
3988
3989 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3990 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3991 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
3992 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
3993 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
3994 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
3995 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
3996 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
3997 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
3998 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
3999 Examples:
4000
4001 @smallexample
4002 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4003 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4004 @end smallexample
4005
4006 @kindex rwatch
4007 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4008 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4009 by the program.
4010
4011 @kindex awatch
4012 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4013 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4014 or written into by the program.
4015
4016 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4017 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4018 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4019 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4020 @end table
4021
4022 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4023 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4024 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4025 a never-changing value:
4026
4027 @smallexample
4028 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4029 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4030 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4031 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4032 @end smallexample
4033
4034 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4035 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4036 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4037 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4038 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4039 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4040
4041 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4042 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4043 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4044 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4045 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4046 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4047 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4048 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4049
4050 @table @code
4051 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4052 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4053 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4054
4055 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4056 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4057 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4058 @end table
4059
4060 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4061 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4062 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4063
4064 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4065
4066 @smallexample
4067 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4068 @end smallexample
4069
4070 @noindent
4071 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4072
4073 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4074 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4075 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4076 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4077 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4078 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4079 will print a message like this:
4080
4081 @smallexample
4082 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4083 @end smallexample
4084
4085 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4086 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4087 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4088 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4089 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4090 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4091 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4092 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4093
4094 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4095 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4096 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4097 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4098 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4099 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4100
4101 @smallexample
4102 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4103 @end smallexample
4104
4105 @noindent
4106 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4107
4108 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4109 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4110 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4111 expression with separately allocated resources.
4112
4113 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4114 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4115 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4116
4117 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4118 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4119 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4120 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4121 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4122 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4123 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4124 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4125 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4126
4127 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4128 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4129 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4130 watched expression from every thread.
4131
4132 @quotation
4133 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4134 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4135 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4136 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4137 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4138 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4139 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4140 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4141 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4142 @end quotation
4143
4144 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4145
4146 @node Set Catchpoints
4147 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4148 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4149 @cindex exception handlers
4150 @cindex event handling
4151
4152 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4153 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4154 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4155
4156 @table @code
4157 @kindex catch
4158 @item catch @var{event}
4159 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4160
4161 @table @code
4162 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4163 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4164 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4165 @kindex catch throw
4166 @kindex catch rethrow
4167 @kindex catch catch
4168 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4169 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4170
4171 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4172 regular expression will be caught.
4173
4174 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4175 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4176 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4177 exception being thrown.
4178
4179 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4180 @value{GDBN}:
4181
4182 @itemize @bullet
4183 @item
4184 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4185 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4186 supported.
4187
4188 @item
4189 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4190 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4191 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4192 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4193 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4194 built.
4195
4196 @item
4197 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4198 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4199
4200 @item
4201 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4202 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4203 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4204 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4205
4206 @item
4207 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4208 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4209 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4210 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4211 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4212 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4213 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4214 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4215 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4216
4217 @item
4218 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4219
4220 @item
4221 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4222 @end itemize
4223
4224 @item exception
4225 @kindex catch exception
4226 @cindex Ada exception catching
4227 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4228 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4229 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4230 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4231 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4232
4233 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4234 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4235 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4236 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4237 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4238 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4239 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4240 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4241
4242 @item exception unhandled
4243 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4244 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4245
4246 @item assert
4247 @kindex catch assert
4248 A failed Ada assertion.
4249
4250 @item exec
4251 @kindex catch exec
4252 @cindex break on fork/exec
4253 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4254 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4255
4256 @item syscall
4257 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4258 @kindex catch syscall
4259 @cindex break on a system call.
4260 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4261 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4262 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4263 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4264 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4265 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4266 will be caught.
4267
4268 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4269 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4270 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4271 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4272
4273 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4274 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4275 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4276 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4277
4278 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4279 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4280 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4281 available choices.
4282
4283 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4284 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4285 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4286 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4287 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4288 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4289 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4290 behind the OS upgrades).
4291
4292 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4293 arguments to it:
4294
4295 @smallexample
4296 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4297 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4298 (@value{GDBP}) r
4299 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4300
4301 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4302 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4303 (@value{GDBP}) c
4304 Continuing.
4305
4306 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4307 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4308 (@value{GDBP})
4309 @end smallexample
4310
4311 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4312
4313 @smallexample
4314 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4315 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4316 (@value{GDBP}) r
4317 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4318
4319 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4320 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4321 (@value{GDBP}) c
4322 Continuing.
4323
4324 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4325 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4326 (@value{GDBP})
4327 @end smallexample
4328
4329 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4330 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4331 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4332
4333 @smallexample
4334 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4335 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4336 (@value{GDBP}) r
4337 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4338
4339 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4340 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4341 (@value{GDBP}) c
4342 Continuing.
4343
4344 Program exited normally.
4345 (@value{GDBP})
4346 @end smallexample
4347
4348 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4349 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4350 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4351 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4352
4353 @smallexample
4354 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4355 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4356 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4357 (@value{GDBP})
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4361 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4362 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4363 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4364 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4365 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4366
4367 @smallexample
4368 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4369 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4370 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4371 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4372 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4373 (@value{GDBP})
4374 @end smallexample
4375
4376 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4377
4378 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4379 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4380
4381 @smallexample
4382 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4383 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4384 @end smallexample
4385
4386 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4387
4388 @item fork
4389 @kindex catch fork
4390 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4391 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4392
4393 @item vfork
4394 @kindex catch vfork
4395 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4396 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4397
4398 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4399 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4400 @kindex catch load
4401 @kindex catch unload
4402 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4403 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4404 matches one of the affected libraries.
4405
4406 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4407 @kindex catch signal
4408 The delivery of a signal.
4409
4410 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4411 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4412 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4413
4414 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4415 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4416 signal names.
4417
4418 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4419 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4420 will be caught.
4421
4422 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4423 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4424 catchpoint.
4425
4426 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4427 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4428 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4429 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4430 commands.
4431
4432 @end table
4433
4434 @item tcatch @var{event}
4435 @kindex tcatch
4436 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4437 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4438
4439 @end table
4440
4441 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4442
4443
4444 @node Delete Breaks
4445 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4446
4447 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4448 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4449 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4450 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4451 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4452 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4453
4454 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4455 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4456 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4457 their breakpoint numbers.
4458
4459 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4460 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4461 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4462
4463 @table @code
4464 @kindex clear
4465 @item clear
4466 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4467 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4468 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4469 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4470
4471 @item clear @var{location}
4472 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4473 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4474 most useful ones are listed below:
4475
4476 @table @code
4477 @item clear @var{function}
4478 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4479 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4480
4481 @item clear @var{linenum}
4482 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4483 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4484 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4485 @end table
4486
4487 @cindex delete breakpoints
4488 @kindex delete
4489 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4490 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4491 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4492 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4493 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4494 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4495 @end table
4496
4497 @node Disabling
4498 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4499
4500 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4501 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4502 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4503 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4504 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4505
4506 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4507 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4508 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4509 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4510 do not know which numbers to use.
4511
4512 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4513 affects all of its locations.
4514
4515 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4516 different states of enablement:
4517
4518 @itemize @bullet
4519 @item
4520 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4521 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4522 @item
4523 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4524 @item
4525 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4526 disabled.
4527 @item
4528 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4529 N times, then becomes disabled.
4530 @item
4531 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4532 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4533 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4534 @end itemize
4535
4536 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4537 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4538
4539 @table @code
4540 @kindex disable
4541 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4542 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4543 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4544 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4545 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4546 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4547 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4548
4549 @kindex enable
4550 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4551 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4552 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4553
4554 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4555 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4556 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4557
4558 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4559 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4560 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4561 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4562 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4563 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4564 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4565
4566 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4567 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4568 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4569 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4570 @end table
4571
4572 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4573 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4574 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4575 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4576 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4577 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4578 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4579 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4580 Stepping}.)
4581
4582 @node Conditions
4583 @subsection Break Conditions
4584 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4585 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4586
4587 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4588 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4589 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4590 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4591 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4592 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4593 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4594 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4595
4596 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4597 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4598 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4599 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4600 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4601
4602 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4603 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4604 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4605 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4606 one.
4607
4608 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4609 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4610 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4611 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4612 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4613 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4614 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4615 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4616 conditions for the
4617 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4618 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4619
4620 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4621 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4622 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4623 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4624 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4625 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4626
4627 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4628 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4629 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4630 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4631 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4632
4633 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4634 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4635 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4636 with the @code{condition} command.
4637
4638 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4639 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4640 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4641 catchpoint.
4642
4643 @table @code
4644 @kindex condition
4645 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4646 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4647 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4648 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4649 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4650 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4651 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4652 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4653 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4654 prints an error message:
4655
4656 @smallexample
4657 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4658 @end smallexample
4659
4660 @noindent
4661 @value{GDBN} does
4662 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4663 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4664 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4665
4666 @item condition @var{bnum}
4667 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4668 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4669 @end table
4670
4671 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4672 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4673 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4674 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4675 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4676 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4677 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4678 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4679 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4680 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4681 your program reaches it.
4682
4683 @table @code
4684 @kindex ignore
4685 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4686 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4687 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4688 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4689 takes no action.
4690
4691 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4692 a count of zero.
4693
4694 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4695 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4696 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4697 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4698
4699 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4700 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4701 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4702
4703 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4704 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4705 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4706 Variables}.
4707 @end table
4708
4709 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4710
4711
4712 @node Break Commands
4713 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4714
4715 @cindex breakpoint commands
4716 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4717 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4718 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4719 enable other breakpoints.
4720
4721 @table @code
4722 @kindex commands
4723 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4724 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4725 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4726 @itemx end
4727 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4728 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4729 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4730
4731 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4732 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4733
4734 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4735 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4736 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4737 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4738 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4739 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4740 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4741 Expressions}).
4742 @end table
4743
4744 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4745 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4746
4747 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4748 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4749 that resumes execution.
4750
4751 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4752 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4753 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4754 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4755 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4756
4757 @kindex silent
4758 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4759 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4760 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4761 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4762 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4763 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4764
4765 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4766 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4767 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4768
4769 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4770 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4771
4772 @smallexample
4773 break foo if x>0
4774 commands
4775 silent
4776 printf "x is %d\n",x
4777 cont
4778 end
4779 @end smallexample
4780
4781 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4782 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4783 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4784 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4785 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4786 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4787 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4788
4789 @smallexample
4790 break 403
4791 commands
4792 silent
4793 set x = y + 4
4794 cont
4795 end
4796 @end smallexample
4797
4798 @node Dynamic Printf
4799 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4800
4801 @cindex dynamic printf
4802 @cindex dprintf
4803 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4804 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4805 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4806 having to recompile it.
4807
4808 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4809 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4810 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4811 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4812 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4813 redirects to files and so forth.
4814
4815 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4816 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4817 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4818 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4819 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4820 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4821 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4822
4823 @table @code
4824 @kindex dprintf
4825 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4826 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4827 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4828 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4829
4830 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4831 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4832 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4833 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4834 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4835 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4836
4837 @item gdb
4838 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4839 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4840
4841 @item call
4842 @kindex dprintf-style call
4843 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4844 @code{printf}).
4845
4846 @item agent
4847 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4848 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4849 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4850 support running commands on the target.
4851
4852 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4853 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4854 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4855 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4856 command.
4857
4858 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4859 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4860 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4861 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4862 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4863 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4864
4865 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4866 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4867 you could do the following:
4868
4869 @example
4870 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4871 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4872 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4873 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4874 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4875 (gdb) info break
4876 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4877 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4878 continue
4879 (gdb)
4880 @end example
4881
4882 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4883 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4884 the variable settings.
4885
4886 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4887 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4888 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4889 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4890 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4891 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4892
4893 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4894 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4895 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4896
4897 @end table
4898
4899 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4900 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4901 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4902 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4903 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4904 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4905
4906 @node Save Breakpoints
4907 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4908
4909 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4910 breakpoints}} command.
4911
4912 @table @code
4913 @kindex save breakpoints
4914 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4915 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4916 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4917 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4918 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4919 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4920 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4921 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4922 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4923 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4924 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4925 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4926 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4927 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4928 that can no longer be recreated.
4929 @end table
4930
4931 @node Static Probe Points
4932 @subsection Static Probe Points
4933
4934 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4935 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4936 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4937 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4938 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4939 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4940 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4941
4942 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4943 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4944 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4945 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4946 in your applications.
4947
4948 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4949 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4950 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4951 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4952 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4953 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4954 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4955 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4956
4957 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4958 probes}, with optional arguments:
4959
4960 @table @code
4961 @kindex info probes
4962 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4963 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4964 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
4965 probes from all providers are listed.
4966
4967 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
4968 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
4969 considered when deciding whether to display them.
4970
4971 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
4972 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
4973 given, all object files are considered.
4974
4975 @item info probes all
4976 List the available static probes, from all types.
4977 @end table
4978
4979 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
4980 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
4981 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
4982 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
4983 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
4984 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
4985 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
4986 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
4987 at the current probe point.
4988
4989 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
4990 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
4991 an error message.
4992
4993
4994 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4995 @node Error in Breakpoints
4996 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4997
4998 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4999 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5000
5001 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5002 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5003 @smallexample
5004 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5005 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5006 @end smallexample
5007
5008 @noindent
5009 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5010 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5011 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5012
5013 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5014 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5015
5016 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5017 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5018 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5019
5020 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5021 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5022 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5023 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5024
5025 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5026 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5027 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5028 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5029 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5030 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5031 first in the bundle.
5032
5033 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5034 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5035 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5036 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5037 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5038 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5039 is hit.
5040
5041 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5042 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5043
5044 @smallexample
5045 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5046 @end smallexample
5047
5048 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5049 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5050 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5051 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5052 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5053 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5054 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5055 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5056
5057 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5058 adjusted breakpoints:
5059
5060 @smallexample
5061 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5062 to 0x00010410.
5063 @end smallexample
5064
5065 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5066 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5067 frequently than expected.
5068
5069 @node Continuing and Stepping
5070 @section Continuing and Stepping
5071
5072 @cindex stepping
5073 @cindex continuing
5074 @cindex resuming execution
5075 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5076 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5077 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5078 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5079 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5080 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5081 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5082 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
5083
5084 @table @code
5085 @kindex continue
5086 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5087 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5088 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5089 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5090 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5091 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5092 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5093 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5094 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5095 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5096
5097 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5098 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5099 @code{continue} is ignored.
5100
5101 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5102 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5103 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5104 @code{continue}.
5105 @end table
5106
5107 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5108 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5109 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5110 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5111
5112 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5113 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5114 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5115 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5116 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5117 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5118
5119 @table @code
5120 @kindex step
5121 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5122 @item step
5123 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5124 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5125 abbreviated @code{s}.
5126
5127 @quotation
5128 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5129 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5130 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5131 @c distinction here.
5132 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5133 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5134 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5135 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5136 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5137 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5138 below.
5139 @end quotation
5140
5141 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5142 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5143 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5144 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5145 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5146 called within the line.
5147
5148 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5149 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5150 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5151 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5152 was any debugging information about the routine.
5153
5154 @item step @var{count}
5155 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5156 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5157 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5158
5159 @kindex next
5160 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5161 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5162 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5163 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5164 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5165 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5166 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5167 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5168
5169 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5170
5171
5172 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5173 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5174 @c
5175 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5176 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5177 @c function are executed without stopping.
5178
5179 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5180 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5181 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5182
5183 @kindex set step-mode
5184 @item set step-mode
5185 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5186 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5187 @itemx set step-mode on
5188 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5189 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5190 information rather than stepping over it.
5191
5192 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5193 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5194 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5195
5196 @item set step-mode off
5197 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5198 debug information. This is the default.
5199
5200 @item show step-mode
5201 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5202 source line debug information.
5203
5204 @kindex finish
5205 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5206 @item finish
5207 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5208 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5209 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5210
5211 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5212 ,Returning from a Function}).
5213
5214 @kindex until
5215 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5216 @cindex run until specified location
5217 @item until
5218 @itemx u
5219 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5220 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5221 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5222 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5223 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5224 than the address of the jump.
5225
5226 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5227 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5228 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5229 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5230 through the next iteration.
5231
5232 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5233 stack frame.
5234
5235 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5236 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5237 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5238 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5239 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5240
5241 @smallexample
5242 (@value{GDBP}) f
5243 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5244 206 expand_input();
5245 (@value{GDBP}) until
5246 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5247 @end smallexample
5248
5249 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5250 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5251 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5252 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5253 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5254 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5255 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5256
5257 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5258 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5259 argument.
5260
5261 @item until @var{location}
5262 @itemx u @var{location}
5263 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5264 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5265 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5266 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5267 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5268 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5269 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5270 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5271 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5272 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5273 invocations have returned.
5274
5275 @smallexample
5276 94 int factorial (int value)
5277 95 @{
5278 96 if (value > 1) @{
5279 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5280 98 @}
5281 99 return (value);
5282 100 @}
5283 @end smallexample
5284
5285
5286 @kindex advance @var{location}
5287 @item advance @var{location}
5288 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5289 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5290 @ref{Specify Location}.
5291 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5292 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5293 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5294 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5295
5296
5297 @kindex stepi
5298 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5299 @item stepi
5300 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5301 @itemx si
5302 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5303
5304 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5305 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5306 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5307 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5308
5309 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5310
5311 @need 750
5312 @kindex nexti
5313 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5314 @item nexti
5315 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5316 @itemx ni
5317 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5318 proceed until the function returns.
5319
5320 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5321
5322 @end table
5323
5324 @anchor{range stepping}
5325 @cindex range stepping
5326 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5327 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5328 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5329 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5330 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5331 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5332 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5333 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5334 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5335 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5336 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5337 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5338 if necessary:
5339
5340 @table @code
5341 @kindex set range-stepping
5342 @kindex show range-stepping
5343 @item set range-stepping
5344 @itemx show range-stepping
5345 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5346
5347 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5348 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5349 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5350 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5351 default is @code{on}.
5352
5353 @end table
5354
5355 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5356 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5357 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5358
5359 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5360 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5361 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5362
5363 For example, consider the following C function:
5364
5365 @smallexample
5366 101 int func()
5367 102 @{
5368 103 foo(boring());
5369 104 bar(boring());
5370 105 @}
5371 @end smallexample
5372
5373 @noindent
5374 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5375 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5376 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5377 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5378
5379 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5380 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5381 is called from many places.
5382
5383 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5384 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5385 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5386 @code{foo}.
5387
5388 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5389 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5390
5391 @table @code
5392 @kindex skip function
5393 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5394 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5395 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5396 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5397 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5398
5399 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5400 will be skipped.
5401
5402 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5403 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5404
5405 @kindex skip file
5406 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5407 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5408 will be skipped over when stepping.
5409
5410 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5411 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5412 @end table
5413
5414 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5415 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5416
5417 @table @code
5418 @kindex info skip
5419 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5420 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5421 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5422 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5423
5424 @table @emph
5425 @item Identifier
5426 A number identifying this skip.
5427 @item Type
5428 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5429 @item Enabled or Disabled
5430 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5431 @item Address
5432 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5433 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5434 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5435 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5436 address here.
5437 @item What
5438 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5439 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5440 where it is defined.
5441 @end table
5442
5443 @kindex skip delete
5444 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5445 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5446 skips.
5447
5448 @kindex skip enable
5449 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5450 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5451 skips.
5452
5453 @kindex skip disable
5454 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5455 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5456 skips.
5457
5458 @end table
5459
5460 @node Signals
5461 @section Signals
5462 @cindex signals
5463
5464 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5465 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5466 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5467 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5468 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5469 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5470 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5471 requested an alarm).
5472
5473 @cindex fatal signals
5474 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5475 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5476 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5477 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5478 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5479 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5480
5481 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5482 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5483 signal.
5484
5485 @cindex handling signals
5486 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5487 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5488 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5489 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5490 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5491
5492 @table @code
5493 @kindex info signals
5494 @kindex info handle
5495 @item info signals
5496 @itemx info handle
5497 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5498 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5499 the defined types of signals.
5500
5501 @item info signals @var{sig}
5502 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5503
5504 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5505
5506 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5507 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5508 for details about this command.
5509
5510 @kindex handle
5511 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5512 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5513 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5514 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5515 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5516 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5517 say what change to make.
5518 @end table
5519
5520 @c @group
5521 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5522 Their full names are:
5523
5524 @table @code
5525 @item nostop
5526 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5527 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5528
5529 @item stop
5530 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5531 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5532
5533 @item print
5534 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5535
5536 @item noprint
5537 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5538 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5539
5540 @item pass
5541 @itemx noignore
5542 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5543 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5544 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5545
5546 @item nopass
5547 @itemx ignore
5548 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5549 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5550 @end table
5551 @c @end group
5552
5553 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5554 program until you
5555 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5556 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5557 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5558 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5559 program sees that signal when you continue.
5560
5561 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5562 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5563 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5564 erroneous signals.
5565
5566 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5567 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5568 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5569 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5570 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5571 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5572 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5573 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5574 Program a Signal}.
5575
5576 @cindex extra signal information
5577 @anchor{extra signal information}
5578
5579 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5580 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5581 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5582 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5583 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5584 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5585 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5586 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5587 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5588 system header.
5589
5590 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5591 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5592
5593 @smallexample
5594 @group
5595 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5596 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5597 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5598 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5599 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5600 type = struct @{
5601 int si_signo;
5602 int si_errno;
5603 int si_code;
5604 union @{
5605 int _pad[28];
5606 struct @{...@} _kill;
5607 struct @{...@} _timer;
5608 struct @{...@} _rt;
5609 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5610 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5611 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5612 @} _sifields;
5613 @}
5614 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5615 type = struct @{
5616 void *si_addr;
5617 @}
5618 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5619 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5620 @end group
5621 @end smallexample
5622
5623 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5624
5625 @node Thread Stops
5626 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5627
5628 @cindex stopped threads
5629 @cindex threads, stopped
5630
5631 @cindex continuing threads
5632 @cindex threads, continuing
5633
5634 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5635 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5636 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5637 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5638 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5639 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5640 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5641 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5642 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5643
5644 @menu
5645 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5646 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5647 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5648 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5649 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5650 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5651 @end menu
5652
5653 @node All-Stop Mode
5654 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5655
5656 @cindex all-stop mode
5657
5658 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5659 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5660 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5661 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5662 underfoot.
5663
5664 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5665 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5666 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5667
5668 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5669 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5670 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5671 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5672 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5673 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5674 stops.
5675
5676 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5677 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5678 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5679 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5680
5681 @cindex automatic thread selection
5682 @cindex switching threads automatically
5683 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5684 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5685 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5686 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5687 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5688 thread.
5689
5690 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5691 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5692
5693 @table @code
5694 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5695 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5696 @cindex lock scheduler
5697 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5698 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5699 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5700 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5701 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5702 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5703 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5704 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5705 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5706 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5707 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5708 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5709
5710 @item show scheduler-locking
5711 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5712 @end table
5713
5714 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5715 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5716 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5717 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5718 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5719 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5720 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5721 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5722 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5723 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5724 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5725 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5726 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5727 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5728
5729 @table @code
5730 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5731 @item set schedule-multiple
5732 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5733 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5734 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5735 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5736 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5737 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5738
5739 @item show schedule-multiple
5740 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5741 multiple processes.
5742 @end table
5743
5744 @node Non-Stop Mode
5745 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5746
5747 @cindex non-stop mode
5748
5749 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5750 @c with more details.
5751
5752 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5753 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5754 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5755 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5756 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5757 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5758
5759 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5760 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5761 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5762 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5763 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5764 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5765 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5766 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5767 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5768 independently and simultaneously.
5769
5770 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5771 or attach to your program:
5772
5773 @smallexample
5774 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5775 set pagination off
5776
5777 # Finally, turn it on!
5778 set non-stop on
5779 @end smallexample
5780
5781 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5782
5783 @table @code
5784 @kindex set non-stop
5785 @item set non-stop on
5786 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5787 @item set non-stop off
5788 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5789 @kindex show non-stop
5790 @item show non-stop
5791 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5792 @end table
5793
5794 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5795 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5796 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5797 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5798 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5799 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5800 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5801 default.
5802
5803 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5804 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5805 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5806
5807 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5808 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5809 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5810 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5811 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5812
5813 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5814 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5815 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5816 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5817 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5818
5819 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5820
5821 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5822 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5823 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5824 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5825 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5826 previously current thread.
5827
5828 @node Background Execution
5829 @subsection Background Execution
5830
5831 @cindex foreground execution
5832 @cindex background execution
5833 @cindex asynchronous execution
5834 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5835
5836 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5837 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5838 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5839 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5840 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5841 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5842
5843 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5844 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5845
5846 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5847 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5848 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5849 are:
5850
5851 @table @code
5852 @kindex run&
5853 @item run
5854 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5855
5856 @item attach
5857 @kindex attach&
5858 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5859
5860 @item step
5861 @kindex step&
5862 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5863
5864 @item stepi
5865 @kindex stepi&
5866 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5867
5868 @item next
5869 @kindex next&
5870 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5871
5872 @item nexti
5873 @kindex nexti&
5874 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5875
5876 @item continue
5877 @kindex continue&
5878 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5879
5880 @item finish
5881 @kindex finish&
5882 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5883
5884 @item until
5885 @kindex until&
5886 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5887
5888 @end table
5889
5890 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5891 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5892 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5893 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5894 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5895 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5896
5897 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5898 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5899
5900 @table @code
5901 @kindex interrupt
5902 @item interrupt
5903 @itemx interrupt -a
5904
5905 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5906 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5907 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5908 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5909 @end table
5910
5911 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5912 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5913
5914 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5915 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5916 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5917
5918 @table @code
5919 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5920 @cindex thread breakpoints
5921 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5922 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5923 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5924 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5925 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5926 specify some source line.
5927
5928 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5929 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5930 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
5931 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
5932 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5933
5934 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5935 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5936 program.
5937
5938 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5939 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5940 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5941
5942 @smallexample
5943 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5944 @end smallexample
5945
5946 @end table
5947
5948 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
5949 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
5950 thread list. For example:
5951
5952 @smallexample
5953 (@value{GDBP}) c
5954 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
5955 @end smallexample
5956
5957 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
5958 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
5959 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
5960 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
5961 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
5962 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
5963 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
5964 command.
5965
5966 @node Interrupted System Calls
5967 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5968
5969 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5970 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5971 @cindex premature return from system calls
5972 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5973 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5974 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5975 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5976 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5977 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5978 stop execution.
5979
5980 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5981 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5982 style anyways.
5983
5984 For example, do not write code like this:
5985
5986 @smallexample
5987 sleep (10);
5988 @end smallexample
5989
5990 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5991 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5992
5993 Instead, write this:
5994
5995 @smallexample
5996 int unslept = 10;
5997 while (unslept > 0)
5998 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5999 @end smallexample
6000
6001 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6002 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6003 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6004 @value{GDBN}.
6005
6006 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6007 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6008 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6009 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6010
6011 @node Observer Mode
6012 @subsection Observer Mode
6013
6014 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6015 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6016 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6017 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6018 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6019
6020 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6021 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6022 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6023 mode.
6024
6025 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6026 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6027 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6028 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6029 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6030
6031 @table @code
6032
6033 @kindex observer
6034 @item set observer on
6035 @itemx set observer off
6036 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6037 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6038 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6039 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6040
6041 @item show observer
6042 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6043
6044 @kindex may-write-registers
6045 @item set may-write-registers on
6046 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6047 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6048 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6049 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6050
6051 @item show may-write-registers
6052 Show the current permission to write registers.
6053
6054 @kindex may-write-memory
6055 @item set may-write-memory on
6056 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6057 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6058 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6059 defaults to @code{on}.
6060
6061 @item show may-write-memory
6062 Show the current permission to write memory.
6063
6064 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6065 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6066 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6067 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6068 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6069 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6070
6071 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6072 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6073
6074 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6075 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6076 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6077 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6078 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6079 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6080 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6081
6082 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6083 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6084
6085 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6086 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6087 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6088 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6089 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6090 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6091 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6092
6093 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6094 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6095
6096 @kindex may-interrupt
6097 @item set may-interrupt on
6098 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6099 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6100 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6101 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6102 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6103
6104 @item show may-interrupt
6105 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6106
6107 @end table
6108
6109 @node Reverse Execution
6110 @chapter Running programs backward
6111 @cindex reverse execution
6112 @cindex running programs backward
6113
6114 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6115 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6116 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6117 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6118
6119 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6120 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6121 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6122 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6123 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6124 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6125
6126 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6127 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6128 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6129 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6130 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6131 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6132 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6133 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6134 prior values@footnote{
6135 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6136 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6137 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6138
6139 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6140 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6141 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6142 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6143 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6144 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6145 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6146 }.
6147
6148 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6149 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6150
6151 @table @code
6152 @kindex reverse-continue
6153 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6154 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6155 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6156 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6157 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6158 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6159 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6160
6161 @kindex reverse-step
6162 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6163 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6164 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6165 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6166
6167 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6168 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6169 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6170 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6171 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6172 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6173
6174 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6175 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6176
6177 @kindex reverse-stepi
6178 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6179 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6180 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6181 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6182 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6183 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6184 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6185
6186 @kindex reverse-next
6187 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6188 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6189 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6190 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6191 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6192 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6193 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6194 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6195 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6196 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6197
6198 @kindex reverse-nexti
6199 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6200 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6201 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6202 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6203 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6204 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6205 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6206 frame) is reached.
6207
6208 @kindex reverse-finish
6209 @item reverse-finish
6210 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6211 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6212 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6213 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6214
6215 @kindex set exec-direction
6216 @item set exec-direction
6217 Set the direction of target execution.
6218 @item set exec-direction reverse
6219 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6220 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6221 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6222 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6223 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6224 @item set exec-direction forward
6225 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6226 This is the default.
6227 @end table
6228
6229
6230 @node Process Record and Replay
6231 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6232 @cindex process record and replay
6233 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6234
6235 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6236 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6237 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6238
6239 @cindex replay mode
6240 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6241 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6242 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6243 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6244 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6245 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6246 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6247 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6248 execution log.
6249
6250 @cindex record mode
6251 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6252 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6253 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6254 for future replay.
6255
6256 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6257 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6258 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6259 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6260 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6261 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6262
6263 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6264 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6265 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6266 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6267
6268 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6269 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6270
6271 @table @code
6272 @kindex target record
6273 @kindex target record-full
6274 @kindex target record-btrace
6275 @kindex record
6276 @kindex record full
6277 @kindex record btrace
6278 @kindex rec
6279 @kindex rec full
6280 @kindex rec btrace
6281 @item record @var{method}
6282 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6283 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6284 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6285 recording methods are available:
6286
6287 @table @code
6288 @item full
6289 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6290 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6291 execution.
6292
6293 @item btrace
6294 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6295 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6296 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6297 reverse execution.
6298
6299 This recording method may not be available on all processors.
6300 @end table
6301
6302 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6303 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6304 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6305 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6306
6307 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6308 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6309
6310 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6311 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6312 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6313 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6314 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6315
6316 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6317 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6318 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6319 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6320 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6321 does not support these two modes.
6322
6323 @kindex record stop
6324 @kindex rec s
6325 @item record stop
6326 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6327 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6328 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6329
6330 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6331 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6332 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6333 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6334 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6335
6336 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6337 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6338 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6339 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6340 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6341
6342 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6343 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6344
6345 @kindex record goto
6346 @item record goto
6347 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6348 ways to specify the location to go to:
6349
6350 @table @code
6351 @item record goto begin
6352 @itemx record goto start
6353 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6354
6355 @item record goto end
6356 Go to the end of the execution log.
6357
6358 @item record goto @var{n}
6359 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6360 @end table
6361
6362 @kindex record save
6363 @item record save @var{filename}
6364 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6365 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6366 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6367
6368 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6369
6370 @kindex record restore
6371 @item record restore @var{filename}
6372 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6373 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6374
6375 @kindex set record full
6376 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6377 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6378 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6379 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6380
6381 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6382 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6383 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6384 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6385 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6386 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6387 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6388 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6389
6390 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6391 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6392 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6393
6394 @kindex show record full
6395 @item show record full insn-number-max
6396 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6397 recording method.
6398
6399 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6400 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6401 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6402 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6403 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6404 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6405 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6406 oldest one to be deleted.
6407
6408 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6409 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6410
6411 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6412 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6413
6414 @item set record full memory-query
6415 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6416 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6417 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6418 case.
6419
6420 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6421 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6422 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6423 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6424 results.
6425
6426 @item show record full memory-query
6427 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6428
6429 @kindex set record btrace
6430 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6431 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6432 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6433 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6434 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6435 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6436 You can use the following command for that:
6437
6438 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6439 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6440 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6441 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6442 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6443 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6444 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6445 position.
6446
6447 @kindex show record btrace
6448 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6449 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6450
6451 @kindex info record
6452 @item info record
6453 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6454 method:
6455
6456 @table @code
6457 @item full
6458 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6459 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6460
6461 @itemize @bullet
6462 @item
6463 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6464 @item
6465 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6466 @item
6467 Highest recorded instruction number.
6468 @item
6469 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6470 @item
6471 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6472 @item
6473 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6474 @end itemize
6475
6476 @item btrace
6477 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows the number of
6478 instructions that have been recorded and the number of blocks of
6479 sequential control-flow that is formed by the recorded instructions.
6480 @end table
6481
6482 @kindex record delete
6483 @kindex rec del
6484 @item record delete
6485 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6486 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6487 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6488 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6489
6490 @kindex record instruction-history
6491 @kindex rec instruction-history
6492 @item record instruction-history
6493 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6494 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6495 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6496 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6497 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6498
6499 @table @code
6500 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6501 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6502 @var{insn}.
6503
6504 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6505 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6506 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6507 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6508 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6509 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6510
6511 @item record instruction-history
6512 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6513
6514 @item record instruction-history -
6515 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6516
6517 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6518 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6519 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6520 number @var{end} is included.
6521 @end table
6522
6523 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6524
6525 @kindex set record
6526 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6527 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6528 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6529 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6530 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6531
6532 @kindex show record
6533 @item show record instruction-history-size
6534 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6535 instruction-history} command.
6536
6537 @kindex record function-call-history
6538 @kindex rec function-call-history
6539 @item record function-call-history
6540 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6541 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6542 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6543 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6544 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6545 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6546 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6547 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6548 given together.
6549
6550 @smallexample
6551 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6552 1 void foo (void)
6553 2 @{
6554 3 @}
6555 4
6556 5 void bar (void)
6557 6 @{
6558 7 ...
6559 8 foo ();
6560 9 ...
6561 10 @}
6562 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6563 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6564 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6565 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6566 @end smallexample
6567
6568 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6569 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6570 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6571 to print:
6572
6573 @table @code
6574 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6575 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6576
6577 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6578 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6579 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6580 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6581 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6582
6583 @item record function-call-history
6584 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6585
6586 @item record function-call-history -
6587 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6588
6589 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6590 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6591 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6592 @end table
6593
6594 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6595
6596 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6597 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6598 Define how many lines to print in the
6599 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6600 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6601
6602 @item show record function-call-history-size
6603 Show how many lines to print in the
6604 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6605 @end table
6606
6607
6608 @node Stack
6609 @chapter Examining the Stack
6610
6611 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6612 stopped and how it got there.
6613
6614 @cindex call stack
6615 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6616 is generated.
6617 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6618 the arguments of the call,
6619 and the local variables of the function being called.
6620 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6621 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6622 stack}.
6623
6624 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6625 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6626
6627 @cindex selected frame
6628 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6629 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6630 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6631 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6632 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6633 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6634
6635 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6636 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6637 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6638
6639 @menu
6640 * Frames:: Stack frames
6641 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6642 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6643 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6644 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6645
6646 @end menu
6647
6648 @node Frames
6649 @section Stack Frames
6650
6651 @cindex frame, definition
6652 @cindex stack frame
6653 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6654 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6655 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6656 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6657 which the function is executing.
6658
6659 @cindex initial frame
6660 @cindex outermost frame
6661 @cindex innermost frame
6662 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6663 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6664 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6665 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6666 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6667 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6668 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6669 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6670
6671 @cindex frame pointer
6672 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6673 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6674 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6675 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6676 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6677 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6678
6679 @cindex frame number
6680 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6681 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6682 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6683 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6684 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6685
6686 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6687 @c underflow problems.
6688 @cindex frameless execution
6689 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6690 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6691 @smallexample
6692 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6693 @end smallexample
6694 generates functions without a frame.)
6695 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6696 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6697 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6698 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6699 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6700 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6701 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6702
6703 @table @code
6704 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6705 @cindex current stack frame
6706 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6707 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6708 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6709 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6710 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6711
6712 @kindex select-frame
6713 @cindex selecting frame silently
6714 @item select-frame
6715 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6716 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6717 @code{frame}.
6718 @end table
6719
6720 @node Backtrace
6721 @section Backtraces
6722
6723 @cindex traceback
6724 @cindex call stack traces
6725 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6726 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6727 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6728 stack.
6729
6730 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6731 @table @code
6732 @kindex backtrace
6733 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6734 @item backtrace
6735 @itemx bt
6736 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6737 frames in the stack.
6738
6739 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6740 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6741
6742 @item backtrace @var{n}
6743 @itemx bt @var{n}
6744 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6745
6746 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6747 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6748 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6749
6750 @item backtrace full
6751 @itemx bt full
6752 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6753 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6754 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
6755 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
6756
6757 @item backtrace no-filters
6758 @itemx bt no-filters
6759 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6760 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6761 @itemx bt no-filters full
6762 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6763 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6764 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6765 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6766 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6767 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6768 support.
6769 @end table
6770
6771 @kindex where
6772 @kindex info stack
6773 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6774 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6775
6776 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6777 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6778 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6779 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6780 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6781 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6782 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6783 multi-threaded program.
6784
6785 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6786 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6787 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6788 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6789 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6790 line number.
6791
6792 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6793 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6794
6795 @smallexample
6796 @group
6797 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6798 at builtin.c:993
6799 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6800 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6801 at macro.c:71
6802 (More stack frames follow...)
6803 @end group
6804 @end smallexample
6805
6806 @noindent
6807 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6808 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6809 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6810
6811 @noindent
6812 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6813 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6814 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6815 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6816 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6817
6818 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6819 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6820 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6821 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6822 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6823 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6824 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6825 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6826 such a backtrace might look like:
6827
6828 @smallexample
6829 @group
6830 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6831 at builtin.c:993
6832 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6833 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6834 at macro.c:71
6835 (More stack frames follow...)
6836 @end group
6837 @end smallexample
6838
6839 @noindent
6840 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6841 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6842
6843 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6844 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6845 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6846
6847 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6848 @cindex program entry point
6849 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6850 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6851 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6852 @code{main}@footnote{
6853 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6854 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6855 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6856 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6857 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6858 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6859
6860 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6861 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6862
6863 @table @code
6864 @item set backtrace past-main
6865 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6866 @kindex set backtrace
6867 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6868
6869 @item set backtrace past-main off
6870 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6871 default.
6872
6873 @item show backtrace past-main
6874 @kindex show backtrace
6875 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6876
6877 @item set backtrace past-entry
6878 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6879 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6880 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6881 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6882
6883 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6884 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6885 application. This is the default.
6886
6887 @item show backtrace past-entry
6888 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6889
6890 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6891 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6892 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
6893 @cindex backtrace limit
6894 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
6895 or zero means unlimited levels.
6896
6897 @item show backtrace limit
6898 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6899 @end table
6900
6901 You can control how file names are displayed.
6902
6903 @table @code
6904 @item set filename-display
6905 @itemx set filename-display relative
6906 @cindex filename-display
6907 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
6908
6909 @item set filename-display basename
6910 Display only basename of a filename.
6911
6912 @item set filename-display absolute
6913 Display an absolute filename.
6914
6915 @item show filename-display
6916 Show the current way to display filenames.
6917 @end table
6918
6919 @node Frame Filter Management
6920 @section Management of Frame Filters.
6921 @cindex managing frame filters
6922
6923 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
6924 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
6925
6926 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
6927 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
6928
6929 @table @code
6930 @kindex info frame-filter
6931 @item info frame-filter
6932 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
6933 their name, priority and enabled status.
6934
6935 @kindex disable frame-filter
6936 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
6937 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6938 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6939 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
6940 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6941 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6942 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
6943 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
6944 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6945 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
6946 may be enabled again later.
6947
6948 @kindex enable frame-filter
6949 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6950 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6951 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
6952 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6953 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6954 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
6955 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
6956 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6957 @var{filter-dictionary}.
6958
6959 Example:
6960
6961 @smallexample
6962 (gdb) info frame-filter
6963
6964 global frame-filters:
6965 Priority Enabled Name
6966 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6967 100 Yes Reverse
6968
6969 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6970 Priority Enabled Name
6971 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6972
6973 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6974 Priority Enabled Name
6975 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
6976
6977 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
6978 (gdb) info frame-filter
6979
6980 global frame-filters:
6981 Priority Enabled Name
6982 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6983 100 Yes Reverse
6984
6985 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6986 Priority Enabled Name
6987 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6988
6989 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6990 Priority Enabled Name
6991 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6992
6993 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
6994 (gdb) info frame-filter
6995
6996 global frame-filters:
6997 Priority Enabled Name
6998 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6999 100 Yes Reverse
7000
7001 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7002 Priority Enabled Name
7003 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7004
7005 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7006 Priority Enabled Name
7007 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7008 @end smallexample
7009
7010 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7011 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7012 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7013 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7014 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7015 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7016 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7017
7018 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7019 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7020 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7021 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7022 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7023 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7024 dictionary resides.
7025
7026 Example:
7027
7028 @smallexample
7029 (gdb) info frame-filter
7030
7031 global frame-filters:
7032 Priority Enabled Name
7033 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7034 100 Yes Reverse
7035
7036 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7037 Priority Enabled Name
7038 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7039
7040 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7041 Priority Enabled Name
7042 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7043
7044 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7045 (gdb) info frame-filter
7046
7047 global frame-filters:
7048 Priority Enabled Name
7049 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7050 50 Yes Reverse
7051
7052 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7053 Priority Enabled Name
7054 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7055
7056 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7057 Priority Enabled Name
7058 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7059 @end smallexample
7060 @end table
7061
7062 @node Selection
7063 @section Selecting a Frame
7064
7065 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7066 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7067 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7068 of the stack frame just selected.
7069
7070 @table @code
7071 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7072 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7073 @item frame @var{n}
7074 @itemx f @var{n}
7075 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7076 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7077 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7078 @code{main}.
7079
7080 @item frame @var{addr}
7081 @itemx f @var{addr}
7082 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7083 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7084 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7085 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7086 switches between them.
7087
7088 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7089 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7090
7091 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7092 pointer and a program counter.
7093
7094 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7095 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7096
7097 @kindex up
7098 @item up @var{n}
7099 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7100 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7101 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7102
7103 @kindex down
7104 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7105 @item down @var{n}
7106 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7107 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7108 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7109 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7110 @end table
7111
7112 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7113 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7114 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7115 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7116
7117 @need 1000
7118 For example:
7119
7120 @smallexample
7121 @group
7122 (@value{GDBP}) up
7123 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7124 at env.c:10
7125 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7126 @end group
7127 @end smallexample
7128
7129 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7130 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7131 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7132 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7133 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7134 for details.
7135
7136 @table @code
7137 @kindex down-silently
7138 @kindex up-silently
7139 @item up-silently @var{n}
7140 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7141 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7142 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7143 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7144 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7145 distracting.
7146 @end table
7147
7148 @node Frame Info
7149 @section Information About a Frame
7150
7151 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7152 stack frame.
7153
7154 @table @code
7155 @item frame
7156 @itemx f
7157 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7158 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7159 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7160 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7161 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7162
7163 @kindex info frame
7164 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7165 @item info frame
7166 @itemx info f
7167 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7168 including:
7169
7170 @itemize @bullet
7171 @item
7172 the address of the frame
7173 @item
7174 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7175 @item
7176 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7177 @item
7178 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7179 @item
7180 the address of the frame's arguments
7181 @item
7182 the address of the frame's local variables
7183 @item
7184 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7185 @item
7186 which registers were saved in the frame
7187 @end itemize
7188
7189 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7190 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7191 the usual conventions.
7192
7193 @item info frame @var{addr}
7194 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7195 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7196 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7197 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7198 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7199 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7200
7201 @kindex info args
7202 @item info args
7203 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7204
7205 @item info locals
7206 @kindex info locals
7207 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7208 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7209 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7210
7211 @end table
7212
7213
7214 @node Source
7215 @chapter Examining Source Files
7216
7217 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7218 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7219 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7220 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7221 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7222 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7223 source files by explicit command.
7224
7225 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7226 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7227 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7228
7229 @menu
7230 * List:: Printing source lines
7231 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7232 * Edit:: Editing source files
7233 * Search:: Searching source files
7234 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7235 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7236 @end menu
7237
7238 @node List
7239 @section Printing Source Lines
7240
7241 @kindex list
7242 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7243 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7244 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7245 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7246 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7247
7248 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7249
7250 @table @code
7251 @item list @var{linenum}
7252 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7253 current source file.
7254
7255 @item list @var{function}
7256 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7257 @var{function}.
7258
7259 @item list
7260 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7261 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7262 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7263 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7264 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7265
7266 @item list -
7267 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7268 @end table
7269
7270 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7271 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7272 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7273
7274 @table @code
7275 @kindex set listsize
7276 @item set listsize @var{count}
7277 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7278 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7279 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7280 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7281
7282 @kindex show listsize
7283 @item show listsize
7284 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7285 @end table
7286
7287 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7288 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7289 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7290 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7291 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7292
7293 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7294 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7295 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7296 to specify some source line.
7297
7298 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7299
7300 @table @code
7301 @item list @var{linespec}
7302 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7303
7304 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7305 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7306 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7307 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7308 the same source file as the first linespec.
7309
7310 @item list ,@var{last}
7311 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7312
7313 @item list @var{first},
7314 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7315
7316 @item list +
7317 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7318
7319 @item list -
7320 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7321
7322 @item list
7323 As described in the preceding table.
7324 @end table
7325
7326 @node Specify Location
7327 @section Specifying a Location
7328 @cindex specifying location
7329 @cindex linespec
7330
7331 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7332 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7333 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7334 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7335
7336 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7337 @value{GDBN} understands:
7338
7339 @table @code
7340 @item @var{linenum}
7341 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7342
7343 @item -@var{offset}
7344 @itemx +@var{offset}
7345 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7346 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7347 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7348 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7349 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7350 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7351 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7352 linespec.
7353
7354 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7355 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7356 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7357 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7358 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7359 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7360 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7361
7362 @item @var{function}
7363 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7364 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7365
7366 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7367 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7368
7369 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7370 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7371 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7372 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7373 functions in different source files.
7374
7375 @item @var{label}
7376 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7377 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7378 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7379 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7380 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7381
7382 @item *@var{address}
7383 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7384 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7385 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7386 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7387 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7388 source files.
7389
7390 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7391 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7392 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7393 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7394 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7395 of @var{address}:
7396
7397 @table @code
7398 @item @var{expression}
7399 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7400
7401 @item @var{funcaddr}
7402 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7403 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7404 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7405 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7406 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7407 (although the Pascal form also works).
7408
7409 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7410 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7411
7412 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
7413 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7414 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7415 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7416 functions with identical names in different source files.
7417 @end table
7418
7419 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7420 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7421 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7422 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7423 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7424 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7425
7426 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7427 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7428 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7429 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7430 each one of those probes.
7431
7432 @end table
7433
7434
7435 @node Edit
7436 @section Editing Source Files
7437 @cindex editing source files
7438
7439 @kindex edit
7440 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7441 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7442 The editing program of your choice
7443 is invoked with the current line set to
7444 the active line in the program.
7445 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7446 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7447
7448 @table @code
7449 @item edit @var{location}
7450 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7451 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7452 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7453 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7454 command most commonly used:
7455
7456 @table @code
7457 @item edit @var{number}
7458 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7459
7460 @item edit @var{function}
7461 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7462 @end table
7463
7464 @end table
7465
7466 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7467 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7468 @footnote{
7469 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7470 following command-line syntax:
7471 @smallexample
7472 ex +@var{number} file
7473 @end smallexample
7474 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7475 the file where to start editing.}.
7476 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7477 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7478 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7479 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7480 @smallexample
7481 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7482 export EDITOR
7483 gdb @dots{}
7484 @end smallexample
7485 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7486 @smallexample
7487 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7488 gdb @dots{}
7489 @end smallexample
7490
7491 @node Search
7492 @section Searching Source Files
7493 @cindex searching source files
7494
7495 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7496 regular expression.
7497
7498 @table @code
7499 @kindex search
7500 @kindex forward-search
7501 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7502 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7503 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7504 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7505 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7506 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7507 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7508 @code{fo}.
7509
7510 @kindex reverse-search
7511 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7512 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7513 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7514 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7515 this command as @code{rev}.
7516 @end table
7517
7518 @node Source Path
7519 @section Specifying Source Directories
7520
7521 @cindex source path
7522 @cindex directories for source files
7523 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7524 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7525 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7526 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7527 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7528 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7529 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7530
7531 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7532 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7533 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7534 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7535 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7536 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7537 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7538 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7539 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7540 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7541 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7542
7543 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7544 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7545 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7546 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7547 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7548 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7549
7550 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7551 source files.
7552
7553 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7554 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7555 each line is in the file.
7556
7557 @kindex directory
7558 @kindex dir
7559 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7560 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7561 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7562
7563 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7564 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7565
7566 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7567 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7568 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7569 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7570 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7571 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7572 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7573 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7574 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7575 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7576 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7577 name to look up the sources.
7578
7579 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7580 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7581 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7582 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7583 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7584 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7585 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7586 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7587
7588 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7589 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7590 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7591 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7592 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7593 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7594 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7595
7596 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7597 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7598 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7599 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7600 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7601 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7602 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7603 command.
7604
7605 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7606 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7607 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7608 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7609 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7610 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7611 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7612
7613 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7614 @cindex default source path substitution
7615 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7616 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7617 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7618 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7619 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7620 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7621 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7622 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7623 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7624 together.
7625
7626 @table @code
7627 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7628 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7629 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7630 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7631 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7632 part of absolute file names) or
7633 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7634 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7635
7636 @kindex cdir
7637 @kindex cwd
7638 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7639 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7640 @cindex compilation directory
7641 @cindex current directory
7642 @cindex working directory
7643 @cindex directory, current
7644 @cindex directory, compilation
7645 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7646 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7647 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7648 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7649 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7650 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7651
7652 @item directory
7653 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7654
7655 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7656 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7657
7658 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7659 @kindex set directories
7660 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7661 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7662
7663 @item show directories
7664 @kindex show directories
7665 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7666
7667 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7668 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7669 @kindex set substitute-path
7670 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7671 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7672 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7673
7674 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7675 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7676
7677 @smallexample
7678 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7679 @end smallexample
7680
7681 @noindent
7682 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7683 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7684 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7685
7686 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7687 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7688 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7689 the substitution.
7690
7691 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7692
7693 @smallexample
7694 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7695 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7696 @end smallexample
7697
7698 @noindent
7699 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7700 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7701 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7702 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7703
7704
7705 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7706 @kindex unset substitute-path
7707 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7708 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7709 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7710
7711 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7712
7713 @item show substitute-path [path]
7714 @kindex show substitute-path
7715 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7716 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7717
7718 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7719 rules.
7720
7721 @end table
7722
7723 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7724 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7725 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7726
7727 @enumerate
7728 @item
7729 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7730
7731 @item
7732 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7733 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7734 directories in one command.
7735 @end enumerate
7736
7737 @node Machine Code
7738 @section Source and Machine Code
7739 @cindex source line and its code address
7740
7741 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7742 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7743 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7744 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7745 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7746 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7747 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7748 well as hex.
7749
7750 @table @code
7751 @kindex info line
7752 @item info line @var{linespec}
7753 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7754 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7755 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7756 @end table
7757
7758 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7759 the object code for the first line of function
7760 @code{m4_changequote}:
7761
7762 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7763 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7764 @smallexample
7765 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7766 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7767 @end smallexample
7768
7769 @noindent
7770 @cindex code address and its source line
7771 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7772 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7773 @smallexample
7774 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7775 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7776 @end smallexample
7777
7778 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7779 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7780 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7781 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7782 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7783 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7784 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7785 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7786 Variables}).
7787
7788 @table @code
7789 @kindex disassemble
7790 @cindex assembly instructions
7791 @cindex instructions, assembly
7792 @cindex machine instructions
7793 @cindex listing machine instructions
7794 @item disassemble
7795 @itemx disassemble /m
7796 @itemx disassemble /r
7797 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7798 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7799 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7800 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7801 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7802 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7803 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7804 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7805 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7806 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7807
7808 @table @code
7809 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7810 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7811 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7812 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7813 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7814 @end table
7815
7816 @noindent
7817 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
7818 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
7819
7820 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
7821 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
7822
7823 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
7824 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
7825 @end table
7826
7827 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
7828 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
7829
7830 @smallexample
7831 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
7832 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
7833 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
7834 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
7835 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7836 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
7837 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
7838 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
7839 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
7840 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7841 End of assembler dump.
7842 @end smallexample
7843
7844 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
7845 program is stopped just after function prologue:
7846
7847 @smallexample
7848 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
7849 Dump of assembler code for function main:
7850 5 @{
7851 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
7852 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
7853 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
7854 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
7855 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
7856
7857 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
7858 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
7859 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
7860
7861 7 return 0;
7862 8 @}
7863 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
7864 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
7865 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
7866
7867 End of assembler dump.
7868 @end smallexample
7869
7870 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
7871
7872 @smallexample
7873 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
7874 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
7875 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
7876 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
7877 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
7878 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
7879 End of assembler dump.
7880 @end smallexample
7881
7882 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
7883 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
7884 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
7885 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
7886
7887 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
7888 mnemonics or other syntax.
7889
7890 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7891 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7892 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7893 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7894 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7895
7896 @table @code
7897 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7898 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7899 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7900 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7901 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7902 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7903
7904 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7905 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7906 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7907 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7908
7909 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7910 @item show disassembly-flavor
7911 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7912 @end table
7913
7914 @table @code
7915 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7916 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7917 @item set disassemble-next-line
7918 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7919 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7920 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7921 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7922 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7923 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7924 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7925 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7926 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7927 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7928 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7929 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7930 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7931 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7932 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7933 instruction.
7934 @end table
7935
7936
7937 @node Data
7938 @chapter Examining Data
7939
7940 @cindex printing data
7941 @cindex examining data
7942 @kindex print
7943 @kindex inspect
7944 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7945 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
7946 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
7947 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
7948 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
7949 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
7950
7951 @table @code
7952 @item print @var{expr}
7953 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
7954 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
7955 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
7956 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
7957 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
7958 Formats}.
7959
7960 @item print
7961 @itemx print /@var{f}
7962 @cindex reprint the last value
7963 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
7964 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
7965 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
7966 @end table
7967
7968 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
7969 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
7970 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7971
7972 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
7973 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
7974 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7975 Table}.
7976
7977 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
7978 @kindex explore
7979 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
7980 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
7981 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
7982 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
7983 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
7984 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
7985 embedded in the higher level data types.
7986
7987 @table @code
7988 @item explore @var{arg}
7989 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
7990 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
7991 @end table
7992
7993 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
7994 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
7995 C program as
7996
7997 @smallexample
7998 struct SimpleStruct
7999 @{
8000 int i;
8001 double d;
8002 @};
8003
8004 struct ComplexStruct
8005 @{
8006 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8007 int arr[10];
8008 @};
8009 @end smallexample
8010
8011 @noindent
8012 followed by variable declarations as
8013
8014 @smallexample
8015 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8016 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8017 @end smallexample
8018
8019 @noindent
8020 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8021 @code{explore} command as follows.
8022
8023 @smallexample
8024 (gdb) explore cs
8025 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8026 the following fields:
8027
8028 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8029 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8030
8031 Enter the field number of choice:
8032 @end smallexample
8033
8034 @noindent
8035 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8036 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8037 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8038 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8039 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8040 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8041 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8042 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8043
8044 @smallexample
8045 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8046 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8047 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8048 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8049
8050 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8051 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8052
8053 Press enter to return to parent value:
8054 @end smallexample
8055
8056 @noindent
8057 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8058 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8059 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8060 to explore.
8061
8062 @smallexample
8063 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8064 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8065
8066 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8067
8068 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8069
8070 Press enter to return to parent value:
8071 @end smallexample
8072
8073 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8074 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8075 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8076 level data structure).
8077
8078 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8079 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8080 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8081 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8082 same example as above, your can explore the type
8083 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8084 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8085
8086 @smallexample
8087 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8088 @end smallexample
8089
8090 @noindent
8091 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8092 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8093 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8094 example.
8095
8096 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8097 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8098 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8099 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8100 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8101
8102 @table @code
8103 @item explore value @var{expr}
8104 @cindex explore value
8105 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8106 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8107 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8108 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8109 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8110
8111 @item explore type @var{arg}
8112 @cindex explore type
8113 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8114 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8115 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8116 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8117 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8118 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8119 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8120 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8121 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8122 @end table
8123
8124 @menu
8125 * Expressions:: Expressions
8126 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8127 * Variables:: Program variables
8128 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8129 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8130 * Memory:: Examining memory
8131 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8132 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8133 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8134 * Value History:: Value history
8135 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8136 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8137 * Registers:: Registers
8138 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8139 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8140 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8141 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8142 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8143 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8144 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8145 character set than GDB does
8146 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8147 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8148 @end menu
8149
8150 @node Expressions
8151 @section Expressions
8152
8153 @cindex expressions
8154 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8155 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8156 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8157 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8158 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8159 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8160 @ref{Compilation}.
8161
8162 @cindex arrays in expressions
8163 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8164 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8165 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8166 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8167 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8168 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8169
8170 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8171 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8172 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8173 languages.
8174
8175 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8176 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8177
8178 @cindex casts, in expressions
8179 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8180 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8181 at that address in memory.
8182 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8183
8184 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8185 to programming languages:
8186
8187 @table @code
8188 @item @@
8189 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8190 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8191
8192 @item ::
8193 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8194 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8195
8196 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8197 @cindex type casting memory
8198 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8199 @cindex casts, to view memory
8200 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8201 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8202 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8203 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8204 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8205 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8206 @end table
8207
8208 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8209 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8210 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8211
8212 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8213 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8214 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8215 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8216 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8217 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8218 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8219
8220 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8221 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8222 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8223 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8224 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8225 as well.
8226
8227 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8228 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8229 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8230 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8231 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8232 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8233 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8234 choices.
8235
8236 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8237 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8238 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8239
8240 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8241 @smallexample
8242 @group
8243 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8244 [0] cancel
8245 [1] all
8246 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8247 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8248 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8249 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8250 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8251 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8252 > 2 4 6
8253 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8254 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8255 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8256 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8257 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8258 breakpoints.
8259 (@value{GDBP})
8260 @end group
8261 @end smallexample
8262
8263 @table @code
8264 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8265 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8266 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8267
8268 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8269 is ambiguous.
8270
8271 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8272 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8273 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8274 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8275 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8276 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8277 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8278 in the use of the menu.
8279
8280 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8281 when an ambiguity is detected.
8282
8283 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8284 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8285
8286 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8287 @item show multiple-symbols
8288 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8289 @end table
8290
8291 @node Variables
8292 @section Program Variables
8293
8294 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8295 in your program.
8296
8297 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8298 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8299
8300 @itemize @bullet
8301 @item
8302 global (or file-static)
8303 @end itemize
8304
8305 @noindent or
8306
8307 @itemize @bullet
8308 @item
8309 visible according to the scope rules of the
8310 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8311 @end itemize
8312
8313 @noindent This means that in the function
8314
8315 @smallexample
8316 foo (a)
8317 int a;
8318 @{
8319 bar (a);
8320 @{
8321 int b = test ();
8322 bar (b);
8323 @}
8324 @}
8325 @end smallexample
8326
8327 @noindent
8328 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8329 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8330 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8331 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8332
8333 @cindex variable name conflict
8334 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8335 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8336 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8337 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8338 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8339 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8340 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8341
8342 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8343 @ifnotinfo
8344 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8345 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8346 @end ifnotinfo
8347 @smallexample
8348 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8349 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8350 @end smallexample
8351
8352 @noindent
8353 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8354 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8355 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8356 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8357
8358 @smallexample
8359 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8360 @end smallexample
8361
8362 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8363 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8364 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8365 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8366 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8367
8368 @smallexample
8369 void
8370 foo (int a)
8371 @{
8372 if (a < 10)
8373 bar (a);
8374 else
8375 process (a); /* Stop here */
8376 @}
8377
8378 int
8379 bar (int a)
8380 @{
8381 foo (a + 5);
8382 @}
8383 @end smallexample
8384
8385 @noindent
8386 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8387 here is what you might see
8388 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8389
8390 @smallexample
8391 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8392 $1 = 10
8393 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8394 $2 = 5
8395 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8396 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8397 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8398 $3 = 5
8399 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8400 $4 = 0
8401 @end smallexample
8402
8403 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8404 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8405 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8406 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8407 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8408
8409 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8410 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8411 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8412 @code{some_global}.
8413
8414 @smallexample
8415 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8416 $1 = 23
8417 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8418 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8419 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8420 $2 = 27
8421 @end smallexample
8422
8423 @cindex wrong values
8424 @cindex variable values, wrong
8425 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8426 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8427 @quotation
8428 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8429 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8430 scope, and just before exit.
8431 @end quotation
8432 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8433 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8434 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8435 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8436 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8437 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8438 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8439 variable definitions may be gone.
8440
8441 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8442 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8443 when compiling.
8444
8445 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8446 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8447 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8448 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8449 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8450 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8451 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8452
8453 @smallexample
8454 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8455 @end smallexample
8456
8457 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8458 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8459 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8460 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8461 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8462
8463 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8464 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8465 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8466 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8467
8468 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8469 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8470 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8471 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8472 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8473
8474 @smallexample
8475 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8476 29 i++;
8477 (gdb) next
8478 30 e (i);
8479 (gdb) print i
8480 $1 = 31
8481 (gdb) print i@@entry
8482 $2 = 30
8483 @end smallexample
8484
8485 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8486 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8487 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8488 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8489 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8490 For program code
8491
8492 @smallexample
8493 char var0[] = "A";
8494 signed char var1[] = "A";
8495 @end smallexample
8496
8497 You get during debugging
8498 @smallexample
8499 (gdb) print var0
8500 $1 = "A"
8501 (gdb) print var1
8502 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8503 @end smallexample
8504
8505 @node Arrays
8506 @section Artificial Arrays
8507
8508 @cindex artificial array
8509 @cindex arrays
8510 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8511 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8512 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8513 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8514 program.
8515
8516 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8517 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8518 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8519 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8520 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8521 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8522 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8523 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8524 example. If a program says
8525
8526 @smallexample
8527 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8528 @end smallexample
8529
8530 @noindent
8531 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8532
8533 @smallexample
8534 p *array@@len
8535 @end smallexample
8536
8537 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8538 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8539 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8540 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8541 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8542
8543 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8544 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8545 The value need not be in memory:
8546 @smallexample
8547 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8548 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8549 @end smallexample
8550
8551 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8552 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8553 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8554 @smallexample
8555 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8556 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8557 @end smallexample
8558
8559 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8560 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8561 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8562 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8563 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8564 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8565 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8566 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8567 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8568 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8569
8570 @smallexample
8571 set $i = 0
8572 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8573 @key{RET}
8574 @key{RET}
8575 @dots{}
8576 @end smallexample
8577
8578 @node Output Formats
8579 @section Output Formats
8580
8581 @cindex formatted output
8582 @cindex output formats
8583 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8584 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8585 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8586 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8587 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8588
8589 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8590 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8591 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8592 letters supported are:
8593
8594 @table @code
8595 @item x
8596 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8597 hexadecimal.
8598
8599 @item d
8600 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8601
8602 @item u
8603 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8604
8605 @item o
8606 Print as integer in octal.
8607
8608 @item t
8609 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8610 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8611 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8612 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8613
8614 @item a
8615 @cindex unknown address, locating
8616 @cindex locate address
8617 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8618 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8619 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8620
8621 @smallexample
8622 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8623 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8624 @end smallexample
8625
8626 @noindent
8627 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8628 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8629
8630 @item c
8631 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8632 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8633 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8634 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8635
8636 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8637 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8638 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8639 data.
8640
8641 @item f
8642 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8643 using typical floating point syntax.
8644
8645 @item s
8646 @cindex printing strings
8647 @cindex printing byte arrays
8648 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8649 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8650 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8651 natural types.
8652
8653 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8654 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8655 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8656 array.
8657
8658 @item z
8659 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8660 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8661 to the size of the integer type.
8662
8663 @item r
8664 @cindex raw printing
8665 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8666 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8667 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8668 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8669 pretty-printer which might exist.
8670 @end table
8671
8672 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8673
8674 @smallexample
8675 p/x $pc
8676 @end smallexample
8677
8678 @noindent
8679 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8680 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8681
8682 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8683 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8684 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8685
8686 @node Memory
8687 @section Examining Memory
8688
8689 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8690 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8691
8692 @cindex examining memory
8693 @table @code
8694 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8695 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8696 @itemx x @var{addr}
8697 @itemx x
8698 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8699 @end table
8700
8701 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8702 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8703 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8704 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8705 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8706
8707 @table @r
8708 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8709 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8710 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8711 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8712 @c 4.1.2.
8713
8714 @item @var{f}, the display format
8715 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8716 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8717 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8718 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8719 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8720
8721 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8722 The unit size is any of
8723
8724 @table @code
8725 @item b
8726 Bytes.
8727 @item h
8728 Halfwords (two bytes).
8729 @item w
8730 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8731 @item g
8732 Giant words (eight bytes).
8733 @end table
8734
8735 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8736 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8737 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8738 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8739 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8740 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8741 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8742 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8743 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8744 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8745 be altered.
8746
8747 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8748 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8749 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8750 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8751 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8752 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8753 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8754 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8755 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8756 a value from memory).
8757 @end table
8758
8759 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8760 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8761 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8762 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8763 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8764
8765 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8766 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8767 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8768 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8769 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8770
8771 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8772 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8773 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8774 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8775 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8776 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8777 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8778 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8779 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8780
8781 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8782 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8783 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8784 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8785 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8786 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8787 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8788
8789 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8790 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8791
8792 @smallexample
8793 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8794 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8795 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8796 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8797 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8798 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8799 @end smallexample
8800
8801 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8802 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8803 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8804 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8805 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8806 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8807 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8808 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8809 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8810
8811 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8812 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8813 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8814
8815 @cindex remote memory comparison
8816 @cindex target memory comparison
8817 @cindex verify remote memory image
8818 @cindex verify target memory image
8819 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
8820 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
8821 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
8822 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
8823 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
8824 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
8825
8826 @table @code
8827 @kindex compare-sections
8828 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
8829 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
8830 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
8831 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
8832 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
8833 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
8834
8835 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
8836 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
8837 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
8838 @end table
8839
8840 @node Auto Display
8841 @section Automatic Display
8842 @cindex automatic display
8843 @cindex display of expressions
8844
8845 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
8846 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
8847 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
8848 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
8849 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
8850 The automatic display looks like this:
8851
8852 @smallexample
8853 2: foo = 38
8854 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
8855 @end smallexample
8856
8857 @noindent
8858 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
8859 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
8860 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
8861 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
8862 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
8863 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
8864
8865 @table @code
8866 @kindex display
8867 @item display @var{expr}
8868 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
8869 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8870
8871 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8872
8873 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
8874 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
8875 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
8876 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
8877 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
8878
8879 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
8880 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
8881 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
8882 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
8883 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8884 @end table
8885
8886 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
8887 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
8888 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8889
8890 @table @code
8891 @kindex delete display
8892 @kindex undisplay
8893 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
8894 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8895 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
8896 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
8897 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
8898 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
8899 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8900
8901 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8902 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
8903
8904 @kindex disable display
8905 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8906 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
8907 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
8908 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
8909 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
8910 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
8911 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
8912 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8913
8914 @kindex enable display
8915 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8916 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
8917 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
8918 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
8919 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
8920 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
8921 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8922
8923 @item display
8924 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
8925 done when your program stops.
8926
8927 @kindex info display
8928 @item info display
8929 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
8930 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
8931 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
8932 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
8933 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
8934 @end table
8935
8936 @cindex display disabled out of scope
8937 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
8938 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
8939 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
8940 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
8941 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
8942 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
8943 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
8944 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
8945 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
8946 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
8947
8948 @node Print Settings
8949 @section Print Settings
8950
8951 @cindex format options
8952 @cindex print settings
8953 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
8954 and symbols are printed.
8955
8956 @noindent
8957 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
8958
8959 @table @code
8960 @kindex set print
8961 @item set print address
8962 @itemx set print address on
8963 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
8964 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
8965 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
8966 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
8967 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
8968 @code{set print address on}:
8969
8970 @smallexample
8971 @group
8972 (@value{GDBP}) f
8973 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
8974 at input.c:530
8975 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8976 @end group
8977 @end smallexample
8978
8979 @item set print address off
8980 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
8981 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
8982
8983 @smallexample
8984 @group
8985 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
8986 (@value{GDBP}) f
8987 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
8988 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8989 @end group
8990 @end smallexample
8991
8992 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
8993 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
8994 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
8995 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
8996
8997 @kindex show print
8998 @item show print address
8999 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9000 @end table
9001
9002 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9003 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9004 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9005 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9006 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9007 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9008 it prints a symbolic address:
9009
9010 @table @code
9011 @item set print symbol-filename on
9012 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9013 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9014 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9015 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9016
9017 @item set print symbol-filename off
9018 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9019 default.
9020
9021 @item show print symbol-filename
9022 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9023 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9024 @end table
9025
9026 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9027 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9028 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9029
9030 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9031 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9032
9033 @table @code
9034 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9035 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9036 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9037 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9038 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9039 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9040 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9041 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9042
9043 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9044 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9045 symbolic address.
9046 @end table
9047
9048 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9049 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9050 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9051 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9052 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9053 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9054 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9055 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9056
9057 @smallexample
9058 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9059 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9060 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9061 @end smallexample
9062
9063 @quotation
9064 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9065 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9066 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9067 @end quotation
9068
9069 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9070 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9071
9072 @table @code
9073 @item set print symbol on
9074 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9075 one exists.
9076
9077 @item set print symbol off
9078 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9079 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9080 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9081
9082 @item show print symbol
9083 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9084 address.
9085 @end table
9086
9087 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9088
9089 @table @code
9090 @item set print array
9091 @itemx set print array on
9092 @cindex pretty print arrays
9093 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9094 but uses more space. The default is off.
9095
9096 @item set print array off
9097 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9098
9099 @item show print array
9100 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9101 arrays.
9102
9103 @cindex print array indexes
9104 @item set print array-indexes
9105 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9106 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9107 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9108 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9109
9110 @item set print array-indexes off
9111 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9112
9113 @item show print array-indexes
9114 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9115 arrays.
9116
9117 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9118 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9119 @cindex number of array elements to print
9120 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9121 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9122 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9123 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9124 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9125 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9126 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9127 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9128
9129 @item show print elements
9130 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9131 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9132
9133 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9134 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9135 @cindex printing frame argument values
9136 @cindex print all frame argument values
9137 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9138 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9139 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9140 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9141 values are:
9142
9143 @table @code
9144 @item all
9145 The values of all arguments are printed.
9146
9147 @item scalars
9148 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9149 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9150 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9151 only scalar arguments are shown:
9152
9153 @smallexample
9154 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9155 at frame-args.c:23
9156 @end smallexample
9157
9158 @item none
9159 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9160 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9161
9162 @smallexample
9163 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9164 at frame-args.c:23
9165 @end smallexample
9166 @end table
9167
9168 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9169 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9170 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9171 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9172 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9173 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9174 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9175 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9176 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9177 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9178
9179 @item show print frame-arguments
9180 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9181
9182 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9183 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9184
9185 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9186 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9187 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9188 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9189 This is the default.
9190
9191 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9192 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9193
9194 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9195 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9196 @kindex set print entry-values
9197 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9198 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9199 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9200 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9201 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9202
9203 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9204 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9205 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9206 @code{no} setting.
9207
9208 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9209 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9210 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9211 this information.
9212
9213 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9214
9215 @table @code
9216 @item no
9217 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9218 point.
9219 @smallexample
9220 #0 equal (val=5)
9221 #0 different (val=6)
9222 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9223 #0 born (val=10)
9224 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9225 @end smallexample
9226
9227 @item only
9228 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9229 values are never printed.
9230 @smallexample
9231 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9232 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9233 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9234 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9235 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9236 @end smallexample
9237
9238 @item preferred
9239 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9240 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9241 value for such parameter.
9242 @smallexample
9243 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9244 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9245 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9246 #0 born (val=10)
9247 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9248 @end smallexample
9249
9250 @item if-needed
9251 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9252 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9253 parameter.
9254 @smallexample
9255 #0 equal (val=5)
9256 #0 different (val=6)
9257 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9258 #0 born (val=10)
9259 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9260 @end smallexample
9261
9262 @item both
9263 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9264 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9265 optimizations.
9266 @smallexample
9267 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9268 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9269 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9270 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9271 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9272 @end smallexample
9273
9274 @item compact
9275 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9276 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9277 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9278 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9279 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9280 @smallexample
9281 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9282 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9283 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9284 #0 born (val=10)
9285 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9286 @end smallexample
9287
9288 @item default
9289 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9290 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9291 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9292 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9293 @smallexample
9294 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9295 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9296 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9297 #0 born (val=10)
9298 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9299 @end smallexample
9300 @end table
9301
9302 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9303 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9304
9305 @item show print entry-values
9306 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9307 entry.
9308
9309 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9310 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9311 @cindex repeated array elements
9312 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9313 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9314 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9315 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9316 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9317 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9318 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9319 is 10.
9320
9321 @item show print repeats
9322 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9323 elements.
9324
9325 @item set print null-stop
9326 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9327 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9328 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9329 contain only short strings.
9330 The default is off.
9331
9332 @item show print null-stop
9333 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9334 @sc{null} character.
9335
9336 @item set print pretty on
9337 @cindex print structures in indented form
9338 @cindex indentation in structure display
9339 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9340 per line, like this:
9341
9342 @smallexample
9343 @group
9344 $1 = @{
9345 next = 0x0,
9346 flags = @{
9347 sweet = 1,
9348 sour = 1
9349 @},
9350 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9351 @}
9352 @end group
9353 @end smallexample
9354
9355 @item set print pretty off
9356 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9357
9358 @smallexample
9359 @group
9360 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9361 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9362 @end group
9363 @end smallexample
9364
9365 @noindent
9366 This is the default format.
9367
9368 @item show print pretty
9369 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9370
9371 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9372 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9373 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9374 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9375 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9376 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9377 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9378 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9379
9380 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9381 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9382 international character sets, and is the default.
9383
9384 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9385 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9386
9387 @item set print union on
9388 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9389 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9390 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9391
9392 @item set print union off
9393 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9394 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9395 instead.
9396
9397 @item show print union
9398 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9399 structures and other unions.
9400
9401 For example, given the declarations
9402
9403 @smallexample
9404 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9405 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9406 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9407 Bug_forms;
9408
9409 struct thing @{
9410 Species it;
9411 union @{
9412 Tree_forms tree;
9413 Bug_forms bug;
9414 @} form;
9415 @};
9416
9417 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9418 @end smallexample
9419
9420 @noindent
9421 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9422
9423 @smallexample
9424 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9425 @end smallexample
9426
9427 @noindent
9428 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9429
9430 @smallexample
9431 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9432 @end smallexample
9433
9434 @noindent
9435 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9436 and in Pascal.
9437 @end table
9438
9439 @need 1000
9440 @noindent
9441 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9442
9443 @table @code
9444 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9445 @item set print demangle
9446 @itemx set print demangle on
9447 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9448 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9449 linkage. The default is on.
9450
9451 @item show print demangle
9452 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9453
9454 @item set print asm-demangle
9455 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9456 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9457 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9458 The default is off.
9459
9460 @item show print asm-demangle
9461 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9462 or demangled form.
9463
9464 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9465 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9466 @kindex set demangle-style
9467 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9468 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9469 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9470
9471 @table @code
9472 @item auto
9473 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9474 This is the default.
9475
9476 @item gnu
9477 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9478
9479 @item hp
9480 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9481
9482 @item lucid
9483 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9484
9485 @item arm
9486 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9487 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9488 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9489 require further enhancement to permit that.
9490
9491 @end table
9492 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9493
9494 @item show demangle-style
9495 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9496
9497 @item set print object
9498 @itemx set print object on
9499 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9500 @cindex display derived types
9501 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9502 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9503 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9504 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9505 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9506 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9507 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9508
9509 @item set print object off
9510 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9511 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9512
9513 @item show print object
9514 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9515
9516 @item set print static-members
9517 @itemx set print static-members on
9518 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9519 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9520
9521 @item set print static-members off
9522 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9523
9524 @item show print static-members
9525 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9526
9527 @item set print pascal_static-members
9528 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9529 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9530 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9531 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9532
9533 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9534 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9535
9536 @item show print pascal_static-members
9537 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9538
9539 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9540 @item set print vtbl
9541 @itemx set print vtbl on
9542 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9543 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9544 @cindex VTBL display
9545 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9546 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9547 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9548
9549 @item set print vtbl off
9550 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9551
9552 @item show print vtbl
9553 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9554 @end table
9555
9556 @node Pretty Printing
9557 @section Pretty Printing
9558
9559 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9560 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9561 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9562
9563 @menu
9564 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9565 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9566 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9567 @end menu
9568
9569 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9570 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9571
9572 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9573 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9574 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9575
9576 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9577 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9578 pretty-printers with their names.
9579 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9580 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9581 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9582 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9583
9584 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9585 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9586 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9587 do anything special.
9588
9589 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9590
9591 @itemize @bullet
9592 @item
9593 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9594 all inferiors.
9595
9596 @item
9597 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9598 when debugging that program.
9599 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9600
9601 @item
9602 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9603 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9604 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9605 @end itemize
9606
9607 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9608 pretty-printers are selected,
9609
9610 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9611 for new types.
9612
9613 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9614 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9615
9616 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9617
9618 @smallexample
9619 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9620 $1 = @{
9621 static npos = 4294967295,
9622 _M_dataplus = @{
9623 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9624 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9625 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9626 @},
9627 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9628 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9629 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9630 @}
9631 @}
9632 @end smallexample
9633
9634 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9635
9636 @smallexample
9637 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9638 $2 = "abcd"
9639 @end smallexample
9640
9641 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9642 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9643 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9644
9645 @table @code
9646 @kindex info pretty-printer
9647 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9648 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9649 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9650
9651 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9652 whose pretty-printers to list.
9653 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9654 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9655 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9656 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9657 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9658
9659 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9660 to list.
9661
9662 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9663 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9664 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9665 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9666
9667 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9668 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9669 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9670 @end table
9671
9672 Example:
9673
9674 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9675 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9676 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9677 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9678
9679 @smallexample
9680 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9681 library1.so:
9682 foo
9683 library2.so:
9684 bar
9685 bar1
9686 bar2
9687 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9688 library2.so:
9689 bar
9690 bar1
9691 bar2
9692 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9693 1 printer disabled
9694 2 of 3 printers enabled
9695 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9696 library1.so:
9697 foo [disabled]
9698 library2.so:
9699 bar
9700 bar1
9701 bar2
9702 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9703 1 printer disabled
9704 1 of 3 printers enabled
9705 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9706 library1.so:
9707 foo [disabled]
9708 library2.so:
9709 bar
9710 bar1 [disabled]
9711 bar2
9712 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9713 1 printer disabled
9714 0 of 3 printers enabled
9715 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9716 library1.so:
9717 foo [disabled]
9718 library2.so:
9719 bar [disabled]
9720 bar1 [disabled]
9721 bar2
9722 @end smallexample
9723
9724 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9725 as can each individual subprinter.
9726
9727 @node Value History
9728 @section Value History
9729
9730 @cindex value history
9731 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9732 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9733 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9734 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9735 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9736 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9737 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9738 symbol table.
9739
9740 @cindex @code{$}
9741 @cindex @code{$$}
9742 @cindex history number
9743 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9744 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9745 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9746 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9747 history number.
9748
9749 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9750 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9751 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9752 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9753 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9754 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9755 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9756
9757 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9758 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9759
9760 @smallexample
9761 p *$
9762 @end smallexample
9763
9764 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9765 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9766
9767 @smallexample
9768 p *$.next
9769 @end smallexample
9770
9771 @noindent
9772 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9773 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9774
9775 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9776 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9777
9778 @smallexample
9779 print x
9780 set x=5
9781 @end smallexample
9782
9783 @noindent
9784 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9785 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9786
9787 @table @code
9788 @kindex show values
9789 @item show values
9790 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9791 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9792 values} does not change the history.
9793
9794 @item show values @var{n}
9795 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9796
9797 @item show values +
9798 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9799 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9800 @end table
9801
9802 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9803 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9804
9805 @node Convenience Vars
9806 @section Convenience Variables
9807
9808 @cindex convenience variables
9809 @cindex user-defined variables
9810 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9811 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9812 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9813 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9814 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9815
9816 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9817 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
9818 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9819 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
9820 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
9821
9822 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
9823 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
9824 For example:
9825
9826 @smallexample
9827 set $foo = *object_ptr
9828 @end smallexample
9829
9830 @noindent
9831 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
9832 @code{object_ptr}.
9833
9834 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
9835 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
9836 value with another assignment at any time.
9837
9838 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
9839 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
9840 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
9841 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
9842
9843 @table @code
9844 @kindex show convenience
9845 @cindex show all user variables and functions
9846 @item show convenience
9847 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
9848 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
9849 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
9850
9851 @kindex init-if-undefined
9852 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
9853 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
9854 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
9855 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
9856 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
9857 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
9858 override default values used in a command script.
9859
9860 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
9861 any side-effects do not occur.
9862 @end table
9863
9864 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
9865 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
9866 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
9867
9868 @smallexample
9869 set $i = 0
9870 print bar[$i++]->contents
9871 @end smallexample
9872
9873 @noindent
9874 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
9875
9876 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
9877 values likely to be useful.
9878
9879 @table @code
9880 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
9881 @item $_
9882 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
9883 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
9884 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
9885 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
9886 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
9887 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
9888 to the type of @code{$__}.
9889
9890 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
9891 @item $__
9892 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
9893 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
9894 to match the format in which the data was printed.
9895
9896 @item $_exitcode
9897 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
9898 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
9899 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
9900 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
9901
9902 @item $_exitsignal
9903 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
9904 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
9905 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
9906 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
9907
9908 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
9909 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
9910 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
9911 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
9912 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
9913
9914 @smallexample
9915 #include <signal.h>
9916
9917 int
9918 main (int argc, char *argv[])
9919 @{
9920 raise (SIGALRM);
9921 return 0;
9922 @}
9923 @end smallexample
9924
9925 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
9926 or signalled would be:
9927
9928 @smallexample
9929 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
9930 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
9931 End with a line saying just ``end''.
9932 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
9933 >echo The program has exited\n
9934 >else
9935 >echo The program has signalled\n
9936 >end
9937 >end
9938 (@value{GDBP}) run
9939 Starting program:
9940
9941 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
9942 The program no longer exists.
9943 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9944 The program has signalled
9945 @end smallexample
9946
9947 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
9948 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
9949 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
9950 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
9951
9952 @smallexample
9953 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9954 The program has exited
9955 @end smallexample
9956
9957 @item $_exception
9958 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
9959 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
9960
9961 @item $_probe_argc
9962 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
9963 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
9964
9965 @item $_sdata
9966 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
9967 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
9968 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
9969 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
9970 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
9971
9972 @item $_siginfo
9973 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
9974 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
9975 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
9976 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
9977 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
9978
9979 @item $_tlb
9980 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
9981 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
9982 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
9983 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
9984 @xref{General Query Packets}.
9985 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
9986
9987 @end table
9988
9989 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9990 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9991 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9992
9993 @node Convenience Funs
9994 @section Convenience Functions
9995
9996 @cindex convenience functions
9997 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
9998 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
9999 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10000 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10001 @value{GDBN}.
10002
10003 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10004 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10005
10006 @table @code
10007
10008 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10009 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10010 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10011 returns zero.
10012
10013 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10014 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10015 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10016 it is @code{void}:
10017
10018 @smallexample
10019 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10020 $1 = void
10021 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10022 $2 = 1
10023 (@value{GDBP}) run
10024 Starting program: ./a.out
10025 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10026 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10027 $3 = 0
10028 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10029 $4 = 0
10030 @end smallexample
10031
10032 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10033 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10034 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10035 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10036 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10037 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10038 anymore.
10039
10040 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10041 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10042
10043 @smallexample
10044 void
10045 foo (void)
10046 @{
10047 @}
10048 @end smallexample
10049
10050 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10051
10052 @smallexample
10053 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10054 $1 = void
10055 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10056 $2 = 1
10057 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10058 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10059 $3 = void
10060 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10061 $4 = 1
10062 @end smallexample
10063
10064 @end table
10065
10066 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10067 @code{Python} support.
10068
10069 @table @code
10070
10071 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10072 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10073 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10074 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10075 Otherwise it returns zero.
10076
10077 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10078 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10079 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10080 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10081 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10082 regular expression support.
10083
10084 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10085 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10086 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10087 Otherwise it returns zero.
10088
10089 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10090 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10091 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10092
10093 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10094 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10095 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10096 Otherwise it returns zero.
10097
10098 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10099 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10100 The default is 1.
10101
10102 Example:
10103
10104 @smallexample
10105 (gdb) backtrace
10106 #0 bottom_func ()
10107 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10108 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10109 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10110 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10111 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10112 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10113 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10114 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10115 $1 = 1
10116 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10117 $1 = 1
10118 @end smallexample
10119
10120 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10121 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10122 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10123 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10124
10125 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10126 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10127 The default is 1.
10128
10129 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10130 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10131 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10132 Otherwise it returns zero.
10133
10134 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10135 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10136 The default is 1.
10137
10138 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10139 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10140 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10141 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10142
10143 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10144 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10145 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10146 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10147
10148 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10149 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10150 The default is 1.
10151
10152 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10153 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10154 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10155 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10156
10157 @end table
10158
10159 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10160 convenience functions.
10161
10162 @table @code
10163 @item help function
10164 @kindex help function
10165 @cindex show all convenience functions
10166 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10167 @end table
10168
10169 @node Registers
10170 @section Registers
10171
10172 @cindex registers
10173 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10174 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10175 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10176 your machine.
10177
10178 @table @code
10179 @kindex info registers
10180 @item info registers
10181 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10182 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10183
10184 @kindex info all-registers
10185 @cindex floating point registers
10186 @item info all-registers
10187 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10188 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10189
10190 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10191 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10192 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10193 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10194 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10195 @end table
10196
10197 @cindex stack pointer register
10198 @cindex program counter register
10199 @cindex process status register
10200 @cindex frame pointer register
10201 @cindex standard registers
10202 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10203 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10204 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10205 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10206 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10207 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10208 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10209 you could print the program counter in hex with
10210
10211 @smallexample
10212 p/x $pc
10213 @end smallexample
10214
10215 @noindent
10216 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10217
10218 @smallexample
10219 x/i $pc
10220 @end smallexample
10221
10222 @noindent
10223 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10224 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10225 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10226 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10227 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10228 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10229 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10230
10231 @smallexample
10232 set $sp += 4
10233 @end smallexample
10234
10235 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10236 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10237 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10238 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10239 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10240 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10241 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10242
10243 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10244 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10245 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10246 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10247 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10248 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10249 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10250
10251 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10252 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10253 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10254 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10255 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10256 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10257 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10258 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10259 prints the data in both formats.
10260
10261 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10262 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10263 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10264 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10265 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10266 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10267 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10268
10269 @smallexample
10270 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10271 $1 = @{
10272 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10273 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10274 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10275 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10276 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10277 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10278 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10279 @}
10280 @end smallexample
10281
10282 @noindent
10283 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10284 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10285 value to a @code{struct} member:
10286
10287 @smallexample
10288 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10289 @end smallexample
10290
10291 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10292 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10293 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10294 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10295 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10296 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10297
10298 @cindex caller-saved registers
10299 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10300 @cindex volatile registers
10301 @cindex <not saved> values
10302 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10303 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10304 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10305 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10306 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10307 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10308 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10309 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10310 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10311 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10312 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10313 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10314 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10315 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10316 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10317 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10318 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10319 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10320 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10321 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10322 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10323 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10324 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10325
10326 @node Floating Point Hardware
10327 @section Floating Point Hardware
10328 @cindex floating point
10329
10330 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10331 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10332
10333 @table @code
10334 @kindex info float
10335 @item info float
10336 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10337 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10338 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10339 the ARM and x86 machines.
10340 @end table
10341
10342 @node Vector Unit
10343 @section Vector Unit
10344 @cindex vector unit
10345
10346 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10347 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10348
10349 @table @code
10350 @kindex info vector
10351 @item info vector
10352 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10353 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10354 @end table
10355
10356 @node OS Information
10357 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10358 @cindex OS information
10359
10360 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10361 you debug your program.
10362
10363 @cindex auxiliary vector
10364 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10365 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10366 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10367 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10368 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10369 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10370 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10371 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10372 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10373 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10374 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10375 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10376
10377 @table @code
10378 @kindex info auxv
10379 @item info auxv
10380 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10381 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10382 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10383 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10384 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10385 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10386 an unrecognized tag.
10387 @end table
10388
10389 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10390 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10391 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10392 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10393 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10394 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10395 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10396
10397 @table @code
10398 @kindex info os
10399 @item info os @var{infotype}
10400
10401 Display OS information of the requested type.
10402
10403 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10404
10405 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10406 @table @code
10407 @kindex info os processes
10408 @item processes
10409 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10410 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10411 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10412 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10413 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10414 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10415
10416 @kindex info os procgroups
10417 @item procgroups
10418 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10419 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10420 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10421 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10422 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10423 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10424 and the process group leader is listed first.
10425
10426 @kindex info os threads
10427 @item threads
10428 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10429 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10430 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10431 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10432 process is not listed.
10433
10434 @kindex info os files
10435 @item files
10436 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10437 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10438 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10439 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10440
10441 @kindex info os sockets
10442 @item sockets
10443 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10444 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10445 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10446 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10447 connection.
10448
10449 @kindex info os shm
10450 @item shm
10451 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10452 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10453 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10454 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10455 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10456 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10457 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10458
10459 @kindex info os semaphores
10460 @item semaphores
10461 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10462 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10463 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10464 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10465 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10466
10467 @kindex info os msg
10468 @item msg
10469 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10470 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10471 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10472 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10473 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10474 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10475 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10476 the message queue was last changed.
10477
10478 @kindex info os modules
10479 @item modules
10480 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10481 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10482 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10483 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10484 in memory.
10485 @end table
10486
10487 @item info os
10488 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10489 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10490 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10491 types, this command will report an error.
10492 @end table
10493
10494 @node Memory Region Attributes
10495 @section Memory Region Attributes
10496 @cindex memory region attributes
10497
10498 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10499 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10500 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10501 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10502 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10503 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10504 user can override the fetched regions.
10505
10506 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10507 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10508 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10509 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10510 all memory.
10511
10512 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10513 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10514
10515 @table @code
10516 @kindex mem
10517 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10518 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10519 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10520 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10521 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10522 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10523
10524 @item mem auto
10525 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10526 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10527
10528 @kindex delete mem
10529 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10530 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10531 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10532
10533 @kindex disable mem
10534 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10535 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10536 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10537 It may be enabled again later.
10538
10539 @kindex enable mem
10540 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10541 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10542
10543 @kindex info mem
10544 @item info mem
10545 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10546 for each region:
10547
10548 @table @emph
10549 @item Memory Region Number
10550 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10551 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10552 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10553
10554 @item Lo Address
10555 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10556
10557 @item Hi Address
10558 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10559
10560 @item Attributes
10561 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10562 @end table
10563 @end table
10564
10565
10566 @subsection Attributes
10567
10568 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10569 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10570 write accesses to a memory region.
10571
10572 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10573 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10574 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10575
10576 @table @code
10577 @item ro
10578 Memory is read only.
10579 @item wo
10580 Memory is write only.
10581 @item rw
10582 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10583 @end table
10584
10585 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10586 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10587 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10588 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10589 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10590
10591 @table @code
10592 @item 8
10593 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10594 @item 16
10595 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10596 @item 32
10597 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10598 @item 64
10599 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10600 @end table
10601
10602 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10603 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10604 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10605 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10606 @c
10607 @c @table @code
10608 @c @item hwbreak
10609 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10610 @c @item swbreak (default)
10611 @c @end table
10612
10613 @subsubsection Data Cache
10614 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10615 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10616 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10617 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10618 registers.
10619
10620 @table @code
10621 @item cache
10622 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10623 @item nocache
10624 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10625 @end table
10626
10627 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10628 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10629 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10630 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10631 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10632
10633 @table @code
10634 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10635 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10636 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10637 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10638 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10639 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10640 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10641 The default value is @code{on}.
10642 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10643 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10644 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10645 @end table
10646
10647
10648 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10649 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10650 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10651 @c
10652 @c @table @code
10653 @c @item verify
10654 @c @item noverify (default)
10655 @c @end table
10656
10657 @node Dump/Restore Files
10658 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10659 @cindex dump/restore files
10660 @cindex append data to a file
10661 @cindex dump data to a file
10662 @cindex restore data from a file
10663
10664 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10665 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10666 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10667 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10668 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10669 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10670 files.
10671
10672 @table @code
10673
10674 @kindex dump
10675 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10676 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10677 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10678 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10679
10680 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10681 @table @code
10682 @item binary
10683 Raw binary form.
10684 @item ihex
10685 Intel hex format.
10686 @item srec
10687 Motorola S-record format.
10688 @item tekhex
10689 Tektronix Hex format.
10690 @end table
10691
10692 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10693 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10694 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10695 form.
10696
10697 @kindex append
10698 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10699 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10700 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10701 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10702 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10703
10704 @kindex restore
10705 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10706 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10707 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10708 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10709 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10710
10711 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10712 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10713 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10714 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10715 from that location.
10716
10717 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10718 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10719 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10720 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10721
10722 @end table
10723
10724 @node Core File Generation
10725 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10726 @cindex dump core from inferior
10727
10728 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10729 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10730 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10731 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10732 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10733 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10734 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10735
10736 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10737 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10738 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10739
10740 @table @code
10741 @kindex gcore
10742 @kindex generate-core-file
10743 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10744 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10745 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10746 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10747 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10748 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10749
10750 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10751 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10752 @end table
10753
10754 @node Character Sets
10755 @section Character Sets
10756 @cindex character sets
10757 @cindex charset
10758 @cindex translating between character sets
10759 @cindex host character set
10760 @cindex target character set
10761
10762 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10763 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
10764 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
10765 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
10766 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
10767 @dfn{target character set}.
10768
10769 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
10770 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
10771 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
10772 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
10773 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
10774 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
10775 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
10776 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
10777 character and string literals in expressions.
10778
10779 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
10780 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
10781 target-charset} command, described below.
10782
10783 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
10784 support:
10785
10786 @table @code
10787 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
10788 @kindex set target-charset
10789 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
10790 list of supported target character sets, type
10791 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10792
10793 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
10794 @kindex set host-charset
10795 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
10796
10797 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10798 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10799 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10800 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10801 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10802
10803 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10804 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10805 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10806
10807 @item set charset @var{charset}
10808 @kindex set charset
10809 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10810 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10811 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10812 for both host and target.
10813
10814 @item show charset
10815 @kindex show charset
10816 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
10817
10818 @item show host-charset
10819 @kindex show host-charset
10820 Show the name of the current host character set.
10821
10822 @item show target-charset
10823 @kindex show target-charset
10824 Show the name of the current target character set.
10825
10826 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
10827 @kindex set target-wide-charset
10828 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
10829 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
10830 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
10831 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10832
10833 @item show target-wide-charset
10834 @kindex show target-wide-charset
10835 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
10836 @end table
10837
10838 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
10839 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
10840 @file{charset-test.c}:
10841
10842 @smallexample
10843 #include <stdio.h>
10844
10845 char ascii_hello[]
10846 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
10847 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
10848 char ibm1047_hello[]
10849 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
10850 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
10851
10852 main ()
10853 @{
10854 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10855 @}
10856 @end smallexample
10857
10858 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
10859 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
10860 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
10861
10862 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
10863
10864 @smallexample
10865 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
10866 $ gdb -nw charset-test
10867 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
10868 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10869 @dots{}
10870 (@value{GDBP})
10871 @end smallexample
10872
10873 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
10874 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
10875 strings:
10876
10877 @smallexample
10878 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10879 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
10880 (@value{GDBP})
10881 @end smallexample
10882
10883 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
10884 initial character set:
10885 @smallexample
10886 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
10887 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10888 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
10889 (@value{GDBP})
10890 @end smallexample
10891
10892 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
10893 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
10894 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
10895 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
10896 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
10897
10898 @smallexample
10899 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10900 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
10901 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10902 $2 = 72 'H'
10903 (@value{GDBP})
10904 @end smallexample
10905
10906 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
10907 literals you use in expressions:
10908
10909 @smallexample
10910 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10911 $3 = 43 '+'
10912 (@value{GDBP})
10913 @end smallexample
10914
10915 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
10916 character.
10917
10918 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
10919 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
10920 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
10921
10922 @smallexample
10923 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10924 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
10925 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10926 $5 = 200 '\310'
10927 (@value{GDBP})
10928 @end smallexample
10929
10930 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
10931 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
10932
10933 @smallexample
10934 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10935 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
10936 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10937 @end smallexample
10938
10939 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
10940 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
10941 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
10942 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
10943 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
10944
10945 @smallexample
10946 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
10947 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10948 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
10949 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
10950 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10951 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
10952 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10953 $7 = 72 '\110'
10954 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10955 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
10956 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10957 $9 = 200 'H'
10958 (@value{GDBP})
10959 @end smallexample
10960
10961 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
10962 string literals you use in expressions:
10963
10964 @smallexample
10965 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10966 $10 = 78 '+'
10967 (@value{GDBP})
10968 @end smallexample
10969
10970 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
10971 character.
10972
10973 @node Caching Target Data
10974 @section Caching Data of Targets
10975 @cindex caching data of targets
10976
10977 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
10978 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
10979 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
10980 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
10981 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
10982 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
10983 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
10984 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
10985 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
10986 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
10987 is executing.
10988 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
10989 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
10990 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
10991 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
10992 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
10993 in the code segment.
10994 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
10995 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
10996
10997 @table @code
10998 @kindex set remotecache
10999 @item set remotecache on
11000 @itemx set remotecache off
11001 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11002 with old scripts.
11003
11004 @kindex show remotecache
11005 @item show remotecache
11006 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11007
11008 @kindex set stack-cache
11009 @item set stack-cache on
11010 @itemx set stack-cache off
11011 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11012 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11013
11014 @kindex show stack-cache
11015 @item show stack-cache
11016 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11017
11018 @kindex set code-cache
11019 @item set code-cache on
11020 @itemx set code-cache off
11021 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11022 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11023 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11024
11025 @kindex show code-cache
11026 @item show code-cache
11027 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11028 accesses.
11029
11030 @kindex info dcache
11031 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11032 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11033 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11034 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11035 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11036 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11037
11038 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11039 printed in hex.
11040
11041 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11042 @cindex dcache size
11043 @kindex set dcache size
11044 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11045
11046 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11047 @cindex dcache line-size
11048 @kindex set dcache line-size
11049 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11050 Must be a power of 2.
11051
11052 @item show dcache size
11053 @kindex show dcache size
11054 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11055
11056 @item show dcache line-size
11057 @kindex show dcache line-size
11058 Show default size of dcache lines.
11059
11060 @end table
11061
11062 @node Searching Memory
11063 @section Search Memory
11064 @cindex searching memory
11065
11066 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11067 @code{find} command.
11068
11069 @table @code
11070 @kindex find
11071 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11072 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11073 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11074 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11075 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11076 @end table
11077
11078 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11079 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11080
11081 @table @r
11082 @item @var{s}, search query size
11083 The size of each search query value.
11084
11085 @table @code
11086 @item b
11087 bytes
11088 @item h
11089 halfwords (two bytes)
11090 @item w
11091 words (four bytes)
11092 @item g
11093 giant words (eight bytes)
11094 @end table
11095
11096 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11097 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11098 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11099
11100 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11101 value's type in the current language.
11102 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11103 pattern as a mixture of types.
11104 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11105 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11106 which is typically four bytes.
11107
11108 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11109 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11110 @end table
11111
11112 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11113 (@code{"}).
11114 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11115 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11116
11117 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11118 number of matches found.
11119
11120 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11121 @samp{$_}.
11122 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11123
11124 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11125
11126 @smallexample
11127 void
11128 hello ()
11129 @{
11130 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11131 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11132 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11133 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11134 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11135 @}
11136 @end smallexample
11137
11138 @noindent
11139 you get during debugging:
11140
11141 @smallexample
11142 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11143 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11144 1 pattern found
11145 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11146 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11147 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11148 2 patterns found
11149 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11150 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11151 1 pattern found
11152 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11153 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11154 1 pattern found
11155 (gdb) print $numfound
11156 $1 = 1
11157 (gdb) print $_
11158 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11159 @end smallexample
11160
11161 @node Optimized Code
11162 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11163 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11164 @cindex debugging optimized code
11165
11166 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11167 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11168 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11169 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11170 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11171 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11172 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11173
11174 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11175 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11176 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11177 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11178
11179 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11180 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11181 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11182 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11183 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11184 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11185
11186 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11187 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11188 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11189 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11190 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11191
11192 @menu
11193 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11194 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11195 @end menu
11196
11197 @node Inline Functions
11198 @section Inline Functions
11199 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11200
11201 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11202 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11203 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11204 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11205 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11206 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11207 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11208 @code{info frame} command.
11209
11210 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11211 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11212 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11213 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11214 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11215 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11216 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11217 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11218 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11219 local variables in the caller.
11220
11221 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11222 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11223 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11224 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11225 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11226 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11227 instructions are executed.
11228
11229 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11230 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11231 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11232 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11233
11234 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11235 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11236
11237 @itemize @bullet
11238 @item
11239 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11240 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11241 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11242 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11243 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11244 or inside the inlined function instead.
11245
11246 @item
11247 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11248 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11249 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11250 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11251
11252 @end itemize
11253
11254 @node Tail Call Frames
11255 @section Tail Call Frames
11256 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11257
11258 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11259 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11260 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11261 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11262 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11263
11264 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11265 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11266 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11267 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11268 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11269 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11270 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11271
11272 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11273 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11274 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11275 this information.
11276
11277 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11278 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11279
11280 @smallexample
11281 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11282 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11283 (gdb) info frame
11284 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11285 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11286 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11287 source language c++.
11288 Arglist at unknown address.
11289 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11290 @end smallexample
11291
11292 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11293 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11294 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11295 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11296 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11297 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11298
11299 @table @code
11300 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11301 @item set debug entry-values
11302 @kindex set debug entry-values
11303 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11304 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11305 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11306 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11307 result.
11308
11309 @item show debug entry-values
11310 @kindex show debug entry-values
11311 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11312 values at function entry and tail calls.
11313 @end table
11314
11315 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11316 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11317 reference by variable @code{x}):
11318
11319 @smallexample
11320 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11321 void (*x) (void) = c;
11322 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11323 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11324 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11325
11326 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11327 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11328 a () at t.c:3
11329 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11330 (gdb) bt
11331 #0 a () at t.c:3
11332 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11333 @end smallexample
11334
11335 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11336
11337 @smallexample
11338 int i;
11339 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11340 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11341 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11342 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11343 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11344 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11345 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11346 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11347
11348 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11349 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11350 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11351 (gdb) bt
11352 #0 f () at t.c:2
11353 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11354 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11355 @end smallexample
11356
11357 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11358 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11359
11360 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11361 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11362 @set ARROW @click{}
11363 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11364 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11365 @end ifset
11366 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11367 @set ARROW ->
11368 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11369 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11370 @end ifclear
11371
11372 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11373 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11374 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11375
11376 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11377 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11378 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11379 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11380 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11381 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11382
11383 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11384 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11385 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11386 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11387 omitted.
11388
11389 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11390 entry may fail:
11391
11392 @smallexample
11393 int v;
11394 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11395 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11396 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11397 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11398 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11399 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11400
11401 (gdb) bt
11402 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11403 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11404 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11405 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11406 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11407 @end smallexample
11408
11409 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11410 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11411 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11412 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11413 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11414
11415 @node Macros
11416 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11417
11418 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11419 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11420 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11421 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11422 where it was defined.
11423
11424 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11425 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11426 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11427 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11428
11429 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11430 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11431 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11432 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11433 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11434 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11435 see @ref{List}.
11436
11437 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11438 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11439 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11440
11441 @table @code
11442
11443 @kindex macro expand
11444 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11445 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11446 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11447 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11448 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11449 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11450 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11451 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11452 it can be any string of tokens.
11453
11454 @kindex macro exp1
11455 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11456 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11457 @cindex expand macro once
11458 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11459 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11460 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11461 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11462 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11463 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11464 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11465 can be any string of tokens.
11466
11467 @kindex info macro
11468 @cindex macro definition, showing
11469 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11470 @cindex macros, from debug info
11471 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11472 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11473 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11474 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11475 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11476 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11477
11478 @kindex info macros
11479 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11480 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11481 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11482 command-line where those definitions were established.
11483
11484 @kindex macro define
11485 @cindex user-defined macros
11486 @cindex defining macros interactively
11487 @cindex macros, user-defined
11488 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11489 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11490 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11491 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11492 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11493 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11494 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11495 @var{arglist}.
11496
11497 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11498 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11499 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11500 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11501 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11502
11503 @kindex macro undef
11504 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11505 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11506 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11507 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11508 in the program being debugged.
11509
11510 @kindex macro list
11511 @item macro list
11512 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11513 @end table
11514
11515 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11516 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11517 show our source files:
11518
11519 @smallexample
11520 $ cat sample.c
11521 #include <stdio.h>
11522 #include "sample.h"
11523
11524 #define M 42
11525 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11526
11527 main ()
11528 @{
11529 #define N 28
11530 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11531 #undef N
11532 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11533 #define N 1729
11534 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11535 @}
11536 $ cat sample.h
11537 #define Q <
11538 $
11539 @end smallexample
11540
11541 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11542 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11543 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11544 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11545 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11546 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11547 information.
11548
11549 @smallexample
11550 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11551 $
11552 @end smallexample
11553
11554 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11555
11556 @smallexample
11557 $ gdb -nw sample
11558 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11559 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11560 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11561 (@value{GDBP})
11562 @end smallexample
11563
11564 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11565 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11566 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11567
11568 @smallexample
11569 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11570 3
11571 4 #define M 42
11572 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11573 6
11574 7 main ()
11575 8 @{
11576 9 #define N 28
11577 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11578 11 #undef N
11579 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11580 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11581 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11582 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11583 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11584 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11585 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11586 #define Q <
11587 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11588 expands to: (42 + 1)
11589 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11590 expands to: once (M + 1)
11591 (@value{GDBP})
11592 @end smallexample
11593
11594 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11595 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11596 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11597 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11598
11599 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11600 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11601
11602 @smallexample
11603 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11604 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11605 (@value{GDBP}) run
11606 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11607
11608 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11609 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11610 (@value{GDBP})
11611 @end smallexample
11612
11613 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11614
11615 @smallexample
11616 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11617 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11618 #define N 28
11619 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11620 expands to: 28 < 42
11621 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11622 $1 = 1
11623 (@value{GDBP})
11624 @end smallexample
11625
11626 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11627 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11628 thereof) in force at each point:
11629
11630 @smallexample
11631 (@value{GDBP}) next
11632 Hello, world!
11633 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11634 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11635 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11636 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11637 (@value{GDBP}) next
11638 We're so creative.
11639 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11640 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11641 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11642 #define N 1729
11643 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11644 expands to: 1729 < 42
11645 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11646 $2 = 0
11647 (@value{GDBP})
11648 @end smallexample
11649
11650 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11651 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11652 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11653 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11654
11655 @smallexample
11656 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11657 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11658 -D__STDC__=1
11659 (@value{GDBP})
11660 @end smallexample
11661
11662
11663 @node Tracepoints
11664 @chapter Tracepoints
11665 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11666 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11667
11668 @cindex tracepoints
11669 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11670 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11671 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11672 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11673 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11674 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11675 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11676
11677 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11678 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11679 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11680 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11681 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11682 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11683 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11684 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11685 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11686 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11687 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11688
11689 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11690 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11691 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11692 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11693 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11694 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11695 Packets}.
11696
11697 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11698 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11699 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11700
11701 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11702
11703 @menu
11704 * Set Tracepoints::
11705 * Analyze Collected Data::
11706 * Tracepoint Variables::
11707 * Trace Files::
11708 @end menu
11709
11710 @node Set Tracepoints
11711 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11712
11713 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11714 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11715 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11716 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11717 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11718 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11719 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11720
11721 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11722 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11723 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11724 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11725 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11726 tracepoint was hit.
11727
11728 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11729 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11730 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11731 either.
11732
11733 @cindex fast tracepoints
11734 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11735 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11736 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11737
11738 @cindex static tracepoints
11739 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11740 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11741 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11742 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11743 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11744 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11745 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11746 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11747 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11748 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11749 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11750 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11751 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11752 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11753 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11754 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11755 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11756 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11757 static tracepoint marker.
11758
11759 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11760 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11761
11762 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11763 conditions and actions.
11764
11765 @menu
11766 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
11767 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
11768 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
11769 * Tracepoint Conditions::
11770 * Trace State Variables::
11771 * Tracepoint Actions::
11772 * Listing Tracepoints::
11773 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
11774 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
11775 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
11776 @end menu
11777
11778 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
11779 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
11780
11781 @table @code
11782 @cindex set tracepoint
11783 @kindex trace
11784 @item trace @var{location}
11785 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
11786 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
11787 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
11788 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
11789 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
11790 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
11791 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
11792 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
11793 in tracing}).
11794 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
11795 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
11796 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
11797 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
11798 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
11799 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
11800 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
11801 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
11802 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
11803 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
11804 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
11805 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
11806
11807 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
11808
11809 @smallexample
11810 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
11811
11812 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11813
11814 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11815
11816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
11817
11818 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
11819 @end smallexample
11820
11821 @noindent
11822 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
11823
11824 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
11825 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
11826 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
11827 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
11828 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
11829 information on tracepoint conditions.
11830
11831 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11832 @cindex set fast tracepoint
11833 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
11834 @kindex ftrace
11835 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
11836 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
11837 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
11838 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
11839 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
11840 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
11841 message.
11842
11843 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
11844 @code{trace}.
11845
11846 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
11847 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
11848 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
11849 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
11850 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
11851 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
11852 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
11853 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
11854
11855 @example
11856 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
11857 @end example
11858
11859 @noindent
11860 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
11861 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
11862
11863 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11864 @cindex set static tracepoint
11865 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
11866 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
11867 @kindex strace
11868 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
11869 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
11870 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
11871 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
11872 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
11873
11874 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
11875 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
11876 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
11877 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
11878 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
11879 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
11880 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
11881 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
11882 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
11883 tracing engine:
11884
11885 @smallexample
11886 main ()
11887 @{
11888 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
11889 @}
11890 @end smallexample
11891
11892 @noindent
11893 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
11894 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
11895
11896 @smallexample
11897 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11898 Cnt Enb ID Address What
11899 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
11900 Data: "str %s"
11901 [etc...]
11902 @end smallexample
11903
11904 @noindent
11905 so you may probe the marker above with:
11906
11907 @smallexample
11908 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
11909 @end smallexample
11910
11911 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
11912 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
11913 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
11914 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
11915 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
11916 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
11917 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
11918 the @samp{Data:} field.
11919
11920 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
11921 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
11922 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
11923
11924 @vindex $tpnum
11925 @cindex last tracepoint number
11926 @cindex recent tracepoint number
11927 @cindex tracepoint number
11928 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
11929 of the most recently set tracepoint.
11930
11931 @kindex delete tracepoint
11932 @cindex tracepoint deletion
11933 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11934 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
11935 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
11936 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
11937
11938 Examples:
11939
11940 @smallexample
11941 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
11942
11943 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
11944 @end smallexample
11945
11946 @noindent
11947 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
11948 @end table
11949
11950 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11951 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11952
11953 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
11954
11955 @table @code
11956 @kindex disable tracepoint
11957 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11958 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
11959 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
11960 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
11961 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
11962 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
11963 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
11964 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
11965 next trace experiment.
11966
11967 @kindex enable tracepoint
11968 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11969 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
11970 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
11971 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
11972 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
11973 next time a trace experiment is run.
11974 @end table
11975
11976 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
11977 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
11978
11979 @table @code
11980 @kindex passcount
11981 @cindex tracepoint pass count
11982 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
11983 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
11984 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
11985 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
11986 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
11987 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
11988 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
11989 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
11990 user.
11991
11992 Examples:
11993
11994 @smallexample
11995 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
11996 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
11997
11998 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
11999 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12000 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12001 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12002 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12003 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12004 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12005 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12006 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12007 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12008 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12009 @end smallexample
12010 @end table
12011
12012 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12013 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12014 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12015 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12016
12017 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12018 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12019 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12020 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12021 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12022 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12023 is true.
12024
12025 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12026 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12027 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12028 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12029 just as with breakpoints.
12030
12031 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12032 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12033 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12034 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12035 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12036 accesses, and so forth.
12037
12038 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12039 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12040 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12041 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12042 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12043 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12044 search through.
12045
12046 @smallexample
12047 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12048 @end smallexample
12049
12050 @node Trace State Variables
12051 @subsection Trace State Variables
12052 @cindex trace state variables
12053
12054 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12055 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12056 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12057 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12058 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12059 integers.
12060
12061 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12062 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12063 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12064 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12065
12066 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12067 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12068 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12069 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12070 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12071 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12072 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12073 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12074 variable with the same name.
12075
12076 @table @code
12077
12078 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12079 @kindex tvariable
12080 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12081 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12082 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12083 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12084 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12085 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12086 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12087 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12088 value. The default initial value is 0.
12089
12090 @item info tvariables
12091 @kindex info tvariables
12092 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12093 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12094 currently running.
12095
12096 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12097 @kindex delete tvariable
12098 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12099 are specified.
12100
12101 @end table
12102
12103 @node Tracepoint Actions
12104 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12105
12106 @table @code
12107 @kindex actions
12108 @cindex tracepoint actions
12109 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12110 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12111 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12112 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12113 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12114 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12115 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12116 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12117 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12118 @code{while-stepping}.
12119
12120 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12121 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12122 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12123
12124 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12125 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12126 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12127
12128 @smallexample
12129 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12130
12131 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12132
12133 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12134 @end smallexample
12135
12136 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12137 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12138 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12139 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12140 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12141 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12142 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12143 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12144
12145 @smallexample
12146 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12147 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12148 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12149 > collect bar,baz
12150 > collect $regs
12151 > while-stepping 12
12152 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12153 > end
12154 end
12155 @end smallexample
12156
12157 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12158 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12159 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12160 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12161 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12162 special arguments are supported:
12163
12164 @table @code
12165 @item $regs
12166 Collect all registers.
12167
12168 @item $args
12169 Collect all function arguments.
12170
12171 @item $locals
12172 Collect all local variables.
12173
12174 @item $_ret
12175 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12176 of a backtrace.
12177
12178 @item $_probe_argc
12179 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12180 tracepoint is located.
12181 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12182
12183 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12184 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12185 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12186 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12187
12188 @item $_sdata
12189 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12190 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12191 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12192 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12193 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12194 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12195 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12196 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12197 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12198
12199 @smallexample
12200 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12201 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12202 @end smallexample
12203
12204 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12205 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12206 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12207 @value{GDBN}.
12208 @end table
12209
12210 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12211 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12212 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12213
12214 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12215 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12216 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12217 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12218 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12219 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12220 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12221 @samp{mystr}.
12222
12223 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12224 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12225
12226 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12227 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12228 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12229 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12230 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12231 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12232 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12233 action were used.
12234
12235 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12236 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12237 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12238 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12239 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12240 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12241
12242 @smallexample
12243 > while-stepping 12
12244 > collect $regs, myglobal
12245 > end
12246 >
12247 @end smallexample
12248
12249 @noindent
12250 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12251 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12252 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12253 @code{stepping}.
12254
12255 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12256 @kindex set default-collect
12257 @cindex default collection action
12258 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12259 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12260 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12261 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12262 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12263 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12264
12265 @item show default-collect
12266 @kindex show default-collect
12267 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12268 tracepoint hit.
12269
12270 @end table
12271
12272 @node Listing Tracepoints
12273 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12274
12275 @table @code
12276 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12277 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12278 @cindex information about tracepoints
12279 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12280 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12281 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12282 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12283 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12284 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12285
12286 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12287 tracing:
12288
12289 @itemize @bullet
12290 @item
12291 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12292
12293 @item
12294 the state about installed on target of each location
12295 @end itemize
12296
12297 @smallexample
12298 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12299 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12300 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12301 while-stepping 20
12302 collect globfoo, $regs
12303 end
12304 collect globfoo2
12305 end
12306 pass count 1200
12307 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12308 collect $eip
12309 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12310 installed on target
12311 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12312 installed on target
12313 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12314 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12315 not installed on target
12316 (@value{GDBP})
12317 @end smallexample
12318
12319 @noindent
12320 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12321 @end table
12322
12323 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12324 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12325
12326 @table @code
12327 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12328 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12329 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12330 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12331 program.
12332
12333 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12334
12335 @table @emph
12336 @item Count
12337 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12338 stable identifier.
12339 @item ID
12340 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12341 @item Enabled or Disabled
12342 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12343 that are not enabled.
12344 @item Address
12345 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12346 @item What
12347 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12348 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12349 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12350 will be left blank.
12351 @end table
12352
12353 @noindent
12354 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12355
12356 @table @emph
12357 @item Data
12358 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12359 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12360 marker call.
12361 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12362 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12363 @end table
12364
12365 @smallexample
12366 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12367 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12368 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12369 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12370 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12371 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12372 Data: str %s
12373 (@value{GDBP})
12374 @end smallexample
12375 @end table
12376
12377 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12378 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12379
12380 @table @code
12381 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12382 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12383 @cindex collected data discarded
12384 @item tstart
12385 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12386 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12387 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12388 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12389 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12390 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12391 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12392 information, and so forth.
12393
12394 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12395 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12396 @item tstop
12397 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12398 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12399 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12400 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12401 needs to be stopped quickly.
12402
12403 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12404 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12405 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12406
12407 @kindex tstatus
12408 @cindex status of trace data collection
12409 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12410 @item tstatus
12411 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12412 collection.
12413 @end table
12414
12415 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12416
12417 @smallexample
12418 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12419 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12420 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12421 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12422 > while-stepping 11
12423 > collect $regs
12424 > end
12425 > end
12426 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12427 [time passes @dots{}]
12428 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12429 @end smallexample
12430
12431 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12432 @cindex disconnected tracing
12433 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12434 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12435 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12436 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12437 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12438 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12439 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12440 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12441
12442 @table @code
12443 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12444 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12445 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12446 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12447 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12448 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12449 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12450 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12451
12452 @item show disconnected-tracing
12453 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12454 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12455
12456 @end table
12457
12458 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12459 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12460 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12461 it will continue after reconnection.
12462
12463 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12464 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12465 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12466 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12467 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12468 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12469 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12470 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12471 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12472 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12473
12474 @cindex circular trace buffer
12475 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12476 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12477 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12478 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12479 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12480 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12481 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12482 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12483 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12484 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12485 the next run.
12486
12487 @table @code
12488 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12489 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12490 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12491 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12492 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12493 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12494 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12495
12496 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12497 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12498 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12499 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12500 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12501 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12502
12503 @end table
12504
12505 @table @code
12506 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12507 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12508 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12509 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12510 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12511 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12512 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12513 likes. This is also the default.
12514
12515 @item show trace-buffer-size
12516 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12517 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12518 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12519 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12520 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12521 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12522 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12523 @end table
12524
12525 @table @code
12526 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12527 @kindex set trace-user
12528
12529 @item show trace-user
12530 @kindex show trace-user
12531
12532 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12533 @kindex set trace-notes
12534 Set the trace run's notes.
12535
12536 @item show trace-notes
12537 @kindex show trace-notes
12538 Show the trace run's notes.
12539
12540 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12541 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12542 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12543 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12544 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12545
12546 @item show trace-stop-notes
12547 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12548 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12549
12550 @end table
12551
12552 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12553 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12554
12555 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12556 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12557 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12558 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12559 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12560 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12561 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12562 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12563 mentioned here.
12564
12565 @itemize @bullet
12566
12567 @item
12568 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12569 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12570 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12571 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12572 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12573 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12574 cannot be collected either.
12575
12576 @item
12577 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12578 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12579 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12580 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12581 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12582 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12583 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12584 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12585 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12586 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12587
12588 @item
12589 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12590 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12591 in a misleading way.
12592
12593 @item
12594 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12595 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12596 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12597 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12598 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12599 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12600 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12601 by @code{ptr}.
12602
12603 @item
12604 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12605 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12606 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12607 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12608 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12609 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12610 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12611 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12612 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12613 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12614 invalid address.
12615
12616 @item
12617 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12618 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12619 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12620 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12621 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12622 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12623 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12624 it to zero.
12625
12626 @end itemize
12627
12628 @node Analyze Collected Data
12629 @section Using the Collected Data
12630
12631 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12632 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12633 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12634 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12635 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12636 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12637 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12638 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12639 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12640 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12641 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12642 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12643 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12644 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12645 the buffer will fail.
12646
12647 @menu
12648 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12649 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12650 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12651 @end menu
12652
12653 @node tfind
12654 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12655
12656 @kindex tfind
12657 @cindex select trace snapshot
12658 @cindex find trace snapshot
12659 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12660 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12661 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12662 snapshot is selected.
12663
12664 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12665
12666 @table @code
12667 @item tfind start
12668 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12669 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12670
12671 @item tfind none
12672 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12673
12674 @item tfind end
12675 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12676
12677 @item tfind
12678 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12679
12680 @item tfind -
12681 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12682 retracing earlier steps.
12683
12684 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12685 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12686 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12687 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12688 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12689
12690 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12691 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12692 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12693 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12694 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12695
12696 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12697 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12698 addresses (exclusive).
12699
12700 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12701 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12702 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12703
12704 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12705 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12706 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12707 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12708 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12709 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12710 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12711 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12712 @end table
12713
12714 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12715 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12716 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12717 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12718 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12719 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12720 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12721 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12722 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12723 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12724 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12725 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12726 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12727 tracepoint as the current one.
12728
12729 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12730 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12731 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12732 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12733 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12734
12735 @smallexample
12736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12737 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12738 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12739 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12740 > tfind
12741 > end
12742
12743 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12744 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12745 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12746 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12747 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12748 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12749 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12750 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12751 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12752 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12753 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12754 @end smallexample
12755
12756 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12757 the buffer:
12758
12759 @smallexample
12760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12762 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12763 > tfind line
12764 > end
12765
12766 Frame 0, X = 1
12767 Frame 7, X = 2
12768 Frame 13, X = 255
12769 @end smallexample
12770
12771 @node tdump
12772 @subsection @code{tdump}
12773 @kindex tdump
12774 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
12775 @cindex tracepoint data, display
12776
12777 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
12778 the current trace snapshot.
12779
12780 @smallexample
12781 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
12782 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12783 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
12784 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
12785 > end
12786
12787 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12788
12789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
12790 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
12791 at gdb_test.c:444
12792 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
12793
12794 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
12795 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
12796 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
12797 d1 0x18 24
12798 d2 0x80 128
12799 d3 0x33 51
12800 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
12801 d5 0x22 34
12802 d6 0xe0 224
12803 d7 0x380035 3670069
12804 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
12805 a1 0x3000668 50333288
12806 a2 0x100 256
12807 a3 0x322000 3284992
12808 a4 0x3000698 50333336
12809 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
12810 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
12811 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
12812 ps 0x0 0
12813 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
12814 fpcontrol 0x0 0
12815 fpstatus 0x0 0
12816 fpiaddr 0x0 0
12817 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
12818 p1 = (void *) 0x11
12819 p2 = (void *) 0x22
12820 p3 = (void *) 0x33
12821 p4 = (void *) 0x44
12822 p5 = (void *) 0x55
12823 p6 = (void *) 0x66
12824 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
12825
12826 (@value{GDBP})
12827 @end smallexample
12828
12829 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
12830 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
12831 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
12832 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
12833
12834 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
12835 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
12836 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
12837 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
12838 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
12839 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
12840 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
12841 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
12842 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
12843 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
12844
12845 @node save tracepoints
12846 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
12847 @kindex save tracepoints
12848 @kindex save-tracepoints
12849 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
12850
12851 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
12852 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
12853 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
12854 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
12855 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
12856 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
12857
12858 @node Tracepoint Variables
12859 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
12860 @cindex tracepoint variables
12861 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
12862
12863 @table @code
12864 @vindex $trace_frame
12865 @item (int) $trace_frame
12866 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
12867 snapshot is selected.
12868
12869 @vindex $tracepoint
12870 @item (int) $tracepoint
12871 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
12872
12873 @vindex $trace_line
12874 @item (int) $trace_line
12875 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
12876
12877 @vindex $trace_file
12878 @item (char []) $trace_file
12879 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
12880
12881 @vindex $trace_func
12882 @item (char []) $trace_func
12883 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
12884 @end table
12885
12886 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
12887 use @code{output} instead.
12888
12889 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
12890 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
12891 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
12892 which are managed by the target.
12893
12894 @smallexample
12895 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12896
12897 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
12898 > output $trace_file
12899 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
12900 > tfind
12901 > end
12902 @end smallexample
12903
12904 @node Trace Files
12905 @section Using Trace Files
12906 @cindex trace files
12907
12908 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
12909 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
12910 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
12911 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
12912 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
12913
12914 @table @code
12915
12916 @kindex tsave
12917 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
12918 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
12919 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
12920 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
12921 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
12922 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
12923 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
12924 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
12925 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
12926 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
12927 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
12928 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
12929 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
12930 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
12931 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
12932
12933 @kindex target tfile
12934 @kindex tfile
12935 @kindex target ctf
12936 @kindex ctf
12937 @item target tfile @var{filename}
12938 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
12939 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
12940 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
12941 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
12942 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
12943 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
12944 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
12945 the host.
12946
12947 @smallexample
12948 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
12949 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
12950 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
12951 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
12952 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
12953 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
12954 i = 0
12955 a = 0
12956 b = 1 '\001'
12957 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
12958 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
12959 (@value{GDBP}) p b
12960 $1 = 1
12961 @end smallexample
12962
12963 @end table
12964
12965 @node Overlays
12966 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
12967 @cindex overlays
12968
12969 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
12970 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
12971 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
12972 use overlays.
12973
12974 @menu
12975 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
12976 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
12977 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
12978 mapped by asking the inferior.
12979 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
12980 @end menu
12981
12982 @node How Overlays Work
12983 @section How Overlays Work
12984 @cindex mapped overlays
12985 @cindex unmapped overlays
12986 @cindex load address, overlay's
12987 @cindex mapped address
12988 @cindex overlay area
12989
12990 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
12991 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
12992 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
12993 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
12994 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
12995
12996 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
12997 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
12998 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
12999 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13000 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13001 largest overlay as well.
13002
13003 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13004 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13005 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13006 there.
13007
13008 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13009 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13010 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13011
13012 @smallexample
13013 @group
13014 Data Instruction Larger
13015 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13016 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13017 | | | | | |
13018 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13019 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13020 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13021 | and heap | | | | | |
13022 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13023 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13024 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13025 | | | | | |
13026 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13027 address | | | | | |
13028 | overlay | <-' | | |
13029 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13030 | | <---. | | load address
13031 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13032 | | | |
13033 +-----------+ | |
13034 +-----------+
13035 | |
13036 +-----------+
13037
13038 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13039 @end group
13040 @end smallexample
13041
13042 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13043 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13044 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13045 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13046 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13047 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13048 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13049 program and the overlay area.
13050
13051 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13052 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13053 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13054 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13055 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13056 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13057 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13058
13059 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13060 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13061 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13062
13063 @itemize @bullet
13064
13065 @item
13066 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13067 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13068 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13069 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13070
13071 @item
13072 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13073 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13074 your program's performance.
13075
13076 @item
13077 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13078 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13079 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13080 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13081 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13082 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13083 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13084
13085 @item
13086 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13087 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13088 instruction and data spaces.
13089
13090 @end itemize
13091
13092 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13093 improved in many ways:
13094
13095 @itemize @bullet
13096
13097 @item
13098 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13099 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13100 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13101 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13102 area in the usual way.
13103
13104 @item
13105 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13106 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13107
13108 @item
13109 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13110 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13111 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13112 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13113 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13114 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13115 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13116
13117 @end itemize
13118
13119
13120 @node Overlay Commands
13121 @section Overlay Commands
13122
13123 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13124 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13125 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13126 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13127 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13128 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13129
13130 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13131 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13132
13133 @table @code
13134 @item overlay off
13135 @kindex overlay
13136 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13137 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13138 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13139 overlay support is disabled.
13140
13141 @item overlay manual
13142 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13143 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13144 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13145 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13146 commands described below.
13147
13148 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13149 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13150 @cindex map an overlay
13151 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13152 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13153 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13154 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13155 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13156 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13157
13158 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13159 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13160 @cindex unmap an overlay
13161 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13162 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13163 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13164 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13165
13166 @item overlay auto
13167 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13168 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13169 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13170 Overlay Debugging}.
13171
13172 @item overlay load-target
13173 @itemx overlay load
13174 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13175 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13176 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13177 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13178 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13179 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13180
13181 @item overlay list-overlays
13182 @itemx overlay list
13183 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13184 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13185 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13186
13187 @end table
13188
13189 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13190 of the function the address falls in:
13191
13192 @smallexample
13193 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13194 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13195 @end smallexample
13196 @noindent
13197 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13198 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13199 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13200 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13201
13202 @smallexample
13203 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13204 No sections are mapped.
13205 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13206 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13207 @end smallexample
13208 @noindent
13209 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13210 name normally:
13211
13212 @smallexample
13213 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13214 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13215 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13216 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13217 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13218 @end smallexample
13219
13220 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13221 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13222 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13223 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13224 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13225
13226 @itemize @bullet
13227 @item
13228 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13229 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13230 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13231 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13232 @item
13233 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13234 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13235 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13236 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13237 breakpoints properly.
13238 @end itemize
13239
13240
13241 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13242 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13243 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13244
13245 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13246 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13247 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13248 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13249 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13250 current state of the overlays.
13251
13252 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13253 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13254
13255 @table @asis
13256
13257 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13258 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13259
13260 @smallexample
13261 struct
13262 @{
13263 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13264 unsigned long vma;
13265
13266 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13267 unsigned long size;
13268
13269 /* The overlay's load address. */
13270 unsigned long lma;
13271
13272 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13273 zero otherwise. */
13274 unsigned long mapped;
13275 @}
13276 @end smallexample
13277
13278 @item @code{_novlys}:
13279 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13280 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13281
13282 @end table
13283
13284 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13285 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13286 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13287 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13288 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13289 currently mapped.
13290
13291 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13292 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13293 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13294 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13295 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13296 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13297 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13298 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13299 are not being executed.
13300
13301 @node Overlay Sample Program
13302 @section Overlay Sample Program
13303 @cindex overlay example program
13304
13305 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13306 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13307 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13308 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13309 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13310 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13311 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13312
13313 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13314 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13315 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13316 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13317
13318 @table @file
13319 @item overlays.c
13320 The main program file.
13321 @item ovlymgr.c
13322 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13323 @item foo.c
13324 @itemx bar.c
13325 @itemx baz.c
13326 @itemx grbx.c
13327 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13328 @item d10v.ld
13329 @itemx m32r.ld
13330 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13331 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13332 @end table
13333
13334 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13335 cross-compiler like this:
13336
13337 @smallexample
13338 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13339 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13340 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13341 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13342 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13343 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13344 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13345 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13346 @end smallexample
13347
13348 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13349 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13350 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13351
13352
13353 @node Languages
13354 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13355 @cindex languages
13356
13357 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13358 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13359 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13360 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13361 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13362 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13363
13364 @cindex working language
13365 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13366 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13367 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13368 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13369 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13370 language}.
13371
13372 @menu
13373 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13374 * Show:: Displaying the language
13375 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13376 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13377 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13378 @end menu
13379
13380 @node Setting
13381 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13382
13383 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13384 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13385 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13386 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13387 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13388 are printed, etc.
13389
13390 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13391 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13392 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13393 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13394 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13395 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13396 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13397 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13398 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13399 Displaying the Language}.
13400
13401 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13402 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13403 another language. In that case, make the
13404 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13405 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13406 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13407
13408 @menu
13409 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13410 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13411 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13412 @end menu
13413
13414 @node Filenames
13415 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13416
13417 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13418 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13419
13420 @table @file
13421 @item .ada
13422 @itemx .ads
13423 @itemx .adb
13424 @itemx .a
13425 Ada source file.
13426
13427 @item .c
13428 C source file
13429
13430 @item .C
13431 @itemx .cc
13432 @itemx .cp
13433 @itemx .cpp
13434 @itemx .cxx
13435 @itemx .c++
13436 C@t{++} source file
13437
13438 @item .d
13439 D source file
13440
13441 @item .m
13442 Objective-C source file
13443
13444 @item .f
13445 @itemx .F
13446 Fortran source file
13447
13448 @item .mod
13449 Modula-2 source file
13450
13451 @item .s
13452 @itemx .S
13453 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13454 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13455 @end table
13456
13457 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13458 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13459
13460 @node Manually
13461 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13462
13463 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13464 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13465 your program.
13466
13467 @kindex set language
13468 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13469 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13470 a language, such as
13471 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13472 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13473
13474 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13475 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13476 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13477 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13478 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13479 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13480 command such as:
13481
13482 @smallexample
13483 print a = b + c
13484 @end smallexample
13485
13486 @noindent
13487 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13488 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13489 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13490 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13491
13492 @node Automatically
13493 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13494
13495 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13496 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13497 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13498 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13499 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13500 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13501 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13502 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13503 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13504
13505 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13506 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13507 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13508 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13509 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13510
13511 @node Show
13512 @section Displaying the Language
13513
13514 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13515 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13516
13517 @table @code
13518 @item show language
13519 @anchor{show language}
13520 @kindex show language
13521 Display the current working language. This is the
13522 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13523 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13524
13525 @item info frame
13526 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13527 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13528 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13529 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13530 information listed here.
13531
13532 @item info source
13533 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13534 Display the source language of this source file.
13535 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13536 information listed here.
13537 @end table
13538
13539 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13540 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13541 with a language explicitly:
13542
13543 @table @code
13544 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13545 @kindex set extension-language
13546 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13547 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13548
13549 @item info extensions
13550 @kindex info extensions
13551 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13552 @end table
13553
13554 @node Checks
13555 @section Type and Range Checking
13556
13557 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13558 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13559 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13560 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13561 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13562 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13563 errors when your program is running.
13564
13565 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13566 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13567 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13568 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13569
13570 @menu
13571 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13572 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13573 @end menu
13574
13575 @cindex type checking
13576 @cindex checks, type
13577 @node Type Checking
13578 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13579
13580 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13581 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13582 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13583 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13584
13585 @smallexample
13586 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13587
13588 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13589 $1 = 2
13590 @exdent but
13591 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13592 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13593 @end smallexample
13594
13595 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13596 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13597
13598 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13599 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13600 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13601 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13602 expressions like the second example above.
13603
13604 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13605 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13606 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13607 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13608 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13609 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13610
13611 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13612
13613 @kindex set check type
13614 @kindex show check type
13615 @table @code
13616 @item set check type on
13617 @itemx set check type off
13618 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13619 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13620 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13621
13622 @item show check type
13623 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13624 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13625 @end table
13626
13627 @cindex range checking
13628 @cindex checks, range
13629 @node Range Checking
13630 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13631
13632 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13633 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13634 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13635 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13636 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13637
13638 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13639 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13640 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13641 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13642
13643 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13644 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13645 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13646 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13647 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13648 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13649
13650 @smallexample
13651 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13652 @end smallexample
13653
13654 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13655 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13656 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13657
13658 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13659
13660 @kindex set check range
13661 @kindex show check range
13662 @table @code
13663 @item set check range auto
13664 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13665 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13666 each language.
13667
13668 @item set check range on
13669 @itemx set check range off
13670 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13671 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13672 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13673 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13674
13675 @item set check range warn
13676 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13677 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13678 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13679 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13680 systems).
13681
13682 @item show range
13683 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13684 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13685 @end table
13686
13687 @node Supported Languages
13688 @section Supported Languages
13689
13690 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13691 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13692 @c This is false ...
13693 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13694 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13695 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13696 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13697 language.
13698
13699 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13700 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13701 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13702 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13703 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13704 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13705 language reference or tutorial.
13706
13707 @menu
13708 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13709 * D:: D
13710 * Go:: Go
13711 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13712 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13713 * Fortran:: Fortran
13714 * Pascal:: Pascal
13715 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13716 * Ada:: Ada
13717 @end menu
13718
13719 @node C
13720 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13721
13722 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13723 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13724
13725 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13726 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13727 together.
13728
13729 @cindex C@t{++}
13730 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13731 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13732 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13733 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13734 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13735 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13736 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13737
13738 @menu
13739 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13740 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13741 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13742 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13743 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13744 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13745 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13746 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13747 @end menu
13748
13749 @node C Operators
13750 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13751
13752 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13753
13754 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13755 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13756 often defined on groups of types.
13757
13758 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13759
13760 @itemize @bullet
13761
13762 @item
13763 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
13764 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
13765
13766 @item
13767 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
13768 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
13769
13770 @item
13771 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
13772
13773 @item
13774 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
13775
13776 @end itemize
13777
13778 @noindent
13779 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
13780 in order of increasing precedence:
13781
13782 @table @code
13783 @item ,
13784 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
13785 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
13786 expression being the last expression evaluated.
13787
13788 @item =
13789 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
13790 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
13791
13792 @item @var{op}=
13793 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
13794 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
13795 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
13796 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
13797 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
13798
13799 @item ?:
13800 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
13801 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
13802 should be of an integral type.
13803
13804 @item ||
13805 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13806
13807 @item &&
13808 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13809
13810 @item |
13811 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13812
13813 @item ^
13814 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13815
13816 @item &
13817 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13818
13819 @item ==@r{, }!=
13820 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
13821 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
13822
13823 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
13824 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
13825 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
13826 and non-zero for true.
13827
13828 @item <<@r{, }>>
13829 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
13830
13831 @item @@
13832 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13833
13834 @item +@r{, }-
13835 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
13836 pointer types.
13837
13838 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
13839 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
13840 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
13841 integral types.
13842
13843 @item ++@r{, }--
13844 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
13845 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
13846 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
13847 operation takes place.
13848
13849 @item *
13850 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
13851 @code{++}.
13852
13853 @item &
13854 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
13855
13856 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
13857 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
13858 to examine the address
13859 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
13860 stored.
13861
13862 @item -
13863 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
13864 precedence as @code{++}.
13865
13866 @item !
13867 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13868 @code{++}.
13869
13870 @item ~
13871 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13872 @code{++}.
13873
13874
13875 @item .@r{, }->
13876 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
13877 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
13878 pointer based on the stored type information.
13879 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
13880
13881 @item .*@r{, }->*
13882 Dereferences of pointers to members.
13883
13884 @item []
13885 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
13886 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13887
13888 @item ()
13889 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13890
13891 @item ::
13892 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
13893 and @code{class} types.
13894
13895 @item ::
13896 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
13897 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
13898 above.
13899 @end table
13900
13901 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
13902 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
13903 predefined meaning.
13904
13905 @node C Constants
13906 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
13907
13908 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
13909
13910 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
13911 following ways:
13912
13913 @itemize @bullet
13914 @item
13915 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
13916 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
13917 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
13918 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
13919 @code{long} value.
13920
13921 @item
13922 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
13923 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
13924 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
13925 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
13926 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
13927 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
13928 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
13929 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
13930 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
13931 constant.
13932
13933 @item
13934 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
13935 integral equivalents.
13936
13937 @item
13938 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
13939 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
13940 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
13941 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
13942 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
13943 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
13944 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
13945 @samp{\n} for newline.
13946
13947 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
13948 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
13949 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
13950 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13951
13952 @item
13953 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
13954 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
13955 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
13956 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
13957 characters.
13958
13959 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
13960 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
13961 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13962
13963 @item
13964 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
13965 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
13966
13967 @item
13968 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
13969 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
13970 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
13971 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
13972 @end itemize
13973
13974 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
13975 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
13976
13977 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
13978 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
13979
13980 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
13981 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
13982 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
13983 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
13984 @quotation
13985 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
13986 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
13987 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
13988 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
13989 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
13990 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
13991 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
13992 code. @xref{Compilation}.
13993 @end quotation
13994
13995 @enumerate
13996
13997 @cindex member functions
13998 @item
13999 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14000
14001 @smallexample
14002 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14003 @end smallexample
14004
14005 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14006 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14007 @item
14008 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14009 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14010 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14011 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14012 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14013
14014 @cindex call overloaded functions
14015 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14016 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14017 @item
14018 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14019 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14020 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14021 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14022 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14023 default arguments.
14024
14025 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14026 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14027 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14028 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14029 number of function arguments.
14030
14031 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14032 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14033 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14034
14035 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14036 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14037 @smallexample
14038 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14039 @end smallexample
14040
14041 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14042 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14043
14044 @cindex reference declarations
14045 @item
14046 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14047 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14048 dereferenced.
14049
14050 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14051 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14052 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14053 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14054 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14055
14056 @item
14057 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14058 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14059 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14060 necessary, for example in an expression like
14061 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14062 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14063 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14064
14065 @item
14066 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14067 specification.
14068 @end enumerate
14069
14070 @node C Defaults
14071 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14072
14073 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14074
14075 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14076 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14077 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14078 selects the working language.
14079
14080 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14081 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14082 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14083 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14084 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14085 for further details.
14086
14087 @node C Checks
14088 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14089
14090 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14091
14092 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14093 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14094 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14095 constants to pointers.
14096
14097 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14098 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14099 that is not itself an array.
14100
14101 @node Debugging C
14102 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14103
14104 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14105 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14106 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14107 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14108
14109 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14110 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14111 ,Expressions}.
14112
14113 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14114 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14115
14116 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14117
14118 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14119 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14120
14121 @table @code
14122 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14123 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14124 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14125 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14126 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14127 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14128
14129 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14130 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14131 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14132 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14133 classes.
14134 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14135
14136 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14137 @item catch throw
14138 @itemx catch rethrow
14139 @itemx catch catch
14140 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14141 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14142
14143 @cindex inheritance
14144 @item ptype @var{typename}
14145 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14146 @var{typename}.
14147 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14148
14149 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14150 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14151 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14152 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14153 multiple inheritance is in use.
14154
14155 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14156 @item set print demangle
14157 @itemx show print demangle
14158 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14159 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14160 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14161 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14162 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14163
14164 @item set print object
14165 @itemx show print object
14166 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14167 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14168
14169 @item set print vtbl
14170 @itemx show print vtbl
14171 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14172 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14173 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14174 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14175
14176 @kindex set overload-resolution
14177 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14178 @item set overload-resolution on
14179 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14180 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14181 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14182 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14183 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14184 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14185
14186 @item set overload-resolution off
14187 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14188 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14189 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14190 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14191 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14192 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14193 argument types.
14194
14195 @kindex show overload-resolution
14196 @item show overload-resolution
14197 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14198
14199 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14200 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14201 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14202 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14203 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14204 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14205 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14206 @end table
14207
14208 @node Decimal Floating Point
14209 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14210 @cindex decimal floating point format
14211
14212 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14213 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14214 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14215 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14216
14217 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14218 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14219 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14220 configured target.
14221
14222 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14223 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14224 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14225
14226 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14227 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14228 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14229
14230 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14231 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14232 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14233
14234 @node D
14235 @subsection D
14236
14237 @cindex D
14238 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14239 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14240 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14241
14242 @node Go
14243 @subsection Go
14244
14245 @cindex Go (programming language)
14246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14247 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14248
14249 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14250
14251 @table @code
14252 @cindex current Go package
14253 @item The current Go package
14254 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14255 specifying global variables and functions.
14256
14257 For example, given the program:
14258
14259 @example
14260 package main
14261 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14262 func main () @{
14263 // ...
14264 @}
14265 @end example
14266
14267 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14268
14269 @example
14270 (gdb) p myglob
14271 (gdb) p main.myglob
14272 @end example
14273
14274 @cindex builtin Go types
14275 @item Builtin Go types
14276 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14277 as a string.
14278
14279 @cindex builtin Go functions
14280 @item Builtin Go functions
14281 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14282 function and handles it internally.
14283
14284 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14285 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14286 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14287 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14288 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14289 @end table
14290
14291 @node Objective-C
14292 @subsection Objective-C
14293
14294 @cindex Objective-C
14295 This section provides information about some commands and command
14296 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14297 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14298 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14299
14300 @menu
14301 * Method Names in Commands::
14302 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14303 @end menu
14304
14305 @node Method Names in Commands
14306 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14307
14308 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14309 names as line specifications:
14310
14311 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14312 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14313 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14314 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14315 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14316 @itemize
14317 @item @code{clear}
14318 @item @code{break}
14319 @item @code{info line}
14320 @item @code{jump}
14321 @item @code{list}
14322 @end itemize
14323
14324 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14325
14326 @smallexample
14327 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14328 @end smallexample
14329
14330 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14331 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14332 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14333 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14334 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14335 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14336 debugged, enter:
14337
14338 @smallexample
14339 break -[Fruit create]
14340 @end smallexample
14341
14342 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14343 enter:
14344
14345 @smallexample
14346 list +[NSText initialize]
14347 @end smallexample
14348
14349 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14350 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14351 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14352 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14353
14354 @smallexample
14355 break create
14356 @end smallexample
14357
14358 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14359 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14360 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14361 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14362 none apply.
14363
14364 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14365 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14366
14367 @smallexample
14368 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14369 @end smallexample
14370
14371 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14372 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14373 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14374 @kindex print-object
14375 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14376
14377 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14378
14379 @smallexample
14380 print -[@var{object} hash]
14381 @end smallexample
14382
14383 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14384 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14385 @noindent
14386 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14387 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14388 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14389 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14390 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14391 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14392
14393 @node OpenCL C
14394 @subsection OpenCL C
14395
14396 @cindex OpenCL C
14397 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14398
14399 @menu
14400 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14401 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14402 * OpenCL C Operators::
14403 @end menu
14404
14405 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14406 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14407
14408 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14409 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14410 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14411 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14412 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14413
14414 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14415 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14416
14417 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14418 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14419 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14420 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14421
14422 @node OpenCL C Operators
14423 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14424
14425 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14426 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14427 vector data types.
14428
14429 @node Fortran
14430 @subsection Fortran
14431 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14432
14433 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14434 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14435
14436 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14437 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14438 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14439 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14440 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14441 underscore.
14442
14443 @menu
14444 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14445 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14446 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14447 @end menu
14448
14449 @node Fortran Operators
14450 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14451
14452 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14453
14454 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14455 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14456 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14457
14458 @table @code
14459 @item **
14460 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14461 of the second one.
14462
14463 @item :
14464 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14465 represent a section of array.
14466
14467 @item %
14468 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14469 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14470 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14471 union type.
14472 @end table
14473
14474 @node Fortran Defaults
14475 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14476
14477 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14478
14479 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14480 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14481 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14482 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14483
14484 @node Special Fortran Commands
14485 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14486
14487 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14488
14489 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14490 such as displaying common blocks.
14491
14492 @table @code
14493 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14494 @kindex info common
14495 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14496 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14497 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14498 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14499 printed.
14500 @end table
14501
14502 @node Pascal
14503 @subsection Pascal
14504
14505 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14506 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14507 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14508 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14509 syntax.
14510
14511 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14512 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14513 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14514
14515 @node Modula-2
14516 @subsection Modula-2
14517
14518 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14519
14520 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14521 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14522 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14523 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14524 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14525 table.
14526
14527 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14528 @menu
14529 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14530 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14531 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14532 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14533 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14534 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14535 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14536 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14537 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14538 @end menu
14539
14540 @node M2 Operators
14541 @subsubsection Operators
14542 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14543
14544 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14545 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14546 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14547 following definitions hold:
14548
14549 @itemize @bullet
14550
14551 @item
14552 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14553 their subranges.
14554
14555 @item
14556 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14557
14558 @item
14559 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14560
14561 @item
14562 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14563 @var{type}}.
14564
14565 @item
14566 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14567
14568 @item
14569 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14570
14571 @item
14572 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14573 @end itemize
14574
14575 @noindent
14576 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14577 increasing precedence:
14578
14579 @table @code
14580 @item ,
14581 Function argument or array index separator.
14582
14583 @item :=
14584 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14585 @var{value}.
14586
14587 @item <@r{, }>
14588 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14589 types.
14590
14591 @item <=@r{, }>=
14592 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14593 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14594 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14595
14596 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14597 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14598 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14599 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14600 comment character.
14601
14602 @item IN
14603 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14604 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14605
14606 @item OR
14607 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14608
14609 @item AND@r{, }&
14610 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14611
14612 @item @@
14613 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14614
14615 @item +@r{, }-
14616 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14617 and difference on set types.
14618
14619 @item *
14620 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14621 on set types.
14622
14623 @item /
14624 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14625 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14626
14627 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14628 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14629 precedence as @code{*}.
14630
14631 @item -
14632 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14633
14634 @item ^
14635 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14636
14637 @item NOT
14638 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14639 @code{^}.
14640
14641 @item .
14642 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14643 precedence as @code{^}.
14644
14645 @item []
14646 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14647
14648 @item ()
14649 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14650 as @code{^}.
14651
14652 @item ::@r{, }.
14653 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14654 @end table
14655
14656 @quotation
14657 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14658 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14659 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14660 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14661 @end quotation
14662
14663
14664 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14665 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14666 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14667
14668 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14669 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14670
14671 @table @var
14672
14673 @item a
14674 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14675
14676 @item c
14677 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14678
14679 @item i
14680 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14681
14682 @item m
14683 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14684 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14685 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14686
14687 @item n
14688 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14689
14690 @item r
14691 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14692
14693 @item t
14694 represents a type.
14695
14696 @item v
14697 represents a variable.
14698
14699 @item x
14700 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14701 explanation of the function for details.
14702 @end table
14703
14704 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14705
14706 @table @code
14707 @item ABS(@var{n})
14708 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14709
14710 @item CAP(@var{c})
14711 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14712 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14713
14714 @item CHR(@var{i})
14715 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14716
14717 @item DEC(@var{v})
14718 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14719
14720 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14721 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14722 new value.
14723
14724 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14725 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14726 set.
14727
14728 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14729 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14730
14731 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14732 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14733
14734 @item INC(@var{v})
14735 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14736
14737 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14738 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14739 new value.
14740
14741 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14742 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14743 there. Returns the new set.
14744
14745 @item MAX(@var{t})
14746 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14747
14748 @item MIN(@var{t})
14749 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14750
14751 @item ODD(@var{i})
14752 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14753
14754 @item ORD(@var{x})
14755 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14756 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
14757 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
14758 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
14759
14760 @item SIZE(@var{x})
14761 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14762 variable or a type.
14763
14764 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
14765 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
14766
14767 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
14768 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14769 variable or a type.
14770
14771 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
14772 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14773 @end table
14774
14775 @quotation
14776 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
14777 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
14778 an error.
14779 @end quotation
14780
14781 @cindex Modula-2 constants
14782 @node M2 Constants
14783 @subsubsection Constants
14784
14785 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
14786 ways:
14787
14788 @itemize @bullet
14789
14790 @item
14791 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
14792 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
14793 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
14794 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
14795
14796 @item
14797 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
14798 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
14799 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
14800 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
14801 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
14802 digits.
14803
14804 @item
14805 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
14806 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
14807 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
14808 followed by a @samp{C}.
14809
14810 @item
14811 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
14812 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
14813 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
14814 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
14815 sequences.
14816
14817 @item
14818 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
14819
14820 @item
14821 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
14822 @code{FALSE}.
14823
14824 @item
14825 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
14826
14827 @item
14828 Set constants are not yet supported.
14829 @end itemize
14830
14831 @node M2 Types
14832 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
14833 @cindex Modula-2 types
14834
14835 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
14836 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
14837 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
14838 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
14839 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
14840 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
14841
14842 The first example contains the following section of code:
14843
14844 @smallexample
14845 VAR
14846 s: SET OF CHAR ;
14847 r: [20..40] ;
14848 @end smallexample
14849
14850 @noindent
14851 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
14852 @code{r} and @code{s}.
14853
14854 @smallexample
14855 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14856 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
14857 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14858 SET OF CHAR
14859 (@value{GDBP}) print r
14860 21
14861 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
14862 [20..40]
14863 @end smallexample
14864
14865 @noindent
14866 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
14867
14868 @smallexample
14869 VAR
14870 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
14871 @end smallexample
14872
14873 @noindent
14874 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
14875
14876 @smallexample
14877 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14878 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
14879 @end smallexample
14880
14881 @noindent
14882 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
14883 expressions using the debugger.
14884
14885 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
14886 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
14887
14888 @smallexample
14889 VAR
14890 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
14891 @end smallexample
14892
14893 @smallexample
14894 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14895 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
14896 @end smallexample
14897
14898 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
14899 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
14900 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
14901 above.
14902
14903 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
14904
14905 @smallexample
14906 TYPE
14907 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
14908 t = [blue..yellow] ;
14909 VAR
14910 s: t ;
14911 BEGIN
14912 s := blue ;
14913 @end smallexample
14914
14915 @noindent
14916 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
14917 and value of a variable.
14918
14919 @smallexample
14920 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14921 $1 = blue
14922 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
14923 type = [blue..yellow]
14924 @end smallexample
14925
14926 @noindent
14927 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
14928 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
14929 their @code{C} counterparts.
14930
14931 @smallexample
14932 VAR
14933 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14934 BEGIN
14935 s[1] := 1 ;
14936 @end smallexample
14937
14938 @smallexample
14939 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14940 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
14941 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14942 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14943 @end smallexample
14944
14945 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
14946 pointer types as shown in this example:
14947
14948 @smallexample
14949 VAR
14950 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14951 BEGIN
14952 NEW(s) ;
14953 s^[1] := 1 ;
14954 @end smallexample
14955
14956 @noindent
14957 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
14958
14959 @smallexample
14960 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14961 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14962 @end smallexample
14963
14964 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
14965 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
14966 types:
14967
14968 @smallexample
14969 TYPE
14970 foo = RECORD
14971 f1: CARDINAL ;
14972 f2: CHAR ;
14973 f3: myarray ;
14974 END ;
14975
14976 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
14977 myrange = [-2..2] ;
14978 VAR
14979 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
14980 @end smallexample
14981
14982 @noindent
14983 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
14984 below.
14985
14986 @smallexample
14987 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14988 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
14989 f1 : CARDINAL;
14990 f2 : CHAR;
14991 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
14992 END
14993 @end smallexample
14994
14995 @node M2 Defaults
14996 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
14997 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
14998
14999 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15000 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15001 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15002 selected the working language.
15003
15004 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15005 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15006 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15007 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15008
15009 @node Deviations
15010 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15011 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15012
15013 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15014 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15015
15016 @itemize @bullet
15017 @item
15018 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15019 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15020 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15021 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15022 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15023 returned a pointer.)
15024
15025 @item
15026 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15027 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15028 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15029 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15030
15031 @item
15032 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15033 argument.
15034
15035 @item
15036 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15037 @end itemize
15038
15039 @node M2 Checks
15040 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15041 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15042
15043 @quotation
15044 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15045 range checking.
15046 @end quotation
15047 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15048
15049 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15050
15051 @itemize @bullet
15052 @item
15053 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15054 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15055
15056 @item
15057 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15058 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15059 @end itemize
15060
15061 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15062 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15063
15064 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15065 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15066
15067 @node M2 Scope
15068 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15069 @cindex scope
15070 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15071 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15072 @ifinfo
15073 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15074 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15075 @end ifinfo
15076 @ifnotinfo
15077 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15078 @end ifnotinfo
15079
15080 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15081 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15082 similar syntax:
15083
15084 @smallexample
15085
15086 @var{module} . @var{id}
15087 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15088 @end smallexample
15089
15090 @noindent
15091 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15092 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15093 identifier within your program, except another module.
15094
15095 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15096 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15097 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15098 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15099
15100 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15101 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15102 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15103 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15104 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15105 @var{module}.
15106
15107 @node GDB/M2
15108 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15109
15110 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15111 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15112 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15113 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15114 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15115 analogue in Modula-2.
15116
15117 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15118 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15119 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15120 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15121 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15122 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15123
15124 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15125 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15126 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15127
15128 @node Ada
15129 @subsection Ada
15130 @cindex Ada
15131
15132 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15133 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15134 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15135 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15136 to be difficult.
15137
15138
15139 @cindex expressions in Ada
15140 @menu
15141 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15142 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15143 in @value{GDBN}.
15144 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15145 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15146 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15147 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15148 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15149 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15150 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15151 Profile
15152 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15153 @end menu
15154
15155 @node Ada Mode Intro
15156 @subsubsection Introduction
15157 @cindex Ada mode, general
15158
15159 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15160 syntax, with some extensions.
15161 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15162
15163 @itemize @bullet
15164 @item
15165 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15166 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15167 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15168 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15169
15170 @item
15171 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15172 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15173
15174 @item
15175 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15176 @end itemize
15177
15178 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15179 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15180 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15181 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15182 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15183
15184 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15185 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15186 was translated from an Ada source file.
15187
15188 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15189 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15190 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15191 middle (to allow based literals).
15192
15193 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15194 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15195 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15196 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15197 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15198 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15199
15200 @node Omissions from Ada
15201 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15202 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15203
15204 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15205
15206 @itemize @bullet
15207 @item
15208 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15209
15210 @itemize @minus
15211 @item
15212 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15213 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15214
15215 @item
15216 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15217
15218 @item
15219 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15220
15221 @item
15222 @t{'Tag}.
15223
15224 @item
15225 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15226 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15227
15228 @item
15229 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15230 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15231
15232 @item
15233 @t{'Address}.
15234 @end itemize
15235
15236 @item
15237 The names in
15238 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15239 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15240 not currently available.
15241
15242 @item
15243 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15244 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15245 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15246 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15247 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15248 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15249 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15250 indeterminate values.
15251
15252 @item
15253 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15254 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15255 are not implemented.
15256
15257 @item
15258 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15259 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15260 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15261 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15262 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15263
15264 @smallexample
15265 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15266 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15267 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15268 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15269 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15270 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15271 @end smallexample
15272
15273 Changing a
15274 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15275 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15276 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15277 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15278 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15279 declared to have a type such as:
15280
15281 @smallexample
15282 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15283 Id : Integer;
15284 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15285 end record;
15286 @end smallexample
15287
15288 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15289 assignments:
15290
15291 @smallexample
15292 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15293 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15294 @end smallexample
15295
15296 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15297 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15298 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15299 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15300 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15301 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15302 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15303 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15304
15305 @item
15306 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15307
15308 @item
15309 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15310 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15311 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15312 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15313 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15314 the proper resolution.
15315
15316 @item
15317 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15318
15319 @item
15320 Entry calls are not implemented.
15321
15322 @item
15323 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15324 formats are not supported.
15325
15326 @item
15327 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15328
15329 @item
15330 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15331 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15332 context.
15333 Should your program
15334 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15335 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15336 @end itemize
15337
15338 @node Additions to Ada
15339 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15340 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15341
15342 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15343 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15344
15345 @itemize @bullet
15346 @item
15347 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15348 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15349 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15350 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15351 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15352 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15353 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15354 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15355
15356 @item
15357 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15358 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15359 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15360
15361 @item
15362 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15363 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15364
15365 @item
15366 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15367 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15368 @end itemize
15369
15370 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15371 additions specific to Ada:
15372
15373 @itemize @bullet
15374 @item
15375 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15376 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15377
15378 @smallexample
15379 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15380 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15381 @end smallexample
15382
15383 @item
15384 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15385 the value of its right-hand operand.
15386 This allows, for example,
15387 complex conditional breaks:
15388
15389 @smallexample
15390 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15391 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15392 @end smallexample
15393
15394 @item
15395 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15396 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15397 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15398 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15399 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15400 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15401 in strings. For example,
15402 @smallexample
15403 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15404 @end smallexample
15405 @noindent
15406 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15407 after each period.
15408
15409 @item
15410 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15411 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15412 to write
15413
15414 @smallexample
15415 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15416 @end smallexample
15417
15418 @item
15419 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15420 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15421 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15422 of 3 might print as
15423
15424 @smallexample
15425 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15426 @end smallexample
15427
15428 @noindent
15429 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15430 clause.
15431
15432 @item
15433 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15434 multi-character subsequence of
15435 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15436 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15437 in place of @t{a'length}.
15438
15439 @item
15440 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15441 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15442 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15443 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15444 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15445 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15446 For example,
15447 @smallexample
15448 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15449 @end smallexample
15450
15451 @item
15452 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15453 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15454 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15455 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15456 object.
15457
15458 @end itemize
15459
15460 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15461 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15462
15463 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15464 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15465 before reaching the main procedure.
15466 As defined in the Ada Reference
15467 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15468 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15469 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15470 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15471
15472 @node Ada Exceptions
15473 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15474
15475 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15476
15477 @table @code
15478 @kindex info exceptions
15479 @item info exceptions
15480 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15481 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15482 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15483 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15484 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15485 @end table
15486
15487 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15488 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15489 argument.
15490
15491 @smallexample
15492 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15493 All defined Ada exceptions:
15494 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15495 program_error: 0x613d20
15496 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15497 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15498 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15499 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15500 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15501 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15502 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15503 @end smallexample
15504
15505 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15506 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15507
15508 @node Ada Tasks
15509 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15510 @cindex Ada, tasking
15511
15512 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15513 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15514
15515 @table @code
15516 @kindex info tasks
15517 @item info tasks
15518 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15519
15520
15521 @smallexample
15522 @iftex
15523 @leftskip=0.5cm
15524 @end iftex
15525 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15526 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15527 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15528 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15529 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15530 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15531
15532 @end smallexample
15533
15534 @noindent
15535 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15536 task currently being inspected.
15537
15538 @table @asis
15539 @item ID
15540 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15541
15542 @item TID
15543 The Ada task ID.
15544
15545 @item P-ID
15546 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15547
15548 @item Pri
15549 The base priority of the task.
15550
15551 @item State
15552 Current state of the task.
15553
15554 @table @code
15555 @item Unactivated
15556 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15557 executing.
15558
15559 @item Runnable
15560 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15561 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15562
15563 @item Terminated
15564 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15565 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15566 terminated themselves.
15567
15568 @item Child Activation Wait
15569 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15570
15571 @item Accept Statement
15572 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15573
15574 @item Waiting on entry call
15575 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15576
15577 @item Async Select Wait
15578 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15579 select statement.
15580
15581 @item Delay Sleep
15582 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15583 alternative open.
15584
15585 @item Child Termination Wait
15586 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15587 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15588 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15589
15590 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15591 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15592 finish terminating.
15593
15594 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15595 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15596 @end table
15597
15598 @item Name
15599 Name of the task in the program.
15600
15601 @end table
15602
15603 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15604 @item info task @var{taskno}
15605 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15606 the following example:
15607 @smallexample
15608 @iftex
15609 @leftskip=0.5cm
15610 @end iftex
15611 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15612 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15613 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15614 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15615 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15616 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15617 Name: task_1
15618 Thread: 0x807f378
15619 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15620 Base Priority: 15
15621 State: Runnable
15622 @end smallexample
15623
15624 @item task
15625 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15626 @cindex current Ada task ID
15627 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15628
15629 @smallexample
15630 @iftex
15631 @leftskip=0.5cm
15632 @end iftex
15633 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15634 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15635 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15636 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15637 (@value{GDBP}) task
15638 [Current task is 2]
15639 @end smallexample
15640
15641 @item task @var{taskno}
15642 @cindex Ada task switching
15643 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15644 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15645 from the current task to the given task.
15646
15647 @smallexample
15648 @iftex
15649 @leftskip=0.5cm
15650 @end iftex
15651 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15652 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15653 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15654 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15655 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15656 [Switching to task 1]
15657 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15658 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15659 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15660 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15661 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15662 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15663 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15664 @end smallexample
15665
15666 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15667 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15668 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15669 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15670 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15671 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15672 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
15673 @var{linespec} argument specifies source lines, as described
15674 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15675
15676 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15677 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15678 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
15679 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15680 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15681
15682 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15683 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15684 program.
15685
15686 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15687 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15688 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15689
15690 For example,
15691
15692 @smallexample
15693 @iftex
15694 @leftskip=0.5cm
15695 @end iftex
15696 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15697 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15698 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15699 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15700 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15701 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15702 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15703 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15704 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15705 Continuing.
15706 task # 1 running
15707 task # 2 running
15708
15709 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15710 15 flush;
15711 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15712 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15713 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15714 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15715 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15716 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15717 @end smallexample
15718 @end table
15719
15720 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15721 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15722 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15723
15724 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15725 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15726 the platform being used.
15727 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15728 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
15729 as usual.
15730
15731 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
15732 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15733 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15734 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15735 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15736 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15737
15738 @node Ravenscar Profile
15739 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15740 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15741
15742 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15743 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15744 requirements.
15745
15746 @table @code
15747 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15748 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15749 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15750 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15751 Profile. This is the default.
15752
15753 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15754 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15755 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15756 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15757 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15758 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15759 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
15760
15761 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
15762 @item show ravenscar task-switching
15763 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
15764 using the Ravenscar Profile.
15765
15766 @end table
15767
15768 @node Ada Glitches
15769 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
15770 @cindex Ada, problems
15771
15772 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
15773 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
15774 @value{GDBN},
15775 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
15776 and the GNU Ada compiler.
15777
15778 @itemize @bullet
15779 @item
15780 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
15781 storage are invisible to the debugger.
15782
15783 @item
15784 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
15785 argument lists are treated as positional).
15786
15787 @item
15788 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
15789
15790 @item
15791 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
15792 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
15793 the host machine.
15794
15795 @item
15796 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
15797 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
15798 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
15799 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
15800 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
15801 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
15802 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
15803 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
15804 you can usually resolve the confusion
15805 by qualifying the problematic names with package
15806 @code{Standard} explicitly.
15807 @end itemize
15808
15809 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
15810 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
15811 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
15812 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
15813 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
15814 enabled.
15815
15816 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15817 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15818 @table @code
15819
15820 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
15821 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
15822 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
15823 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
15824 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
15825 This is the default.
15826
15827 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
15828 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
15829 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
15830 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
15831 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
15832 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
15833 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
15834
15835 @end table
15836
15837 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
15838 @cindex GNAT encoding
15839 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
15840 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
15841 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
15842 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
15843 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
15844 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
15845
15846 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
15847 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
15848 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
15849 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
15850 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
15851 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
15852 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
15853 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
15854
15855 @table @code
15856
15857 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
15858 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
15859 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
15860 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
15861
15862 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15863 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15864 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
15865
15866 @end table
15867
15868 @node Unsupported Languages
15869 @section Unsupported Languages
15870
15871 @cindex unsupported languages
15872 @cindex minimal language
15873 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
15874 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
15875 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
15876 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
15877 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
15878 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
15879
15880 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
15881 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
15882 language.
15883
15884 @node Symbols
15885 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
15886
15887 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
15888 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
15889 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
15890 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
15891 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
15892 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
15893 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15894
15895 @cindex symbol names
15896 @cindex names of symbols
15897 @cindex quoting names
15898 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
15899 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
15900 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
15901 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
15902 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
15903 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
15904 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
15905 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
15906
15907 @smallexample
15908 p 'foo.c'::x
15909 @end smallexample
15910
15911 @noindent
15912 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
15913
15914 @table @code
15915 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
15916 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
15917 @kindex set case-sensitive
15918 @item set case-sensitive on
15919 @itemx set case-sensitive off
15920 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
15921 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
15922 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
15923 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
15924 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
15925 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
15926 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
15927 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
15928 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
15929 case-insensitive matches.
15930
15931 @kindex show case-sensitive
15932 @item show case-sensitive
15933 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
15934 lookups.
15935
15936 @kindex set print type methods
15937 @item set print type methods
15938 @itemx set print type methods on
15939 @itemx set print type methods off
15940 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
15941 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15942 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15943 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15944 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
15945 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
15946
15947 @kindex show print type methods
15948 @item show print type methods
15949 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
15950 classes.
15951
15952 @kindex set print type typedefs
15953 @item set print type typedefs
15954 @itemx set print type typedefs on
15955 @itemx set print type typedefs off
15956
15957 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
15958 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15959 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15960 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15961 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
15962 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
15963 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
15964 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
15965 types.
15966
15967 @kindex show print type typedefs
15968 @item show print type typedefs
15969 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
15970 printing classes.
15971
15972 @kindex info address
15973 @cindex address of a symbol
15974 @item info address @var{symbol}
15975 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
15976 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
15977 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
15978 is always stored.
15979
15980 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
15981 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
15982 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
15983
15984 @kindex info symbol
15985 @cindex symbol from address
15986 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
15987 @item info symbol @var{addr}
15988 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
15989 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
15990 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
15991
15992 @smallexample
15993 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
15994 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
15995 @end smallexample
15996
15997 @noindent
15998 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
15999 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16000
16001 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16002 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16003
16004 @smallexample
16005 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16006 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16007 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16008 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16009 @end smallexample
16010
16011 @kindex whatis
16012 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16013 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16014 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16015 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16016
16017 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16018 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16019 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16020
16021 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16022 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16023 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16024 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16025 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16026 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16027 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16028 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16029 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16030
16031 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16032 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16033 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16034 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16035 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16036 unroll it.
16037
16038 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16039 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16040 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16041
16042 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16043 Available flags are:
16044
16045 @table @code
16046 @item r
16047 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16048 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16049 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16050
16051 @item m
16052 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16053
16054 @item M
16055 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16056 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16057
16058 @item t
16059 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16060 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16061 names are substituted when printing other types.
16062
16063 @item T
16064 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16065 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16066 @end table
16067
16068 @kindex ptype
16069 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16070 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16071 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16072 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16073
16074 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16075 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16076 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16077 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16078 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16079 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16080 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16081 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16082
16083 For example, for this variable declaration:
16084
16085 @smallexample
16086 typedef double real_t;
16087 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16088 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16089 complex_t var;
16090 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16091 @end smallexample
16092
16093 @noindent
16094 the two commands give this output:
16095
16096 @smallexample
16097 @group
16098 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16099 type = complex_t
16100 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16101 type = struct complex @{
16102 real_t real;
16103 double imag;
16104 @}
16105 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16106 type = struct complex
16107 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16108 type = struct complex
16109 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16110 type = struct complex @{
16111 real_t real;
16112 double imag;
16113 @}
16114 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16115 type = real_t *
16116 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16117 type = double *
16118 @end group
16119 @end smallexample
16120
16121 @noindent
16122 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16123 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16124
16125 @cindex incomplete type
16126 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16127 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16128 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16129 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16130 given these declarations:
16131
16132 @smallexample
16133 struct foo;
16134 struct foo *fooptr;
16135 @end smallexample
16136
16137 @noindent
16138 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16139
16140 @smallexample
16141 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16142 $1 = <incomplete type>
16143 @end smallexample
16144
16145 @noindent
16146 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16147 completely specified.
16148
16149 @kindex info types
16150 @item info types @var{regexp}
16151 @itemx info types
16152 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16153 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16154 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16155 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16156 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16157 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16158 name is @code{value}.
16159
16160 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16161 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16162 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16163
16164 @kindex info type-printers
16165 @item info type-printers
16166 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16167 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16168 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16169 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16170 type printers.
16171
16172 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16173
16174 @kindex enable type-printer
16175 @kindex disable type-printer
16176 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16177 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16178 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16179
16180 @kindex info scope
16181 @cindex local variables
16182 @item info scope @var{location}
16183 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16184 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16185 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16186 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16187 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16188
16189 @smallexample
16190 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16191 Scope for command_line_handler:
16192 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16193 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16194 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16195 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16196 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16197 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16198 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16199 @end smallexample
16200
16201 @noindent
16202 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16203 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16204 collect}.
16205
16206 @kindex info source
16207 @item info source
16208 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16209 the function containing the current point of execution:
16210 @itemize @bullet
16211 @item
16212 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16213 @item
16214 the directory it was compiled in,
16215 @item
16216 its length, in lines,
16217 @item
16218 which programming language it is written in,
16219 @item
16220 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16221 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16222 @item
16223 whether the debugging information includes information about
16224 preprocessor macros.
16225 @end itemize
16226
16227
16228 @kindex info sources
16229 @item info sources
16230 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16231 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16232 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16233
16234 @kindex info functions
16235 @item info functions
16236 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16237
16238 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16239 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16240 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16241 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16242 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16243 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16244 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16245 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16246
16247 @kindex info variables
16248 @item info variables
16249 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16250 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16251
16252 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16253 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16254 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16255 @var{regexp}.
16256
16257 @kindex info classes
16258 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16259 @item info classes
16260 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16261 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16262 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16263 expression.
16264
16265 @kindex info selectors
16266 @item info selectors
16267 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16268 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16269 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16270 expression.
16271
16272 @ignore
16273 This was never implemented.
16274 @kindex info methods
16275 @item info methods
16276 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16277 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16278 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16279 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16280 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16281 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16282 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16283 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16284 @end ignore
16285
16286 @cindex opaque data types
16287 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16288 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16289 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16290 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16291 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16292 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16293 another source file. The default is on.
16294
16295 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16296 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16297
16298 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16299 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16300 is printed as follows:
16301 @smallexample
16302 @{<no data fields>@}
16303 @end smallexample
16304
16305 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16306 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16307 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16308
16309 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16310 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16311 @item set print symbol-loading
16312 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16313 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16314 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16315 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16316 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16317 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16318 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16319 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16320 can be annoying.
16321 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16322 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16323 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16324 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16325
16326 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16327 @item show print symbol-loading
16328 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16329 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16330
16331 @kindex maint print symbols
16332 @cindex symbol dump
16333 @kindex maint print psymbols
16334 @cindex partial symbol dump
16335 @kindex maint print msymbols
16336 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16337 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16338 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16339 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16340 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16341 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16342 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16343 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16344 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16345 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16346 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16347 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16348 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16349 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16350 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16351 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16352 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16353 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16354
16355 @kindex maint info symtabs
16356 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16357 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16358 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16359 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16360 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16361 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16362 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16363
16364 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16365 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16366 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16367 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16368 structure in more detail. For example:
16369
16370 @smallexample
16371 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16372 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16373 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16374 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16375 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16376 readin no
16377 fullname (null)
16378 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16379 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16380 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16381 dependencies (none)
16382 @}
16383 @}
16384 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16385 (@value{GDBP})
16386 @end smallexample
16387 @noindent
16388 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16389 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16390 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16391 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16392 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16393
16394 @smallexample
16395 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16396 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16397 line 1574.
16398 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16399 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16400 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16401 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16402 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16403 dirname (null)
16404 fullname (null)
16405 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16406 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16407 debugformat DWARF 2
16408 @}
16409 @}
16410 (@value{GDBP})
16411 @end smallexample
16412 @end table
16413
16414
16415 @node Altering
16416 @chapter Altering Execution
16417
16418 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16419 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16420 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16421 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16422 program.
16423
16424 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16425 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16426 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16427
16428 @menu
16429 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16430 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16431 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16432 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16433 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16434 * Patching:: Patching your program
16435 @end menu
16436
16437 @node Assignment
16438 @section Assignment to Variables
16439
16440 @cindex assignment
16441 @cindex setting variables
16442 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16443 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16444
16445 @smallexample
16446 print x=4
16447 @end smallexample
16448
16449 @noindent
16450 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16451 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16452 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16453 information on operators in supported languages.
16454
16455 @kindex set variable
16456 @cindex variables, setting
16457 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16458 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16459 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16460 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16461 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16462
16463 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16464 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16465 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16466 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16467 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16468 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16469 command @code{set width}:
16470
16471 @smallexample
16472 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16473 type = double
16474 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16475 $4 = 13
16476 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16477 Invalid syntax in expression.
16478 @end smallexample
16479
16480 @noindent
16481 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16482 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16483
16484 @smallexample
16485 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16486 @end smallexample
16487
16488 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16489 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16490 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16491 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16492 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16493 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16494
16495 @smallexample
16496 @group
16497 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16498 type = double
16499 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16500 $1 = 1
16501 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16502 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16503 $2 = 1
16504 (@value{GDBP}) r
16505 The program being debugged has been started already.
16506 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16507 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16508 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16509 Invalid bfd target.
16510 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16511 The current BFD target is "=4".
16512 @end group
16513 @end smallexample
16514
16515 @noindent
16516 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16517 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16518 @code{g}, use
16519
16520 @smallexample
16521 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16522 @end smallexample
16523
16524 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16525 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16526 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16527 same length or shorter.
16528 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16529 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16530
16531 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16532 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16533 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16534 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16535 and representation in memory), and
16536
16537 @smallexample
16538 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16539 @end smallexample
16540
16541 @noindent
16542 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16543
16544 @node Jumping
16545 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16546
16547 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16548 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16549 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16550
16551 @table @code
16552 @kindex jump
16553 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16554 @item jump @var{linespec}
16555 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16556 @itemx jump @var{location}
16557 @itemx j @var{location}
16558 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16559 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16560 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16561 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16562 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16563 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16564
16565 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16566 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16567 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16568 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16569 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16570 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16571 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16572 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16573 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16574 @end table
16575
16576 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16577 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16578 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16579 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16580 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16581 example,
16582
16583 @smallexample
16584 set $pc = 0x485
16585 @end smallexample
16586
16587 @noindent
16588 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16589 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16590 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16591
16592 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16593 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16594 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16595 detail.
16596
16597 @c @group
16598 @node Signaling
16599 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16600 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16601
16602 @table @code
16603 @kindex signal
16604 @item signal @var{signal}
16605 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
16606 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16607 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16608 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16609
16610 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16611 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16612 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16613 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16614 signal.
16615
16616 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
16617 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
16618 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
16619 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
16620 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
16621 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
16622 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
16623 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
16624
16625 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16626 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16627 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16628 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16629 passes the signal directly to your program.
16630
16631 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16632 after executing the command.
16633
16634 @kindex queue-signal
16635 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
16636 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
16637 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
16638 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
16639 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16640 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
16641 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
16642 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
16643 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
16644
16645 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
16646 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
16647 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
16648 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16649 @code{continue} command.
16650
16651 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
16652 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
16653 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
16654 (@pxref{Signals}).
16655 @end table
16656 @c @end group
16657
16658 @node Returning
16659 @section Returning from a Function
16660
16661 @table @code
16662 @cindex returning from a function
16663 @kindex return
16664 @item return
16665 @itemx return @var{expression}
16666 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16667 command. If you give an
16668 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16669 value.
16670 @end table
16671
16672 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16673 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16674 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16675 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16676
16677 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16678 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16679 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16680 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16681 of functions.
16682
16683 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16684 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16685 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16686 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16687 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16688
16689 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16690 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16691 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16692 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16693 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16694 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16695 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16696 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16697 assignment into the right register(s).
16698
16699 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16700 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16701 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16702 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16703 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16704 into a @code{long long int}:
16705
16706 @smallexample
16707 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16708 29 return 31;
16709 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16710 Make func return now? (y or n) y
16711 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
16712 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
16713 (@value{GDBP})
16714 @end smallexample
16715
16716 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
16717 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
16718 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
16719 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
16720 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
16721 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
16722 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
16723 an appropriate cast explicitly:
16724
16725 @smallexample
16726 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
16727 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16728 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
16729 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
16730 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
16731 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
16732 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
16733 (@value{GDBP})
16734 @end smallexample
16735
16736 @node Calling
16737 @section Calling Program Functions
16738
16739 @table @code
16740 @cindex calling functions
16741 @cindex inferior functions, calling
16742 @item print @var{expr}
16743 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
16744 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
16745 debugged.
16746
16747 @kindex call
16748 @item call @var{expr}
16749 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
16750 returned values.
16751
16752 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
16753 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
16754 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
16755 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
16756 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
16757 value history.
16758 @end table
16759
16760 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
16761 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
16762 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
16763 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
16764
16765 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
16766 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
16767 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
16768 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
16769 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
16770 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
16771 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
16772 in that case is controlled by the
16773 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
16774
16775 @table @code
16776 @item set unwindonsignal
16777 @kindex set unwindonsignal
16778 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
16779 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
16780 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
16781 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
16782 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
16783 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
16784 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
16785 received.
16786
16787 @item show unwindonsignal
16788 @kindex show unwindonsignal
16789 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16790 @value{GDBN}.
16791
16792 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16793 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16794 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
16795 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
16796 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
16797 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
16798 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
16799 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
16800 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
16801 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
16802
16803 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16804 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16805 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16806 @value{GDBN}.
16807
16808 @end table
16809
16810 @cindex weak alias functions
16811 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
16812 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
16813 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
16814 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
16815 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
16816 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
16817 function instead.
16818
16819 @node Patching
16820 @section Patching Programs
16821
16822 @cindex patching binaries
16823 @cindex writing into executables
16824 @cindex writing into corefiles
16825
16826 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
16827 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
16828 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
16829 patching your program's binary.
16830
16831 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
16832 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
16833 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
16834 repairs.
16835
16836 @table @code
16837 @kindex set write
16838 @item set write on
16839 @itemx set write off
16840 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
16841 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
16842 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
16843
16844 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
16845 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
16846 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
16847
16848 @item show write
16849 @kindex show write
16850 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
16851 as well as reading.
16852 @end table
16853
16854 @node GDB Files
16855 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
16856
16857 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
16858 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
16859 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
16860 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
16861
16862 @menu
16863 * Files:: Commands to specify files
16864 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
16865 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
16866 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
16867 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
16868 * Data Files:: GDB data files
16869 @end menu
16870
16871 @node Files
16872 @section Commands to Specify Files
16873
16874 @cindex symbol table
16875 @cindex core dump file
16876
16877 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
16878 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
16879 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
16880 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
16881
16882 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
16883 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
16884 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
16885 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
16886 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
16887 new files are useful.
16888
16889 @table @code
16890 @cindex executable file
16891 @kindex file
16892 @item file @var{filename}
16893 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
16894 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
16895 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
16896 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
16897 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
16898 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
16899 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
16900 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
16901
16902 @cindex unlinked object files
16903 @cindex patching object files
16904 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
16905 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
16906 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
16907 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
16908 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
16909 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
16910 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
16911 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
16912
16913 @item file
16914 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
16915 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
16916
16917 @kindex exec-file
16918 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16919 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
16920 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
16921 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
16922 discard information on the executable file.
16923
16924 @kindex symbol-file
16925 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16926 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
16927 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
16928 table and program to run from the same file.
16929
16930 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
16931 program's symbol table.
16932
16933 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
16934 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
16935 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
16936 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
16937 @value{GDBN}.
16938
16939 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
16940 executing it once.
16941
16942 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
16943 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
16944 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
16945 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
16946 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
16947 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
16948 optimized code.
16949
16950 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
16951 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
16952 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
16953 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
16954 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
16955
16956 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
16957 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
16958 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
16959 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
16960 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
16961 Warnings and Messages}.)
16962
16963 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
16964 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
16965 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
16966 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
16967 in stabs format.
16968
16969 @kindex readnow
16970 @cindex reading symbols immediately
16971 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
16972 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16973 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16974 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
16975 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
16976 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
16977 entire symbol table available.
16978
16979 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
16980 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
16981 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
16982 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
16983 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
16984 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
16985 @c files.
16986
16987 @kindex core-file
16988 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
16989 @itemx core
16990 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
16991 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
16992 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
16993 executable file itself for other parts.
16994
16995 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
16996 to be used.
16997
16998 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
16999 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17000 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17001 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17002 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17003
17004 @kindex add-symbol-file
17005 @cindex dynamic linking
17006 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17007 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17008 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17009 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17010 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17011 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17012 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17013 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17014 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17015 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17016 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17017 @var{address} as an expression.
17018
17019 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17020 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17021 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17022 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17023
17024 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17025
17026 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17027 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17028 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17029 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17030 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17031 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17032 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17033 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17034 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17035
17036 @itemize @bullet
17037 @item
17038 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17039 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17040 @item
17041 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17042 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17043 @item
17044 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17045 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17046 @end itemize
17047
17048 @noindent
17049 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17050 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17051 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17052 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17053 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17054 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17055 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17056 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17057 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17058 way.
17059
17060 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17061
17062 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17063 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17064 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17065 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17066 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17067 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17068
17069 @smallexample
17070 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17071 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17072 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17073 (y or n) y
17074 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17075 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17076 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17077 (gdb)
17078 @end smallexample
17079
17080
17081 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17082
17083 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17084 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17085 @cindex load symbols from memory
17086 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17087 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17088 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17089 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17090 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17091 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17092 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17093 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17094 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17095
17096 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
17097 @kindex assf
17098 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
17099 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
17100 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
17101 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
17102
17103 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
17104 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
17105 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
17106 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
17107 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
17108 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
17109 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
17110 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
17111
17112 @kindex section
17113 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17114 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17115 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17116 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17117 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17118 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17119 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17120 their addresses.
17121
17122 @kindex info files
17123 @kindex info target
17124 @item info files
17125 @itemx info target
17126 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17127 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17128 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17129 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17130 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17131 current ones.
17132
17133 @kindex maint info sections
17134 @item maint info sections
17135 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17136 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17137 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17138 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17139 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17140 may be arbitrarily combined):
17141
17142 @table @code
17143 @item ALLOBJ
17144 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17145 @item @var{sections}
17146 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17147 @item @var{section-flags}
17148 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17149 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17150 @table @code
17151 @item ALLOC
17152 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17153 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17154 @item LOAD
17155 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17156 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17157 @item RELOC
17158 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17159 @item READONLY
17160 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17161 @item CODE
17162 Section contains executable code only.
17163 @item DATA
17164 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17165 @item ROM
17166 Section will reside in ROM.
17167 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17168 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17169 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17170 Section is not empty.
17171 @item NEVER_LOAD
17172 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17173 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17174 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17175 COFF shared library information.
17176 @item IS_COMMON
17177 Section contains common symbols.
17178 @end table
17179 @end table
17180 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17181 @cindex read-only sections
17182 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17183 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17184 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17185 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17186 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17187 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17188 enhancement to debugging performance.
17189
17190 The default is off.
17191
17192 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17193 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17194 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17195 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17196
17197 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17198 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17199 @end table
17200
17201 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17202 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17203 name and remembers it that way.
17204
17205 @cindex shared libraries
17206 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17207 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17208 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17209
17210 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17211 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17212
17213 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17214 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17215 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17216 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17217 debugging a core file).
17218
17219 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17220 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17221
17222 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17223 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17224 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17225
17226 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17227 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17228 particularly large or there are many of them.
17229
17230 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17231 commands:
17232
17233 @table @code
17234 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17235 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17236 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17237 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17238 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17239 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17240 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17241 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17242
17243 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17244 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17245 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17246 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17247 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17248 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17249 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17250 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17251 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17252
17253 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17254 @item show auto-solib-add
17255 Display the current autoloading mode.
17256 @end table
17257
17258 @cindex load shared library
17259 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17260 command:
17261
17262 @table @code
17263 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17264 @kindex info share
17265 @item info share @var{regex}
17266 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17267 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17268 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17269 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17270
17271 @kindex sharedlibrary
17272 @kindex share
17273 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17274 @itemx share @var{regex}
17275 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17276 Unix regular expression.
17277 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17278 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17279 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17280 loaded.
17281
17282 @item nosharedlibrary
17283 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17284 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17285 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17286 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17287 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17288 discarded.
17289 @end table
17290
17291 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17292 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17293 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17294 Catchpoints}).
17295
17296 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17297 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17298 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17299 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17300
17301 @table @code
17302 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17303 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17304 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17305 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17306 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17307 shared library.
17308
17309 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17310 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17311 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17312 library events happen.
17313 @end table
17314
17315 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17316 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17317 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17318 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17319 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17320 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17321 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17322 not.
17323
17324 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17325 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17326 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17327 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17328 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17329
17330 @table @code
17331 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
17332 @cindex system root, alternate
17333 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17334 @kindex set sysroot
17335 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17336 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17337 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17338 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17339 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
17340 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
17341 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
17342 under @var{path}.
17343
17344 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
17345 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
17346 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
17347 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
17348 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
17349 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
17350 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
17351 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
17352 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
17353
17354 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17355 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17356 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17357 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17358 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17359
17360 @smallexample
17361 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17362 @end smallexample
17363
17364 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17365 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17366 system:
17367
17368 @smallexample
17369 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17370 @end smallexample
17371
17372 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17373 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17374 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17375 colons:
17376
17377 @smallexample
17378 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17379 @end smallexample
17380
17381 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17382 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17383 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17384 @samp{z}):
17385
17386 @smallexample
17387 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17388 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17389 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17390 @end smallexample
17391
17392 @noindent
17393 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17394 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17395 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17396
17397 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
17398 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17399
17400 @smallexample
17401 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17402 @end smallexample
17403
17404 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17405 if you don't want or need to.
17406
17407 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
17408 sysroot}.
17409
17410 @cindex default system root
17411 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
17412 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
17413 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
17414 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17415 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
17416 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17417 location.
17418
17419 @kindex show sysroot
17420 @item show sysroot
17421 Display the current shared library prefix.
17422
17423 @kindex set solib-search-path
17424 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
17425 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
17426 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
17427 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
17428 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
17429 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
17430 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17431 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
17432 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
17433 of shared library symbols.
17434
17435 @kindex show solib-search-path
17436 @item show solib-search-path
17437 Display the current shared library search path.
17438
17439 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
17440 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
17441 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
17442 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
17443 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
17444
17445 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
17446 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
17447 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
17448 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
17449 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
17450 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
17451 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
17452 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
17453 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
17454 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
17455 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
17456 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
17457 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
17458 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
17459 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
17460 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
17461 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
17462 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
17463 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
17464 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
17465 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
17466 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
17467
17468 @table @code
17469 @item unix
17470 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
17471 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
17472 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
17473 the forward slash.
17474
17475 @item dos-based
17476 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
17477 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
17478 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
17479 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
17480 considered directory separators.
17481
17482 @item auto
17483 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
17484 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
17485 This is the default.
17486 @end table
17487 @end table
17488
17489 @cindex file name canonicalization
17490 @cindex base name differences
17491 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
17492 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
17493 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
17494 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
17495 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
17496 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
17497 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
17498 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
17499 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
17500 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
17501 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
17502 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
17503 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
17504 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
17505 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
17506
17507 @table @code
17508 @item set basenames-may-differ
17509 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
17510 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17511
17512 @item show basenames-may-differ
17513 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
17514 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17515 @end table
17516
17517 @node Separate Debug Files
17518 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
17519 @cindex separate debugging information files
17520 @cindex debugging information in separate files
17521 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
17522 @cindex debugging information directory, global
17523 @cindex global debugging information directories
17524 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
17525 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
17526
17527 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
17528 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
17529 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
17530 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
17531 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
17532 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
17533 install only when they need to debug a problem.
17534
17535 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
17536 file:
17537
17538 @itemize @bullet
17539 @item
17540 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
17541 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
17542 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
17543 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
17544 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
17545 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
17546 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
17547 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
17548
17549 @item
17550 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
17551 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
17552 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
17553 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
17554 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
17555 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
17556 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
17557 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
17558 below.
17559 @end itemize
17560
17561 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
17562 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
17563
17564 @itemize @bullet
17565 @item
17566 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
17567 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
17568 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
17569 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
17570 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
17571
17572 @item
17573 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
17574 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
17575 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
17576 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
17577 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
17578 hex characters, not 10.)
17579 @end itemize
17580
17581 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
17582 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
17583 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
17584 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
17585 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
17586 debug information files, in the indicated order:
17587
17588 @itemize @minus
17589 @item
17590 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
17591 @item
17592 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
17593 @item
17594 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
17595 @item
17596 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
17597 @end itemize
17598
17599 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
17600 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
17601 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
17602 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
17603 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
17604
17605 @table @code
17606
17607 @kindex set debug-file-directory
17608 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
17609 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17610 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
17611 concatenating them by a path separator.
17612
17613 @kindex show debug-file-directory
17614 @item show debug-file-directory
17615 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17616 information files.
17617
17618 @end table
17619
17620 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
17621 @cindex debug link sections
17622 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
17623 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
17624
17625 @itemize
17626 @item
17627 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
17628 a zero byte,
17629 @item
17630 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
17631 boundary within the section, and
17632 @item
17633 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
17634 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
17635 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
17636 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
17637 @end itemize
17638
17639 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
17640 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
17641 described above.
17642
17643 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
17644 @cindex build ID sections
17645 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
17646 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
17647 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
17648 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
17649 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
17650 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
17651 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
17652 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
17653 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
17654
17655 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
17656 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
17657 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
17658 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
17659 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
17660 in an ordinary executable.
17661
17662 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
17663 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
17664 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
17665 following commands:
17666
17667 @smallexample
17668 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
17669 @kbd{strip -g foo}
17670 @end smallexample
17671
17672 @noindent
17673 These commands remove the debugging
17674 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
17675 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
17676 two files:
17677
17678 @itemize @bullet
17679 @item
17680 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
17681 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
17682
17683 @smallexample
17684 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
17685 @end smallexample
17686
17687 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
17688 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
17689 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
17690 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
17691
17692 @item
17693 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
17694 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
17695 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
17696 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
17697 @end itemize
17698
17699 @noindent
17700
17701 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
17702 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
17703 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
17704
17705 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
17706 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
17707 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
17708 @c different ways!
17709 @ifhtml
17710 @display
17711 @html
17712 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
17713 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
17714 @end html
17715 @end display
17716 @end ifhtml
17717 @ifnothtml
17718 @display
17719 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
17720 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
17721 @end display
17722 @end ifnothtml
17723
17724 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
17725 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
17726 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
17727 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
17728 CRC.
17729
17730 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
17731 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
17732 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
17733 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
17734 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
17735
17736 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
17737 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
17738 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
17739 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
17740 @code{0xffffffff}.
17741
17742 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
17743 @smallexample
17744 unsigned long
17745 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
17746 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
17747 @{
17748 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
17749 @{
17750 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
17751 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
17752 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
17753 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
17754 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
17755 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
17756 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
17757 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
17758 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
17759 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
17760 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
17761 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
17762 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
17763 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
17764 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
17765 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
17766 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
17767 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
17768 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
17769 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
17770 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
17771 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
17772 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
17773 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
17774 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
17775 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
17776 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
17777 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
17778 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
17779 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
17780 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
17781 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
17782 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
17783 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
17784 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
17785 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
17786 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
17787 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
17788 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
17789 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
17790 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
17791 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
17792 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
17793 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
17794 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
17795 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
17796 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
17797 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
17798 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
17799 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
17800 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
17801 0x2d02ef8d
17802 @};
17803 unsigned char *end;
17804
17805 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17806 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
17807 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
17808 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17809 @}
17810 @end smallexample
17811
17812 @noindent
17813 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
17814
17815 @node MiniDebugInfo
17816 @section Debugging information in a special section
17817 @cindex separate debug sections
17818 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
17819
17820 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
17821 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
17822 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
17823 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
17824
17825 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
17826 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
17827 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
17828 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
17829 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
17830 debugging information might be included in the section.
17831
17832 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
17833 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
17834 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
17835
17836 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
17837 standard utilities:
17838
17839 @smallexample
17840 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
17841 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
17842 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17843 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
17844
17845 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
17846 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
17847 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
17848 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17849 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
17850 | sort > funcsyms
17851
17852 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
17853 # table.
17854 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
17855
17856 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
17857 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
17858
17859 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
17860 # removing some unnecessary sections.
17861 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
17862 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
17863
17864 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
17865 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
17866
17867 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
17868 # original binary.
17869 xz mini_debuginfo
17870 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
17871 @end smallexample
17872
17873 @node Index Files
17874 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
17875 @cindex index files
17876 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
17877
17878 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
17879 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
17880 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
17881 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
17882 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
17883 startup.
17884
17885 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
17886 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
17887 using @command{objcopy}.
17888
17889 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
17890
17891 @table @code
17892 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
17893 @kindex save gdb-index
17894 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
17895 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
17896 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
17897 @var{directory}.
17898 @end table
17899
17900 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
17901 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
17902
17903 @smallexample
17904 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
17905 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
17906 @end smallexample
17907
17908 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
17909 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
17910 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
17911 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
17912 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
17913 The default is @code{off}.
17914 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
17915 @xref{Index Section Format}.
17916
17917 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
17918 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
17919
17920 @smallexample
17921 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17922 @end smallexample
17923
17924 Instead you must do, for example,
17925
17926 @smallexample
17927 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17928 @end smallexample
17929
17930 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
17931 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
17932 currently work for programs using Ada.
17933
17934 @node Symbol Errors
17935 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
17936
17937 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
17938 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
17939 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
17940 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
17941 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
17942 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
17943 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
17944 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
17945 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
17946 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17947 Messages}).
17948
17949 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
17950
17951 @table @code
17952 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
17953
17954 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
17955 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
17956 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
17957 in its outer scope blocks.
17958
17959 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
17960 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
17961 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
17962 function.
17963
17964 @item block at @var{address} out of order
17965
17966 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
17967 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
17968 do so.
17969
17970 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
17971 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
17972 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
17973 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17974 Messages}.)
17975
17976 @item bad block start address patched
17977
17978 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
17979 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
17980 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
17981
17982 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
17983 starting on the previous source line.
17984
17985 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
17986
17987 @cindex foo
17988 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
17989 larger than the size of the string table.
17990
17991 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
17992 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
17993 with this name.
17994
17995 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
17996
17997 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
17998 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
17999 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18000
18001 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18002 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18003 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18004 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18005 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18006 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18007
18008 @item stub type has NULL name
18009
18010 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18011
18012 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18013 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18014 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18015 it.
18016
18017 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18018
18019 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18020
18021 @end table
18022
18023 @node Data Files
18024 @section GDB Data Files
18025
18026 @cindex prefix for data files
18027 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18028 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18029
18030 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18031 is currently using.
18032
18033 @table @code
18034 @kindex set data-directory
18035 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18036 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18037 to @var{directory}.
18038
18039 @kindex show data-directory
18040 @item show data-directory
18041 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18042 @end table
18043
18044 @cindex default data directory
18045 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18046 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18047 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18048 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18049 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18050 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18051 location.
18052
18053 The data directory may also be specified with the
18054 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18055 @xref{Mode Options}.
18056
18057 @node Targets
18058 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18059
18060 @cindex debugging target
18061 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18062
18063 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18064 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18065 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18066 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18067 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18068 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18069 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18070 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18071
18072 @cindex target architecture
18073 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18074 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18075 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18076 command.
18077
18078 @table @code
18079 @kindex set architecture
18080 @kindex show architecture
18081 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18082 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18083 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18084 supported architectures.
18085
18086 @item show architecture
18087 Show the current target architecture.
18088
18089 @item set processor
18090 @itemx processor
18091 @kindex set processor
18092 @kindex show processor
18093 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18094 and @code{show architecture}.
18095 @end table
18096
18097 @menu
18098 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18099 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18100 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18101 @end menu
18102
18103 @node Active Targets
18104 @section Active Targets
18105
18106 @cindex stacking targets
18107 @cindex active targets
18108 @cindex multiple targets
18109
18110 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18111 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18112 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18113 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18114 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18115 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18116 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18117 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18118 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18119
18120 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18121 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18122 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18123 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18124
18125 @node Target Commands
18126 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18127
18128 @table @code
18129 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18130 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18131 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18132 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18133 protocol of the target machine.
18134
18135 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18136 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18137 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18138
18139 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18140 after executing the command.
18141
18142 @kindex help target
18143 @item help target
18144 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
18145 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
18146 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18147
18148 @item help target @var{name}
18149 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18150 select it.
18151
18152 @kindex set gnutarget
18153 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18154 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18155 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18156 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18157 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18158 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18159
18160 @quotation
18161 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18162 you must know the actual BFD name.
18163 @end quotation
18164
18165 @noindent
18166 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18167
18168 @kindex show gnutarget
18169 @item show gnutarget
18170 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18171 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18172 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18173 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18174 @end table
18175
18176 @cindex common targets
18177 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18178 configuration):
18179
18180 @table @code
18181 @kindex target
18182 @item target exec @var{program}
18183 @cindex executable file target
18184 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18185 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18186
18187 @item target core @var{filename}
18188 @cindex core dump file target
18189 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18190 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18191
18192 @item target remote @var{medium}
18193 @cindex remote target
18194 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18195 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18196 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18197
18198 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18199 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18200
18201 @smallexample
18202 target remote /dev/ttya
18203 @end smallexample
18204
18205 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18206 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18207 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18208 clobbered by the download.
18209
18210 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18211 @cindex built-in simulator target
18212 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18213 In general,
18214 @smallexample
18215 target sim
18216 load
18217 run
18218 @end smallexample
18219 @noindent
18220 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18221 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18222 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18223 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18224 Processors}.
18225
18226 @item target native
18227 @cindex native target
18228 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
18229 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
18230 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
18231 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
18232
18233 @end table
18234
18235 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18236 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18237
18238 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18239 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18240 various aspects of this process.
18241
18242 @table @code
18243
18244 @item set hash
18245 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18246 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18247 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18248 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18249 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18250 monitor.
18251
18252 @item show hash
18253 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18254 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18255
18256 @item set debug monitor
18257 @kindex set debug monitor
18258 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18259 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18260 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18261
18262 @item show debug monitor
18263 @kindex show debug monitor
18264 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18265 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18266 @end table
18267
18268 @table @code
18269
18270 @kindex load @var{filename}
18271 @item load @var{filename}
18272 @anchor{load}
18273 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18274 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18275 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18276 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18277 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18278 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18279
18280 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18281 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18282 target is @dots{}}''
18283
18284 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18285 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18286 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18287 specifies a fixed address.
18288 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18289
18290 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18291 load programs into flash memory.
18292
18293 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18294 @end table
18295
18296 @node Byte Order
18297 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18298
18299 @cindex choosing target byte order
18300 @cindex target byte order
18301
18302 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18303 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18304 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18305 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18306 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18307 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18308
18309 @table @code
18310 @kindex set endian
18311 @item set endian big
18312 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18313
18314 @item set endian little
18315 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18316
18317 @item set endian auto
18318 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18319 executable.
18320
18321 @item show endian
18322 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18323
18324 @end table
18325
18326 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18327 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18328 target system.
18329
18330
18331 @node Remote Debugging
18332 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18333 @cindex remote debugging
18334
18335 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18336 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18337 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18338 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18339 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18340
18341 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18342 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18343 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18344 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18345 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18346 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18347
18348 Other remote targets may be available in your
18349 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18350
18351 @menu
18352 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18353 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18354 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18355 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18356 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18357 @end menu
18358
18359 @node Connecting
18360 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18361
18362 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18363 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18364 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18365 program as the first argument.
18366
18367 @cindex @code{target remote}
18368 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18369 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18370 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18371 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18372 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18373 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18374
18375 @table @code
18376
18377 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18378 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18379 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18380 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18381
18382 @smallexample
18383 target remote /dev/ttyb
18384 @end smallexample
18385
18386 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18387 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18388 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18389 @code{target} command.
18390
18391 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18392 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18393 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18394 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18395 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18396 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18397 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18398 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18399 target.
18400
18401 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18402 @code{manyfarms}:
18403
18404 @smallexample
18405 target remote manyfarms:2828
18406 @end smallexample
18407
18408 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
18409 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
18410 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
18411 port 1234 on your local machine:
18412
18413 @smallexample
18414 target remote :1234
18415 @end smallexample
18416 @noindent
18417
18418 Note that the colon is still required here.
18419
18420 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18421 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
18422 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
18423 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
18424
18425 @smallexample
18426 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
18427 @end smallexample
18428
18429 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
18430 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
18431 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
18432 cause havoc with your debugging session.
18433
18434 @item target remote | @var{command}
18435 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
18436 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
18437 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
18438 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
18439 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
18440 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
18441 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
18442 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
18443
18444 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
18445 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
18446 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
18447
18448 @end table
18449
18450 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
18451 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
18452 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
18453 need to use @kbd{run}.
18454
18455 @cindex interrupting remote programs
18456 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
18457 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
18458 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
18459 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
18460 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
18461 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
18462
18463 @smallexample
18464 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
18465 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
18466 @end smallexample
18467
18468 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
18469 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
18470 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
18471 goes back to waiting.
18472
18473 @table @code
18474 @kindex detach (remote)
18475 @item detach
18476 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
18477 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
18478 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
18479 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
18480 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
18481
18482 @kindex disconnect
18483 @item disconnect
18484 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
18485 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
18486 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
18487 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
18488 another target.
18489
18490 @cindex send command to remote monitor
18491 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
18492 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
18493 @kindex monitor
18494 @item monitor @var{cmd}
18495 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
18496 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
18497 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
18498 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
18499 and implement.
18500 @end table
18501
18502 @node File Transfer
18503 @section Sending files to a remote system
18504 @cindex remote target, file transfer
18505 @cindex file transfer
18506 @cindex sending files to remote systems
18507
18508 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
18509 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
18510 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
18511 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
18512 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
18513 the only way to upload or download files.
18514
18515 Not all remote targets support these commands.
18516
18517 @table @code
18518 @kindex remote put
18519 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
18520 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
18521 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
18522
18523 @kindex remote get
18524 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
18525 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
18526 on the host system.
18527
18528 @kindex remote delete
18529 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
18530 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
18531
18532 @end table
18533
18534 @node Server
18535 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
18536
18537 @kindex gdbserver
18538 @cindex remote connection without stubs
18539 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
18540 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
18541 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
18542
18543 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
18544 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
18545 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
18546 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
18547 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
18548 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
18549 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
18550 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
18551 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
18552 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
18553 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
18554 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
18555 choice for debugging.
18556
18557 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
18558 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
18559 protocol.
18560
18561 @quotation
18562 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
18563 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
18564 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
18565 target system with the same privileges as the user running
18566 @code{gdbserver}.
18567 @end quotation
18568
18569 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
18570 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
18571 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
18572
18573 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
18574 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
18575 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
18576 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
18577 system does all the symbol handling.
18578
18579 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
18580 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
18581 syntax is:
18582
18583 @smallexample
18584 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
18585 @end smallexample
18586
18587 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
18588 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
18589 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
18590 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
18591 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
18592 @file{/dev/com1}:
18593
18594 @smallexample
18595 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
18596 @end smallexample
18597
18598 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
18599 with it.
18600
18601 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
18602
18603 @smallexample
18604 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
18605 @end smallexample
18606
18607 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
18608 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
18609 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
18610 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
18611 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
18612 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
18613 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
18614 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
18615 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
18616 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
18617 @code{target remote} command.
18618
18619 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
18620 with ssh:
18621
18622 @smallexample
18623 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
18624 @end smallexample
18625
18626 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
18627 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
18628 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
18629 You could elide it if you want to.
18630
18631 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
18632 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
18633 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
18634 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
18635
18636 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
18637 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
18638 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
18639
18640 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
18641 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
18642
18643 @smallexample
18644 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
18645 @end smallexample
18646
18647 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
18648 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
18649
18650 @pindex pidof
18651 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
18652 @code{pidof} utility:
18653
18654 @smallexample
18655 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
18656 @end smallexample
18657
18658 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
18659 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
18660 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
18661
18662 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
18663 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
18664 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
18665
18666 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
18667 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
18668 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
18669 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
18670
18671 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
18672 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
18673 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
18674 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
18675 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
18676 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
18677 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
18678 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
18679 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
18680
18681 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
18682 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
18683 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
18684 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
18685 the program you want to debug.
18686
18687 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
18688 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
18689 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
18690 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
18691 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
18692 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
18693
18694 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
18695
18696 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
18697
18698 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
18699 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
18700 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
18701 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
18702 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
18703 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
18704 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
18705 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
18706
18707 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
18708 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
18709 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
18710
18711 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
18712 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
18713 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
18714 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
18715 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
18716 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
18717 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
18718 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
18719 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
18720 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
18721 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
18722 instance closes its port after the first connection.
18723
18724 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
18725 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
18726
18727 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18728 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
18729 status information about the debugging process.
18730 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18731 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
18732 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
18733 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
18734
18735 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
18736 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
18737 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
18738 Possible options are:
18739
18740 @table @code
18741 @item none
18742 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18743 @item all
18744 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18745 @item timestamps
18746 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18747 @end table
18748
18749 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18750 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18751
18752 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
18753 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
18754 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
18755 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
18756 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
18757
18758 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
18759 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
18760 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
18761 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
18762
18763 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
18764 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
18765 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
18766 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
18767
18768 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
18769 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
18770 environment:
18771
18772 @smallexample
18773 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
18774 @end smallexample
18775
18776 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
18777
18778 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
18779
18780 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
18781 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
18782 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
18783 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
18784
18785 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
18786 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
18787 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
18788 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
18789 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
18790 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
18791 programs.
18792
18793 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
18794 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
18795 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
18796 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
18797 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
18798 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
18799 already on the target.
18800
18801 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
18802 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
18803 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
18804
18805 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
18806 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
18807 Here are the available commands.
18808
18809 @table @code
18810 @item monitor help
18811 List the available monitor commands.
18812
18813 @item monitor set debug 0
18814 @itemx monitor set debug 1
18815 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
18816
18817 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
18818 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
18819 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
18820 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
18821
18822 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
18823 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
18824 Possible options are:
18825
18826 @table @code
18827 @item none
18828 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18829 @item all
18830 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18831 @item timestamps
18832 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18833 @end table
18834
18835 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18836 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18837
18838 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
18839 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
18840 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18841 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
18842 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
18843 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
18844
18845 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
18846 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
18847
18848 @item monitor exit
18849 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
18850 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
18851 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
18852 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
18853 of a multi-process mode debug session.
18854
18855 @end table
18856
18857 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18858 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18859
18860 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
18861 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
18862
18863 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
18864 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
18865 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
18866 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
18867 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
18868 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
18869 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
18870 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
18871 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
18872 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
18873 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
18874 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
18875
18876 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
18877
18878 @table @code
18879 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
18880
18881 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
18882 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
18883 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
18884
18885 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
18886
18887 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
18888 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
18889 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
18890 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
18891 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
18892 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
18893
18894 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
18895
18896 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
18897 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
18898 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
18899 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
18900 command for that. For example:
18901
18902 @smallexample
18903 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
18904 @end smallexample
18905
18906 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
18907 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
18908 @end table
18909
18910 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
18911 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
18912 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
18913 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
18914 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
18915 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
18916 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
18917 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
18918 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
18919 @code{gdbserver} like so:
18920
18921 @smallexample
18922 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
18923 @end smallexample
18924
18925 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
18926
18927 @smallexample
18928 $ gdb myprogram
18929 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
18930 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
18931 (@value{GDBP}) b main
18932 (@value{GDBP}) continue
18933 @end smallexample
18934
18935 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
18936 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
18937 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
18938 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
18939 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
18940 tracing.
18941
18942 @node Remote Configuration
18943 @section Remote Configuration
18944
18945 @kindex set remote
18946 @kindex show remote
18947 This section documents the configuration options available when
18948 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
18949 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
18950 system-call-allowed}.
18951
18952 @table @code
18953 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
18954 @cindex address size for remote targets
18955 @cindex bits in remote address
18956 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
18957 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
18958 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
18959 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
18960
18961 @item show remoteaddresssize
18962 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
18963
18964 @item set serial baud @var{n}
18965 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
18966 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
18967 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
18968 remote targets.
18969
18970 @item show serial baud
18971 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
18972
18973 @item set remotebreak
18974 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18975 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
18976 @anchor{set remotebreak}
18977 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
18978 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
18979 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
18980 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
18981 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
18982
18983 @item show remotebreak
18984 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
18985 interrupt the remote program.
18986
18987 @item set remoteflow on
18988 @itemx set remoteflow off
18989 @kindex set remoteflow
18990 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
18991 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
18992
18993 @item show remoteflow
18994 @kindex show remoteflow
18995 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
18996
18997 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
18998 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
18999 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
19000 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
19001 @code{ascii}.
19002
19003 @item show remotelogbase
19004 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
19005 protocol.
19006
19007 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
19008 @cindex record serial communications on file
19009 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
19010 default is not to record at all.
19011
19012 @item show remotelogfile.
19013 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19014 serial communications.
19015
19016 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19017 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19018 @cindex remote timeout
19019 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19020 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19021
19022 @item show remotetimeout
19023 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19024 responses.
19025
19026 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19027 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19028 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19029 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19030 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19031 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19032 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19033 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19034
19035 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19036 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19037 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19038 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19039 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19040 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19041 as unlimited.
19042
19043 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19044 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19045 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19046
19047 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19048 @itemx show remote exec-file
19049 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19050 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19051 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19052 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19053 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19054 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19055
19056 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19057 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19058 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19059 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19060 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19061 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19062 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19063 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19064 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19065 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19066
19067 @item show interrupt-sequence
19068 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19069 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19070 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19071 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19072
19073 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19074 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19075 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19076 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19077 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19078 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19079
19080 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19081 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19082 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19083
19084 @kindex set tcp
19085 @kindex show tcp
19086 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19087 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19088 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19089 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19090 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19091 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19092 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19093 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19094 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19095
19096 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19097 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19098
19099 @item show tcp auto-retry
19100 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19101
19102 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19103 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19104 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19105 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19106 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19107 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19108 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19109 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19110 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19111 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19112 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19113
19114 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19115 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19116 @end table
19117
19118 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19119 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19120 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19121 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19122 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19123 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19124 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19125 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19126 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19127
19128 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
19129 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
19130 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
19131 @value{GDBN} developers.
19132
19133 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
19134 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
19135 are:
19136
19137 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
19138 @item Command Name
19139 @tab Remote Packet
19140 @tab Related Features
19141
19142 @item @code{fetch-register}
19143 @tab @code{p}
19144 @tab @code{info registers}
19145
19146 @item @code{set-register}
19147 @tab @code{P}
19148 @tab @code{set}
19149
19150 @item @code{binary-download}
19151 @tab @code{X}
19152 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
19153
19154 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19155 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19156 @tab @code{info auxv}
19157
19158 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19159 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19160 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19161
19162 @item @code{attach}
19163 @tab @code{vAttach}
19164 @tab @code{attach}
19165
19166 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19167 @tab @code{vCont}
19168 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19169
19170 @item @code{run}
19171 @tab @code{vRun}
19172 @tab @code{run}
19173
19174 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19175 @tab @code{Z0}
19176 @tab @code{break}
19177
19178 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19179 @tab @code{Z1}
19180 @tab @code{hbreak}
19181
19182 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19183 @tab @code{Z2}
19184 @tab @code{watch}
19185
19186 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19187 @tab @code{Z3}
19188 @tab @code{rwatch}
19189
19190 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19191 @tab @code{Z4}
19192 @tab @code{awatch}
19193
19194 @item @code{target-features}
19195 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19196 @tab @code{set architecture}
19197
19198 @item @code{library-info}
19199 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19200 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19201
19202 @item @code{memory-map}
19203 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19204 @tab @code{info mem}
19205
19206 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19207 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19208 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19209
19210 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19211 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19212 @tab @code{info spu}
19213
19214 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19215 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19216 @tab @code{info spu}
19217
19218 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19219 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19220 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19221
19222 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19223 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19224 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19225
19226 @item @code{threads}
19227 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19228 @tab @code{info threads}
19229
19230 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19231 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19232 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19233
19234 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19235 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19236 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19237
19238 @item @code{search-memory}
19239 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19240 @tab @code{find}
19241
19242 @item @code{supported-packets}
19243 @tab @code{qSupported}
19244 @tab Remote communications parameters
19245
19246 @item @code{pass-signals}
19247 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19248 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19249
19250 @item @code{program-signals}
19251 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19252 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19253
19254 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19255 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19256 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19257
19258 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19259 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19260 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19261
19262 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19263 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19264 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19265
19266 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19267 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19268 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19269
19270 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19271 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19272 @tab @code{remote delete}
19273
19274 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19275 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19276 @tab Host I/O
19277
19278 @item @code{noack-packet}
19279 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19280 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19281
19282 @item @code{osdata}
19283 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19284 @tab @code{info os}
19285
19286 @item @code{query-attached}
19287 @tab @code{qAttached}
19288 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19289
19290 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19291 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19292 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19293
19294 @item @code{trace-status}
19295 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19296 @tab @code{tstatus}
19297
19298 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19299 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19300 @tab Traceframe info
19301
19302 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19303 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19304 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19305
19306 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19307 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19308 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19309
19310 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19311 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19312 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19313 @end multitable
19314
19315 @node Remote Stub
19316 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19317
19318 @cindex debugging stub, example
19319 @cindex remote stub, example
19320 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19321 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19322 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19323 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19324 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19325 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19326 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19327 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19328
19329 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19330 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19331 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19332 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19333 program, you need:
19334
19335 @enumerate
19336 @item
19337 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19338 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19339 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19340
19341 @item
19342 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19343 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19344
19345 @item
19346 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19347 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19348 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19349 documentation.
19350 @end enumerate
19351
19352 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19353 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19354 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19355
19356 @table @emph
19357 @item On the host,
19358 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19359 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19360 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19361
19362 @item On the target,
19363 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19364 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19365 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19366
19367 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19368 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19369 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19370 @end table
19371
19372 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19373 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19374 @sc{sparc} boards.
19375
19376 @cindex remote serial stub list
19377 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19378
19379 @table @code
19380
19381 @item i386-stub.c
19382 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19383 @cindex Intel
19384 @cindex i386
19385 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19386
19387 @item m68k-stub.c
19388 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
19389 @cindex Motorola 680x0
19390 @cindex m680x0
19391 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
19392
19393 @item sh-stub.c
19394 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
19395 @cindex Renesas
19396 @cindex SH
19397 For Renesas SH architectures.
19398
19399 @item sparc-stub.c
19400 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
19401 @cindex Sparc
19402 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
19403
19404 @item sparcl-stub.c
19405 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
19406 @cindex Fujitsu
19407 @cindex SparcLite
19408 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
19409
19410 @end table
19411
19412 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
19413 recently added stubs.
19414
19415 @menu
19416 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
19417 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
19418 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
19419 @end menu
19420
19421 @node Stub Contents
19422 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
19423
19424 @cindex remote serial stub
19425 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
19426 subroutines:
19427
19428 @table @code
19429 @item set_debug_traps
19430 @findex set_debug_traps
19431 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
19432 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
19433 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
19434 program's startup code.
19435
19436 @item handle_exception
19437 @findex handle_exception
19438 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
19439 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
19440 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
19441 run when a trap is triggered.
19442
19443 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
19444 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
19445 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
19446 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
19447 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
19448 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
19449 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
19450 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
19451 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
19452 machine.
19453
19454 @item breakpoint
19455 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
19456 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
19457 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
19458 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
19459 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
19460 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
19461 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
19462 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
19463 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
19464 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
19465 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
19466
19467 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
19468 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
19469 start of your debugging session.
19470 @end table
19471
19472 @node Bootstrapping
19473 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
19474
19475 @cindex remote stub, support routines
19476 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
19477 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
19478 debugging target machine.
19479
19480 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
19481 serial port.
19482
19483 @table @code
19484 @item int getDebugChar()
19485 @findex getDebugChar
19486 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
19487 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
19488 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19489
19490 @item void putDebugChar(int)
19491 @findex putDebugChar
19492 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
19493 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
19494 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19495 @end table
19496
19497 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
19498 @cindex interrupting remote targets
19499 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
19500 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
19501 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
19502 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
19503 remote system to stop.
19504
19505 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
19506 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
19507 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
19508 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
19509
19510 Other routines you need to supply are:
19511
19512 @table @code
19513 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
19514 @findex exceptionHandler
19515 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
19516 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
19517 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
19518 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
19519 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
19520 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
19521 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
19522 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
19523 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
19524 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
19525 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
19526 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
19527 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
19528
19529 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
19530 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
19531 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
19532 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
19533 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
19534
19535 @item void flush_i_cache()
19536 @findex flush_i_cache
19537 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
19538 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
19539 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
19540
19541 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
19542 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
19543 @end table
19544
19545 @noindent
19546 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
19547
19548 @table @code
19549 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
19550 @findex memset
19551 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
19552 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
19553 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
19554 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
19555 @end table
19556
19557 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
19558 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
19559 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
19560 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
19561
19562
19563 @node Debug Session
19564 @subsection Putting it All Together
19565
19566 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
19567 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
19568 steps.
19569
19570 @enumerate
19571 @item
19572 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
19573 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
19574 @display
19575 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
19576 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
19577 @end display
19578
19579 @item
19580 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
19581 procedure is called:
19582
19583 @smallexample
19584 set_debug_traps();
19585 breakpoint();
19586 @end smallexample
19587
19588 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
19589 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
19590 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
19591 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
19592 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
19593 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
19594 progress.
19595
19596 @item
19597 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
19598 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
19599
19600 @smallexample
19601 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
19602 @end smallexample
19603
19604 @noindent
19605 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
19606 function in your program, that function is called when
19607 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
19608 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
19609 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
19610
19611 @item
19612 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
19613 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
19614
19615 @item
19616 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
19617 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
19618
19619 @item
19620 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
19621 @c document that. FIXME.
19622 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
19623 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
19624
19625 @item
19626 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
19627 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19628
19629 @end enumerate
19630
19631 @node Configurations
19632 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
19633
19634 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
19635 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
19636 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
19637
19638 There are three major categories of configurations: native
19639 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
19640 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
19641 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
19642 are quite different from each other.
19643
19644 @menu
19645 * Native::
19646 * Embedded OS::
19647 * Embedded Processors::
19648 * Architectures::
19649 @end menu
19650
19651 @node Native
19652 @section Native
19653
19654 This section describes details specific to particular native
19655 configurations.
19656
19657 @menu
19658 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
19659 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
19660 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
19661 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
19662 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
19663 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
19664 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
19665 @end menu
19666
19667 @node HP-UX
19668 @subsection HP-UX
19669
19670 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
19671 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
19672 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
19673
19674
19675 @node BSD libkvm Interface
19676 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
19677
19678 @cindex libkvm
19679 @cindex kernel memory image
19680 @cindex kernel crash dump
19681
19682 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
19683 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
19684 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
19685 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
19686 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
19687 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
19688 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
19689 @code{kvm} target:
19690
19691 @smallexample
19692 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
19693 @end smallexample
19694
19695 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
19696 argument:
19697
19698 @smallexample
19699 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
19700 @end smallexample
19701
19702 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
19703 available:
19704
19705 @table @code
19706 @kindex kvm
19707 @item kvm pcb
19708 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
19709
19710 @item kvm proc
19711 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
19712 modern FreeBSD systems.
19713 @end table
19714
19715 @node SVR4 Process Information
19716 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
19717 @cindex /proc
19718 @cindex examine process image
19719 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
19720
19721 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
19722 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
19723 process using file-system subroutines.
19724
19725 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
19726 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
19727 information about the process running your program, or about any
19728 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
19729 @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, and Irix, but
19730 not HP-UX, for example.
19731
19732 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
19733 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
19734
19735 @table @code
19736 @kindex info proc
19737 @cindex process ID
19738 @item info proc
19739 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
19740 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
19741 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
19742 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
19743 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
19744 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
19745 executable file's absolute file name.
19746
19747 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
19748 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
19749 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
19750 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
19751 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
19752 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
19753
19754 @item info proc cmdline
19755 @cindex info proc cmdline
19756 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
19757 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19758
19759 @item info proc cwd
19760 @cindex info proc cwd
19761 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
19762 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19763
19764 @item info proc exe
19765 @cindex info proc exe
19766 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
19767 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19768
19769 @item info proc mappings
19770 @cindex memory address space mappings
19771 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
19772 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
19773 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
19774 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
19775 memory access rights to that range.
19776
19777 @item info proc stat
19778 @itemx info proc status
19779 @cindex process detailed status information
19780 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
19781 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
19782 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
19783 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
19784 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
19785 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
19786 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
19787
19788 @item info proc all
19789 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
19790 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
19791
19792 @ignore
19793 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
19794 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
19795 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
19796 @kindex info proc times
19797 @item info proc times
19798 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
19799 its children.
19800
19801 @kindex info proc id
19802 @item info proc id
19803 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
19804 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
19805 @end ignore
19806
19807 @item set procfs-trace
19808 @kindex set procfs-trace
19809 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
19810 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
19811
19812 @item show procfs-trace
19813 @kindex show procfs-trace
19814 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
19815
19816 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
19817 @kindex set procfs-file
19818 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
19819 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
19820 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
19821 standard output.
19822
19823 @item show procfs-file
19824 @kindex show procfs-file
19825 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
19826
19827 @item proc-trace-entry
19828 @itemx proc-trace-exit
19829 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
19830 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
19831 @kindex proc-trace-entry
19832 @kindex proc-trace-exit
19833 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
19834 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
19835 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
19836 from the @code{syscall} interface.
19837
19838 @item info pidlist
19839 @kindex info pidlist
19840 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
19841 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
19842 processes and all the threads within each process.
19843
19844 @item info meminfo
19845 @kindex info meminfo
19846 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
19847 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
19848 @end table
19849
19850 @node DJGPP Native
19851 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
19852 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
19853 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
19854 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
19855
19856 @cindex DPMI
19857 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
19858 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
19859 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
19860 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
19861
19862 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
19863 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
19864 subsection describes those commands.
19865
19866 @table @code
19867 @kindex info dos
19868 @item info dos
19869 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
19870 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19871
19872 @kindex sysinfo
19873 @cindex MS-DOS system info
19874 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
19875 @item info dos sysinfo
19876 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
19877 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
19878 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
19879
19880 @cindex GDT
19881 @cindex LDT
19882 @cindex IDT
19883 @cindex segment descriptor tables
19884 @cindex descriptor tables display
19885 @item info dos gdt
19886 @itemx info dos ldt
19887 @itemx info dos idt
19888 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
19889 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
19890 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
19891 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
19892 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
19893 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
19894 rights.
19895
19896 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
19897 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
19898 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
19899 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
19900 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
19901
19902 @cindex garbled pointers
19903 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
19904 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
19905 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
19906 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
19907 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
19908 debugged program's data segment:
19909
19910 @smallexample
19911 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
19912 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
19913 @end smallexample
19914
19915 @noindent
19916 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
19917 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
19918
19919 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
19920 @item info dos pde
19921 @itemx info dos pte
19922 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
19923 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
19924 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
19925 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
19926 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
19927 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
19928 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
19929 that is currently in use.
19930
19931 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
19932 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
19933 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
19934 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
19935 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
19936 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
19937 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
19938
19939 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
19940 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
19941 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
19942 controller.
19943
19944 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
19945
19946 @cindex physical address from linear address
19947 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
19948 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
19949 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
19950 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
19951 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
19952 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
19953 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
19954
19955 @smallexample
19956 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
19957 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
19958 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
19959 @end smallexample
19960
19961 @noindent
19962 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
19963 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
19964 attributes of that page.
19965
19966 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
19967 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
19968 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
19969 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
19970 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
19971 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
19972
19973 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
19974 transfer buffer:
19975
19976 @smallexample
19977 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
19978 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
19979 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
19980 @end smallexample
19981
19982 @noindent
19983 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
19984 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
19985 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
19986 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
19987 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
19988
19989 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
19990 @end table
19991
19992 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
19993 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
19994 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
19995 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
19996
19997 @table @code
19998 @kindex set com1base
19999 @kindex set com1irq
20000 @kindex set com2base
20001 @kindex set com2irq
20002 @kindex set com3base
20003 @kindex set com3irq
20004 @kindex set com4base
20005 @kindex set com4irq
20006 @item set com1base @var{addr}
20007 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
20008 port.
20009
20010 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
20011 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
20012 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20013
20014 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20015 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20016 other 3 COM ports.
20017
20018 @kindex show com1base
20019 @kindex show com1irq
20020 @kindex show com2base
20021 @kindex show com2irq
20022 @kindex show com3base
20023 @kindex show com3irq
20024 @kindex show com4base
20025 @kindex show com4irq
20026 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20027 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20028 lines used by the COM ports.
20029
20030 @item info serial
20031 @kindex info serial
20032 @cindex DOS serial port status
20033 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20034 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20035 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20036 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20037 @end table
20038
20039
20040 @node Cygwin Native
20041 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20042 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20043 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20044 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20045
20046 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20047 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20048
20049 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20050 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20051 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20052 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20053 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20054 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20055 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20056 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20057
20058 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20059 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20060 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20061
20062 @table @code
20063 @kindex info w32
20064 @item info w32
20065 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20066 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20067
20068 @item info w32 selector
20069 This command displays information returned by
20070 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
20071 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
20072 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
20073 Without argument, this command displays information
20074 about the six segment registers.
20075
20076 @item info w32 thread-information-block
20077 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
20078 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
20079 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
20080
20081 @kindex info dll
20082 @item info dll
20083 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
20084
20085 @kindex dll-symbols
20086 @item dll-symbols
20087 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
20088 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
20089
20090 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
20091 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
20092
20093 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20094 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20095 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20096 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20097 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20098 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20099 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20100 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20101 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20102 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20103 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20104
20105 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20106 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20107 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20108 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20109
20110 @kindex set new-console
20111 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20112 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
20113 be started in a new console on next start.
20114 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
20115 be started in the same console as the debugger.
20116
20117 @kindex show new-console
20118 @item show new-console
20119 Displays whether a new console is used
20120 when the debuggee is started.
20121
20122 @kindex set new-group
20123 @item set new-group @var{mode}
20124 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
20125 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
20126 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
20127 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
20128
20129 @kindex show new-group
20130 @item show new-group
20131 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
20132
20133 @kindex set debugevents
20134 @item set debugevents
20135 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
20136 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
20137 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
20138 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
20139 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
20140
20141 @kindex set debugexec
20142 @item set debugexec
20143 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
20144 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
20145
20146 @kindex set debugexceptions
20147 @item set debugexceptions
20148 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
20149 debuggee seen by the debugger.
20150
20151 @kindex set debugmemory
20152 @item set debugmemory
20153 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
20154 and writes by the debugger.
20155
20156 @kindex set shell
20157 @item set shell
20158 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20159 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20160
20161 @kindex show shell
20162 @item show shell
20163 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20164
20165 @end table
20166
20167 @menu
20168 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20169 @end menu
20170
20171 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20172 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20173 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20174 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20175
20176 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20177 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20178 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20179 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20180 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20181 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20182 ``minimal symbols''.
20183
20184 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20185 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20186 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20187 program run once to completion.
20188
20189 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20190
20191 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20192 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20193 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20194 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20195 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20196 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20197 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20198 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20199 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20200
20201 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20202 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20203 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20204 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20205 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20206 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20207
20208 @smallexample
20209 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20210 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20211
20212 Non-debugging symbols:
20213 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20214 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20215 @end smallexample
20216
20217 @smallexample
20218 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20219 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20220
20221 Non-debugging symbols:
20222 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20223 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20224 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20225 [etc...]
20226 @end smallexample
20227
20228 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20229
20230 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20231 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20232 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20233 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20234 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20235 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20236 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20237
20238 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20239 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20240 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20241 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20242 problem:
20243
20244 @smallexample
20245 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20246 $1 = 268572168
20247 @end smallexample
20248
20249 @smallexample
20250 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20251 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20252 @end smallexample
20253
20254 And two possible solutions:
20255
20256 @smallexample
20257 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20258 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20259 @end smallexample
20260
20261 @smallexample
20262 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20263 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20264 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20265 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20266 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20267 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20268 @end smallexample
20269
20270 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20271 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20272 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20273 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20274 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20275
20276 @smallexample
20277 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20278 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20279 @end smallexample
20280
20281 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20282 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20283 safe.
20284
20285 @node Hurd Native
20286 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20287 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20288
20289 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20290 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20291
20292 @table @code
20293 @item set signals
20294 @itemx set sigs
20295 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20296 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20297 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20298 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20299 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20300 @code{signals}.
20301
20302 @item show signals
20303 @itemx show sigs
20304 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20305 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20306 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20307
20308 @item set signal-thread
20309 @itemx set sigthread
20310 @kindex set signal-thread
20311 @kindex set sigthread
20312 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20313 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20314 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20315 signal-thread}.
20316
20317 @item show signal-thread
20318 @itemx show sigthread
20319 @kindex show signal-thread
20320 @kindex show sigthread
20321 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20322 delivered a signal.
20323
20324 @item set stopped
20325 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20326 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20327 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20328 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20329
20330 @item show stopped
20331 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20332 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20333 stopped.
20334
20335 @item set exceptions
20336 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20337 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20338 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20339 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20340 trapping on.
20341
20342 @item show exceptions
20343 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20344 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20345
20346 @item set task pause
20347 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20348 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20349 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20350 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20351 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20352 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20353 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20354 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20355 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20356
20357 @item show task pause
20358 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20359 Show the current state of task suspension.
20360
20361 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20362 @cindex task suspend count
20363 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20364 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20365 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20366
20367 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20368 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20369
20370 @item set task exception-port
20371 @itemx set task excp
20372 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20373 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20374 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20375 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20376
20377 @item set noninvasive
20378 @cindex noninvasive task options
20379 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20380 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20381 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20382 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20383
20384 @item info send-rights
20385 @itemx info receive-rights
20386 @itemx info port-rights
20387 @itemx info port-sets
20388 @itemx info dead-names
20389 @itemx info ports
20390 @itemx info psets
20391 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20392 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20393 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20394 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20395 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20396 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
20397 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
20398 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
20399 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
20400
20401 @item set thread pause
20402 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
20403 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20404 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20405 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
20406 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
20407 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
20408 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
20409 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
20410 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
20411 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
20412 only the current thread.
20413
20414 @item show thread pause
20415 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
20416 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
20417
20418 @item set thread run
20419 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20420
20421 @item show thread run
20422 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20423
20424 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
20425 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20426 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20427 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
20428 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
20429 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
20430 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
20431
20432 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
20433 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
20434 detaching.
20435
20436 @item set thread exception-port
20437 @itemx set thread excp
20438 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
20439 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
20440 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
20441
20442 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
20443 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
20444 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
20445 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
20446
20447 @item set thread default
20448 @itemx show thread default
20449 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20450 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
20451 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
20452 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
20453 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
20454 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
20455 the non-default commands.
20456 @end table
20457
20458 @node Darwin
20459 @subsection Darwin
20460 @cindex Darwin
20461
20462 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
20463
20464 @table @code
20465 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
20466 @kindex set debug darwin
20467 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
20468 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
20469
20470 @item show debug darwin
20471 @kindex show debug darwin
20472 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
20473
20474 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
20475 @kindex set debug mach-o
20476 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
20477 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
20478 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
20479 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
20480 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
20481 usage.
20482
20483 @item show debug mach-o
20484 @kindex show debug mach-o
20485 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
20486
20487 @item set mach-exceptions on
20488 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
20489 @kindex set mach-exceptions
20490 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
20491 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
20492 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
20493 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
20494
20495 @item show mach-exceptions
20496 @kindex show mach-exceptions
20497 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
20498 @end table
20499
20500
20501 @node Embedded OS
20502 @section Embedded Operating Systems
20503
20504 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
20505 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
20506 architectures.
20507
20508 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
20509 various real-time operating systems.
20510
20511 @node Embedded Processors
20512 @section Embedded Processors
20513
20514 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
20515 configurations.
20516
20517 @cindex send command to simulator
20518 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
20519 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
20520
20521 @table @code
20522 @item sim @var{command}
20523 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
20524 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
20525 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
20526 acceptable commands.
20527 @end table
20528
20529
20530 @menu
20531 * ARM:: ARM RDI
20532 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
20533 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
20534 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
20535 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
20536 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
20537 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
20538 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
20539 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
20540 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
20541 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
20542 * CRIS:: CRIS
20543 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
20544 @end menu
20545
20546 @node ARM
20547 @subsection ARM
20548 @cindex ARM RDI
20549
20550 @table @code
20551 @kindex target rdi
20552 @item target rdi @var{dev}
20553 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
20554 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
20555 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
20556
20557 @kindex target rdp
20558 @item target rdp @var{dev}
20559 ARM Demon monitor.
20560
20561 @end table
20562
20563 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
20564
20565 @table @code
20566 @item set arm disassembler
20567 @kindex set arm
20568 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
20569 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
20570
20571 @item show arm disassembler
20572 @kindex show arm
20573 Show the current disassembly style.
20574
20575 @item set arm apcs32
20576 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
20577 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
20578
20579 @item show arm apcs32
20580 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
20581
20582 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
20583 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
20584 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
20585
20586 @table @code
20587 @item auto
20588 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
20589 @item softfpa
20590 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
20591 processors.
20592 @item fpa
20593 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
20594 @item softvfp
20595 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
20596 @item vfp
20597 VFP co-processor.
20598 @end table
20599
20600 @item show arm fpu
20601 Show the current type of the FPU.
20602
20603 @item set arm abi
20604 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
20605
20606 @item show arm abi
20607 Show the currently used ABI.
20608
20609 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20610 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
20611 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
20612 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
20613 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
20614 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
20615 register).
20616
20617 @item show arm fallback-mode
20618 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
20619
20620 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20621 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
20622 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
20623 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
20624 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
20625
20626 @item show arm force-mode
20627 Show the current forced instruction mode.
20628
20629 @item set debug arm
20630 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
20631 target support subsystem.
20632
20633 @item show debug arm
20634 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
20635 @end table
20636
20637 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
20638 using the RDI interface:
20639
20640 @table @code
20641 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20642 @kindex rdilogfile
20643 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
20644 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
20645 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
20646 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
20647 @file{rdi.log}.
20648
20649 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
20650 @kindex rdilogenable
20651 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
20652 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
20653 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
20654 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
20655 are logged to a file.
20656
20657 @item set rdiromatzero
20658 @kindex set rdiromatzero
20659 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
20660 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
20661 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
20662 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
20663 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
20664
20665 @item show rdiromatzero
20666 @kindex show rdiromatzero
20667 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
20668
20669 @item set rdiheartbeat
20670 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
20671 @cindex RDI heartbeat
20672 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
20673 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
20674 well as the Angel monitor.
20675
20676 @item show rdiheartbeat
20677 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
20678 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
20679 @end table
20680
20681 @table @code
20682 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20683 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
20684
20685 @table @code
20686 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
20687 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
20688 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
20689 The default value is @code{all}.
20690
20691 @table @code
20692 @item none
20693 @item demon
20694 @item angel
20695 @item redboot
20696 @item all
20697 @end table
20698 @end table
20699 @end table
20700
20701 @node M32R/D
20702 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
20703
20704 @table @code
20705 @kindex target m32r
20706 @item target m32r @var{dev}
20707 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
20708
20709 @kindex target m32rsdi
20710 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
20711 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
20712 @end table
20713
20714 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
20715
20716 @table @code
20717 @item set download-path @var{path}
20718 @kindex set download-path
20719 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
20720 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20721
20722 @item show download-path
20723 @kindex show download-path
20724 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20725
20726 @item set board-address @var{addr}
20727 @kindex set board-address
20728 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
20729 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
20730
20731 @item show board-address
20732 @kindex show board-address
20733 Show the current IP address of the target board.
20734
20735 @item set server-address @var{addr}
20736 @kindex set server-address
20737 @cindex download server address (M32R)
20738 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
20739 host machine.
20740
20741 @item show server-address
20742 @kindex show server-address
20743 Display the IP address of the download server.
20744
20745 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20746 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
20747 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
20748 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
20749 executable file is uploaded.
20750
20751 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20752 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
20753 Test the @code{upload} command.
20754 @end table
20755
20756 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
20757
20758 @table @code
20759 @item sdireset
20760 @kindex sdireset
20761 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
20762 This command resets the SDI connection.
20763
20764 @item sdistatus
20765 @kindex sdistatus
20766 This command shows the SDI connection status.
20767
20768 @item debug_chaos
20769 @kindex debug_chaos
20770 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
20771 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
20772
20773 @item use_debug_dma
20774 @kindex use_debug_dma
20775 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
20776
20777 @item use_mon_code
20778 @kindex use_mon_code
20779 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
20780
20781 @item use_ib_break
20782 @kindex use_ib_break
20783 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
20784
20785 @item use_dbt_break
20786 @kindex use_dbt_break
20787 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
20788 @end table
20789
20790 @node M68K
20791 @subsection M68k
20792
20793 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
20794 target command for the following ROM monitor.
20795
20796 @table @code
20797
20798 @kindex target dbug
20799 @item target dbug @var{dev}
20800 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
20801
20802 @end table
20803
20804 @node MicroBlaze
20805 @subsection MicroBlaze
20806 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
20807 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
20808
20809 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
20810 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
20811 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
20812 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
20813 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
20814 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
20815 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
20816 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
20817 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
20818 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
20819 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
20820
20821 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
20822
20823 @table @code
20824 @item target remote :1234
20825 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
20826 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
20827
20828 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
20829 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
20830 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
20831
20832 @item load
20833 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
20834
20835 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
20836 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
20837
20838 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
20839 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
20840 @end table
20841
20842 @node MIPS Embedded
20843 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
20844
20845 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
20846 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
20847 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
20848 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
20849
20850 @need 1000
20851 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
20852
20853 @table @code
20854 @item target mips @var{port}
20855 @kindex target mips @var{port}
20856 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
20857 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
20858 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
20859 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
20860 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
20861 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
20862
20863 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
20864 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
20865 debugger:
20866
20867 @smallexample
20868 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
20869 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
20870 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
20871 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
20872 (@value{GDBP}) run
20873 @end smallexample
20874
20875 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
20876 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
20877 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
20878 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
20879 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
20880
20881 @item target pmon @var{port}
20882 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
20883 PMON ROM monitor.
20884
20885 @item target ddb @var{port}
20886 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
20887 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
20888
20889 @item target lsi @var{port}
20890 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
20891 LSI variant of PMON.
20892
20893 @kindex target r3900
20894 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
20895 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
20896
20897 @kindex target array
20898 @item target array @var{dev}
20899 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
20900
20901 @end table
20902
20903
20904 @noindent
20905 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
20906
20907 @table @code
20908 @item set mipsfpu double
20909 @itemx set mipsfpu single
20910 @itemx set mipsfpu none
20911 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
20912 @itemx show mipsfpu
20913 @kindex set mipsfpu
20914 @kindex show mipsfpu
20915 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
20916 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
20917 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
20918 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
20919 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
20920 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
20921 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
20922 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
20923 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
20924 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
20925 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
20926 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
20927 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
20928
20929 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
20930 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
20931 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
20932
20933 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
20934 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
20935
20936 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
20937 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
20938 @itemx show timeout
20939 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
20940 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20941 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20942 @kindex set timeout
20943 @kindex show timeout
20944 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
20945 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
20946 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
20947 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
20948 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
20949 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
20950 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
20951 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
20952 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
20953 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
20954
20955 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
20956 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
20957 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
20958 to run before stopping.
20959
20960 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
20961 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20962 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
20963 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
20964 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
20965 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
20966
20967 @item show syn-garbage-limit
20968 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20969 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
20970 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
20971
20972 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
20973 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20974 @cindex remote monitor prompt
20975 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
20976 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
20977 @table @asis
20978 @item pmon target
20979 @samp{PMON}
20980 @item ddb target
20981 @samp{NEC010}
20982 @item lsi target
20983 @samp{PMON>}
20984 @end table
20985
20986 @item show monitor-prompt
20987 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20988 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
20989 remote monitor.
20990
20991 @item set monitor-warnings
20992 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20993 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
20994 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
20995 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
20996 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
20997
20998 @item show monitor-warnings
20999 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21000 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21001
21002 @item pmon @var{command}
21003 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21004 @cindex send PMON command
21005 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21006 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21007 @end table
21008
21009 @node PowerPC Embedded
21010 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21011
21012 @cindex DVC register
21013 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21014 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21015
21016 @smallexample
21017 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21018 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21019 @end smallexample
21020
21021 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21022 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21023 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21024 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21025 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21026 or newer.
21027
21028 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21029 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21030 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21031 watching variables of scalar types.
21032
21033 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21034 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21035
21036 @smallexample
21037 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21038 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21039 @end smallexample
21040
21041 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21042 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21043
21044 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21045 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21046 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21047 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21048 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21049 use the @code{break-range} command.
21050
21051 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21052
21053 @table @code
21054 @kindex break-range
21055 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21056 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21057 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21058 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21059 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21060 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21061 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21062 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21063 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21064
21065 @kindex set powerpc
21066 @item set powerpc soft-float
21067 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21068 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21069 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21070 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21071
21072 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21073 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21074 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21075 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21076 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21077 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21078 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21079 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21080
21081 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21082 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21083 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21084 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21085 address of its first byte.
21086
21087 @kindex target dink32
21088 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21089 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21090
21091 @kindex target ppcbug
21092 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21093 @kindex target ppcbug1
21094 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21095 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21096
21097 @kindex target sds
21098 @item target sds @var{dev}
21099 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21100 @end table
21101
21102 @cindex SDS protocol
21103 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21104 by @value{GDBN}:
21105
21106 @table @code
21107 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21108 @kindex set sdstimeout
21109 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21110 default is 2 seconds.
21111
21112 @item show sdstimeout
21113 @kindex show sdstimeout
21114 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21115
21116 @item sds @var{command}
21117 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21118 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21119 @end table
21120
21121
21122 @node PA
21123 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21124
21125 @table @code
21126
21127 @kindex target op50n
21128 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21129 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21130
21131 @kindex target w89k
21132 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21133 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21134
21135 @end table
21136
21137 @node Sparclet
21138 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21139
21140 @cindex Sparclet
21141
21142 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21143 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21144 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21145 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21146 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21147
21148 @table @code
21149 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21150 @kindex remotetimeout
21151 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21152 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21153 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21154 @end table
21155
21156 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21157 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21158 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21159 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21160 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21161
21162 @smallexample
21163 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21164 @end smallexample
21165
21166 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21167
21168 @smallexample
21169 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21170 @end smallexample
21171
21172 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21173 Once you have set
21174 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21175 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21176 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21177
21178 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21179
21180 @smallexample
21181 (gdbslet)
21182 @end smallexample
21183
21184 @menu
21185 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21186 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21187 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21188 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21189 @end menu
21190
21191 @node Sparclet File
21192 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21193
21194 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21195
21196 @smallexample
21197 (gdbslet) file prog
21198 @end smallexample
21199
21200 @need 1000
21201 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21202 @value{GDBN} locates
21203 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21204 path.
21205 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21206 files will be searched as well.
21207 @value{GDBN} locates
21208 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21209 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21210 If it fails
21211 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21212
21213 @smallexample
21214 prog: No such file or directory.
21215 @end smallexample
21216
21217 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21218 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21219 @code{target} command again.
21220
21221 @node Sparclet Connection
21222 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21223
21224 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21225 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21226
21227 @smallexample
21228 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21229 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21230 main () at ../prog.c:3
21231 @end smallexample
21232
21233 @need 750
21234 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21235
21236 @smallexample
21237 Connected to ttya.
21238 @end smallexample
21239
21240 @node Sparclet Download
21241 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21242
21243 @cindex download to Sparclet
21244 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21245 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21246 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21247 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21248 command.
21249 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21250 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21251 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21252 of each of the file's sections.
21253 For instance, if the program
21254 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21255 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21256
21257 @smallexample
21258 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21259 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21260 @end smallexample
21261
21262 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21263 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21264 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21265
21266 @node Sparclet Execution
21267 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21268
21269 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21270 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21271 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21272 manual for the list of commands.
21273
21274 @smallexample
21275 (gdbslet) b main
21276 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21277 (gdbslet) run
21278 Starting program: prog
21279 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21280 3 char *symarg = 0;
21281 (gdbslet) step
21282 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21283 (gdbslet)
21284 @end smallexample
21285
21286 @node Sparclite
21287 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21288
21289 @table @code
21290
21291 @kindex target sparclite
21292 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21293 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21294 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21295 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21296 remote protocol.
21297
21298 @end table
21299
21300 @node Z8000
21301 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21302
21303 @cindex Z8000
21304 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21305 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21306
21307 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21308 a Z8000 simulator.
21309
21310 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21311 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21312 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21313 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21314
21315 @table @code
21316 @item target sim @var{args}
21317 @kindex sim
21318 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21319 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21320 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21321 @end table
21322
21323 @noindent
21324 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21325 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21326 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21327 to run your program, and so on.
21328
21329 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21330 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21331 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21332
21333 @table @code
21334
21335 @item cycles
21336 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21337
21338 @item insts
21339 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21340
21341 @item time
21342 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21343
21344 @end table
21345
21346 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21347 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21348 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21349 simulated clock ticks.
21350
21351 @node AVR
21352 @subsection Atmel AVR
21353 @cindex AVR
21354
21355 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21356 following AVR-specific commands:
21357
21358 @table @code
21359 @item info io_registers
21360 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21361 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21362 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21363 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21364 @end table
21365
21366 @node CRIS
21367 @subsection CRIS
21368 @cindex CRIS
21369
21370 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21371 following CRIS-specific commands:
21372
21373 @table @code
21374 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21375 @cindex CRIS version
21376 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21377 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21378 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21379
21380 @item show cris-version
21381 Show the current CRIS version.
21382
21383 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21384 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21385 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21386 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21387 @code{R59}.
21388
21389 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21390 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21391
21392 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21393 @cindex CRIS mode
21394 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21395 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21396 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21397
21398 @item show cris-mode
21399 Show the current CRIS mode.
21400 @end table
21401
21402 @node Super-H
21403 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21404 @cindex Super-H
21405
21406 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21407 commands:
21408
21409 @table @code
21410 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21411 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21412 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21413 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21414 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21415 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21416 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21417 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21418 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21419 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21420 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21421 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21422
21423 @item show sh calling-convention
21424 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21425 Show the current calling convention setting.
21426
21427 @end table
21428
21429
21430 @node Architectures
21431 @section Architectures
21432
21433 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21434 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21435
21436 @menu
21437 * AArch64::
21438 * i386::
21439 * Alpha::
21440 * MIPS::
21441 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21442 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21443 * PowerPC::
21444 * Nios II::
21445 @end menu
21446
21447 @node AArch64
21448 @subsection AArch64
21449 @cindex AArch64 support
21450
21451 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21452 following special commands:
21453
21454 @table @code
21455 @item set debug aarch64
21456 @kindex set debug aarch64
21457 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21458 messages are to be displayed.
21459
21460 @item show debug aarch64
21461 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21462
21463 @end table
21464
21465 @node i386
21466 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21467
21468 @table @code
21469 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21470 @kindex set struct-convention
21471 @cindex struct return convention
21472 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
21473 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
21474 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
21475 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
21476 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
21477 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
21478 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
21479 be returned in a register.
21480
21481 @item show struct-convention
21482 @kindex show struct-convention
21483 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
21484 from functions.
21485 @end table
21486
21487 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
21488 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
21489
21490 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
21491 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
21492 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
21493 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
21494 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
21495 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
21496 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
21497
21498 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
21499 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
21500 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
21501 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
21502 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
21503 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
21504
21505 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
21506 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
21507 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
21508
21509 @smallexample
21510 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
21511 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
21512 @end smallexample
21513
21514 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
21515 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
21516 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
21517 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
21518 the pointer.
21519
21520 @node Alpha
21521 @subsection Alpha
21522
21523 See the following section.
21524
21525 @node MIPS
21526 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
21527
21528 @cindex stack on Alpha
21529 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
21530 @cindex Alpha stack
21531 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
21532 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
21533 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
21534 find the beginning of a function.
21535
21536 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
21537 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
21538 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
21539 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
21540 commands:
21541
21542 @table @code
21543 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
21544 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
21545 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
21546 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
21547 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
21548 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
21549 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
21550 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
21551
21552 @item show heuristic-fence-post
21553 Display the current limit.
21554 @end table
21555
21556 @noindent
21557 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
21558 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
21559
21560 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
21561 programs:
21562
21563 @table @code
21564 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
21565 @kindex set mips abi
21566 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
21567 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
21568 values of @var{arg} are:
21569
21570 @table @samp
21571 @item auto
21572 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
21573 default).
21574 @item o32
21575 @item o64
21576 @item n32
21577 @item n64
21578 @item eabi32
21579 @item eabi64
21580 @end table
21581
21582 @item show mips abi
21583 @kindex show mips abi
21584 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21585
21586 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
21587 @kindex set mips compression
21588 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
21589 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
21590 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
21591 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
21592 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
21593 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
21594 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
21595 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
21596 provided by the executable.
21597
21598 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
21599 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
21600 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
21601 identified as such.
21602
21603 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
21604 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
21605 implicitly from an executable.
21606
21607 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
21608 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
21609 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
21610 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
21611 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
21612
21613 @item show mips compression
21614 @kindex show mips compression
21615 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
21616 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21617
21618 @item set mipsfpu
21619 @itemx show mipsfpu
21620 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
21621
21622 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
21623 @kindex set mips mask-address
21624 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
21625 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
21626 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
21627 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
21628 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
21629
21630 @item show mips mask-address
21631 @kindex show mips mask-address
21632 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
21633 not.
21634
21635 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21636 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21637 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
21638 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
21639 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
21640 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
21641
21642 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21643 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21644 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
21645
21646 @item set debug mips
21647 @kindex set debug mips
21648 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
21649 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21650
21651 @item show debug mips
21652 @kindex show debug mips
21653 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
21654 @end table
21655
21656
21657 @node HPPA
21658 @subsection HPPA
21659 @cindex HPPA support
21660
21661 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
21662 following special commands:
21663
21664 @table @code
21665 @item set debug hppa
21666 @kindex set debug hppa
21667 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
21668 messages are to be displayed.
21669
21670 @item show debug hppa
21671 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
21672
21673 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
21674 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
21675 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
21676 given @var{address}.
21677
21678 @end table
21679
21680
21681 @node SPU
21682 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21683 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
21684 @cindex SPU
21685
21686 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
21687 it provides the following special commands:
21688
21689 @table @code
21690 @item info spu event
21691 @kindex info spu
21692 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
21693 and pending event status.
21694
21695 @item info spu signal
21696 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
21697 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
21698 notification channels.
21699
21700 @item info spu mailbox
21701 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
21702 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
21703 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
21704
21705 @item info spu dma
21706 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21707 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21708 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21709
21710 @item info spu proxydma
21711 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21712 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21713 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21714
21715 @end table
21716
21717 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
21718 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
21719 special commands:
21720
21721 @table @code
21722 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
21723 @kindex set spu
21724 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
21725 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
21726 function. The default is @code{off}.
21727
21728 @item show spu stop-on-load
21729 @kindex show spu
21730 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
21731
21732 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
21733 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
21734 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
21735 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
21736 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
21737 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
21738
21739 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
21740 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
21741
21742 @end table
21743
21744 @node PowerPC
21745 @subsection PowerPC
21746 @cindex PowerPC architecture
21747
21748 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
21749 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
21750 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
21751 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
21752 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
21753
21754 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
21755 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
21756 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
21757
21758 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
21759 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
21760
21761 @node Nios II
21762 @subsection Nios II
21763 @cindex Nios II architecture
21764
21765 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
21766 it provides the following special commands:
21767
21768 @table @code
21769
21770 @item set debug nios2
21771 @kindex set debug nios2
21772 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
21773 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21774
21775 @item show debug nios2
21776 @kindex show debug nios2
21777 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
21778 @end table
21779
21780 @node Controlling GDB
21781 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
21782
21783 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
21784 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
21785 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
21786 described here.
21787
21788 @menu
21789 * Prompt:: Prompt
21790 * Editing:: Command editing
21791 * Command History:: Command history
21792 * Screen Size:: Screen size
21793 * Numbers:: Numbers
21794 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
21795 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
21796 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
21797 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
21798 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
21799 @end menu
21800
21801 @node Prompt
21802 @section Prompt
21803
21804 @cindex prompt
21805
21806 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
21807 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
21808 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
21809 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
21810 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
21811 which one you are talking to.
21812
21813 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
21814 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
21815 or a prompt that does not.
21816
21817 @table @code
21818 @kindex set prompt
21819 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
21820 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
21821
21822 @kindex show prompt
21823 @item show prompt
21824 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
21825 @end table
21826
21827 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
21828 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
21829 are:
21830
21831 @table @code
21832 @kindex set extended-prompt
21833 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
21834 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
21835 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
21836 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
21837 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
21838 is displayed.
21839
21840 For example:
21841
21842 @smallexample
21843 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
21844 @end smallexample
21845
21846 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
21847 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
21848
21849 @kindex show extended-prompt
21850 @item show extended-prompt
21851 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
21852 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
21853 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
21854 @end table
21855
21856 @node Editing
21857 @section Command Editing
21858 @cindex readline
21859 @cindex command line editing
21860
21861 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
21862 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
21863 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
21864 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
21865 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
21866 debugging sessions.
21867
21868 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
21869 command @code{set}.
21870
21871 @table @code
21872 @kindex set editing
21873 @cindex editing
21874 @item set editing
21875 @itemx set editing on
21876 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
21877
21878 @item set editing off
21879 Disable command line editing.
21880
21881 @kindex show editing
21882 @item show editing
21883 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
21884 @end table
21885
21886 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21887 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
21888 @end ifset
21889 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21890 @xref{Command Line Editing},
21891 @end ifclear
21892 for more details about the Readline
21893 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
21894 encouraged to read that chapter.
21895
21896 @node Command History
21897 @section Command History
21898 @cindex command history
21899
21900 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
21901 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
21902 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
21903 history facility.
21904
21905 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
21906 package, to provide the history facility.
21907 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21908 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
21909 @end ifset
21910 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21911 @xref{Using History Interactively},
21912 @end ifclear
21913 for the detailed description of the History library.
21914
21915 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
21916 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
21917 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
21918 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
21919 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
21920 pressed on a line by itself.
21921
21922 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
21923 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21924 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21925 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21926
21927 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
21928 history.
21929
21930 @table @code
21931 @cindex history substitution
21932 @cindex history file
21933 @kindex set history filename
21934 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
21935 @item set history filename @var{fname}
21936 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
21937 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
21938 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
21939 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
21940 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
21941 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
21942 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
21943 is not set.
21944
21945 @cindex save command history
21946 @kindex set history save
21947 @item set history save
21948 @itemx set history save on
21949 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
21950 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
21951
21952 @item set history save off
21953 Stop recording command history in a file.
21954
21955 @cindex history size
21956 @kindex set history size
21957 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
21958 @item set history size @var{size}
21959 @itemx set history size unlimited
21960 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
21961 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
21962 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
21963 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
21964 history list is unlimited.
21965 @end table
21966
21967 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
21968 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21969 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
21970 @end ifset
21971 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21972 @xref{Event Designators},
21973 @end ifclear
21974 for more details.
21975
21976 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
21977 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
21978 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
21979 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
21980 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
21981 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
21982 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
21983 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
21984
21985 The commands to control history expansion are:
21986
21987 @table @code
21988 @item set history expansion on
21989 @itemx set history expansion
21990 @kindex set history expansion
21991 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
21992
21993 @item set history expansion off
21994 Disable history expansion.
21995
21996 @c @group
21997 @kindex show history
21998 @item show history
21999 @itemx show history filename
22000 @itemx show history save
22001 @itemx show history size
22002 @itemx show history expansion
22003 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22004 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22005 @c @end group
22006 @end table
22007
22008 @table @code
22009 @kindex show commands
22010 @cindex show last commands
22011 @cindex display command history
22012 @item show commands
22013 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22014
22015 @item show commands @var{n}
22016 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22017
22018 @item show commands +
22019 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22020 @end table
22021
22022 @node Screen Size
22023 @section Screen Size
22024 @cindex size of screen
22025 @cindex screen size
22026 @cindex pagination
22027 @cindex page size
22028 @cindex pauses in output
22029
22030 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22031 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22032 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22033 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22034 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22035 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22036 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22037 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22038
22039 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22040 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22041 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22042 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22043 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22044 width} commands:
22045
22046 @table @code
22047 @kindex set height
22048 @kindex set width
22049 @kindex show width
22050 @kindex show height
22051 @item set height @var{lpp}
22052 @itemx set height unlimited
22053 @itemx show height
22054 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22055 @itemx set width unlimited
22056 @itemx show width
22057 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22058 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22059 commands display the current settings.
22060
22061 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22062 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22063 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22064 buffer.
22065
22066 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22067 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22068
22069 @item set pagination on
22070 @itemx set pagination off
22071 @kindex set pagination
22072 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22073 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22074 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22075 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22076
22077 @item show pagination
22078 @kindex show pagination
22079 Show the current pagination mode.
22080 @end table
22081
22082 @node Numbers
22083 @section Numbers
22084 @cindex number representation
22085 @cindex entering numbers
22086
22087 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22088 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22089 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22090 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22091 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22092 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22093 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22094 both input and output with the commands described below.
22095
22096 @table @code
22097 @kindex set input-radix
22098 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22099 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22100 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22101 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22102 example, any of
22103
22104 @smallexample
22105 set input-radix 012
22106 set input-radix 10.
22107 set input-radix 0xa
22108 @end smallexample
22109
22110 @noindent
22111 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22112 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22113 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22114 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22115 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22116 change the radix.
22117
22118 @kindex set output-radix
22119 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22120 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22121 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22122 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22123
22124 @kindex show input-radix
22125 @item show input-radix
22126 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22127
22128 @kindex show output-radix
22129 @item show output-radix
22130 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22131
22132 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22133 @itemx show radix
22134 @kindex set radix
22135 @kindex show radix
22136 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22137 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22138 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22139 default value of 10.
22140
22141 @end table
22142
22143 @node ABI
22144 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22145
22146 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22147 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22148 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22149 current ABI.
22150
22151 @cindex OS ABI
22152 @kindex set osabi
22153 @kindex show osabi
22154 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22155
22156 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22157 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22158 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22159 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22160 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22161 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22162 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22163 platform provides.
22164
22165 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22166 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22167 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22168 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22169
22170 @table @code
22171 @item show osabi
22172 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22173
22174 @item set osabi
22175 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22176
22177 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22178 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22179 @end table
22180
22181 @cindex float promotion
22182
22183 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22184 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22185 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22186 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22187 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22188 @code{double} and then passed.
22189
22190 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22191 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22192 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22193
22194 @table @code
22195 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22196 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22197 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22198 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22199 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22200
22201 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22202 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22203 functions.
22204
22205 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22206 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22207 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22208 @end table
22209
22210 @kindex set cp-abi
22211 @kindex show cp-abi
22212 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22213 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22214 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22215 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22216 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22217 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22218 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22219 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22220 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22221 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22222 ``auto''.
22223
22224 @table @code
22225 @item show cp-abi
22226 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22227
22228 @item set cp-abi
22229 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22230
22231 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22232 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22233 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22234 @end table
22235
22236 @node Auto-loading
22237 @section Automatically loading associated files
22238 @cindex auto-loading
22239
22240 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22241 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22242 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22243 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22244 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22245 sources).
22246
22247 @menu
22248 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22249 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22250
22251 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22252 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22253 @end menu
22254
22255 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22256 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22257 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22258
22259 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22260 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22261 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22262
22263 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22264 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22265
22266 @table @code
22267 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22268 @kindex set auto-load off
22269 @item set auto-load off
22270 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22271 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22272 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22273 @smallexample
22274 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22275 @end smallexample
22276
22277 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22278 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22279 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22280 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22281 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22282 @code{set auto-load no}.
22283
22284 @anchor{show auto-load}
22285 @kindex show auto-load
22286 @item show auto-load
22287 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22288 or disabled.
22289
22290 @smallexample
22291 (gdb) show auto-load
22292 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22293 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22294 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22295 is on.
22296 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22297 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22298 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22299 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22300 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22301 @end smallexample
22302
22303 @anchor{info auto-load}
22304 @kindex info auto-load
22305 @item info auto-load
22306 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22307 not.
22308
22309 @smallexample
22310 (gdb) info auto-load
22311 gdb-scripts:
22312 Loaded Script
22313 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22314 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22315 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22316 loaded.
22317 python-scripts:
22318 Loaded Script
22319 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22320 @end smallexample
22321 @end table
22322
22323 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22324
22325 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22326 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22327 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22328 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22329 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22330 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22331 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22332 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22333 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22334 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22335 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22336 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22337 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22338 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22339 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22340 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22341 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22342 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22343 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22344 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22345 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22346 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22347 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22348 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22349 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22350 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22351 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22352 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22353 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22354 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22355 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22356 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22357 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22358 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22359 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22360 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22361 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22362 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22363 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22364 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22365 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22366 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22367 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22368 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22369 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22370 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22371 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22372 @end multitable
22373
22374 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22375 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22376 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22377
22378 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22379 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22380 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22381
22382 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22383 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22384
22385 @table @code
22386 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22387 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22388 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22389 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22390 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22391
22392 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22393 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22394 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22395 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22396 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22397
22398 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22399 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
22400 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
22401 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22402 current directory have been auto-loaded.
22403 @end table
22404
22405 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
22406 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
22407 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
22408
22409 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
22410
22411 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
22412 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
22413
22414 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
22415 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
22416 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
22417 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
22418 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
22419 library.
22420
22421 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
22422 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22423
22424 @table @code
22425 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
22426 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
22427 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
22428 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22429
22430 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22431 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22432 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22433 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22434 enabled or disabled.
22435
22436 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
22437 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
22438 @item info auto-load libthread-db
22439 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
22440 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
22441 @end table
22442
22443 @node Auto-loading safe path
22444 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
22445 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
22446
22447 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
22448 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
22449 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
22450 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
22451 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
22452
22453 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
22454 get loaded:
22455
22456 @smallexample
22457 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
22458 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
22459 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
22460 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22461 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22462 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
22463 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22464 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22465 @end smallexample
22466
22467 @noindent
22468 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
22469 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
22470
22471 @smallexample
22472 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
22473 @end smallexample
22474
22475 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
22476
22477 @table @code
22478 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
22479 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
22480 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
22481 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
22482 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
22483 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
22484 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
22485 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
22486 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
22487 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
22488
22489 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
22490 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
22491 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
22492
22493 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
22494 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
22495 @item show auto-load safe-path
22496 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
22497 scripts.
22498
22499 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
22500 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
22501 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
22502 Add an entry (or list of entries) the list of directories trusted for automatic
22503 loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited by the
22504 host platform path separator in use.
22505 @end table
22506
22507 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
22508 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
22509 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22510 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
22511 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
22512
22513 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
22514 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
22515 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
22516 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
22517 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
22518 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
22519 init file in the current directory
22520 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
22521
22522 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
22523 example, you could use one of the following ways:
22524
22525 @table @asis
22526 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
22527 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
22528 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
22529 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
22530
22531 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
22532 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
22533 @value{GDBN} session.
22534
22535 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
22536 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22537 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
22538 from trusted sources.
22539
22540 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
22541 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
22542 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
22543 trusted sources.
22544 @end table
22545
22546 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
22547 also suppresses any such warning messages:
22548
22549 @table @asis
22550 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
22551 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22552
22553 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
22554 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
22555 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
22556 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
22557 @end table
22558
22559 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
22560 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
22561 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
22562 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
22563 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
22564 recommended to be entered.
22565
22566 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
22567 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
22568 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
22569
22570 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
22571 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
22572 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
22573 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
22574 be printed.
22575
22576 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22577 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
22578 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
22579
22580 @smallexample
22581 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
22582 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
22583 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
22584 for objfile "/tmp/true".
22585 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
22586 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
22587 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
22588 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
22589 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
22590 @end smallexample
22591
22592 @table @code
22593 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
22594 @kindex set debug auto-load
22595 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
22596 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
22597
22598 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
22599 @kindex show debug auto-load
22600 @item show debug auto-load
22601 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
22602 on or off.
22603 @end table
22604
22605 @node Messages/Warnings
22606 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
22607
22608 @cindex verbose operation
22609 @cindex optional warnings
22610 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
22611 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
22612 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
22613 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
22614
22615 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
22616 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
22617 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
22618
22619 @table @code
22620 @kindex set verbose
22621 @item set verbose on
22622 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22623
22624 @item set verbose off
22625 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22626
22627 @kindex show verbose
22628 @item show verbose
22629 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
22630 @end table
22631
22632 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
22633 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
22634 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
22635 Symbol Files}).
22636
22637 @table @code
22638
22639 @kindex set complaints
22640 @item set complaints @var{limit}
22641 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
22642 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
22643 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
22644 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
22645
22646 @kindex show complaints
22647 @item show complaints
22648 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
22649
22650 @end table
22651
22652 @anchor{confirmation requests}
22653 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
22654 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
22655 you try to run a program which is already running:
22656
22657 @smallexample
22658 (@value{GDBP}) run
22659 The program being debugged has been started already.
22660 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
22661 @end smallexample
22662
22663 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
22664 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
22665
22666 @table @code
22667
22668 @kindex set confirm
22669 @cindex flinching
22670 @cindex confirmation
22671 @cindex stupid questions
22672 @item set confirm off
22673 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
22674 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
22675 automatically disables confirmation requests.
22676
22677 @item set confirm on
22678 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
22679
22680 @kindex show confirm
22681 @item show confirm
22682 Displays state of confirmation requests.
22683
22684 @end table
22685
22686 @cindex command tracing
22687 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
22688 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
22689 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
22690 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
22691
22692 @table @code
22693 @kindex set trace-commands
22694 @cindex command scripts, debugging
22695 @item set trace-commands on
22696 Enable command tracing.
22697 @item set trace-commands off
22698 Disable command tracing.
22699 @item show trace-commands
22700 Display the current state of command tracing.
22701 @end table
22702
22703 @node Debugging Output
22704 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
22705 @cindex optional debugging messages
22706
22707 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
22708 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
22709 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
22710 section documents those commands.
22711
22712 @table @code
22713 @kindex set exec-done-display
22714 @item set exec-done-display
22715 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
22716 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
22717 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
22718 @kindex show exec-done-display
22719 @item show exec-done-display
22720 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
22721 notification.
22722 @kindex set debug
22723 @cindex ARM AArch64
22724 @item set debug aarch64
22725 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
22726 The default is off.
22727 @kindex show debug
22728 @item show debug aarch64
22729 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22730 ARM AArch64.
22731 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
22732 @cindex architecture debugging info
22733 @item set debug arch
22734 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
22735 @item show debug arch
22736 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
22737 @item set debug aix-solib
22738 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
22739 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
22740 support module. The default is off.
22741 @item show debug aix-thread
22742 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
22743 @item set debug aix-thread
22744 @cindex AIX threads
22745 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
22746 module.
22747 @item show debug aix-thread
22748 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
22749 @item set debug check-physname
22750 @cindex physname
22751 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
22752 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
22753 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
22754 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
22755 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
22756 both ways and display any discrepancies.
22757 @item show debug check-physname
22758 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
22759 @item set debug coff-pe-read
22760 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
22761 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
22762 exported symbols. The default is off.
22763 @item show debug coff-pe-read
22764 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22765 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22766 @item set debug dwarf2-die
22767 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
22768 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
22769 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
22770 A value of zero turns off the display.
22771 @item show debug dwarf2-die
22772 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
22773 @item set debug dwarf2-read
22774 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
22775 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
22776 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
22777 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22778 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22779 @item show debug dwarf2-read
22780 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
22781 @item set debug displaced
22782 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
22783 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
22784 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
22785 @item show debug displaced
22786 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
22787 related to displaced stepping.
22788 @item set debug event
22789 @cindex event debugging info
22790 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
22791 default is off.
22792 @item show debug event
22793 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
22794 info.
22795 @item set debug expression
22796 @cindex expression debugging info
22797 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
22798 expression parsing. The default is off.
22799 @item show debug expression
22800 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
22801 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
22802 @item set debug frame
22803 @cindex frame debugging info
22804 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
22805 default is off.
22806 @item show debug frame
22807 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
22808 info.
22809 @item set debug gnu-nat
22810 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
22811 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
22812 @item show debug gnu-nat
22813 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
22814 @item set debug infrun
22815 @cindex inferior debugging info
22816 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
22817 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
22818 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
22819 @item show debug infrun
22820 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
22821 @item set debug jit
22822 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
22823 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
22824 @item show debug jit
22825 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
22826 @item set debug lin-lwp
22827 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
22828 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
22829 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
22830 @item show debug lin-lwp
22831 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
22832 @item set debug mach-o
22833 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
22834 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
22835 processing. The default is off.
22836 @item show debug mach-o
22837 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22838 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22839 @item set debug notification
22840 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
22841 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
22842 The default is off.
22843 @item show debug notification
22844 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
22845 @item set debug observer
22846 @cindex observer debugging info
22847 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
22848 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
22849 @item show debug observer
22850 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
22851 @item set debug overload
22852 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
22853 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
22854 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
22855 is off.
22856 @item show debug overload
22857 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
22858 debugging info.
22859 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
22860 @cindex debug expression parser
22861 @item set debug parser
22862 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
22863 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
22864 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
22865 details. The default is off.
22866 @item show debug parser
22867 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
22868 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
22869 @cindex serial connections, debugging
22870 @cindex debug remote protocol
22871 @cindex remote protocol debugging
22872 @cindex display remote packets
22873 @item set debug remote
22874 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
22875 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
22876 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
22877 @item show debug remote
22878 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
22879 @item set debug serial
22880 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
22881 default is off.
22882 @item show debug serial
22883 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
22884 info.
22885 @item set debug solib-frv
22886 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
22887 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
22888 @item show debug solib-frv
22889 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
22890 messages.
22891 @item set debug symfile
22892 @cindex symbol file functions
22893 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
22894 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
22895 @item show debug symfile
22896 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
22897 @item set debug symtab-create
22898 @cindex symbol table creation
22899 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
22900 The default is 0 (off).
22901 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22902 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22903 @item show debug symtab-create
22904 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
22905 @item set debug target
22906 @cindex target debugging info
22907 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
22908 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
22909 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
22910 value of large memory transfers.
22911 @item show debug target
22912 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
22913 info.
22914 @item set debug timestamp
22915 @cindex timestampping debugging info
22916 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
22917 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
22918 message.
22919 @item show debug timestamp
22920 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
22921 debugging info.
22922 @item set debug varobj
22923 @cindex variable object debugging info
22924 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
22925 info. The default is off.
22926 @item show debug varobj
22927 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
22928 debugging info.
22929 @item set debug xml
22930 @cindex XML parser debugging
22931 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
22932 @item show debug xml
22933 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
22934 @end table
22935
22936 @node Other Misc Settings
22937 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
22938 @cindex miscellaneous settings
22939
22940 @table @code
22941 @kindex set interactive-mode
22942 @item set interactive-mode
22943 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
22944 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
22945 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
22946 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
22947 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
22948 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
22949 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
22950 is, non-interactively otherwise.
22951
22952 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
22953 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
22954 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
22955 inside a cygwin window.
22956
22957 @kindex show interactive-mode
22958 @item show interactive-mode
22959 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
22960 @end table
22961
22962 @node Extending GDB
22963 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
22964 @cindex extending GDB
22965
22966 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
22967 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
22968 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
22969 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
22970 being debugged.
22971
22972 @menu
22973 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
22974 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
22975 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
22976 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
22977 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
22978 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
22979 @end menu
22980
22981 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
22982 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
22983 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
22984 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
22985 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22986 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
22987
22988 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
22989 setting:
22990
22991 @table @code
22992 @kindex set script-extension
22993 @kindex show script-extension
22994 @item set script-extension off
22995 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22996
22997 @item set script-extension soft
22998 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
22999 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23000 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23001 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23002
23003 @item set script-extension strict
23004 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23005 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23006 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23007
23008 @item show script-extension
23009 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23010
23011 @end table
23012
23013 @node Sequences
23014 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23015
23016 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23017 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23018 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23019 files.
23020
23021 @menu
23022 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23023 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23024 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23025 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23026 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23027 @end menu
23028
23029 @node Define
23030 @subsection User-defined Commands
23031
23032 @cindex user-defined command
23033 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23034 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23035 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23036 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23037 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23038 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23039
23040 @smallexample
23041 define adder
23042 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23043 end
23044 @end smallexample
23045
23046 @noindent
23047 To execute the command use:
23048
23049 @smallexample
23050 adder 1 2 3
23051 @end smallexample
23052
23053 @noindent
23054 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23055 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23056 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23057 functions calls.
23058
23059 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23060 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23061 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23062 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23063
23064 @smallexample
23065 define adder
23066 if $argc == 2
23067 print $arg0 + $arg1
23068 end
23069 if $argc == 3
23070 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23071 end
23072 end
23073 @end smallexample
23074
23075 @table @code
23076
23077 @kindex define
23078 @item define @var{commandname}
23079 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23080 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23081 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23082 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23083 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23084 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23085
23086 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23087 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23088 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23089
23090 @kindex document
23091 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23092 @item document @var{commandname}
23093 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23094 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23095 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23096 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23097 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23098 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23099
23100 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23101 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23102 does not change the documentation.
23103
23104 @kindex dont-repeat
23105 @cindex don't repeat command
23106 @item dont-repeat
23107 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23108 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23109 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23110
23111 @kindex help user-defined
23112 @item help user-defined
23113 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23114 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23115 included (if any).
23116
23117 @kindex show user
23118 @item show user
23119 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23120 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23121 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23122 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23123 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23124
23125 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23126 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23127 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23128 @item show max-user-call-depth
23129 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23130 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23131 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23132 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23133 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23134 @end table
23135
23136 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23137 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23138
23139 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23140 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23141 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23142
23143 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23144 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23145 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23146 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23147
23148 @node Hooks
23149 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23150 @cindex command hooks
23151 @cindex hooks, for commands
23152 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23153
23154 @kindex hook
23155 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23156 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23157 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23158 before that command.
23159
23160 @cindex hooks, post-command
23161 @kindex hookpost
23162 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23163 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23164 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23165 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23166 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23167
23168 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23169 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23170
23171 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23172 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23173
23174 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23175 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23176 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23177 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23178 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23179
23180 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23181 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23182 you could define:
23183
23184 @smallexample
23185 define hook-stop
23186 handle SIGALRM nopass
23187 end
23188
23189 define hook-run
23190 handle SIGALRM pass
23191 end
23192
23193 define hook-continue
23194 handle SIGALRM pass
23195 end
23196 @end smallexample
23197
23198 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23199 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23200 you could define:
23201
23202 @smallexample
23203 define hook-echo
23204 echo <<<---
23205 end
23206
23207 define hookpost-echo
23208 echo --->>>\n
23209 end
23210
23211 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23212 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23213 (@value{GDBP})
23214
23215 @end smallexample
23216
23217 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23218 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23219 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23220 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23221 @c or not?
23222 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23223 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23224 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23225
23226 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23227 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23228 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23229
23230 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23231 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23232
23233 @node Command Files
23234 @subsection Command Files
23235
23236 @cindex command files
23237 @cindex scripting commands
23238 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23239 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23240 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23241 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23242 terminal.
23243
23244 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23245 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23246 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23247 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23248 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23249
23250 @table @code
23251 @kindex source
23252 @cindex execute commands from a file
23253 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23254 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23255 @end table
23256
23257 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23258 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23259 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23260 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23261 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23262
23263 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23264 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23265 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23266 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23267 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23268 is not relevant to scripts.
23269
23270 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23271 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23272 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23273 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23274 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23275 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23276 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23277 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23278 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23279 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23280 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23281 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23282 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23283 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23284
23285 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23286 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23287 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23288
23289 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23290 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23291 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23292 when called from command files.
23293
23294 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23295 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23296 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23297 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23298 the next command.
23299
23300 @smallexample
23301 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23302 @end smallexample
23303
23304 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23305 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23306 would be directed to @file{log}.
23307
23308 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23309 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23310 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23311 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23312 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23313 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23314 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23315 conditionally, etc.
23316
23317 @table @code
23318 @kindex if
23319 @kindex else
23320 @item if
23321 @itemx else
23322 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23323 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23324 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23325 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23326 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23327 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23328 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23329
23330 @kindex while
23331 @item while
23332 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23333 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23334 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23335 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23336 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23337 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23338
23339 @kindex loop_break
23340 @item loop_break
23341 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23342 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23343 line.
23344
23345 @kindex loop_continue
23346 @item loop_continue
23347 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23348 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23349 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23350 the controlling expression.
23351
23352 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23353 @item end
23354 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23355 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23356 @end table
23357
23358
23359 @node Output
23360 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23361
23362 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23363 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23364 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23365 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23366 want.
23367
23368 @table @code
23369 @kindex echo
23370 @item echo @var{text}
23371 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23372 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23373 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23374 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23375 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23376 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23377 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23378 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23379 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23380 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23381 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23382
23383 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23384 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23385
23386 @smallexample
23387 echo This is some text\n\
23388 which is continued\n\
23389 onto several lines.\n
23390 @end smallexample
23391
23392 produces the same output as
23393
23394 @smallexample
23395 echo This is some text\n
23396 echo which is continued\n
23397 echo onto several lines.\n
23398 @end smallexample
23399
23400 @kindex output
23401 @item output @var{expression}
23402 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
23403 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
23404 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23405 on expressions.
23406
23407 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23408 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23409 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23410 Formats}, for more information.
23411
23412 @kindex printf
23413 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23414 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23415 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
23416 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
23417 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
23418 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
23419 executing the code below:
23420
23421 @smallexample
23422 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
23423 @end smallexample
23424
23425 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
23426 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
23427 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
23428 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
23429 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
23430 printed.
23431
23432 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
23433
23434 @smallexample
23435 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
23436 @end smallexample
23437
23438 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
23439 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
23440 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
23441
23442 @itemize @bullet
23443 @item
23444 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
23445
23446 @item
23447 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
23448 width.
23449
23450 @item
23451 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
23452 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
23453
23454 @item
23455 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
23456 supported.
23457
23458 @item
23459 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
23460
23461 @item
23462 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
23463 @end itemize
23464
23465 @noindent
23466 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
23467 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
23468 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
23469 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
23470
23471 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
23472 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
23473 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
23474 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
23475 supported.
23476
23477 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
23478 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
23479 together with a floating point specifier.
23480 letters:
23481
23482 @itemize @bullet
23483 @item
23484 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
23485
23486 @item
23487 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
23488
23489 @item
23490 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
23491 @end itemize
23492
23493 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
23494 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
23495 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
23496
23497 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
23498 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
23499
23500 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
23501 @smallexample
23502 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
23503 @end smallexample
23504
23505 @kindex eval
23506 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23507 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23508 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
23509
23510 @end table
23511
23512 @node Auto-loading sequences
23513 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
23514 @cindex native script auto-loading
23515
23516 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23517 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23518 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
23519 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23520
23521 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23522 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23523
23524 @table @code
23525 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
23526 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
23527 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
23528 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
23529
23530 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
23531 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
23532 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
23533 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
23534 disabled.
23535
23536 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
23537 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
23538 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
23539 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
23540 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
23541 auto-loaded.
23542 @end table
23543
23544 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
23545 matching names are printed.
23546
23547 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
23548 @include python.texi
23549
23550 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
23551 @include guile.texi
23552
23553 @node Auto-loading extensions
23554 @section Auto-loading extensions
23555 @cindex auto-loading extensions
23556
23557 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
23558 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23559 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
23560 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
23561 section of modern file formats like ELF.
23562
23563 @menu
23564 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23565 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23566 * Which flavor to choose?::
23567 @end menu
23568
23569 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23570 debugging commands and features.
23571
23572 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23573 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23574 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
23575 for more information.
23576 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
23577 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
23578
23579 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23580 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23581
23582 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
23583 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23584 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23585 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23586 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23587
23588 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
23589 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
23590 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
23591 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
23592
23593 @table @code
23594 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23595 GDB's own command language
23596 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23597 Python
23598 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23599 Guile
23600 @end table
23601
23602 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
23603 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
23604 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
23605 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
23606 script in the specified extension language.
23607
23608 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23609 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
23610
23611 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
23612 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23613
23614 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
23615 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
23616 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
23617 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
23618 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
23619 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
23620
23621 @table @code
23622 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
23623 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
23624 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23625 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
23626 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
23627 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
23628
23629 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
23630 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
23631
23632 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
23633 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
23634 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
23635 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
23636
23637 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
23638 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
23639 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
23640 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
23641 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
23642 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
23643 platform.
23644
23645 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23646 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23647 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23648
23649 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
23650 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
23651 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
23652 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23653 @end table
23654
23655 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23656 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23657 @var{objfile} is opened.
23658 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23659 is evaluated more than once.
23660
23661 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
23662 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23663 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23664
23665 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23666 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23667 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23668 If this section exists, its contents is a list of NUL-terminated names
23669 of scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-NULL prefix byte that
23670 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language.
23671
23672 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23673 current directory and then along the source search path
23674 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23675 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23676 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23677
23678 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23679 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
23680
23681 @example
23682 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23683 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23684 asm("\
23685 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23686 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
23687 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23688 .popsection \n\
23689 ");
23690 @end example
23691
23692 @noindent
23693 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
23694 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23695
23696 @example
23697 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23698 @end example
23699
23700 The script name may include directories if desired.
23701
23702 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23703 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23704
23705 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
23706 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
23707 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
23708 will remove duplicates.
23709
23710 @node Which flavor to choose?
23711 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
23712
23713 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
23714 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23715
23716 @noindent
23717 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
23718
23719 @itemize @bullet
23720 @item
23721 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23722
23723 @item
23724 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23725
23726 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23727 in the source search path.
23728 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23729 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23730
23731 @item
23732 Doesn't require source code additions.
23733 @end itemize
23734
23735 @noindent
23736 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23737
23738 @itemize @bullet
23739 @item
23740 Works with static linking.
23741
23742 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
23743 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23744 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23745 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
23746 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
23747
23748 @item
23749 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23750
23751 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23752 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
23753
23754 @item
23755 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23756
23757 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23758 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23759 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23760 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23761 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23762 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23763 @end itemize
23764
23765 @node Multiple Extension Languages
23766 @section Multiple Extension Languages
23767
23768 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
23769 and generally do not interfere with each other.
23770 There are some things to be aware of, however.
23771
23772 @subsection Python comes first
23773
23774 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
23775 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
23776 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
23777 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
23778 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
23779 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
23780 pretty-printed form of a value).
23781 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
23782 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
23783 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
23784
23785 @node Aliases
23786 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
23787 @cindex aliases for commands
23788
23789 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
23790 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
23791 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
23792 that involves less typing.
23793
23794 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
23795 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
23796 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
23797
23798 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
23799 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
23800 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
23801
23802 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
23803
23804 @table @code
23805
23806 @kindex alias
23807 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
23808
23809 @end table
23810
23811 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
23812 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
23813 underscores.
23814
23815 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
23816 that is being aliased.
23817
23818 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
23819 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
23820 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
23821
23822 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
23823 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
23824
23825 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
23826 of a command so that there is less to type.
23827 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
23828 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
23829 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
23830 The following will accomplish this.
23831
23832 @smallexample
23833 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
23834 @end smallexample
23835
23836 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
23837 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
23838 for it with the @samp{document} command.
23839 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
23840
23841 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
23842 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
23843 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
23844 of a command.
23845
23846 @smallexample
23847 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
23848 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
23849 (gdb) set p elms 20
23850 (gdb) show p elms
23851 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
23852 @end smallexample
23853
23854 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
23855 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
23856 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
23857
23858 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
23859 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
23860
23861 @smallexample
23862 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
23863 @end smallexample
23864
23865 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
23866 alias for a more complex command.
23867 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
23868
23869 @smallexample
23870 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
23871 (gdb) spe 20
23872 @end smallexample
23873
23874 @node Interpreters
23875 @chapter Command Interpreters
23876 @cindex command interpreters
23877
23878 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
23879 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
23880 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
23881
23882 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
23883 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
23884 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
23885 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
23886
23887 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
23888 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
23889 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
23890 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
23891
23892 @table @code
23893 @item console
23894 @cindex console interpreter
23895 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
23896 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
23897 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
23898
23899 @item mi
23900 @cindex mi interpreter
23901 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
23902 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
23903 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
23904 Interface}.
23905
23906 @item mi2
23907 @cindex mi2 interpreter
23908 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
23909
23910 @item mi1
23911 @cindex mi1 interpreter
23912 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
23913
23914 @end table
23915
23916 @cindex invoke another interpreter
23917 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
23918 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
23919 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
23920 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
23921 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
23922 the IDE inoperable!
23923
23924 @kindex interpreter-exec
23925 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
23926 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
23927 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
23928 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
23929
23930 @smallexample
23931 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
23932 @end smallexample
23933
23934 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
23935 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
23936
23937 @node TUI
23938 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
23939 @cindex TUI
23940 @cindex Text User Interface
23941
23942 @menu
23943 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
23944 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
23945 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
23946 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
23947 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
23948 @end menu
23949
23950 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
23951 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
23952 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
23953 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
23954 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
23955 is available.
23956
23957 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
23958 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
23959 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
23960 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
23961 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
23962
23963 @node TUI Overview
23964 @section TUI Overview
23965
23966 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
23967
23968 @table @emph
23969 @item command
23970 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
23971 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
23972 managed using readline.
23973
23974 @item source
23975 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
23976 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
23977
23978 @item assembly
23979 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
23980
23981 @item register
23982 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
23983 when their values change.
23984 @end table
23985
23986 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
23987 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
23988 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
23989 indicates the breakpoint type:
23990
23991 @table @code
23992 @item B
23993 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23994
23995 @item b
23996 Breakpoint which was never hit.
23997
23998 @item H
23999 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24000
24001 @item h
24002 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24003 @end table
24004
24005 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24006
24007 @table @code
24008 @item +
24009 Breakpoint is enabled.
24010
24011 @item -
24012 Breakpoint is disabled.
24013 @end table
24014
24015 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24016 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24017 changes.
24018
24019 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24020 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24021 layouts:
24022
24023 @itemize @bullet
24024 @item
24025 source only,
24026
24027 @item
24028 assembly only,
24029
24030 @item
24031 source and assembly,
24032
24033 @item
24034 source and registers, or
24035
24036 @item
24037 assembly and registers.
24038 @end itemize
24039
24040 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24041
24042 @table @emph
24043 @item target
24044 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24045 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24046
24047 @item process
24048 Gives the current process or thread number.
24049 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24050
24051 @item function
24052 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24053 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24054 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24055 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24056
24057 @item line
24058 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24059 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24060
24061 @item pc
24062 Indicates the current program counter address.
24063 @end table
24064
24065 @node TUI Keys
24066 @section TUI Key Bindings
24067 @cindex TUI key bindings
24068
24069 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24070 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24071 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24072 @end ifset
24073 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24074 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24075 @end ifclear
24076 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24077 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24078
24079 @table @kbd
24080 @kindex C-x C-a
24081 @item C-x C-a
24082 @kindex C-x a
24083 @itemx C-x a
24084 @kindex C-x A
24085 @itemx C-x A
24086 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24087 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24088 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24089 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24090 The screen is then refreshed.
24091
24092 @kindex C-x 1
24093 @item C-x 1
24094 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24095 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24096 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24097
24098 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24099
24100 @kindex C-x 2
24101 @item C-x 2
24102 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24103 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24104 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24105 previous layout and the new one.
24106
24107 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24108
24109 @kindex C-x o
24110 @item C-x o
24111 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24112 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24113 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24114
24115 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24116
24117 @kindex C-x s
24118 @item C-x s
24119 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24120 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24121 @end table
24122
24123 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24124
24125 @table @asis
24126 @kindex PgUp
24127 @item @key{PgUp}
24128 Scroll the active window one page up.
24129
24130 @kindex PgDn
24131 @item @key{PgDn}
24132 Scroll the active window one page down.
24133
24134 @kindex Up
24135 @item @key{Up}
24136 Scroll the active window one line up.
24137
24138 @kindex Down
24139 @item @key{Down}
24140 Scroll the active window one line down.
24141
24142 @kindex Left
24143 @item @key{Left}
24144 Scroll the active window one column left.
24145
24146 @kindex Right
24147 @item @key{Right}
24148 Scroll the active window one column right.
24149
24150 @kindex C-L
24151 @item @kbd{C-L}
24152 Refresh the screen.
24153 @end table
24154
24155 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24156 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24157 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24158 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24159 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24160
24161 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24162 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24163 @cindex TUI single key mode
24164
24165 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24166 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24167 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24168
24169 @table @kbd
24170 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24171 @item c
24172 continue
24173
24174 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24175 @item d
24176 down
24177
24178 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24179 @item f
24180 finish
24181
24182 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24183 @item n
24184 next
24185
24186 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24187 @item q
24188 exit the SingleKey mode.
24189
24190 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24191 @item r
24192 run
24193
24194 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24195 @item s
24196 step
24197
24198 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24199 @item u
24200 up
24201
24202 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24203 @item v
24204 info locals
24205
24206 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24207 @item w
24208 where
24209 @end table
24210
24211 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24212 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24213 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24214 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24215 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24216 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24217
24218
24219 @node TUI Commands
24220 @section TUI-specific Commands
24221 @cindex TUI commands
24222
24223 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24224 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24225 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24226 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24227
24228 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24229 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24230 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24231 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24232 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24233
24234 @table @code
24235 @item info win
24236 @kindex info win
24237 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24238
24239 @item layout next
24240 @kindex layout
24241 Display the next layout.
24242
24243 @item layout prev
24244 Display the previous layout.
24245
24246 @item layout src
24247 Display the source window only.
24248
24249 @item layout asm
24250 Display the assembly window only.
24251
24252 @item layout split
24253 Display the source and assembly window.
24254
24255 @item layout regs
24256 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24257
24258 @item focus next
24259 @kindex focus
24260 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24261
24262 @item focus prev
24263 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24264
24265 @item focus src
24266 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24267
24268 @item focus asm
24269 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24270
24271 @item focus regs
24272 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24273
24274 @item focus cmd
24275 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24276
24277 @item refresh
24278 @kindex refresh
24279 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24280
24281 @item tui reg float
24282 @kindex tui reg
24283 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24284
24285 @item tui reg general
24286 Show the general registers in the register window.
24287
24288 @item tui reg next
24289 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24290 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24291 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24292 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24293
24294 @item tui reg system
24295 Show the system registers in the register window.
24296
24297 @item update
24298 @kindex update
24299 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24300
24301 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24302 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24303 @kindex winheight
24304 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24305 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24306 decrease it.
24307
24308 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24309 @kindex tabset
24310 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
24311 @end table
24312
24313 @node TUI Configuration
24314 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24315 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24316
24317 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24318
24319 @table @code
24320 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24321 @kindex set tui border-kind
24322 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24323 The possible values are the following:
24324 @table @code
24325 @item space
24326 Use a space character to draw the border.
24327
24328 @item ascii
24329 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
24330
24331 @item acs
24332 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
24333 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
24334 @end table
24335
24336 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
24337 @kindex set tui border-mode
24338 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
24339 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
24340 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
24341 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
24342 @table @code
24343 @item normal
24344 Use normal attributes to display the border.
24345
24346 @item standout
24347 Use standout mode.
24348
24349 @item reverse
24350 Use reverse video mode.
24351
24352 @item half
24353 Use half bright mode.
24354
24355 @item half-standout
24356 Use half bright and standout mode.
24357
24358 @item bold
24359 Use extra bright or bold mode.
24360
24361 @item bold-standout
24362 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
24363 @end table
24364 @end table
24365
24366 @node Emacs
24367 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
24368
24369 @cindex Emacs
24370 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
24371 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
24372 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
24373 @value{GDBN}.
24374
24375 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
24376 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
24377 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
24378 created Emacs buffer.
24379 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
24380
24381 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
24382 things:
24383
24384 @itemize @bullet
24385 @item
24386 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
24387 the GUD buffer.
24388
24389 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
24390 and output done by the program you are debugging.
24391
24392 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
24393 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
24394 in this way.
24395
24396 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
24397 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
24398 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
24399 stop.
24400
24401 @item
24402 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
24403
24404 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
24405 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
24406 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
24407 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
24408 and the source.
24409
24410 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
24411 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
24412 @end itemize
24413
24414 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
24415 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
24416 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
24417 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
24418
24419 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
24420 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
24421 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
24422 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
24423 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
24424 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
24425 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
24426 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
24427 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
24428
24429 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
24430 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
24431 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
24432 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24433
24434 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
24435 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
24436 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
24437 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
24438 one you want.
24439
24440 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
24441 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
24442
24443 @table @kbd
24444 @item C-h m
24445 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
24446
24447 @item C-c C-s
24448 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
24449 update the display window to show the current file and location.
24450
24451 @item C-c C-n
24452 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
24453 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
24454 to show the current file and location.
24455
24456 @item C-c C-i
24457 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
24458 display window accordingly.
24459
24460 @item C-c C-f
24461 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
24462 @code{finish} command.
24463
24464 @item C-c C-r
24465 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
24466 command.
24467
24468 @item C-c <
24469 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
24470 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
24471 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
24472
24473 @item C-c >
24474 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
24475 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
24476 @end table
24477
24478 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
24479 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
24480
24481 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
24482 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
24483 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
24484 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
24485 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
24486 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
24487 speedbar displays watch expressions.
24488
24489 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
24490 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
24491 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
24492 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
24493 frame.
24494
24495 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
24496 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
24497 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
24498 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
24499 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
24500 to correspond properly with the code.
24501
24502 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
24503 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
24504 Emacs Manual}).
24505
24506 @node GDB/MI
24507 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
24508
24509 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
24510
24511 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
24512 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
24513 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
24514 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
24515 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
24516 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
24517
24518 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
24519 in the form of a reference manual.
24520
24521 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
24522 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
24523 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
24524
24525 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
24526
24527 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
24528 This chapter uses the following notation:
24529
24530 @itemize @bullet
24531 @item
24532 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
24533
24534 @item
24535 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
24536 it may or may not be given.
24537
24538 @item
24539 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24540 may repeat zero or more times.
24541
24542 @item
24543 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24544 may repeat one or more times.
24545
24546 @item
24547 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
24548 @end itemize
24549
24550 @ignore
24551 @heading Dependencies
24552 @end ignore
24553
24554 @menu
24555 * GDB/MI General Design::
24556 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
24557 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
24558 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
24559 * GDB/MI Output Records::
24560 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
24561 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
24562 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
24563 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
24564 * GDB/MI Program Context::
24565 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
24566 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
24567 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
24568 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
24569 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
24570 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
24571 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
24572 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
24573 * GDB/MI File Commands::
24574 @ignore
24575 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
24576 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
24577 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24578 @end ignore
24579 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24580 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24581 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
24582 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
24583 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24584 @end menu
24585
24586 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24587 @node GDB/MI General Design
24588 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24589 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24590
24591 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24592 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24593 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24594 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24595 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24596 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24597 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24598 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24599 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24600 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24601
24602 The important examples of notifications are:
24603 @itemize @bullet
24604
24605 @item
24606 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24607 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24608 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24609 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24610 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24611 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24612 command itself was successfully executed.
24613
24614 @item
24615 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24616 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24617 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24618 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24619 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24620 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24621
24622 @item
24623 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24624 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24625 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24626 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24627 orthogonal frontend design.
24628
24629 @end itemize
24630
24631 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24632 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24633 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24634 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24635 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24636 the user interface.
24637
24638
24639 @menu
24640 * Context management::
24641 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24642 * Thread groups::
24643 @end menu
24644
24645 @node Context management
24646 @subsection Context management
24647
24648 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
24649
24650 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24651 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24652 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24653 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24654 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24655 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24656 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24657 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24658 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24659
24660 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24661 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24662 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24663 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24664 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24665 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24666 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24667 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24668 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24669 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24670 for thread and frame to operate on.
24671
24672 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24673 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24674 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24675 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24676 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24677 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24678 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24679 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24680 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24681 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24682
24683 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24684 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24685 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24686 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24687 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24688 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24689 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24690 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24691 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24692 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24693 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24694 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24695 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24696 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24697 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24698 @samp{--frame} options.
24699
24700 @subsubsection Language
24701
24702 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
24703 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
24704 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
24705 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
24706 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
24707 For instance:
24708
24709 @smallexample
24710 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
24711 ^done,value="4"
24712 (gdb)
24713 @end smallexample
24714
24715 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
24716 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
24717 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
24718
24719 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24720 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24721
24722 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24723 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24724 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24725 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24726 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24727 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24728 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24729 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24730 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24731
24732 @table @code
24733 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
24734 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
24735 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
24736
24737 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
24738 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
24739 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
24740
24741 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
24742 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
24743 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
24744 MI commands even while the target is running.
24745
24746 @item -gdb-show mi-async
24747 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
24748 @end table
24749
24750 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
24751 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
24752 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
24753 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
24754 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
24755 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
24756
24757 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24758 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24759 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24760 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24761 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24762 are running.
24763
24764 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24765 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24766 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24767 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24768 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24769 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24770 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24771 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24772 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24773 @samp{--thread} option).
24774
24775 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24776 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24777 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24778 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24779
24780 @node Thread groups
24781 @subsection Thread groups
24782 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24783 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24784 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24785 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24786 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24787
24788 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24789 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24790 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24791 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24792 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24793 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24794 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24795 into processes.
24796
24797 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24798 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24799 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24800 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24801 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24802 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24803 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24804 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24805 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24806 the members of specific thread group.
24807
24808 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24809 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24810 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24811 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24812 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24813 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24814 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24815 after attaching to that thread group.
24816
24817 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24818 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24819 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24820 such thread groups.
24821
24822 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24823 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24824 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24825
24826 @menu
24827 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24828 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24829 @end menu
24830
24831 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24832 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24833
24834 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24835 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24836 @table @code
24837 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24838 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24839
24840 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24841 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24842 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24843
24844 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24845 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24846 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
24847
24848 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24849 "any sequence of digits"
24850
24851 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
24852 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
24853
24854 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
24855 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
24856
24857 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
24858 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
24859
24860 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
24861 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
24862 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
24863
24864 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
24865 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
24866
24867 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24868 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24869 @end table
24870
24871 @noindent
24872 Notes:
24873
24874 @itemize @bullet
24875 @item
24876 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
24877 output is described below.
24878
24879 @item
24880 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
24881 finishes.
24882
24883 @item
24884 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
24885 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
24886 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
24887 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
24888 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
24889 @end itemize
24890
24891 Pragmatics:
24892
24893 @itemize @bullet
24894 @item
24895 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
24896
24897 @item
24898 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
24899 @end itemize
24900
24901 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
24902 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
24903
24904 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
24905 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
24906 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
24907 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
24908 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
24909 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
24910
24911 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
24912 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
24913 @var{token}.
24914
24915 @table @code
24916 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
24917 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
24918
24919 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
24920 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24921
24922 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
24923 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
24924
24925 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
24926 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
24927
24928 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
24929 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
24930
24931 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
24932 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
24933
24934 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
24935 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
24936
24937 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
24938 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
24939
24940 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
24941 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
24942
24943 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
24944 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
24945 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
24946
24947 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
24948 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
24949
24950 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
24951 @code{ @var{string} }
24952
24953 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
24954 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
24955
24956 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
24957 @code{@var{c-string}}
24958
24959 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
24960 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
24961
24962 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
24963 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
24964 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
24965
24966 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
24967 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
24968
24969 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
24970 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
24971
24972 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
24973 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
24974
24975 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
24976 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
24977
24978 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24979 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24980
24981 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24982 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
24983 @end table
24984
24985 @noindent
24986 Notes:
24987
24988 @itemize @bullet
24989 @item
24990 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
24991
24992 @item
24993 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
24994 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
24995 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
24996 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
24997 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
24998 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
24999 prior command.
25000
25001 @item
25002 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25003 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25004 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25005 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25006
25007 @item
25008 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25009 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25010 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25011 @samp{*}.
25012
25013 @item
25014 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25015 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25016 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25017 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25018
25019 @item
25020 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25021 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25022 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25023 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25024
25025 @item
25026 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25027 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25028 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25029
25030 @item
25031 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25032 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25033 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25034 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25035
25036 @item
25037 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25038 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25039 @var{values}.
25040
25041
25042 @end itemize
25043
25044 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25045 details about the various output records.
25046
25047 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25048 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25049 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25050
25051 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25052 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25053
25054 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25055 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25056 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25057 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25058 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25059 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25060
25061 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25062 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25063 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25064
25065 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25066 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25067 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25068 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25069
25070 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25071 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25072
25073 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25074 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25075 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25076 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25077 might change.
25078
25079 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25080 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25081 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25082 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25083
25084 @itemize @bullet
25085 @item
25086 New MI commands may be added.
25087
25088 @item
25089 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25090
25091 @item
25092 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25093 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25094
25095 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25096 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25097
25098 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25099 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25100 @end itemize
25101
25102 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25103 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25104 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25105 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25106 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25107
25108 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25109 @c version?
25110
25111 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25112 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25113 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25114 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25115 @cindex mailing lists
25116
25117 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25118 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25119 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25120
25121 @menu
25122 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25123 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25124 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25125 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25126 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25127 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25128 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25129 @end menu
25130
25131 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25132 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25133
25134 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25135 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25136 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25137 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25138
25139 @table @code
25140 @findex ^done
25141 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25142 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25143 values.
25144
25145 @item "^running"
25146 @findex ^running
25147 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25148 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25149 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25150 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25151 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25152 which threads are resumed.
25153
25154 @item "^connected"
25155 @findex ^connected
25156 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25157
25158 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25159 @findex ^error
25160 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25161 the corresponding error message.
25162
25163 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25164 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25165 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25166
25167 @table @samp
25168 @item "undefined-command"
25169 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25170 @end table
25171
25172 @item "^exit"
25173 @findex ^exit
25174 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25175
25176 @end table
25177
25178 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25179 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25180
25181 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25182 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25183 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25184 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25185 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25186
25187 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25188 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25189 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25190 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25191 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25192
25193 @table @code
25194 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25195 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25196 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25197
25198 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25199 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25200 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25201 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25202
25203 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25204 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25205 internals.
25206 @end table
25207
25208 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25209 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25210
25211 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25212 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25213 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25214 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25215 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25216 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25217
25218 The following is the list of possible async records:
25219
25220 @table @code
25221
25222 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25223 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25224 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25225 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25226 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25227 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25228 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25229 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25230 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25231 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25232
25233 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25234 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25235 following values:
25236
25237 @table @code
25238 @item breakpoint-hit
25239 A breakpoint was reached.
25240 @item watchpoint-trigger
25241 A watchpoint was triggered.
25242 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25243 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25244 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25245 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25246 @item function-finished
25247 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25248 @item location-reached
25249 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25250 @item watchpoint-scope
25251 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25252 @item end-stepping-range
25253 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25254 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25255 @item exited-signalled
25256 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25257 @item exited
25258 The inferior exited.
25259 @item exited-normally
25260 The inferior exited normally.
25261 @item signal-received
25262 A signal was received by the inferior.
25263 @item solib-event
25264 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25265 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25266 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25267 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25268 @item fork
25269 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25270 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25271 @item vfork
25272 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25273 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25274 @item syscall-entry
25275 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25276 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25277 @item syscall-entry
25278 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25279 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25280 @item exec
25281 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25282 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25283 @end table
25284
25285 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25286 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25287 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25288 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25289 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25290 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25291 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25292 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25293 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25294 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25295 if such information is not available.
25296
25297 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25298 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25299 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25300 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25301 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25302 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25303 cannot be used in any way.
25304
25305 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25306 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25307 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25308 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25309 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25310 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25311
25312 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25313 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25314 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25315 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25316 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
25317 only when the inferior exited with some code.
25318
25319 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25320 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25321 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25322 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25323 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25324
25325 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
25326 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
25327 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
25328 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
25329 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
25330 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
25331 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
25332
25333 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
25334 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
25335 that thread.
25336
25337 @item =library-loaded,...
25338 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
25339 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
25340 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
25341 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
25342 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
25343 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
25344 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
25345 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
25346 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
25347 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
25348 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
25349 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
25350 thread groups.
25351
25352 @item =library-unloaded,...
25353 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
25354 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
25355 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
25356 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
25357 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
25358 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
25359 thread groups.
25360
25361 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
25362 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
25363 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
25364 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
25365 frame is @var{tpnum}.
25366
25367 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
25368 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
25369 initial value @var{initial}.
25370
25371 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
25372 @itemx =tsv-deleted
25373 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
25374 trace state variables are deleted.
25375
25376 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
25377 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
25378 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
25379 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
25380 value of trace state variable is known.
25381
25382 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
25383 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
25384 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
25385 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
25386 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
25387 user.
25388
25389 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
25390 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
25391 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
25392
25393 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
25394 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
25395
25396 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
25397 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
25398 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
25399 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
25400 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
25401
25402 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
25403 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
25404 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
25405 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
25406 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
25407 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
25408
25409 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
25410 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
25411 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
25412 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
25413 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
25414 executable code.
25415 @end table
25416
25417 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
25418 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
25419
25420 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
25421 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
25422 following fields:
25423
25424 @table @code
25425 @item number
25426 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
25427 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
25428 @samp{1.2}.
25429
25430 @item type
25431 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
25432 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
25433
25434 @item catch-type
25435 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
25436 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
25437
25438 @item disp
25439 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
25440 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
25441 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
25442
25443 @item enabled
25444 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
25445 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
25446 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
25447
25448 @item addr
25449 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
25450 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
25451 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
25452 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
25453 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
25454
25455 @item func
25456 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
25457 If not known, this field is not present.
25458
25459 @item filename
25460 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
25461 If not known, this field is not present.
25462
25463 @item fullname
25464 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
25465 known. If not known, this field is not present.
25466
25467 @item line
25468 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
25469 If not known, this field is not present.
25470
25471 @item at
25472 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
25473 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
25474 by a symbol name.
25475
25476 @item pending
25477 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
25478 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
25479
25480 @item evaluated-by
25481 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
25482 @samp{target}.
25483
25484 @item thread
25485 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
25486 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
25487
25488 @item task
25489 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
25490 field will hold the task identifier.
25491
25492 @item cond
25493 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
25494
25495 @item ignore
25496 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
25497
25498 @item enable
25499 The enable count of the breakpoint.
25500
25501 @item traceframe-usage
25502 FIXME.
25503
25504 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
25505 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
25506
25507 @item mask
25508 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
25509
25510 @item pass
25511 A tracepoint's pass count.
25512
25513 @item original-location
25514 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
25515 This field is optional.
25516
25517 @item times
25518 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
25519
25520 @item installed
25521 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
25522 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
25523 is not.
25524
25525 @item what
25526 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
25527
25528 @end table
25529
25530 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
25531 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
25532
25533 @smallexample
25534 -> -break-insert main
25535 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25536 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25537 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25538 times="0"@}
25539 <- (gdb)
25540 @end smallexample
25541
25542 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
25543 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
25544
25545 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
25546 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
25547 fields:
25548
25549 @table @code
25550 @item level
25551 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
25552 zero. This field is always present.
25553
25554 @item func
25555 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
25556 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
25557
25558 @item addr
25559 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
25560
25561 @item file
25562 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
25563 address. This field may be absent.
25564
25565 @item line
25566 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
25567 may be absent.
25568
25569 @item from
25570 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
25571 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
25572
25573 @end table
25574
25575 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
25576 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
25577
25578 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
25579 uses a tuple with the following fields:
25580
25581 @table @code
25582 @item id
25583 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
25584 always present.
25585
25586 @item target-id
25587 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
25588
25589 @item details
25590 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
25591 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
25592 frontend. This field is optional.
25593
25594 @item state
25595 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
25596 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
25597
25598 @item core
25599 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
25600 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
25601 @end table
25602
25603 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
25604 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
25605
25606 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
25607 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
25608 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
25609 the @code{exception-name} field.
25610
25611 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25612 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
25613 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
25614 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
25615
25616 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
25617 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
25618 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
25619 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
25620
25621 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
25622 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
25623
25624 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
25625
25626 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
25627 information of the breakpoint.
25628
25629 @smallexample
25630 -> -break-insert main
25631 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25632 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25633 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25634 times="0"@}
25635 <- (gdb)
25636 @end smallexample
25637
25638 @subheading Program Execution
25639
25640 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
25641 reason that execution stopped.
25642
25643 @smallexample
25644 -> -exec-run
25645 <- ^running
25646 <- (gdb)
25647 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
25648 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
25649 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
25650 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
25651 <- (gdb)
25652 -> -exec-continue
25653 <- ^running
25654 <- (gdb)
25655 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
25656 <- (gdb)
25657 @end smallexample
25658
25659 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
25660
25661 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
25662
25663 @smallexample
25664 -> (gdb)
25665 <- -gdb-exit
25666 <- ^exit
25667 @end smallexample
25668
25669 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
25670 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
25671 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
25672 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
25673 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
25674 fails to exit in reasonable time.
25675
25676 @subheading A Bad Command
25677
25678 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
25679
25680 @smallexample
25681 -> -rubbish
25682 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
25683 <- (gdb)
25684 @end smallexample
25685
25686
25687 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25688 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
25689 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
25690
25691 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
25692 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
25693
25694 @subheading Motivation
25695
25696 The motivation for this collection of commands.
25697
25698 @subheading Introduction
25699
25700 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
25701
25702 @subheading Commands
25703
25704 For each command in the block, the following is described:
25705
25706 @subsubheading Synopsis
25707
25708 @smallexample
25709 -command @var{args}@dots{}
25710 @end smallexample
25711
25712 @subsubheading Result
25713
25714 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25715
25716 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
25717
25718 @subsubheading Example
25719
25720 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
25721 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
25722
25723
25724 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25725 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
25726 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
25727
25728 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
25729 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
25730 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
25731 breakpoints.
25732
25733 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
25734 @findex -break-after
25735
25736 @subsubheading Synopsis
25737
25738 @smallexample
25739 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
25740 @end smallexample
25741
25742 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
25743 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
25744 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
25745 @samp{-break-list} command below.
25746
25747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25748
25749 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
25750
25751 @subsubheading Example
25752
25753 @smallexample
25754 (gdb)
25755 -break-insert main
25756 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25757 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25758 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25759 times="0"@}
25760 (gdb)
25761 -break-after 1 3
25762 ~
25763 ^done
25764 (gdb)
25765 -break-list
25766 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25767 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25768 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25769 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25770 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25771 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25772 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25773 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25774 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25775 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25776 (gdb)
25777 @end smallexample
25778
25779 @ignore
25780 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
25781 @findex -break-catch
25782 @end ignore
25783
25784 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
25785 @findex -break-commands
25786
25787 @subsubheading Synopsis
25788
25789 @smallexample
25790 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
25791 @end smallexample
25792
25793 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
25794 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
25795 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
25796 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
25797 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
25798 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
25799
25800 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25801
25802 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
25803
25804 @subsubheading Example
25805
25806 @smallexample
25807 (gdb)
25808 -break-insert main
25809 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25810 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25811 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25812 times="0"@}
25813 (gdb)
25814 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
25815 ^done
25816 (gdb)
25817 @end smallexample
25818
25819 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
25820 @findex -break-condition
25821
25822 @subsubheading Synopsis
25823
25824 @smallexample
25825 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
25826 @end smallexample
25827
25828 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
25829 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
25830 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
25831 command below).
25832
25833 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25834
25835 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
25836
25837 @subsubheading Example
25838
25839 @smallexample
25840 (gdb)
25841 -break-condition 1 1
25842 ^done
25843 (gdb)
25844 -break-list
25845 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25846 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25847 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25848 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25849 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25850 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25851 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25852 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25853 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25854 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25855 (gdb)
25856 @end smallexample
25857
25858 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
25859 @findex -break-delete
25860
25861 @subsubheading Synopsis
25862
25863 @smallexample
25864 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25865 @end smallexample
25866
25867 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
25868 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
25869
25870 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25871
25872 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
25873
25874 @subsubheading Example
25875
25876 @smallexample
25877 (gdb)
25878 -break-delete 1
25879 ^done
25880 (gdb)
25881 -break-list
25882 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25883 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25884 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25885 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25886 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25887 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25888 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25889 body=[]@}
25890 (gdb)
25891 @end smallexample
25892
25893 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
25894 @findex -break-disable
25895
25896 @subsubheading Synopsis
25897
25898 @smallexample
25899 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25900 @end smallexample
25901
25902 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
25903 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
25904
25905 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25906
25907 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
25908
25909 @subsubheading Example
25910
25911 @smallexample
25912 (gdb)
25913 -break-disable 2
25914 ^done
25915 (gdb)
25916 -break-list
25917 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25918 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25919 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25920 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25921 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25922 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25923 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25924 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
25925 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25926 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
25927 (gdb)
25928 @end smallexample
25929
25930 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
25931 @findex -break-enable
25932
25933 @subsubheading Synopsis
25934
25935 @smallexample
25936 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25937 @end smallexample
25938
25939 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
25940
25941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25942
25943 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
25944
25945 @subsubheading Example
25946
25947 @smallexample
25948 (gdb)
25949 -break-enable 2
25950 ^done
25951 (gdb)
25952 -break-list
25953 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25954 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25955 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25956 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25957 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25958 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25959 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25960 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25961 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25962 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
25963 (gdb)
25964 @end smallexample
25965
25966 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
25967 @findex -break-info
25968
25969 @subsubheading Synopsis
25970
25971 @smallexample
25972 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
25973 @end smallexample
25974
25975 @c REDUNDANT???
25976 Get information about a single breakpoint.
25977
25978 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
25979 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
25980 table.
25981
25982 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25983
25984 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
25985
25986 @subsubheading Example
25987 N.A.
25988
25989 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
25990 @findex -break-insert
25991
25992 @subsubheading Synopsis
25993
25994 @smallexample
25995 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
25996 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
25997 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
25998 @end smallexample
25999
26000 @noindent
26001 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26002
26003 @itemize @bullet
26004 @item function
26005 @c @item +offset
26006 @c @item -offset
26007 @c @item linenum
26008 @item filename:linenum
26009 @item filename:function
26010 @item *address
26011 @end itemize
26012
26013 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26014
26015 @table @samp
26016 @item -t
26017 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26018 @item -h
26019 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26020 @item -f
26021 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26022 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26023 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26024 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26025 cannot be parsed.
26026 @item -d
26027 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26028 @item -a
26029 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26030 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26031 @item -c @var{condition}
26032 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26033 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26034 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26035 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26036 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26037 @end table
26038
26039 @subsubheading Result
26040
26041 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26042 resulting breakpoint.
26043
26044 Note: this format is open to change.
26045 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26046
26047 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26048
26049 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26050 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26051
26052 @subsubheading Example
26053
26054 @smallexample
26055 (gdb)
26056 -break-insert main
26057 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26058 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26059 times="0"@}
26060 (gdb)
26061 -break-insert -t foo
26062 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26063 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26064 times="0"@}
26065 (gdb)
26066 -break-list
26067 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26068 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26069 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26070 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26071 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26072 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26073 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26074 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26075 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26076 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26077 times="0"@},
26078 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26079 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26080 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26081 times="0"@}]@}
26082 (gdb)
26083 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26084 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26085 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26086 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26087 @c times="0"@}
26088 @c (gdb)
26089 @end smallexample
26090
26091 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26092 @findex -dprintf-insert
26093
26094 @subsubheading Synopsis
26095
26096 @smallexample
26097 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26098 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26099 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26100 [ @var{argument} ]
26101 @end smallexample
26102
26103 @noindent
26104 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26105
26106 @itemize @bullet
26107 @item @var{function}
26108 @c @item +offset
26109 @c @item -offset
26110 @c @item @var{linenum}
26111 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26112 @item @var{filename}:function
26113 @item *@var{address}
26114 @end itemize
26115
26116 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26117
26118 @table @samp
26119 @item -t
26120 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26121 @item -f
26122 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26123 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26124 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26125 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26126 cannot be parsed.
26127 @item -d
26128 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26129 @item -c @var{condition}
26130 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26131 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26132 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26133 to @var{ignore-count}.
26134 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26135 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26136 @end table
26137
26138 @subsubheading Result
26139
26140 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26141 resulting breakpoint.
26142
26143 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26144
26145 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26146
26147 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26148
26149 @subsubheading Example
26150
26151 @smallexample
26152 (gdb)
26153 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26154 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26155 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26156 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26157 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26158 original-location="foo"@}
26159 (gdb)
26160 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26161 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26162 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26163 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26164 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26165 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26166 (gdb)
26167 @end smallexample
26168
26169 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26170 @findex -break-list
26171
26172 @subsubheading Synopsis
26173
26174 @smallexample
26175 -break-list
26176 @end smallexample
26177
26178 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26179
26180 @table @samp
26181 @item Number
26182 number of the breakpoint
26183 @item Type
26184 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26185 @item Disposition
26186 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26187 or @samp{nokeep}
26188 @item Enabled
26189 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26190 @item Address
26191 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26192 @item What
26193 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26194 name, line number
26195 @item Thread-groups
26196 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26197 @item Times
26198 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26199 @end table
26200
26201 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26202 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26203
26204 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26205
26206 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26207
26208 @subsubheading Example
26209
26210 @smallexample
26211 (gdb)
26212 -break-list
26213 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26214 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26215 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26216 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26217 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26218 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26219 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26220 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26221 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26222 times="0"@},
26223 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26224 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26225 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26226 (gdb)
26227 @end smallexample
26228
26229 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26230
26231 @smallexample
26232 (gdb)
26233 -break-list
26234 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26235 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26236 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26237 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26238 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26239 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26240 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26241 body=[]@}
26242 (gdb)
26243 @end smallexample
26244
26245 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26246 @findex -break-passcount
26247
26248 @subsubheading Synopsis
26249
26250 @smallexample
26251 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26252 @end smallexample
26253
26254 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26255 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26256 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26257 command @samp{passcount}.
26258
26259 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26260 @findex -break-watch
26261
26262 @subsubheading Synopsis
26263
26264 @smallexample
26265 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26266 @end smallexample
26267
26268 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26269 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26270 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26271 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26272 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26273 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26274 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26275 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26276
26277 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26278 breakpoints inserted.
26279
26280 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26281
26282 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26283 @samp{rwatch}.
26284
26285 @subsubheading Example
26286
26287 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26288
26289 @smallexample
26290 (gdb)
26291 -break-watch x
26292 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26293 (gdb)
26294 -exec-continue
26295 ^running
26296 (gdb)
26297 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26298 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26299 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26300 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26301 (gdb)
26302 @end smallexample
26303
26304 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26305 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26306 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26307
26308 @smallexample
26309 (gdb)
26310 -break-watch C
26311 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26312 (gdb)
26313 -exec-continue
26314 ^running
26315 (gdb)
26316 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26317 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26318 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26319 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26320 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26321 (gdb)
26322 -exec-continue
26323 ^running
26324 (gdb)
26325 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26326 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26327 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26328 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26329 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26330 (gdb)
26331 @end smallexample
26332
26333 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
26334 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
26335 deleted.
26336
26337 @smallexample
26338 (gdb)
26339 -break-watch C
26340 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
26341 (gdb)
26342 -break-list
26343 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26344 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26345 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26346 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26347 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26348 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26349 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26350 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26351 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26352 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26353 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26354 times="1"@},
26355 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26356 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26357 (gdb)
26358 -exec-continue
26359 ^running
26360 (gdb)
26361 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
26362 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26363 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26364 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26365 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26366 (gdb)
26367 -break-list
26368 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26369 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26370 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26371 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26372 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26373 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26374 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26375 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26376 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26377 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26378 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26379 times="1"@},
26380 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26381 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
26382 (gdb)
26383 -exec-continue
26384 ^running
26385 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
26386 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26387 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26388 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26389 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26390 (gdb)
26391 -break-list
26392 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26393 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26394 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26395 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26396 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26397 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26398 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26399 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26400 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26401 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26402 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
26403 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
26404 (gdb)
26405 @end smallexample
26406
26407
26408 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26409 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26410 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
26411
26412 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26413 catchpoints.
26414
26415 @menu
26416 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26417 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26418 @end menu
26419
26420 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26421 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26422
26423 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
26424 @findex -catch-load
26425
26426 @subsubheading Synopsis
26427
26428 @smallexample
26429 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26430 @end smallexample
26431
26432 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
26433 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26434 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
26435 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26436 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
26437
26438
26439 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26440
26441 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
26442
26443 @subsubheading Example
26444
26445 @smallexample
26446 -catch-load -t foo.so
26447 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26448 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
26449 (gdb)
26450 @end smallexample
26451
26452
26453 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
26454 @findex -catch-unload
26455
26456 @subsubheading Synopsis
26457
26458 @smallexample
26459 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26460 @end smallexample
26461
26462 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
26463 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26464 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
26465 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26466 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
26467
26468 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26469
26470 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
26471
26472 @subsubheading Example
26473
26474 @smallexample
26475 -catch-unload -d bar.so
26476 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26477 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
26478 (gdb)
26479 @end smallexample
26480
26481 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26482 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26483
26484 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
26485 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
26486
26487 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
26488 @findex -catch-assert
26489
26490 @subsubheading Synopsis
26491
26492 @smallexample
26493 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
26494 @end smallexample
26495
26496 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
26497
26498 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26499
26500 @table @samp
26501 @item -c @var{condition}
26502 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26503 @item -d
26504 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26505 @item -t
26506 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26507 @end table
26508
26509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26510
26511 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
26512
26513 @subsubheading Example
26514
26515 @smallexample
26516 -catch-assert
26517 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26518 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
26519 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
26520 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
26521 (gdb)
26522 @end smallexample
26523
26524 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
26525 @findex -catch-exception
26526
26527 @subsubheading Synopsis
26528
26529 @smallexample
26530 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
26531 [ -t ] [ -u ]
26532 @end smallexample
26533
26534 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
26535 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
26536 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
26537 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
26538 catchpoints.
26539
26540 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26541
26542 @table @samp
26543 @item -c @var{condition}
26544 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26545 @item -d
26546 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26547 @item -e @var{exception-name}
26548 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
26549 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
26550 @item -t
26551 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26552 @item -u
26553 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
26554 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
26555 @end table
26556
26557 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26558
26559 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
26560 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
26561
26562 @subsubheading Example
26563
26564 @smallexample
26565 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
26566 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26567 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
26568 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
26569 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
26570 (gdb)
26571 @end smallexample
26572
26573 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26574 @node GDB/MI Program Context
26575 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
26576
26577 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
26578 @findex -exec-arguments
26579
26580
26581 @subsubheading Synopsis
26582
26583 @smallexample
26584 -exec-arguments @var{args}
26585 @end smallexample
26586
26587 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
26588 @samp{-exec-run}.
26589
26590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26591
26592 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
26593
26594 @subsubheading Example
26595
26596 @smallexample
26597 (gdb)
26598 -exec-arguments -v word
26599 ^done
26600 (gdb)
26601 @end smallexample
26602
26603
26604 @ignore
26605 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
26606 @findex -exec-show-arguments
26607
26608 @subsubheading Synopsis
26609
26610 @smallexample
26611 -exec-show-arguments
26612 @end smallexample
26613
26614 Print the arguments of the program.
26615
26616 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26617
26618 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
26619
26620 @subsubheading Example
26621 N.A.
26622 @end ignore
26623
26624
26625 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
26626 @findex -environment-cd
26627
26628 @subsubheading Synopsis
26629
26630 @smallexample
26631 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
26632 @end smallexample
26633
26634 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
26635
26636 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26637
26638 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
26639
26640 @subsubheading Example
26641
26642 @smallexample
26643 (gdb)
26644 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26645 ^done
26646 (gdb)
26647 @end smallexample
26648
26649
26650 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
26651 @findex -environment-directory
26652
26653 @subsubheading Synopsis
26654
26655 @smallexample
26656 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26657 @end smallexample
26658
26659 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
26660 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
26661 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
26662 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26663 occurs as normal.
26664 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26665 multiple directories in a single command
26666 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26667 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26668 If blanks are needed as
26669 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26670 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26671 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26672 character must not be used
26673 in any directory name.
26674 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
26675
26676 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26677
26678 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
26679
26680 @subsubheading Example
26681
26682 @smallexample
26683 (gdb)
26684 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26685 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26686 (gdb)
26687 -environment-directory ""
26688 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26689 (gdb)
26690 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
26691 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
26692 (gdb)
26693 -environment-directory -r
26694 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
26695 (gdb)
26696 @end smallexample
26697
26698
26699 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
26700 @findex -environment-path
26701
26702 @subsubheading Synopsis
26703
26704 @smallexample
26705 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26706 @end smallexample
26707
26708 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
26709 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
26710 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
26711 supplied in addition to the
26712 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26713 occurs as normal.
26714 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26715 multiple directories in a single command
26716 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26717 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26718 If blanks are needed as
26719 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26720 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26721 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26722 character must not be used
26723 in any directory name.
26724 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
26725
26726
26727 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26728
26729 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
26730
26731 @subsubheading Example
26732
26733 @smallexample
26734 (gdb)
26735 -environment-path
26736 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
26737 (gdb)
26738 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
26739 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
26740 (gdb)
26741 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
26742 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
26743 (gdb)
26744 @end smallexample
26745
26746
26747 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
26748 @findex -environment-pwd
26749
26750 @subsubheading Synopsis
26751
26752 @smallexample
26753 -environment-pwd
26754 @end smallexample
26755
26756 Show the current working directory.
26757
26758 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26759
26760 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
26761
26762 @subsubheading Example
26763
26764 @smallexample
26765 (gdb)
26766 -environment-pwd
26767 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
26768 (gdb)
26769 @end smallexample
26770
26771 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26772 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
26773 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
26774
26775
26776 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
26777 @findex -thread-info
26778
26779 @subsubheading Synopsis
26780
26781 @smallexample
26782 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
26783 @end smallexample
26784
26785 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
26786 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
26787 threads. When printing information about all threads,
26788 also reports the current thread.
26789
26790 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26791
26792 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
26793 about all threads.
26794
26795 @subsubheading Result
26796
26797 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
26798 defined for a given thread:
26799
26800 @table @samp
26801 @item current
26802 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26803
26804 @item id
26805 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
26806
26807 @item target-id
26808 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
26809
26810 @item details
26811 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
26812 field is optional.
26813
26814 @item name
26815 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
26816 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
26817 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
26818 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
26819 field is omitted.
26820
26821 @item frame
26822 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
26823
26824 @item state
26825 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
26826 values:
26827
26828 @table @code
26829 @item stopped
26830 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
26831 threads.
26832
26833 @item running
26834 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
26835 threads.
26836
26837 @end table
26838
26839 @item core
26840 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
26841 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
26842
26843 @end table
26844
26845 @subsubheading Example
26846
26847 @smallexample
26848 -thread-info
26849 ^done,threads=[
26850 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
26851 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
26852 args=[]@},state="running"@},
26853 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
26854 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
26855 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
26856 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
26857 state="running"@}],
26858 current-thread-id="1"
26859 (gdb)
26860 @end smallexample
26861
26862 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
26863 @findex -thread-list-ids
26864
26865 @subsubheading Synopsis
26866
26867 @smallexample
26868 -thread-list-ids
26869 @end smallexample
26870
26871 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
26872 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
26873
26874 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
26875 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
26876
26877 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26878
26879 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
26880
26881 @subsubheading Example
26882
26883 @smallexample
26884 (gdb)
26885 -thread-list-ids
26886 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26887 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
26888 (gdb)
26889 @end smallexample
26890
26891
26892 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
26893 @findex -thread-select
26894
26895 @subsubheading Synopsis
26896
26897 @smallexample
26898 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
26899 @end smallexample
26900
26901 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
26902 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
26903
26904 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
26905 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
26906
26907 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26908
26909 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
26910
26911 @subsubheading Example
26912
26913 @smallexample
26914 (gdb)
26915 -exec-next
26916 ^running
26917 (gdb)
26918 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
26919 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
26920 (gdb)
26921 -thread-list-ids
26922 ^done,
26923 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26924 number-of-threads="3"
26925 (gdb)
26926 -thread-select 3
26927 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
26928 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
26929 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
26930 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
26931 (gdb)
26932 @end smallexample
26933
26934 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26935 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
26936 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
26937
26938 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
26939 @findex -ada-task-info
26940
26941 @subsubheading Synopsis
26942
26943 @smallexample
26944 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
26945 @end smallexample
26946
26947 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
26948 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
26949
26950 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26951
26952 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
26953 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
26954
26955 @subsubheading Result
26956
26957 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
26958 defined for each Ada task:
26959
26960 @table @samp
26961 @item current
26962 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26963
26964 @item id
26965 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
26966
26967 @item task-id
26968 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
26969
26970 @item thread-id
26971 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
26972
26973 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
26974 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
26975 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
26976
26977 @item parent-id
26978 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
26979 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
26980
26981 @item priority
26982 The base priority of the task.
26983
26984 @item state
26985 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
26986 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
26987
26988 @item name
26989 The name of the task.
26990
26991 @end table
26992
26993 @subsubheading Example
26994
26995 @smallexample
26996 -ada-task-info
26997 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
26998 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
26999 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27000 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27001 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27002 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27003 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27004 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27005 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27006 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27007 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27008 (gdb)
27009 @end smallexample
27010
27011 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27012 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27013 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27014
27015 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27016 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27017 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27018 other cases.
27019
27020 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27021 @findex -exec-continue
27022
27023 @subsubheading Synopsis
27024
27025 @smallexample
27026 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27027 @end smallexample
27028
27029 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27030 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27031 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27032 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27033 @itemize @bullet
27034 @item
27035 breakpoints or watchpoints
27036 @item
27037 signals or exceptions
27038 @item
27039 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27040 @item
27041 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27042 @end itemize
27043 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27044 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27045 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27046 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27047 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27048 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27049
27050 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27051
27052 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27053
27054 @subsubheading Example
27055
27056 @smallexample
27057 -exec-continue
27058 ^running
27059 (gdb)
27060 @@Hello world
27061 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27062 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27063 line="13"@}
27064 (gdb)
27065 @end smallexample
27066
27067
27068 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27069 @findex -exec-finish
27070
27071 @subsubheading Synopsis
27072
27073 @smallexample
27074 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27075 @end smallexample
27076
27077 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27078 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27079 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27080 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27081 function was called.
27082
27083 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27084
27085 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27086
27087 @subsubheading Example
27088
27089 Function returning @code{void}.
27090
27091 @smallexample
27092 -exec-finish
27093 ^running
27094 (gdb)
27095 @@hello from foo
27096 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27097 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27098 (gdb)
27099 @end smallexample
27100
27101 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27102 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27103 value itself.
27104
27105 @smallexample
27106 -exec-finish
27107 ^running
27108 (gdb)
27109 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27110 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27111 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27112 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27113 (gdb)
27114 @end smallexample
27115
27116
27117 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27118 @findex -exec-interrupt
27119
27120 @subsubheading Synopsis
27121
27122 @smallexample
27123 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27124 @end smallexample
27125
27126 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27127 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27128 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27129 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27130 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27131
27132 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27133 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27134 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27135 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27136
27137 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27138 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27139 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27140 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27141
27142 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27143
27144 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27145
27146 @subsubheading Example
27147
27148 @smallexample
27149 (gdb)
27150 111-exec-continue
27151 111^running
27152
27153 (gdb)
27154 222-exec-interrupt
27155 222^done
27156 (gdb)
27157 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27158 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27159 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27160 (gdb)
27161
27162 (gdb)
27163 -exec-interrupt
27164 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27165 (gdb)
27166 @end smallexample
27167
27168 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27169 @findex -exec-jump
27170
27171 @subsubheading Synopsis
27172
27173 @smallexample
27174 -exec-jump @var{location}
27175 @end smallexample
27176
27177 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27178 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27179 different forms of @var{location}.
27180
27181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27182
27183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27184
27185 @subsubheading Example
27186
27187 @smallexample
27188 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27189 *running,thread-id="all"
27190 ^running
27191 @end smallexample
27192
27193
27194 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27195 @findex -exec-next
27196
27197 @subsubheading Synopsis
27198
27199 @smallexample
27200 -exec-next [--reverse]
27201 @end smallexample
27202
27203 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27204 of the next source line is reached.
27205
27206 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27207 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27208 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27209 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27210 source line where the function was called.
27211
27212
27213 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27214
27215 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27216
27217 @subsubheading Example
27218
27219 @smallexample
27220 -exec-next
27221 ^running
27222 (gdb)
27223 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27224 (gdb)
27225 @end smallexample
27226
27227
27228 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27229 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27230
27231 @subsubheading Synopsis
27232
27233 @smallexample
27234 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27235 @end smallexample
27236
27237 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27238 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27239 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27240 printed as well.
27241
27242 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27243 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27244 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27245 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27246 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27247
27248 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27249
27250 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27251
27252 @subsubheading Example
27253
27254 @smallexample
27255 (gdb)
27256 -exec-next-instruction
27257 ^running
27258
27259 (gdb)
27260 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27261 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27262 (gdb)
27263 @end smallexample
27264
27265
27266 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27267 @findex -exec-return
27268
27269 @subsubheading Synopsis
27270
27271 @smallexample
27272 -exec-return
27273 @end smallexample
27274
27275 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27276 Displays the new current frame.
27277
27278 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27279
27280 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27281
27282 @subsubheading Example
27283
27284 @smallexample
27285 (gdb)
27286 200-break-insert callee4
27287 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27288 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27289 (gdb)
27290 000-exec-run
27291 000^running
27292 (gdb)
27293 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27294 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27295 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27296 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27297 (gdb)
27298 205-break-delete
27299 205^done
27300 (gdb)
27301 111-exec-return
27302 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27303 args=[@{name="strarg",
27304 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27305 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27306 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27307 (gdb)
27308 @end smallexample
27309
27310
27311 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27312 @findex -exec-run
27313
27314 @subsubheading Synopsis
27315
27316 @smallexample
27317 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
27318 @end smallexample
27319
27320 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27321 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27322 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27323 the program has exited exceptionally.
27324
27325 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
27326 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27327 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27328 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
27329 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
27330
27331 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
27332 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
27333 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
27334 (@pxref{Starting}).
27335
27336 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27337
27338 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
27339
27340 @subsubheading Examples
27341
27342 @smallexample
27343 (gdb)
27344 -break-insert main
27345 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27346 (gdb)
27347 -exec-run
27348 ^running
27349 (gdb)
27350 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27351 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27352 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27353 (gdb)
27354 @end smallexample
27355
27356 @noindent
27357 Program exited normally:
27358
27359 @smallexample
27360 (gdb)
27361 -exec-run
27362 ^running
27363 (gdb)
27364 x = 55
27365 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27366 (gdb)
27367 @end smallexample
27368
27369 @noindent
27370 Program exited exceptionally:
27371
27372 @smallexample
27373 (gdb)
27374 -exec-run
27375 ^running
27376 (gdb)
27377 x = 55
27378 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
27379 (gdb)
27380 @end smallexample
27381
27382 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
27383 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
27384
27385 @smallexample
27386 (gdb)
27387 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
27388 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
27389 @end smallexample
27390
27391
27392 @c @subheading -exec-signal
27393
27394
27395 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
27396 @findex -exec-step
27397
27398 @subsubheading Synopsis
27399
27400 @smallexample
27401 -exec-step [--reverse]
27402 @end smallexample
27403
27404 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27405 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
27406 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
27407 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
27408 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
27409 previously executed source line.
27410
27411 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27412
27413 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
27414
27415 @subsubheading Example
27416
27417 Stepping into a function:
27418
27419 @smallexample
27420 -exec-step
27421 ^running
27422 (gdb)
27423 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27424 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
27425 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
27426 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
27427 (gdb)
27428 @end smallexample
27429
27430 Regular stepping:
27431
27432 @smallexample
27433 -exec-step
27434 ^running
27435 (gdb)
27436 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
27437 (gdb)
27438 @end smallexample
27439
27440
27441 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
27442 @findex -exec-step-instruction
27443
27444 @subsubheading Synopsis
27445
27446 @smallexample
27447 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
27448 @end smallexample
27449
27450 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
27451 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
27452 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
27453 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
27454 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
27455 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
27456 as well.
27457
27458 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27459
27460 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
27461
27462 @subsubheading Example
27463
27464 @smallexample
27465 (gdb)
27466 -exec-step-instruction
27467 ^running
27468
27469 (gdb)
27470 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27471 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27472 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27473 (gdb)
27474 -exec-step-instruction
27475 ^running
27476
27477 (gdb)
27478 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27479 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27480 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27481 (gdb)
27482 @end smallexample
27483
27484
27485 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
27486 @findex -exec-until
27487
27488 @subsubheading Synopsis
27489
27490 @smallexample
27491 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
27492 @end smallexample
27493
27494 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
27495 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
27496 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
27497 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
27498
27499 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27500
27501 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
27502
27503 @subsubheading Example
27504
27505 @smallexample
27506 (gdb)
27507 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
27508 ^running
27509 (gdb)
27510 x = 55
27511 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27512 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
27513 (gdb)
27514 @end smallexample
27515
27516 @ignore
27517 @subheading -file-clear
27518 Is this going away????
27519 @end ignore
27520
27521 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27522 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
27523 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
27524
27525 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
27526 @findex -enable-frame-filters
27527
27528 @smallexample
27529 -enable-frame-filters
27530 @end smallexample
27531
27532 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
27533 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
27534 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
27535 request that this functionality be enabled.
27536
27537 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
27538
27539 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
27540 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
27541
27542 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
27543 @findex -stack-info-frame
27544
27545 @subsubheading Synopsis
27546
27547 @smallexample
27548 -stack-info-frame
27549 @end smallexample
27550
27551 Get info on the selected frame.
27552
27553 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27554
27555 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
27556 (without arguments).
27557
27558 @subsubheading Example
27559
27560 @smallexample
27561 (gdb)
27562 -stack-info-frame
27563 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27564 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27565 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
27566 (gdb)
27567 @end smallexample
27568
27569 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
27570 @findex -stack-info-depth
27571
27572 @subsubheading Synopsis
27573
27574 @smallexample
27575 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
27576 @end smallexample
27577
27578 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
27579 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
27580
27581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27582
27583 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
27584
27585 @subsubheading Example
27586
27587 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
27588
27589 @smallexample
27590 (gdb)
27591 -stack-info-depth
27592 ^done,depth="12"
27593 (gdb)
27594 -stack-info-depth 4
27595 ^done,depth="4"
27596 (gdb)
27597 -stack-info-depth 12
27598 ^done,depth="12"
27599 (gdb)
27600 -stack-info-depth 11
27601 ^done,depth="11"
27602 (gdb)
27603 -stack-info-depth 13
27604 ^done,depth="12"
27605 (gdb)
27606 @end smallexample
27607
27608 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
27609 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
27610 @findex -stack-list-arguments
27611
27612 @subsubheading Synopsis
27613
27614 @smallexample
27615 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27616 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27617 @end smallexample
27618
27619 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
27620 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
27621 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
27622 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
27623 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
27624 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
27625 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
27626 which case only existing frames will be returned.
27627
27628 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27629 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27630 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27631 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27632 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27633 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27634
27635 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
27636 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
27637 are still displayed, however.
27638
27639 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
27640 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27641
27642 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27643
27644 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
27645 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
27646 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
27647
27648 @subsubheading Example
27649
27650 @smallexample
27651 (gdb)
27652 -stack-list-frames
27653 ^done,
27654 stack=[
27655 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27656 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27657 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
27658 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27659 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27660 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
27661 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
27662 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27663 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
27664 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
27665 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27666 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
27667 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
27668 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27669 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
27670 (gdb)
27671 -stack-list-arguments 0
27672 ^done,
27673 stack-args=[
27674 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27675 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
27676 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
27677 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
27678 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27679 (gdb)
27680 -stack-list-arguments 1
27681 ^done,
27682 stack-args=[
27683 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27684 frame=@{level="1",
27685 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27686 frame=@{level="2",args=[
27687 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27688 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27689 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
27690 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27691 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
27692 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
27693 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27694 (gdb)
27695 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
27696 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
27697 (gdb)
27698 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
27699 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
27700 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27701 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
27702 (gdb)
27703 @end smallexample
27704
27705 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
27706
27707
27708 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
27709 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
27710 @findex -stack-list-frames
27711
27712 @subsubheading Synopsis
27713
27714 @smallexample
27715 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27716 @end smallexample
27717
27718 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
27719 following info:
27720
27721 @table @samp
27722 @item @var{level}
27723 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
27724 @item @var{addr}
27725 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
27726 @item @var{func}
27727 Function name.
27728 @item @var{file}
27729 File name of the source file where the function lives.
27730 @item @var{fullname}
27731 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
27732 @item @var{line}
27733 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
27734 @item @var{from}
27735 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
27736 if the frame's function is not known.
27737 @end table
27738
27739 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
27740 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
27741 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
27742 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
27743 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
27744 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
27745 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
27746 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27747 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27748
27749 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27750
27751 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
27752
27753 @subsubheading Example
27754
27755 Full stack backtrace:
27756
27757 @smallexample
27758 (gdb)
27759 -stack-list-frames
27760 ^done,stack=
27761 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
27762 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
27763 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27764 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27765 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27766 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27767 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27768 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27769 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27770 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27771 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27772 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27773 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27774 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27775 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27776 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27777 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27778 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27779 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27780 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27781 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27782 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27783 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
27784 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
27785 (gdb)
27786 @end smallexample
27787
27788 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
27789
27790 @smallexample
27791 (gdb)
27792 -stack-list-frames 3 5
27793 ^done,stack=
27794 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27795 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27796 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27797 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27798 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27799 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27800 (gdb)
27801 @end smallexample
27802
27803 Show a single frame:
27804
27805 @smallexample
27806 (gdb)
27807 -stack-list-frames 3 3
27808 ^done,stack=
27809 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27810 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27811 (gdb)
27812 @end smallexample
27813
27814
27815 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
27816 @findex -stack-list-locals
27817 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
27818
27819 @subsubheading Synopsis
27820
27821 @smallexample
27822 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27823 @end smallexample
27824
27825 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
27826 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27827 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27828 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27829 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27830 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
27831 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
27832 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
27833 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27834 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27835
27836 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27837 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
27838 variables are still displayed, however.
27839
27840 This command is deprecated in favor of the
27841 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27842
27843 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27844
27845 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
27846
27847 @subsubheading Example
27848
27849 @smallexample
27850 (gdb)
27851 -stack-list-locals 0
27852 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
27853 (gdb)
27854 -stack-list-locals --all-values
27855 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
27856 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
27857 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
27858 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
27859 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
27860 (gdb)
27861 @end smallexample
27862
27863 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
27864 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
27865 @findex -stack-list-variables
27866
27867 @subsubheading Synopsis
27868
27869 @smallexample
27870 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27871 @end smallexample
27872
27873 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
27874 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27875 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27876 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27877 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27878 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27879 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27880
27881 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27882 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
27883 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
27884
27885 @subsubheading Example
27886
27887 @smallexample
27888 (gdb)
27889 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
27890 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
27891 (gdb)
27892 @end smallexample
27893
27894
27895 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
27896 @findex -stack-select-frame
27897
27898 @subsubheading Synopsis
27899
27900 @smallexample
27901 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
27902 @end smallexample
27903
27904 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
27905 the stack.
27906
27907 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
27908 option to every command.
27909
27910 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27911
27912 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
27913 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
27914
27915 @subsubheading Example
27916
27917 @smallexample
27918 (gdb)
27919 -stack-select-frame 2
27920 ^done
27921 (gdb)
27922 @end smallexample
27923
27924 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27925 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
27926 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
27927
27928 @ignore
27929
27930 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
27931
27932 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
27933 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
27934 used by @code{Insight}.
27935
27936 The two main reasons for that are:
27937
27938 @enumerate 1
27939 @item
27940 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
27941
27942 @item
27943 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
27944 now).
27945 @end enumerate
27946
27947 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
27948 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
27949 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
27950 hints about their use.
27951
27952 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
27953 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
27954 least, the following operations:
27955
27956 @itemize @bullet
27957 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
27958 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
27959 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
27960 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
27961 @end itemize
27962
27963 @end ignore
27964
27965 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
27966
27967 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
27968
27969 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
27970 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
27971 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
27972 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
27973 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
27974 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
27975 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
27976 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
27977 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
27978 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
27979 object, or to change display format.
27980
27981 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
27982 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
27983 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
27984 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
27985 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
27986 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
27987 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
27988 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
27989 child will be created.
27990
27991 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
27992 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
27993 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
27994 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
27995 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
27996
27997 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
27998 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
27999 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28000 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28001 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28002 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28003 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28004 variables that frontend has created.
28005
28006 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28007 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28008 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28009 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28010 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28011 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28012 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28013 implicitly updated.
28014
28015 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28016 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28017 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28018 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28019 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28020 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28021 frame. Consider this example:
28022
28023 @smallexample
28024 void do_work(...)
28025 @{
28026 struct work_state state;
28027
28028 if (...)
28029 do_work(...);
28030 @}
28031 @end smallexample
28032
28033 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28034 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28035 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28036 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28037 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28038
28039 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28040 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28041 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28042 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28043 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28044 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28045
28046 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28047 access this functionality:
28048
28049 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28050 @item @strong{Operation}
28051 @tab @strong{Description}
28052
28053 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28054 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28055 @item @code{-var-create}
28056 @tab create a variable object
28057 @item @code{-var-delete}
28058 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28059 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28060 @tab set the display format of this variable
28061 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28062 @tab show the display format of this variable
28063 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28064 @tab tells how many children this object has
28065 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28066 @tab return a list of the object's children
28067 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28068 @tab show the type of this variable object
28069 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28070 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28071 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28072 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28073 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28074 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28075 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28076 @tab get the value of this variable
28077 @item @code{-var-assign}
28078 @tab set the value of this variable
28079 @item @code{-var-update}
28080 @tab update the variable and its children
28081 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28082 @tab set frozeness attribute
28083 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28084 @tab set range of children to display on update
28085 @end multitable
28086
28087 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28088 how it can be used.
28089
28090 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28091
28092 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28093 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28094
28095 @smallexample
28096 -enable-pretty-printing
28097 @end smallexample
28098
28099 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28100 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28101 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28102 request that this functionality be enabled.
28103
28104 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28105
28106 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28107 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28108
28109 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28110 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28111
28112 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28113 @findex -var-create
28114
28115 @subsubheading Synopsis
28116
28117 @smallexample
28118 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28119 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28120 @end smallexample
28121
28122 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28123 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28124 register.
28125
28126 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28127 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28128 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28129 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28130 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28131
28132 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28133 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28134 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28135 object must be created.
28136
28137 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28138 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28139
28140 @itemize @bullet
28141 @item
28142 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28143
28144 @item
28145 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28146
28147 @item
28148 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28149 @end itemize
28150
28151 @cindex dynamic varobj
28152 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28153 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28154 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28155 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28156 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28157 compatibility for existing clients.
28158
28159 @subsubheading Result
28160
28161 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28162 are:
28163
28164 @table @samp
28165 @item name
28166 The name of the varobj.
28167
28168 @item numchild
28169 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28170 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28171 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28172
28173 @item value
28174 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28175 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28176 will not be interesting.
28177
28178 @item type
28179 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28180 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28181 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28182 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28183 @emph{declared} one.
28184
28185 @item thread-id
28186 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28187 thread's identifier.
28188
28189 @item has_more
28190 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28191 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28192
28193 @item dynamic
28194 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28195 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28196 then this attribute will not be present.
28197
28198 @item displayhint
28199 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28200 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28201 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28202 @end table
28203
28204 Typical output will look like this:
28205
28206 @smallexample
28207 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28208 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28209 @end smallexample
28210
28211
28212 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28213 @findex -var-delete
28214
28215 @subsubheading Synopsis
28216
28217 @smallexample
28218 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28219 @end smallexample
28220
28221 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28222 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28223
28224 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28225
28226
28227 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28228 @findex -var-set-format
28229
28230 @subsubheading Synopsis
28231
28232 @smallexample
28233 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28234 @end smallexample
28235
28236 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28237 @var{format-spec}.
28238
28239 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28240 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28241
28242 @smallexample
28243 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28244 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28245 @end smallexample
28246
28247 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28248 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28249 for pointers, etc.).
28250
28251 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28252 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28253
28254 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28255 @findex -var-show-format
28256
28257 @subsubheading Synopsis
28258
28259 @smallexample
28260 -var-show-format @var{name}
28261 @end smallexample
28262
28263 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28264
28265 @smallexample
28266 @var{format} @expansion{}
28267 @var{format-spec}
28268 @end smallexample
28269
28270
28271 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28272 @findex -var-info-num-children
28273
28274 @subsubheading Synopsis
28275
28276 @smallexample
28277 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28278 @end smallexample
28279
28280 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28281
28282 @smallexample
28283 numchild=@var{n}
28284 @end smallexample
28285
28286 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28287 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28288 be available.
28289
28290
28291 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28292 @findex -var-list-children
28293
28294 @subsubheading Synopsis
28295
28296 @smallexample
28297 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28298 @end smallexample
28299 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28300
28301 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28302 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28303 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28304 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28305 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28306 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28307 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28308 and unions.
28309
28310 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28311 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28312 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28313 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28314 reported.
28315
28316 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28317 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28318 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28319 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28320 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28321 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28322 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28323 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28324 the visible items.
28325
28326 For each child the following results are returned:
28327
28328 @table @var
28329
28330 @item name
28331 Name of the variable object created for this child.
28332
28333 @item exp
28334 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
28335 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
28336
28337 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
28338 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
28339
28340 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
28341 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
28342 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
28343 type and value are not present.
28344
28345 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
28346 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
28347 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
28348
28349 @item numchild
28350 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
28351 0.
28352
28353 @item type
28354 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
28355 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28356 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28357 @emph{declared} one.
28358
28359 @item value
28360 If values were requested, this is the value.
28361
28362 @item thread-id
28363 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
28364 Otherwise this result is not present.
28365
28366 @item frozen
28367 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
28368
28369 @item displayhint
28370 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28371 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28372 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28373
28374 @item dynamic
28375 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28376 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28377 then this attribute will not be present.
28378
28379 @end table
28380
28381 The result may have its own attributes:
28382
28383 @table @samp
28384 @item displayhint
28385 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28386 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28387 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28388
28389 @item has_more
28390 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
28391 remaining after the end of the selected range.
28392 @end table
28393
28394 @subsubheading Example
28395
28396 @smallexample
28397 (gdb)
28398 -var-list-children n
28399 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28400 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28401 (gdb)
28402 -var-list-children --all-values n
28403 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28404 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28405 @end smallexample
28406
28407
28408 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
28409 @findex -var-info-type
28410
28411 @subsubheading Synopsis
28412
28413 @smallexample
28414 -var-info-type @var{name}
28415 @end smallexample
28416
28417 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
28418 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
28419 @value{GDBN} CLI:
28420
28421 @smallexample
28422 type=@var{typename}
28423 @end smallexample
28424
28425
28426 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
28427 @findex -var-info-expression
28428
28429 @subsubheading Synopsis
28430
28431 @smallexample
28432 -var-info-expression @var{name}
28433 @end smallexample
28434
28435 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
28436 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
28437 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
28438
28439 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
28440 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
28441
28442 @smallexample
28443 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
28444 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
28445 @end smallexample
28446
28447 @noindent
28448 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
28449 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
28450
28451 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
28452 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
28453 is of limited use.
28454
28455 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
28456 @findex -var-info-path-expression
28457
28458 @subsubheading Synopsis
28459
28460 @smallexample
28461 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
28462 @end smallexample
28463
28464 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
28465 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
28466 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
28467 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
28468 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
28469 watchpoint from a variable object.
28470
28471 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
28472 and will give an error when invoked on one.
28473
28474 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
28475 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
28476 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
28477 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
28478 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
28479 @smallexample
28480 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
28481 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
28482 @end smallexample
28483
28484 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
28485 @findex -var-show-attributes
28486
28487 @subsubheading Synopsis
28488
28489 @smallexample
28490 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
28491 @end smallexample
28492
28493 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
28494
28495 @smallexample
28496 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
28497 @end smallexample
28498
28499 @noindent
28500 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
28501
28502 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
28503 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
28504
28505 @subsubheading Synopsis
28506
28507 @smallexample
28508 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
28509 @end smallexample
28510
28511 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
28512 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
28513 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
28514 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
28515 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
28516 the current display format will be used. The current display format
28517 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
28518
28519 @smallexample
28520 value=@var{value}
28521 @end smallexample
28522
28523 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
28524 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
28525
28526 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
28527 @findex -var-assign
28528
28529 @subsubheading Synopsis
28530
28531 @smallexample
28532 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
28533 @end smallexample
28534
28535 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
28536 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
28537 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
28538 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
28539
28540 @subsubheading Example
28541
28542 @smallexample
28543 (gdb)
28544 -var-assign var1 3
28545 ^done,value="3"
28546 (gdb)
28547 -var-update *
28548 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
28549 (gdb)
28550 @end smallexample
28551
28552 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
28553 @findex -var-update
28554
28555 @subsubheading Synopsis
28556
28557 @smallexample
28558 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
28559 @end smallexample
28560
28561 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
28562 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
28563 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
28564 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
28565 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
28566 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
28567 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
28568 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
28569 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
28570 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
28571 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
28572 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
28573 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
28574
28575 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
28576 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
28577 diagnostic.
28578
28579 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
28580 only the selected range of children will be reported.
28581
28582 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
28583 @samp{changelist}.
28584
28585 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
28586
28587 @table @samp
28588 @item name
28589 The name of the varobj.
28590
28591 @item value
28592 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
28593 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
28594
28595 @item in_scope
28596 @anchor{-var-update}
28597 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
28598
28599 @table @code
28600 @item "true"
28601 The variable object's current value is valid.
28602
28603 @item "false"
28604 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
28605 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
28606 scope.
28607
28608 @item "invalid"
28609 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
28610 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
28611 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
28612 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
28613 objects.
28614 @end table
28615
28616 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
28617 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
28618
28619 @item type_changed
28620 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
28621 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
28622 be @samp{false}.
28623
28624 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
28625 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
28626 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
28627 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
28628 unset.
28629
28630 @item new_type
28631 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
28632 hold the new type.
28633
28634 @item new_num_children
28635 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
28636 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
28637
28638 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
28639 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
28640 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
28641 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
28642 children which may be available.
28643
28644 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
28645 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
28646 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
28647 only happen at the end of the update range).
28648
28649 @item displayhint
28650 The display hint, if any.
28651
28652 @item has_more
28653 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
28654 available outside the varobj's update range.
28655
28656 @item dynamic
28657 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28658 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28659 then this attribute will not be present.
28660
28661 @item new_children
28662 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
28663 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
28664 be listed in this attribute.
28665 @end table
28666
28667 @subsubheading Example
28668
28669 @smallexample
28670 (gdb)
28671 -var-assign var1 3
28672 ^done,value="3"
28673 (gdb)
28674 -var-update --all-values var1
28675 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
28676 type_changed="false"@}]
28677 (gdb)
28678 @end smallexample
28679
28680 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
28681 @findex -var-set-frozen
28682 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
28683
28684 @subsubheading Synopsis
28685
28686 @smallexample
28687 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
28688 @end smallexample
28689
28690 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
28691 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
28692 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
28693 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
28694 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
28695 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
28696 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
28697 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
28698 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
28699 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
28700 @code{-var-update} does.
28701
28702 @subsubheading Example
28703
28704 @smallexample
28705 (gdb)
28706 -var-set-frozen V 1
28707 ^done
28708 (gdb)
28709 @end smallexample
28710
28711 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
28712 @findex -var-set-update-range
28713 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
28714
28715 @subsubheading Synopsis
28716
28717 @smallexample
28718 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
28719 @end smallexample
28720
28721 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
28722 @code{-var-update}.
28723
28724 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
28725 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
28726 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
28727 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
28728
28729 @subsubheading Example
28730
28731 @smallexample
28732 (gdb)
28733 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
28734 ^done
28735 @end smallexample
28736
28737 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
28738 @findex -var-set-visualizer
28739 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
28740
28741 @subsubheading Synopsis
28742
28743 @smallexample
28744 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
28745 @end smallexample
28746
28747 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
28748
28749 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
28750 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
28751
28752 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
28753 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
28754 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
28755 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
28756 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
28757 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
28758 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
28759
28760 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
28761 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
28762 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
28763 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
28764
28765 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
28766 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
28767 can be used to check this.
28768
28769 @subsubheading Example
28770
28771 Resetting the visualizer:
28772
28773 @smallexample
28774 (gdb)
28775 -var-set-visualizer V None
28776 ^done
28777 @end smallexample
28778
28779 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
28780
28781 @smallexample
28782 (gdb)
28783 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
28784 ^done
28785 @end smallexample
28786
28787 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
28788 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
28789
28790 @smallexample
28791 (gdb)
28792 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
28793 ^done
28794 @end smallexample
28795
28796 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28797 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
28798 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
28799
28800 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
28801 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
28802 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
28803 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
28804
28805 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
28806 @c @subheading -data-assign
28807 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
28808 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
28809 @c set variable
28810 @c @subsubheading Example
28811 @c N.A.
28812
28813 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
28814 @findex -data-disassemble
28815
28816 @subsubheading Synopsis
28817
28818 @smallexample
28819 -data-disassemble
28820 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
28821 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
28822 -- @var{mode}
28823 @end smallexample
28824
28825 @noindent
28826 Where:
28827
28828 @table @samp
28829 @item @var{start-addr}
28830 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
28831 @item @var{end-addr}
28832 is the end address
28833 @item @var{filename}
28834 is the name of the file to disassemble
28835 @item @var{linenum}
28836 is the line number to disassemble around
28837 @item @var{lines}
28838 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
28839 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
28840 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
28841 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
28842 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
28843 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
28844 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
28845 are displayed.
28846 @item @var{mode}
28847 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
28848 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
28849 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
28850 @end table
28851
28852 @subsubheading Result
28853
28854 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
28855 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
28856 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
28857
28858 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
28859 following fields:
28860
28861 @table @code
28862 @item address
28863 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
28864
28865 @item func-name
28866 The name of the function this instruction is within.
28867
28868 @item offset
28869 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
28870
28871 @item inst
28872 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
28873
28874 @item opcodes
28875 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
28876 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
28877
28878 @end table
28879
28880 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
28881 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
28882
28883 @table @code
28884 @item line
28885 The line number within @samp{file}.
28886
28887 @item file
28888 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
28889 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
28890 used.
28891
28892 @item fullname
28893 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
28894 using the source file search path
28895 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
28896 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
28897
28898 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
28899 present in the debug information.
28900
28901 @item line_asm_insn
28902 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
28903 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
28904 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
28905 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
28906 @samp{opcodes}.
28907
28908 @end table
28909
28910 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
28911 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
28912 adjust its format.
28913
28914 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28915
28916 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
28917
28918 @subsubheading Example
28919
28920 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
28921
28922 @smallexample
28923 (gdb)
28924 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
28925 ^done,
28926 asm_insns=[
28927 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28928 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28929 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28930 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28931 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
28932 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
28933 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
28934 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28935 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
28936 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
28937 (gdb)
28938 @end smallexample
28939
28940 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
28941 @code{main}.
28942
28943 @smallexample
28944 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
28945 ^done,asm_insns=[
28946 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28947 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
28948 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28949 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28950 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28951 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28952 [@dots{}]
28953 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
28954 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
28955 (gdb)
28956 @end smallexample
28957
28958 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
28959
28960 @smallexample
28961 (gdb)
28962 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
28963 ^done,asm_insns=[
28964 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28965 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
28966 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28967 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28968 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28969 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
28970 (gdb)
28971 @end smallexample
28972
28973 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
28974
28975 @smallexample
28976 (gdb)
28977 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
28978 ^done,asm_insns=[
28979 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
28980 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28981 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28982 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
28983 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
28984 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
28985 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28986 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28987 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
28988 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28989 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28990 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
28991 (gdb)
28992 @end smallexample
28993
28994
28995 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
28996 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
28997
28998 @subsubheading Synopsis
28999
29000 @smallexample
29001 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29002 @end smallexample
29003
29004 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29005 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29006 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29007
29008 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29009
29010 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29011 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29012 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29013
29014 @subsubheading Example
29015
29016 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29017 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29018 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29019 output.
29020
29021 @smallexample
29022 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29023 211^done,value="1"
29024 (gdb)
29025 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29026 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29027 (gdb)
29028 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29029 411^done,value="4"
29030 (gdb)
29031 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29032 511^done,value="4"
29033 (gdb)
29034 @end smallexample
29035
29036
29037 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29038 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29039
29040 @subsubheading Synopsis
29041
29042 @smallexample
29043 -data-list-changed-registers
29044 @end smallexample
29045
29046 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29047
29048 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29049
29050 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29051 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29052
29053 @subsubheading Example
29054
29055 On a PPC MBX board:
29056
29057 @smallexample
29058 (gdb)
29059 -exec-continue
29060 ^running
29061
29062 (gdb)
29063 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29064 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29065 line="5"@}
29066 (gdb)
29067 -data-list-changed-registers
29068 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29069 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29070 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29071 (gdb)
29072 @end smallexample
29073
29074
29075 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29076 @findex -data-list-register-names
29077
29078 @subsubheading Synopsis
29079
29080 @smallexample
29081 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29082 @end smallexample
29083
29084 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29085 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29086 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29087 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29088 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29089 include empty register names.
29090
29091 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29092
29093 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29094 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29095 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29096
29097 @subsubheading Example
29098
29099 For the PPC MBX board:
29100 @smallexample
29101 (gdb)
29102 -data-list-register-names
29103 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29104 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29105 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29106 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29107 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29108 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29109 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29110 (gdb)
29111 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29112 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29113 (gdb)
29114 @end smallexample
29115
29116 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29117 @findex -data-list-register-values
29118
29119 @subsubheading Synopsis
29120
29121 @smallexample
29122 -data-list-register-values
29123 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29124 @end smallexample
29125
29126 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29127 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29128 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29129 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29130 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29131 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29132
29133 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29134
29135 @table @code
29136 @item x
29137 Hexadecimal
29138 @item o
29139 Octal
29140 @item t
29141 Binary
29142 @item d
29143 Decimal
29144 @item r
29145 Raw
29146 @item N
29147 Natural
29148 @end table
29149
29150 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29151
29152 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29153 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29154
29155 @subsubheading Example
29156
29157 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29158 don't appear in the actual output):
29159
29160 @smallexample
29161 (gdb)
29162 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29163 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29164 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29165 (gdb)
29166 -data-list-register-values x
29167 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29168 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29169 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29170 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29171 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29172 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29173 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29174 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29175 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29176 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29177 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29178 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29179 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29180 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29181 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29182 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29183 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29184 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29185 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29186 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29187 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29188 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29189 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29190 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29191 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29192 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29193 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29194 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29195 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29196 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29197 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29198 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29199 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29200 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29201 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29202 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29203 (gdb)
29204 @end smallexample
29205
29206
29207 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29208 @findex -data-read-memory
29209
29210 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29211
29212 @subsubheading Synopsis
29213
29214 @smallexample
29215 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29216 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29217 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29218 @end smallexample
29219
29220 @noindent
29221 where:
29222
29223 @table @samp
29224 @item @var{address}
29225 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29226 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29227 quoted using the C convention.
29228
29229 @item @var{word-format}
29230 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29231 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29232 ,Output Formats}).
29233
29234 @item @var{word-size}
29235 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29236
29237 @item @var{nr-rows}
29238 The number of rows in the output table.
29239
29240 @item @var{nr-cols}
29241 The number of columns in the output table.
29242
29243 @item @var{aschar}
29244 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29245 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29246 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29247 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29248
29249 @item @var{byte-offset}
29250 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29251 @end table
29252
29253 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29254 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29255 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29256 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29257 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29258 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29259 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29260 @samp{addr}.
29261
29262 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29263 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29264 @samp{prev-page}.
29265
29266 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29267
29268 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29269 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29270
29271 @subsubheading Example
29272
29273 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29274 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29275 word. Display each word in hex.
29276
29277 @smallexample
29278 (gdb)
29279 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29280 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29281 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29282 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29283 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29284 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29285 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29286 (gdb)
29287 @end smallexample
29288
29289 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29290 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29291
29292 @smallexample
29293 (gdb)
29294 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29295 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29296 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29297 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29298 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29299 (gdb)
29300 @end smallexample
29301
29302 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29303 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29304 used as the non-printable character.
29305
29306 @smallexample
29307 (gdb)
29308 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29309 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29310 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29311 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29312 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29313 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29314 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29315 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29316 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29317 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29318 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29319 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29320 (gdb)
29321 @end smallexample
29322
29323 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29324 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29325
29326 @subsubheading Synopsis
29327
29328 @smallexample
29329 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29330 @var{address} @var{count}
29331 @end smallexample
29332
29333 @noindent
29334 where:
29335
29336 @table @samp
29337 @item @var{address}
29338 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29339 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29340 quoted using the C convention.
29341
29342 @item @var{count}
29343 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
29344
29345 @item @var{byte-offset}
29346 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
29347 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
29348 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
29349 perform address arithmetics itself.
29350
29351 @end table
29352
29353 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
29354 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
29355 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
29356 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
29357 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
29358 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
29359
29360 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
29361 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
29362 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
29363 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
29364 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
29365 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
29366 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
29367 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
29368
29369 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
29370 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
29371 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
29372 and has the following fields:
29373
29374 @table @code
29375 @item begin
29376 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29377
29378 @item end
29379 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29380
29381 @item offset
29382 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
29383 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
29384
29385 @item contents
29386 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
29387
29388 @end table
29389
29390
29391
29392 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29393
29394 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
29395
29396 @subsubheading Example
29397
29398 @smallexample
29399 (gdb)
29400 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
29401 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
29402 end="0xbffff15e",
29403 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
29404 (gdb)
29405 @end smallexample
29406
29407
29408 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
29409 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
29410
29411 @subsubheading Synopsis
29412
29413 @smallexample
29414 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
29415 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
29416 @end smallexample
29417
29418 @noindent
29419 where:
29420
29421 @table @samp
29422 @item @var{address}
29423 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29424 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29425 quoted using the C convention.
29426
29427 @item @var{contents}
29428 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
29429
29430 @item @var{count}
29431 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
29432 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
29433 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
29434
29435 @end table
29436
29437 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29438
29439 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29440
29441 @subsubheading Example
29442
29443 @smallexample
29444 (gdb)
29445 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
29446 ^done
29447 (gdb)
29448 @end smallexample
29449
29450 @smallexample
29451 (gdb)
29452 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
29453 ^done
29454 (gdb)
29455 @end smallexample
29456
29457 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29458 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
29459 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
29460
29461 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
29462 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
29463
29464 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
29465 @findex -trace-find
29466
29467 @subsubheading Synopsis
29468
29469 @smallexample
29470 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
29471 @end smallexample
29472
29473 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
29474 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
29475 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
29476
29477 @table @samp
29478
29479 @item none
29480 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
29481
29482 @item frame-number
29483 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
29484 that index.
29485
29486 @item tracepoint-number
29487 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
29488 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
29489
29490 @item pc
29491 An address is required as parameter. Finds
29492 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
29493 address.
29494
29495 @item pc-inside-range
29496 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
29497 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
29498 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29499
29500 @item pc-outside-range
29501 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
29502 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
29503 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29504
29505 @item line
29506 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
29507 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
29508 the specified location.
29509
29510 @end table
29511
29512 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
29513 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
29514
29515 @table @samp
29516 @item found
29517 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
29518 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
29519
29520 @item traceframe
29521 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
29522 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29523
29524 @item tracepoint
29525 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
29526 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29527
29528 @item frame
29529 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
29530 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
29531 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
29532
29533 @end table
29534
29535 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29536
29537 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
29538
29539 @subheading -trace-define-variable
29540 @findex -trace-define-variable
29541
29542 @subsubheading Synopsis
29543
29544 @smallexample
29545 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
29546 @end smallexample
29547
29548 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
29549 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
29550 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
29551 with the @samp{$} character.
29552
29553 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29554
29555 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
29556
29557 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
29558 @findex -trace-frame-collected
29559
29560 @subsubheading Synopsis
29561
29562 @smallexample
29563 -trace-frame-collected
29564 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
29565 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
29566 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
29567 [--memory-contents]
29568 @end smallexample
29569
29570 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
29571 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
29572 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
29573 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
29574 See the output description table below for more details.
29575
29576 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
29577 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
29578 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
29579 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
29580 memory range and which is a computed expression.
29581
29582 For instance, if the actions were
29583 @smallexample
29584 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
29585 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
29586 @end smallexample
29587
29588 @noindent
29589 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
29590 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
29591 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
29592 objects would be computed expressions.
29593
29594 An example output would be:
29595
29596 @smallexample
29597 (gdb)
29598 -trace-frame-collected
29599 ^done,
29600 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
29601 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
29602 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
29603 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
29604 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
29605 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
29606 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
29607 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
29608 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
29609 ...
29610 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
29611 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
29612 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
29613 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
29614 (gdb)
29615 @end smallexample
29616
29617 Where:
29618
29619 @table @code
29620 @item explicit-variables
29621 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
29622 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
29623 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
29624 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
29625 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
29626 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
29627 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
29628 arrays, structures and unions.
29629
29630 @item computed-expressions
29631 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
29632 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
29633 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
29634 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
29635
29636 @item registers
29637 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
29638 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
29639 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
29640 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
29641 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
29642
29643 @item tvars
29644 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
29645 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
29646 current value are returned.
29647
29648 @item memory
29649 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
29650 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
29651 collected memory range and has the following fields:
29652
29653 @table @code
29654 @item address
29655 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
29656
29657 @item length
29658 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
29659
29660 @item contents
29661 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
29662 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
29663
29664 @end table
29665
29666 @end table
29667
29668 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29669
29670 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29671
29672 @subsubheading Example
29673
29674 @subheading -trace-list-variables
29675 @findex -trace-list-variables
29676
29677 @subsubheading Synopsis
29678
29679 @smallexample
29680 -trace-list-variables
29681 @end smallexample
29682
29683 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
29684 table has the following fields:
29685
29686 @table @samp
29687 @item name
29688 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
29689
29690 @item initial
29691 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
29692 field is always present.
29693
29694 @item current
29695 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
29696 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
29697 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
29698 presently running.
29699
29700 @end table
29701
29702 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29703
29704 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
29705
29706 @subsubheading Example
29707
29708 @smallexample
29709 (gdb)
29710 -trace-list-variables
29711 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
29712 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
29713 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
29714 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
29715 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
29716 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
29717 (gdb)
29718 @end smallexample
29719
29720 @subheading -trace-save
29721 @findex -trace-save
29722
29723 @subsubheading Synopsis
29724
29725 @smallexample
29726 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
29727 @end smallexample
29728
29729 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
29730 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
29731 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
29732 to perform the save.
29733
29734 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29735
29736 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
29737
29738
29739 @subheading -trace-start
29740 @findex -trace-start
29741
29742 @subsubheading Synopsis
29743
29744 @smallexample
29745 -trace-start
29746 @end smallexample
29747
29748 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
29749 have any fields.
29750
29751 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29752
29753 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
29754
29755 @subheading -trace-status
29756 @findex -trace-status
29757
29758 @subsubheading Synopsis
29759
29760 @smallexample
29761 -trace-status
29762 @end smallexample
29763
29764 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
29765 the following fields:
29766
29767 @table @samp
29768
29769 @item supported
29770 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
29771 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
29772 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
29773 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
29774 started. This field is always present.
29775
29776 @item running
29777 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
29778 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
29779 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29780
29781 @item stop-reason
29782 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
29783 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
29784 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
29785 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
29786 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
29787 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
29788 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
29789 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
29790 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29791
29792 @item stopping-tracepoint
29793 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
29794 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
29795 @samp{passcount}.
29796
29797 @item frames
29798 @itemx frames-created
29799 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
29800 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
29801 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
29802 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
29803
29804 @item buffer-size
29805 @itemx buffer-free
29806 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
29807 remaining space. These fields are optional.
29808
29809 @item circular
29810 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
29811 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
29812 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
29813 and may fill up.
29814
29815 @item disconnected
29816 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
29817 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
29818 that the trace run will stop.
29819
29820 @item trace-file
29821 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
29822 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
29823
29824 @end table
29825
29826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29827
29828 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
29829
29830 @subheading -trace-stop
29831 @findex -trace-stop
29832
29833 @subsubheading Synopsis
29834
29835 @smallexample
29836 -trace-stop
29837 @end smallexample
29838
29839 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
29840 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
29841 @samp{running} fields are not output.
29842
29843 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29844
29845 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
29846
29847
29848 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29849 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
29850 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
29851
29852
29853 @ignore
29854 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
29855 @findex -symbol-info-address
29856
29857 @subsubheading Synopsis
29858
29859 @smallexample
29860 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
29861 @end smallexample
29862
29863 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
29864
29865 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29866
29867 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
29868
29869 @subsubheading Example
29870 N.A.
29871
29872
29873 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
29874 @findex -symbol-info-file
29875
29876 @subsubheading Synopsis
29877
29878 @smallexample
29879 -symbol-info-file
29880 @end smallexample
29881
29882 Show the file for the symbol.
29883
29884 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29885
29886 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
29887 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
29888
29889 @subsubheading Example
29890 N.A.
29891
29892
29893 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
29894 @findex -symbol-info-function
29895
29896 @subsubheading Synopsis
29897
29898 @smallexample
29899 -symbol-info-function
29900 @end smallexample
29901
29902 Show which function the symbol lives in.
29903
29904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29905
29906 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
29907
29908 @subsubheading Example
29909 N.A.
29910
29911
29912 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
29913 @findex -symbol-info-line
29914
29915 @subsubheading Synopsis
29916
29917 @smallexample
29918 -symbol-info-line
29919 @end smallexample
29920
29921 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
29922
29923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29924
29925 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
29926 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
29927
29928 @subsubheading Example
29929 N.A.
29930
29931
29932 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
29933 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
29934
29935 @subsubheading Synopsis
29936
29937 @smallexample
29938 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
29939 @end smallexample
29940
29941 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
29942
29943 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29944
29945 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
29946
29947 @subsubheading Example
29948 N.A.
29949
29950
29951 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
29952 @findex -symbol-list-functions
29953
29954 @subsubheading Synopsis
29955
29956 @smallexample
29957 -symbol-list-functions
29958 @end smallexample
29959
29960 List the functions in the executable.
29961
29962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29963
29964 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
29965 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
29966
29967 @subsubheading Example
29968 N.A.
29969 @end ignore
29970
29971
29972 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
29973 @findex -symbol-list-lines
29974
29975 @subsubheading Synopsis
29976
29977 @smallexample
29978 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
29979 @end smallexample
29980
29981 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
29982 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
29983 ascending PC order.
29984
29985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29986
29987 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29988
29989 @subsubheading Example
29990 @smallexample
29991 (gdb)
29992 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
29993 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
29994 (gdb)
29995 @end smallexample
29996
29997
29998 @ignore
29999 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30000 @findex -symbol-list-types
30001
30002 @subsubheading Synopsis
30003
30004 @smallexample
30005 -symbol-list-types
30006 @end smallexample
30007
30008 List all the type names.
30009
30010 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30011
30012 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30013 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30014
30015 @subsubheading Example
30016 N.A.
30017
30018
30019 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30020 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30021
30022 @subsubheading Synopsis
30023
30024 @smallexample
30025 -symbol-list-variables
30026 @end smallexample
30027
30028 List all the global and static variable names.
30029
30030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30031
30032 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30033
30034 @subsubheading Example
30035 N.A.
30036
30037
30038 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30039 @findex -symbol-locate
30040
30041 @subsubheading Synopsis
30042
30043 @smallexample
30044 -symbol-locate
30045 @end smallexample
30046
30047 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30048
30049 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30050
30051 @subsubheading Example
30052 N.A.
30053
30054
30055 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30056 @findex -symbol-type
30057
30058 @subsubheading Synopsis
30059
30060 @smallexample
30061 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30062 @end smallexample
30063
30064 Show type of @var{variable}.
30065
30066 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30067
30068 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30069 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30070
30071 @subsubheading Example
30072 N.A.
30073 @end ignore
30074
30075
30076 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30077 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30078 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30079
30080 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30081 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30082
30083 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30084 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30085
30086 @subsubheading Synopsis
30087
30088 @smallexample
30089 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30090 @end smallexample
30091
30092 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30093 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30094 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30095 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30096 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30097 notification.
30098
30099 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30100
30101 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30102
30103 @subsubheading Example
30104
30105 @smallexample
30106 (gdb)
30107 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30108 ^done
30109 (gdb)
30110 @end smallexample
30111
30112
30113 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30114 @findex -file-exec-file
30115
30116 @subsubheading Synopsis
30117
30118 @smallexample
30119 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30120 @end smallexample
30121
30122 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30123 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30124 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30125 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30126 notification.
30127
30128 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30129
30130 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30131
30132 @subsubheading Example
30133
30134 @smallexample
30135 (gdb)
30136 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30137 ^done
30138 (gdb)
30139 @end smallexample
30140
30141
30142 @ignore
30143 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30144 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30145
30146 @subsubheading Synopsis
30147
30148 @smallexample
30149 -file-list-exec-sections
30150 @end smallexample
30151
30152 List the sections of the current executable file.
30153
30154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30155
30156 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30157 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30158 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30159
30160 @subsubheading Example
30161 N.A.
30162 @end ignore
30163
30164
30165 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30166 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30167
30168 @subsubheading Synopsis
30169
30170 @smallexample
30171 -file-list-exec-source-file
30172 @end smallexample
30173
30174 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30175 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30176 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30177 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30178
30179 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30180
30181 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30182
30183 @subsubheading Example
30184
30185 @smallexample
30186 (gdb)
30187 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30188 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30189 (gdb)
30190 @end smallexample
30191
30192
30193 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30194 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30195
30196 @subsubheading Synopsis
30197
30198 @smallexample
30199 -file-list-exec-source-files
30200 @end smallexample
30201
30202 List the source files for the current executable.
30203
30204 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30205 name) of a source file.
30206
30207 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30208
30209 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30210 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30211
30212 @subsubheading Example
30213 @smallexample
30214 (gdb)
30215 -file-list-exec-source-files
30216 ^done,files=[
30217 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30218 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30219 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30220 (gdb)
30221 @end smallexample
30222
30223 @ignore
30224 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30225 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30226
30227 @subsubheading Synopsis
30228
30229 @smallexample
30230 -file-list-shared-libraries
30231 @end smallexample
30232
30233 List the shared libraries in the program.
30234
30235 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30236
30237 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30238
30239 @subsubheading Example
30240 N.A.
30241
30242
30243 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30244 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30245
30246 @subsubheading Synopsis
30247
30248 @smallexample
30249 -file-list-symbol-files
30250 @end smallexample
30251
30252 List symbol files.
30253
30254 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30255
30256 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30257
30258 @subsubheading Example
30259 N.A.
30260 @end ignore
30261
30262
30263 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30264 @findex -file-symbol-file
30265
30266 @subsubheading Synopsis
30267
30268 @smallexample
30269 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30270 @end smallexample
30271
30272 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30273 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30274 produced, except for a completion notification.
30275
30276 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30277
30278 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30279
30280 @subsubheading Example
30281
30282 @smallexample
30283 (gdb)
30284 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30285 ^done
30286 (gdb)
30287 @end smallexample
30288
30289 @ignore
30290 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30291 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30292 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30293
30294 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30295
30296 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30297
30298 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30299
30300 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30301
30302 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30303
30304 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30305
30306 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30307
30308 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30309
30310 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30311 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30312 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30313
30314 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30315
30316 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30317
30318 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30319
30320 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30321 @end ignore
30322
30323
30324 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30325 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30326 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30327
30328
30329 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
30330 @findex -target-attach
30331
30332 @subsubheading Synopsis
30333
30334 @smallexample
30335 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
30336 @end smallexample
30337
30338 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
30339 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
30340 group, the id previously returned by
30341 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
30342
30343 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30344
30345 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
30346
30347 @subsubheading Example
30348 @smallexample
30349 (gdb)
30350 -target-attach 34
30351 =thread-created,id="1"
30352 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
30353 ^done
30354 (gdb)
30355 @end smallexample
30356
30357 @ignore
30358 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
30359 @findex -target-compare-sections
30360
30361 @subsubheading Synopsis
30362
30363 @smallexample
30364 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
30365 @end smallexample
30366
30367 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
30368 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
30369
30370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30371
30372 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
30373
30374 @subsubheading Example
30375 N.A.
30376 @end ignore
30377
30378
30379 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
30380 @findex -target-detach
30381
30382 @subsubheading Synopsis
30383
30384 @smallexample
30385 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
30386 @end smallexample
30387
30388 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
30389 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
30390 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
30391
30392 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30393
30394 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
30395
30396 @subsubheading Example
30397
30398 @smallexample
30399 (gdb)
30400 -target-detach
30401 ^done
30402 (gdb)
30403 @end smallexample
30404
30405
30406 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
30407 @findex -target-disconnect
30408
30409 @subsubheading Synopsis
30410
30411 @smallexample
30412 -target-disconnect
30413 @end smallexample
30414
30415 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
30416 generally not resumed.
30417
30418 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30419
30420 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
30421
30422 @subsubheading Example
30423
30424 @smallexample
30425 (gdb)
30426 -target-disconnect
30427 ^done
30428 (gdb)
30429 @end smallexample
30430
30431
30432 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
30433 @findex -target-download
30434
30435 @subsubheading Synopsis
30436
30437 @smallexample
30438 -target-download
30439 @end smallexample
30440
30441 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
30442 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
30443
30444 @table @samp
30445 @item section
30446 The name of the section.
30447 @item section-sent
30448 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
30449 @item section-size
30450 The size of the section.
30451 @item total-sent
30452 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
30453 @item total-size
30454 The size of the overall executable to download.
30455 @end table
30456
30457 @noindent
30458 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
30459 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
30460
30461 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
30462 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
30463
30464 @table @samp
30465 @item section
30466 The name of the section.
30467 @item section-size
30468 The size of the section.
30469 @item total-size
30470 The size of the overall executable to download.
30471 @end table
30472
30473 @noindent
30474 At the end, a summary is printed.
30475
30476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30477
30478 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
30479
30480 @subsubheading Example
30481
30482 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
30483 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
30484
30485 @smallexample
30486 (gdb)
30487 -target-download
30488 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
30489 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
30490 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
30491 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
30492 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
30493 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
30494 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
30495 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
30496 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
30497 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
30498 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
30499 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
30500 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
30501 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
30502 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
30503 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
30504 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
30505 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
30506 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
30507 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
30508 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
30509 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
30510 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
30511 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
30512 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
30513 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
30514 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
30515 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30516 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30517 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
30518 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
30519 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
30520 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
30521 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
30522 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
30523 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
30524 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
30525 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
30526 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
30527 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
30528 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
30529 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
30530 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
30531 write-rate="429"
30532 (gdb)
30533 @end smallexample
30534
30535
30536 @ignore
30537 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
30538 @findex -target-exec-status
30539
30540 @subsubheading Synopsis
30541
30542 @smallexample
30543 -target-exec-status
30544 @end smallexample
30545
30546 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
30547 not, for instance).
30548
30549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30550
30551 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30552
30553 @subsubheading Example
30554 N.A.
30555
30556
30557 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
30558 @findex -target-list-available-targets
30559
30560 @subsubheading Synopsis
30561
30562 @smallexample
30563 -target-list-available-targets
30564 @end smallexample
30565
30566 List the possible targets to connect to.
30567
30568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30569
30570 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
30571
30572 @subsubheading Example
30573 N.A.
30574
30575
30576 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
30577 @findex -target-list-current-targets
30578
30579 @subsubheading Synopsis
30580
30581 @smallexample
30582 -target-list-current-targets
30583 @end smallexample
30584
30585 Describe the current target.
30586
30587 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30588
30589 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
30590 other things).
30591
30592 @subsubheading Example
30593 N.A.
30594
30595
30596 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
30597 @findex -target-list-parameters
30598
30599 @subsubheading Synopsis
30600
30601 @smallexample
30602 -target-list-parameters
30603 @end smallexample
30604
30605 @c ????
30606 @end ignore
30607
30608 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30609
30610 No equivalent.
30611
30612 @subsubheading Example
30613 N.A.
30614
30615
30616 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
30617 @findex -target-select
30618
30619 @subsubheading Synopsis
30620
30621 @smallexample
30622 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
30623 @end smallexample
30624
30625 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
30626
30627 @table @samp
30628 @item @var{type}
30629 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
30630 @item @var{parameters}
30631 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
30632 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
30633 @end table
30634
30635 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
30636 which the target program is, in the following form:
30637
30638 @smallexample
30639 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
30640 args=[@var{arg list}]
30641 @end smallexample
30642
30643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30644
30645 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
30646
30647 @subsubheading Example
30648
30649 @smallexample
30650 (gdb)
30651 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
30652 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
30653 (gdb)
30654 @end smallexample
30655
30656 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30657 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
30658 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
30659
30660
30661 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
30662 @findex -target-file-put
30663
30664 @subsubheading Synopsis
30665
30666 @smallexample
30667 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
30668 @end smallexample
30669
30670 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
30671 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
30672
30673 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30674
30675 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
30676
30677 @subsubheading Example
30678
30679 @smallexample
30680 (gdb)
30681 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
30682 ^done
30683 (gdb)
30684 @end smallexample
30685
30686
30687 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
30688 @findex -target-file-get
30689
30690 @subsubheading Synopsis
30691
30692 @smallexample
30693 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
30694 @end smallexample
30695
30696 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
30697 on the host system.
30698
30699 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30700
30701 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
30702
30703 @subsubheading Example
30704
30705 @smallexample
30706 (gdb)
30707 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
30708 ^done
30709 (gdb)
30710 @end smallexample
30711
30712
30713 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
30714 @findex -target-file-delete
30715
30716 @subsubheading Synopsis
30717
30718 @smallexample
30719 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
30720 @end smallexample
30721
30722 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
30723
30724 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30725
30726 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
30727
30728 @subsubheading Example
30729
30730 @smallexample
30731 (gdb)
30732 -target-file-delete remotefile
30733 ^done
30734 (gdb)
30735 @end smallexample
30736
30737
30738 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30739 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
30740 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30741
30742 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
30743 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
30744
30745 @subsubheading Synopsis
30746
30747 @smallexample
30748 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
30749 @end smallexample
30750
30751 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
30752 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
30753 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
30754
30755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30756
30757 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
30758
30759 @subsubheading Result
30760
30761 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
30762 defined for each exception:
30763
30764 @table @samp
30765 @item name
30766 The name of the exception.
30767
30768 @item address
30769 The address of the exception.
30770
30771 @end table
30772
30773 @subsubheading Example
30774
30775 @smallexample
30776 -info-ada-exceptions aint
30777 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
30778 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30779 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
30780 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
30781 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
30782 @end smallexample
30783
30784 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
30785
30786 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
30787 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
30788 Catchpoint Commands}.
30789
30790
30791 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30792 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
30793 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
30794
30795 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
30796 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
30797 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
30798 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
30799
30800 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
30801 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
30802 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
30803
30804 @subsubheading Synopsis
30805
30806 @smallexample
30807 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
30808 @end smallexample
30809
30810 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
30811
30812 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
30813 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
30814 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
30815 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
30816 dash.
30817
30818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30819
30820 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30821
30822 @subsubheading Result
30823
30824 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
30825
30826 @table @samp
30827 @item exists
30828 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
30829 @code{"false"} otherwise.
30830
30831 @end table
30832
30833 @subsubheading Example
30834
30835 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
30836
30837 @smallexample
30838 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
30839 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
30840 @end smallexample
30841
30842 @noindent
30843 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
30844 to the debugger:
30845
30846 @smallexample
30847 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
30848 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
30849 @end smallexample
30850
30851 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
30852 @findex -list-features
30853 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
30854
30855 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
30856 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
30857 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
30858 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
30859 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
30860 startup.
30861
30862 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
30863 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
30864 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
30865 is given below.
30866
30867 Example output:
30868
30869 @smallexample
30870 (gdb) -list-features
30871 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
30872 @end smallexample
30873
30874 The current list of features is:
30875
30876 @ftable @samp
30877 @item frozen-varobjs
30878 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
30879 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
30880 of @code{-varobj-create}.
30881 @item pending-breakpoints
30882 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
30883 command.
30884 @item python
30885 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
30886 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
30887 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
30888 @item thread-info
30889 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
30890 @item data-read-memory-bytes
30891 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
30892 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
30893 @item breakpoint-notifications
30894 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
30895 CLI will be announced via async records.
30896 @item ada-task-info
30897 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
30898 @item language-option
30899 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
30900 option (@pxref{Context management}).
30901 @item info-gdb-mi-command
30902 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
30903 @item undefined-command-error-code
30904 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
30905 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
30906 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
30907 @item exec-run-start-option
30908 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
30909 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
30910 @end ftable
30911
30912 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
30913 @findex -list-target-features
30914
30915 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
30916 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
30917 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
30918 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
30919 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
30920 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
30921 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
30922 Example output:
30923
30924 @smallexample
30925 (gdb) -list-target-features
30926 ^done,result=["async"]
30927 @end smallexample
30928
30929 The current list of features is:
30930
30931 @table @samp
30932 @item async
30933 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
30934 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
30935 while the target is running.
30936
30937 @item reverse
30938 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
30939 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
30940
30941 @end table
30942
30943 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30944 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
30945 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30946
30947 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
30948
30949 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
30950 @findex -gdb-exit
30951
30952 @subsubheading Synopsis
30953
30954 @smallexample
30955 -gdb-exit
30956 @end smallexample
30957
30958 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
30959
30960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30961
30962 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
30963
30964 @subsubheading Example
30965
30966 @smallexample
30967 (gdb)
30968 -gdb-exit
30969 ^exit
30970 @end smallexample
30971
30972
30973 @ignore
30974 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
30975 @findex -exec-abort
30976
30977 @subsubheading Synopsis
30978
30979 @smallexample
30980 -exec-abort
30981 @end smallexample
30982
30983 Kill the inferior running program.
30984
30985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30986
30987 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
30988
30989 @subsubheading Example
30990 N.A.
30991 @end ignore
30992
30993
30994 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
30995 @findex -gdb-set
30996
30997 @subsubheading Synopsis
30998
30999 @smallexample
31000 -gdb-set
31001 @end smallexample
31002
31003 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31004 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31005
31006 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31007
31008 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31009
31010 @subsubheading Example
31011
31012 @smallexample
31013 (gdb)
31014 -gdb-set $foo=3
31015 ^done
31016 (gdb)
31017 @end smallexample
31018
31019
31020 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31021 @findex -gdb-show
31022
31023 @subsubheading Synopsis
31024
31025 @smallexample
31026 -gdb-show
31027 @end smallexample
31028
31029 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31030
31031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31032
31033 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31034
31035 @subsubheading Example
31036
31037 @smallexample
31038 (gdb)
31039 -gdb-show annotate
31040 ^done,value="0"
31041 (gdb)
31042 @end smallexample
31043
31044 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31045
31046
31047 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31048 @findex -gdb-version
31049
31050 @subsubheading Synopsis
31051
31052 @smallexample
31053 -gdb-version
31054 @end smallexample
31055
31056 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31057
31058 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31059
31060 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31061 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31062
31063 @subsubheading Example
31064
31065 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31066 @c box in TeX.
31067 @smallexample
31068 (gdb)
31069 -gdb-version
31070 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31071 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31072 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31073 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31074 ~ certain conditions.
31075 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31076 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31077 ~ details.
31078 ~This GDB was configured as
31079 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31080 ^done
31081 (gdb)
31082 @end smallexample
31083
31084 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31085 @findex -list-thread-groups
31086
31087 @subheading Synopsis
31088
31089 @smallexample
31090 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31091 @end smallexample
31092
31093 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31094 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31095 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31096 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31097 top-level thread groups.
31098
31099 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31100 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31101 available on the target.
31102
31103 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31104 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31105 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31106 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31107 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31108 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31109 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31110 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31111
31112 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31113 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31114 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31115 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31116 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31117 @samp{threads} field.
31118
31119 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31120 the following caveats:
31121
31122 @itemize @bullet
31123 @item
31124 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31125 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31126 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31127
31128 @item
31129 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31130 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31131 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31132 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31133 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31134 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31135
31136 @end itemize
31137
31138 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31139 have the following fields:
31140
31141 @table @code
31142 @item id
31143 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31144 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31145 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31146
31147 @item type
31148 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31149 valid type.
31150
31151 @item pid
31152 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31153 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31154
31155 @item exit-code
31156 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
31157 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
31158 only if the process is not running.
31159
31160 @item num_children
31161 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31162 absent for an available thread group.
31163
31164 @item threads
31165 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31166 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31167 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31168
31169 @item cores
31170 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31171 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31172 such information is not available.
31173
31174 @item executable
31175 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31176 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31177 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31178
31179 @end table
31180
31181 @subheading Example
31182
31183 @smallexample
31184 @value{GDBP}
31185 -list-thread-groups
31186 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31187 -list-thread-groups 17
31188 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31189 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31190 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31191 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31192 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31193 -list-thread-groups --available
31194 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31195 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31196 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31197 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31198 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31199 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31200 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31201 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31202 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31203 @end smallexample
31204
31205 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31206 @findex -info-os
31207
31208 @subsubheading Synopsis
31209
31210 @smallexample
31211 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31212 @end smallexample
31213
31214 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31215 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31216 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31217 of data of that type.
31218
31219 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31220 system.
31221
31222 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31223
31224 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31225
31226 @subsubheading Example
31227
31228 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31229 like this:
31230
31231 @smallexample
31232 @value{GDBP}
31233 -info-os
31234 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
31235 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31236 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31237 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31238 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31239 col2="Processes"@},
31240 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31241 col2="Process groups"@},
31242 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31243 col2="Threads"@},
31244 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31245 col2="File descriptors"@},
31246 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31247 col2="Sockets"@},
31248 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31249 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31250 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31251 col2="Semaphores"@},
31252 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31253 col2="Message queues"@},
31254 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31255 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
31256 @value{GDBP}
31257 -info-os processes
31258 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31259 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31260 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31261 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31262 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31263 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31264 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31265 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31266 ...
31267 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31268 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31269 (gdb)
31270 @end smallexample
31271
31272 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31273 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31274 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31275 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31276 @code{info os} omits it.)
31277
31278 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31279 @findex -add-inferior
31280
31281 @subheading Synopsis
31282
31283 @smallexample
31284 -add-inferior
31285 @end smallexample
31286
31287 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31288 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31289 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31290 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31291 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31292 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31293
31294 @subheading Example
31295
31296 @smallexample
31297 @value{GDBP}
31298 -add-inferior
31299 ^done,inferior="i3"
31300 @end smallexample
31301
31302 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31303 @findex -interpreter-exec
31304
31305 @subheading Synopsis
31306
31307 @smallexample
31308 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31309 @end smallexample
31310 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31311
31312 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31313
31314 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31315
31316 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31317
31318 @subheading Example
31319
31320 @smallexample
31321 (gdb)
31322 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31323 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31324 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31325 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31326 ^done
31327 (gdb)
31328 @end smallexample
31329
31330 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
31331 @findex -inferior-tty-set
31332
31333 @subheading Synopsis
31334
31335 @smallexample
31336 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31337 @end smallexample
31338
31339 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
31340
31341 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31342
31343 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
31344
31345 @subheading Example
31346
31347 @smallexample
31348 (gdb)
31349 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31350 ^done
31351 (gdb)
31352 @end smallexample
31353
31354 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
31355 @findex -inferior-tty-show
31356
31357 @subheading Synopsis
31358
31359 @smallexample
31360 -inferior-tty-show
31361 @end smallexample
31362
31363 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
31364
31365 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31366
31367 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
31368
31369 @subheading Example
31370
31371 @smallexample
31372 (gdb)
31373 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31374 ^done
31375 (gdb)
31376 -inferior-tty-show
31377 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
31378 (gdb)
31379 @end smallexample
31380
31381 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
31382 @findex -enable-timings
31383
31384 @subheading Synopsis
31385
31386 @smallexample
31387 -enable-timings [yes | no]
31388 @end smallexample
31389
31390 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
31391 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
31392 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
31393 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
31394
31395 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31396
31397 No equivalent.
31398
31399 @subheading Example
31400
31401 @smallexample
31402 (gdb)
31403 -enable-timings
31404 ^done
31405 (gdb)
31406 -break-insert main
31407 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31408 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31409 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
31410 times="0"@},
31411 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
31412 (gdb)
31413 -enable-timings no
31414 ^done
31415 (gdb)
31416 -exec-run
31417 ^running
31418 (gdb)
31419 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31420 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
31421 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
31422 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
31423 (gdb)
31424 @end smallexample
31425
31426 @node Annotations
31427 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
31428
31429 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
31430 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
31431 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
31432 relatively high level.
31433
31434 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
31435 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
31436
31437 @ignore
31438 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
31439 @end ignore
31440
31441 @menu
31442 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
31443 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
31444 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
31445 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
31446 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
31447 * Annotations for Running::
31448 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
31449 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
31450 @end menu
31451
31452 @node Annotations Overview
31453 @section What is an Annotation?
31454 @cindex annotations
31455
31456 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
31457 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
31458 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
31459 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
31460 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
31461 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
31462 cannot contain newline characters.
31463
31464 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
31465 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
31466 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
31467 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
31468 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
31469 means those three characters as output.
31470
31471 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
31472 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
31473 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
31474 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
31475 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
31476 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
31477 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
31478 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
31479 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
31480
31481 @table @code
31482 @kindex set annotate
31483 @item set annotate @var{level}
31484 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
31485 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
31486
31487 @item show annotate
31488 @kindex show annotate
31489 Show the current annotation level.
31490 @end table
31491
31492 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
31493
31494 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
31495
31496 @smallexample
31497 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
31498 GNU gdb 6.0
31499 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31500 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
31501 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
31502 under certain conditions.
31503 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31504 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
31505 for details.
31506 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
31507
31508 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31509 (@value{GDBP})
31510 ^Z^Zprompt
31511 @kbd{quit}
31512
31513 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31514 $
31515 @end smallexample
31516
31517 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
31518 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
31519 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
31520 output from @value{GDBN}.
31521
31522 @node Server Prefix
31523 @section The Server Prefix
31524 @cindex server prefix
31525
31526 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
31527 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
31528 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
31529 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
31530 a transparent manner.
31531
31532 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
31533 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
31534 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
31535 @code{print} command.
31536
31537 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
31538 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
31539
31540 @node Prompting
31541 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
31542
31543 @cindex annotations for prompts
31544 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
31545 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
31546 over, etc.
31547
31548 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
31549 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
31550 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
31551 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
31552 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
31553 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
31554 features the following annotations:
31555
31556 @smallexample
31557 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31558 ^Z^Zprompt
31559 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31560 @end smallexample
31561
31562 The input types are
31563
31564 @table @code
31565 @findex pre-prompt annotation
31566 @findex prompt annotation
31567 @findex post-prompt annotation
31568 @item prompt
31569 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
31570
31571 @findex pre-commands annotation
31572 @findex commands annotation
31573 @findex post-commands annotation
31574 @item commands
31575 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
31576 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
31577
31578 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
31579 @findex overload-choice annotation
31580 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
31581 @item overload-choice
31582 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
31583
31584 @findex pre-query annotation
31585 @findex query annotation
31586 @findex post-query annotation
31587 @item query
31588 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
31589
31590 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
31591 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
31592 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
31593 @item prompt-for-continue
31594 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
31595 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
31596 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
31597 presence of annotations.
31598 @end table
31599
31600 @node Errors
31601 @section Errors
31602 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
31603
31604 @findex quit annotation
31605 @smallexample
31606 ^Z^Zquit
31607 @end smallexample
31608
31609 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
31610
31611 @findex error annotation
31612 @smallexample
31613 ^Z^Zerror
31614 @end smallexample
31615
31616 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
31617
31618 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
31619 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
31620 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
31621 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
31622 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
31623 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
31624 to the top level.
31625
31626 @findex error-begin annotation
31627 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
31628
31629 @smallexample
31630 ^Z^Zerror-begin
31631 @end smallexample
31632
31633 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
31634 message.
31635
31636 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
31637 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
31638 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
31639
31640 @node Invalidation
31641 @section Invalidation Notices
31642
31643 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
31644 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
31645 changed.
31646
31647 @table @code
31648 @findex frames-invalid annotation
31649 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
31650
31651 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
31652 have changed.
31653
31654 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
31655 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
31656
31657 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
31658 deleted a breakpoint.
31659 @end table
31660
31661 @node Annotations for Running
31662 @section Running the Program
31663 @cindex annotations for running programs
31664
31665 @findex starting annotation
31666 @findex stopping annotation
31667 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
31668 @code{step} or @code{continue},
31669
31670 @smallexample
31671 ^Z^Zstarting
31672 @end smallexample
31673
31674 is output. When the program stops,
31675
31676 @smallexample
31677 ^Z^Zstopped
31678 @end smallexample
31679
31680 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
31681 annotations describe how the program stopped.
31682
31683 @table @code
31684 @findex exited annotation
31685 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
31686 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
31687 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
31688
31689 @findex signalled annotation
31690 @findex signal-name annotation
31691 @findex signal-name-end annotation
31692 @findex signal-string annotation
31693 @findex signal-string-end annotation
31694 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
31695 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
31696 annotation continues:
31697
31698 @smallexample
31699 @var{intro-text}
31700 ^Z^Zsignal-name
31701 @var{name}
31702 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
31703 @var{middle-text}
31704 ^Z^Zsignal-string
31705 @var{string}
31706 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
31707 @var{end-text}
31708 @end smallexample
31709
31710 @noindent
31711 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
31712 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
31713 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
31714 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
31715 user's benefit and have no particular format.
31716
31717 @findex signal annotation
31718 @item ^Z^Zsignal
31719 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
31720 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
31721 terminated with it.
31722
31723 @findex breakpoint annotation
31724 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
31725 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
31726
31727 @findex watchpoint annotation
31728 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
31729 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
31730 @end table
31731
31732 @node Source Annotations
31733 @section Displaying Source
31734 @cindex annotations for source display
31735
31736 @findex source annotation
31737 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
31738
31739 @smallexample
31740 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
31741 @end smallexample
31742
31743 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
31744 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
31745 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
31746 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
31747 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
31748 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
31749 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
31750 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
31751 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
31752 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
31753 depend on the language).
31754
31755 @node JIT Interface
31756 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
31757 @cindex just-in-time compilation
31758 @cindex JIT compilation interface
31759
31760 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
31761 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
31762 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
31763 performance while maintaining platform independence.
31764
31765 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
31766 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
31767 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
31768 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
31769 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
31770 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
31771
31772 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
31773 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
31774 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
31775 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
31776 LLVM JIT.
31777
31778 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
31779 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
31780 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
31781 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
31782 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
31783 out about additional code.
31784
31785 @menu
31786 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
31787 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
31788 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
31789 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
31790 @end menu
31791
31792 @node Declarations
31793 @section JIT Declarations
31794
31795 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
31796 implement the interface:
31797
31798 @smallexample
31799 typedef enum
31800 @{
31801 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
31802 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
31803 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
31804 @} jit_actions_t;
31805
31806 struct jit_code_entry
31807 @{
31808 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
31809 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
31810 const char *symfile_addr;
31811 uint64_t symfile_size;
31812 @};
31813
31814 struct jit_descriptor
31815 @{
31816 uint32_t version;
31817 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
31818 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
31819 uint32_t action_flag;
31820 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
31821 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
31822 @};
31823
31824 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
31825 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
31826
31827 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
31828 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
31829 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
31830 @end smallexample
31831
31832 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
31833 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
31834 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
31835
31836 @node Registering Code
31837 @section Registering Code
31838
31839 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
31840
31841 @itemize @bullet
31842 @item
31843 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
31844 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
31845
31846 @item
31847 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
31848 file.
31849
31850 @item
31851 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
31852
31853 @item
31854 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
31855
31856 @item
31857 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
31858 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31859 @end itemize
31860
31861 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
31862 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
31863 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
31864 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
31865
31866 @node Unregistering Code
31867 @section Unregistering Code
31868
31869 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
31870
31871 @itemize @bullet
31872 @item
31873 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
31874
31875 @item
31876 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
31877
31878 @item
31879 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
31880 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31881 @end itemize
31882
31883 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
31884 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
31885
31886 @node Custom Debug Info
31887 @section Custom Debug Info
31888 @cindex custom JIT debug info
31889 @cindex JIT debug info reader
31890
31891 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
31892 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
31893 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
31894 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
31895 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
31896 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
31897 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
31898 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
31899 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
31900
31901 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
31902 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
31903 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
31904 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
31905 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
31906 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
31907 compiler.
31908
31909 @menu
31910 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
31911 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
31912 @end menu
31913
31914 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31915 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31916 @kindex jit-reader-load
31917 @kindex jit-reader-unload
31918
31919 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
31920 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
31921
31922 @table @code
31923 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
31924 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
31925 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
31926 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
31927 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
31928 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
31929 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
31930
31931 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
31932 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
31933 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
31934 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
31935 @code{jit-reader-load}.
31936
31937 @item jit-reader-unload
31938 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
31939
31940 @end table
31941
31942 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
31943 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
31944 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
31945
31946 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
31947 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
31948
31949 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
31950 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
31951 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
31952 the system include directory.
31953
31954 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
31955 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
31956 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
31957
31958 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
31959 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
31960
31961 @findex gdb_init_reader
31962 @smallexample
31963 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
31964 @end smallexample
31965
31966 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
31967
31968 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
31969 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
31970 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
31971 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
31972 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
31973 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
31974
31975 @smallexample
31976 struct gdb_reader_funcs
31977 @{
31978 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
31979 int reader_version;
31980
31981 /* For use by the reader. */
31982 void *priv_data;
31983
31984 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
31985 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
31986 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
31987 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
31988 @};
31989 @end smallexample
31990
31991 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
31992 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
31993
31994 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
31995 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
31996 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
31997 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
31998 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
31999 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32000 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32001 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32002 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32003 target's address space.
32004
32005 @node In-Process Agent
32006 @chapter In-Process Agent
32007 @cindex debugging agent
32008 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32009 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32010 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32011 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32012 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32013 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32014 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32015 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32016 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32017 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32018 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32019 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32020 behavior without interrupting it.
32021
32022 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32023 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32024 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32025 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32026 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32027 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32028 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32029 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32030 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32031
32032 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32033 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32034 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32035 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32036
32037 @anchor{Control Agent}
32038 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32039 debugging with the following commands:
32040
32041 @table @code
32042 @kindex set agent on
32043 @item set agent on
32044 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32045 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32046 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32047 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32048 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32049 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32050
32051 @kindex set agent off
32052 @item set agent off
32053 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32054 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32055
32056 @kindex show agent
32057 @item show agent
32058 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32059 the in-process agent.
32060 @end table
32061
32062 @menu
32063 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32064 @end menu
32065
32066 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32067 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32068 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32069
32070 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32071 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32072 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32073 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32074 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32075 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32076 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32077 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32078 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32079
32080 @menu
32081 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32082 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32083 @end menu
32084
32085 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32086 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32087 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32088
32089 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32090 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32091
32092 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32093 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32094 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32095 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32096
32097 @enumerate
32098 @item
32099 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32100 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32101 @item
32102 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32103 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32104 the other one.
32105 @end enumerate
32106
32107 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32108
32109 @enumerate
32110 @item
32111 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32112 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32113 @anchor{agent expression object}
32114 @item
32115 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32116 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32117 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32118 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32119 @item
32120 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32121 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32122
32123 @end enumerate
32124
32125 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32126 object:
32127
32128 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32129 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32130 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32131 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32132 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32133 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32134 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32135 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32136 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32137 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32138 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32139 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32140 memory address for collecting.
32141 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32142 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32143 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32144 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32145 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32146 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32147 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32148 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32149 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32150 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32151 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32152 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32153 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32154 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32155 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32156 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32157 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32158 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32159 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32160 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32161 @ref{agent expression object}
32162 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32163 @ref{agent expression object}
32164 @item actions @tab variable
32165 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32166 @end multitable
32167
32168 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32169 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32170 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32171
32172 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32173 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32174
32175 @table @samp
32176
32177 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32178 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32179 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32180 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32181 in IPA finally.
32182
32183 Replies:
32184 @table @samp
32185 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32186 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32187 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32188 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32189 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32190 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32191 @item E @var{NN}
32192 for an error
32193
32194 @end table
32195
32196 @item close
32197 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32198 is about to kill inferiors.
32199
32200 @item qTfSTM
32201 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32202 @item qTsSTM
32203 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32204 @item qTSTMat
32205 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32206 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32207 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32208
32209 Replies:
32210 @table @samp
32211 @item E @var{NN}
32212 for an error
32213 @end table
32214 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32215 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32216 @end table
32217
32218 @node GDB Bugs
32219 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32220 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32221 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32222
32223 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32224
32225 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32226 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32227 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32228 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32229
32230 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32231 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32232
32233 @menu
32234 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32235 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32236 @end menu
32237
32238 @node Bug Criteria
32239 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32240 @cindex bug criteria
32241
32242 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32243
32244 @itemize @bullet
32245 @cindex fatal signal
32246 @cindex debugger crash
32247 @cindex crash of debugger
32248 @item
32249 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32250 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32251
32252 @cindex error on valid input
32253 @item
32254 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32255 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32256 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32257
32258 @cindex invalid input
32259 @item
32260 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32261 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32262 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32263 for traditional practice''.
32264
32265 @item
32266 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32267 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32268 @end itemize
32269
32270 @node Bug Reporting
32271 @section How to Report Bugs
32272 @cindex bug reports
32273 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32274
32275 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32276 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32277 contact that organization first.
32278
32279 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32280 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32281 distribution.
32282 @c should add a web page ref...
32283
32284 @ifset BUGURL
32285 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32286 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32287 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32288 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32289 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32290 be used.
32291
32292 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32293 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32294 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32295 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32296
32297 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32298 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32299 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32300 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32301 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32302 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32303 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32304 bug reports to the mailing list.
32305 @end ifset
32306 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32307 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32308 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32309 @end ifclear
32310 @end ifset
32311
32312 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32313 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32314 fact or leave it out, state it!
32315
32316 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32317 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32318 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32319 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32320 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32321 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32322 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
32323 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
32324 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
32325
32326 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
32327 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
32328 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
32329 self-contained.
32330
32331 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
32332 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
32333 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
32334 bugs properly.
32335
32336 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
32337
32338 @itemize @bullet
32339 @item
32340 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
32341 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
32342 version}.
32343
32344 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
32345 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
32346
32347 @item
32348 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
32349 version number.
32350
32351 @item
32352 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
32353 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
32354 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
32355 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
32356
32357 @item
32358 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
32359 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
32360
32361 @item
32362 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
32363 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
32364 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
32365 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
32366 those compilers.
32367
32368 @item
32369 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
32370 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
32371 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
32372 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
32373
32374 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
32375 and then we might not encounter the bug.
32376
32377 @item
32378 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
32379 reproduce the bug.
32380
32381 @item
32382 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
32383 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
32384
32385 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
32386 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
32387 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
32388 a chance to make a mistake.
32389
32390 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
32391 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
32392 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
32393 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
32394 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
32395 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
32396 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
32397 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
32398
32399 @pindex script
32400 @cindex recording a session script
32401 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
32402 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
32403 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
32404 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
32405
32406 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
32407 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
32408
32409 @item
32410 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
32411 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
32412 it by context, not by line number.
32413
32414 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
32415 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
32416
32417 @end itemize
32418
32419 Here are some things that are not necessary:
32420
32421 @itemize @bullet
32422 @item
32423 A description of the envelope of the bug.
32424
32425 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
32426 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
32427 changes will not affect it.
32428
32429 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
32430 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
32431 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
32432 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
32433
32434 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
32435 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
32436 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
32437 less time, and so on.
32438
32439 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
32440 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
32441
32442 @item
32443 A patch for the bug.
32444
32445 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
32446 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
32447 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
32448 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
32449
32450 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
32451 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
32452 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
32453 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
32454
32455 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
32456 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
32457 help us to understand.
32458
32459 @item
32460 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
32461
32462 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
32463 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
32464 @end itemize
32465
32466 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
32467 @c and consists of the two following files:
32468 @c rluser.texi
32469 @c hsuser.texi
32470 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
32471 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
32472 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
32473 @include rluser.texi
32474 @include hsuser.texi
32475 @end ifclear
32476
32477 @node In Memoriam
32478 @appendix In Memoriam
32479
32480 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
32481 contributors:
32482
32483 @table @code
32484 @item Fred Fish
32485 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
32486 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
32487 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
32488
32489 @item Michael Snyder
32490 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
32491 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
32492 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
32493 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
32494 @end table
32495
32496 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
32497 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
32498
32499 @node Formatting Documentation
32500 @appendix Formatting Documentation
32501
32502 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
32503 @cindex reference card
32504 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
32505 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
32506 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
32507 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
32508 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
32509 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
32510
32511 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
32512 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
32513
32514 @smallexample
32515 make refcard.dvi
32516 @end smallexample
32517
32518 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
32519 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
32520 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
32521 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
32522 your @sc{dvi} output program.
32523
32524 @cindex documentation
32525
32526 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
32527 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
32528 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
32529 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
32530 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
32531 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
32532
32533 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
32534 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
32535 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
32536 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
32537 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
32538 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
32539 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
32540 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
32541
32542 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
32543 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
32544 @code{makeinfo}.
32545
32546 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
32547 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
32548 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
32549
32550 @smallexample
32551 cd gdb
32552 make gdb.info
32553 @end smallexample
32554
32555 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
32556 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
32557 Texinfo definitions file.
32558
32559 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
32560 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
32561 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
32562 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
32563 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
32564 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
32565 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
32566
32567 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
32568 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
32569 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
32570 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
32571 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
32572 directory.
32573
32574 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
32575 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
32576 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
32577 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
32578
32579 @smallexample
32580 make gdb.dvi
32581 @end smallexample
32582
32583 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
32584
32585 @node Installing GDB
32586 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
32587 @cindex installation
32588
32589 @menu
32590 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
32591 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
32592 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
32593 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
32594 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
32595 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
32596 @end menu
32597
32598 @node Requirements
32599 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
32600 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
32601
32602 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
32603 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
32604
32605 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
32606 @table @asis
32607 @item ISO C90 compiler
32608 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
32609 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
32610
32611 @end table
32612
32613 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
32614 @table @asis
32615 @item Expat
32616 @anchor{Expat}
32617 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
32618 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
32619 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
32620 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
32621 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
32622 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
32623
32624 Expat is used for:
32625
32626 @itemize @bullet
32627 @item
32628 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
32629 @item
32630 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
32631 @item
32632 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
32633 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
32634 @item
32635 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
32636 @item
32637 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
32638 @item
32639 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format})
32640 @end itemize
32641
32642 @item zlib
32643 @cindex compressed debug sections
32644 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
32645 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
32646 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
32647 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
32648 information in such binaries.
32649
32650 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
32651 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
32652 @url{http://zlib.net}.
32653
32654 @item iconv
32655 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
32656 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
32657 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
32658 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
32659
32660 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
32661 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
32662 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
32663 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
32664
32665 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
32666 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
32667 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
32668
32669 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
32670 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
32671 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
32672 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
32673 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
32674 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
32675 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
32676 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
32677 @end table
32678
32679 @node Running Configure
32680 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
32681 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
32682 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
32683 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
32684 build the @code{gdb} program.
32685 @iftex
32686 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
32687 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
32688 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
32689 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
32690 @end iftex
32691
32692 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
32693 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
32694 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
32695
32696 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
32697 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
32698
32699 @table @code
32700 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
32701 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
32702
32703 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
32704 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
32705
32706 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
32707 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
32708
32709 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
32710 @sc{gnu} include files
32711
32712 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
32713 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
32714
32715 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
32716 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
32717
32718 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
32719 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
32720
32721 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
32722 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
32723
32724 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
32725 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
32726 @end table
32727
32728 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
32729 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
32730 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
32731
32732 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
32733 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
32734 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
32735 argument.
32736
32737 For example:
32738
32739 @smallexample
32740 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32741 ./configure @var{host}
32742 make
32743 @end smallexample
32744
32745 @noindent
32746 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
32747 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
32748 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
32749 correct value by examining your system.)
32750
32751 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
32752 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
32753 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
32754 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
32755
32756 @need 750
32757 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
32758 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
32759 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
32760
32761 @smallexample
32762 sh configure @var{host}
32763 @end smallexample
32764
32765 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
32766 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
32767 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
32768 @file{configure}
32769 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
32770 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
32771
32772 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
32773 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
32774 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
32775 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
32776 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
32777 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
32778 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
32779 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
32780 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32781
32782 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
32783 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
32784 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
32785 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
32786 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
32787
32788 @node Separate Objdir
32789 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
32790
32791 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
32792 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
32793 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
32794 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
32795 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
32796 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
32797 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
32798 program specified there.
32799
32800 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
32801 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
32802 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
32803 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
32804 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
32805 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
32806
32807 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
32808 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
32809
32810 @smallexample
32811 @group
32812 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32813 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
32814 cd ../gdb-sun4
32815 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
32816 make
32817 @end group
32818 @end smallexample
32819
32820 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
32821 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
32822 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
32823 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
32824 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
32825 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
32826
32827 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
32828 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
32829 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
32830 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
32831 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32832
32833 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
32834 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
32835 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
32836 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
32837 You specify a cross-debugging target by
32838 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
32839
32840 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
32841 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
32842 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
32843
32844 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
32845 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
32846 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
32847 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
32848 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
32849
32850 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
32851 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
32852 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
32853 with each other.
32854
32855 @node Config Names
32856 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
32857
32858 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
32859 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
32860 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
32861 of information in the following pattern:
32862
32863 @smallexample
32864 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
32865 @end smallexample
32866
32867 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
32868 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
32869 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
32870
32871 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
32872 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
32873 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
32874 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
32875 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
32876 abbreviations---for example:
32877
32878 @smallexample
32879 % sh config.sub i386-linux
32880 i386-pc-linux-gnu
32881 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
32882 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
32883 % sh config.sub hp9k700
32884 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
32885 % sh config.sub sun4
32886 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
32887 % sh config.sub sun3
32888 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
32889 % sh config.sub i986v
32890 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
32891 @end smallexample
32892
32893 @noindent
32894 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
32895 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
32896
32897 @node Configure Options
32898 @section @file{configure} Options
32899
32900 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
32901 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
32902 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
32903 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
32904
32905 @smallexample
32906 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
32907 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32908 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32909 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
32910 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
32911 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
32912 @var{host}
32913 @end smallexample
32914
32915 @noindent
32916 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
32917 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
32918 @samp{--}.
32919
32920 @table @code
32921 @item --help
32922 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
32923
32924 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
32925 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
32926 @file{@var{dir}}.
32927
32928 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
32929 Configure the source to install programs under directory
32930 @file{@var{dir}}.
32931
32932 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
32933 @need 2000
32934 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
32935 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
32936 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
32937 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
32938 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
32939 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
32940 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
32941 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
32942 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
32943 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
32944 @var{dirname}.
32945
32946 @item --norecursion
32947 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
32948 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
32949
32950 @item --target=@var{target}
32951 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
32952 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
32953 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
32954
32955 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
32956
32957 @item @var{host} @dots{}
32958 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
32959
32960 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
32961 @end table
32962
32963 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
32964 needed for special purposes only.
32965
32966 @node System-wide configuration
32967 @section System-wide configuration and settings
32968 @cindex system-wide init file
32969
32970 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
32971 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
32972 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
32973
32974 Here is the corresponding configure option:
32975
32976 @table @code
32977 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
32978 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
32979 @var{file}.
32980 @end table
32981
32982 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
32983 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
32984
32985 @itemize @bullet
32986 @item
32987 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
32988 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
32989 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
32990 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
32991 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
32992 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
32993
32994 @item
32995 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
32996 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
32997 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32998 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32999 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33000 @end itemize
33001
33002 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33003 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33004 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33005 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33006 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33007 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33008 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33009 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33010 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33011 reread.
33012
33013 @menu
33014 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33015 @end menu
33016
33017 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33018 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33019 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33020
33021 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33022 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33023 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33024 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33025 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33026 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33027
33028 The following scripts are currently available:
33029 @itemize @bullet
33030
33031 @item @file{elinos.py}
33032 @pindex elinos.py
33033 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33034 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33035 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33036 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33037 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33038 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33039
33040 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33041 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33042 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33043 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33044 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33045 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33046
33047 @end itemize
33048
33049 @node Maintenance Commands
33050 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33051 @cindex maintenance commands
33052 @cindex internal commands
33053
33054 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33055 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33056 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33057 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33058 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33059
33060 @table @code
33061 @kindex maint agent
33062 @kindex maint agent-eval
33063 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33064 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33065 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33066 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33067 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33068 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33069 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33070 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33071 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33072 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33073 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33074 addition and return the sum.
33075 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33076 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33077
33078 @kindex maint agent-printf
33079 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33080 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33081 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33082 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33083 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33084
33085 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33086 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33087 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33088 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33089 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33090 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33091 is shown:
33092
33093 @table @code
33094 @item breakpoint
33095 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33096
33097 @item watchpoint
33098 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33099
33100 @item longjmp
33101 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33102 @code{longjmp} calls.
33103
33104 @item longjmp resume
33105 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33106
33107 @item until
33108 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33109
33110 @item finish
33111 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33112
33113 @item shlib events
33114 Shared library events.
33115
33116 @end table
33117
33118 @kindex maint info bfds
33119 @item maint info bfds
33120 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33121 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33122
33123 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33124 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33125 @cindex displaced stepping support
33126 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33127 @item set displaced-stepping
33128 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33129 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33130 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33131 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33132 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33133 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33134
33135 @table @code
33136 @item set displaced-stepping on
33137 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33138 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33139
33140 @item set displaced-stepping off
33141 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33142 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33143
33144 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33145 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33146 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33147 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33148 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33149 @end table
33150
33151 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33152 @item maint check-psymtabs
33153 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33154 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33155
33156 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33157 @item maint check-symtabs
33158 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33159
33160 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33161 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33162 Expand symbol tables.
33163 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33164 names matching @var{regexp}.
33165
33166 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
33167 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33168 @cindex demangler crashes
33169 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
33170 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33171 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
33172 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
33173 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
33174 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
33175 option to terminate the current session.
33176
33177 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33178 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33179 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33180
33181 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33182 @item maint cplus namespace
33183 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33184
33185 @kindex maint demangle
33186 @item maint demangle @var{name}
33187 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
33188
33189 @kindex maint deprecate
33190 @kindex maint undeprecate
33191 @cindex deprecated commands
33192 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33193 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33194 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33195 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33196 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33197 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33198 the replacement as part of the warning.
33199
33200 @kindex maint dump-me
33201 @item maint dump-me
33202 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33203 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33204 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33205 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33206
33207 @kindex maint internal-error
33208 @kindex maint internal-warning
33209 @kindex maint demangler-warning
33210 @cindex demangler crashes
33211 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33212 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33213 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33214
33215 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
33216 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
33217 as though an internal problam has been detected. In addition to
33218 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
33219 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
33220 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
33221 @value{GDBN} session.
33222
33223 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33224 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33225
33226 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33227
33228 @smallexample
33229 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33230 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33231 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33232 debugging may prove unreliable.
33233 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33234 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33235 (@value{GDBP})
33236 @end smallexample
33237
33238 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33239 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33240 @cindex demangler crashes
33241
33242 @kindex maint set internal-error
33243 @kindex maint show internal-error
33244 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33245 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33246 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
33247 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
33248 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33249 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33250 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33251 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33252 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33253 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
33254 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33255 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33256 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33257 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33258 described in the table below.
33259
33260 @table @samp
33261 @item quit
33262 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33263 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33264
33265 @item corefile
33266 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33267 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
33268 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
33269 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
33270 disabled.
33271 @end table
33272
33273 @kindex maint packet
33274 @item maint packet @var{text}
33275 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33276 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33277 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33278 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33279 checksum.
33280
33281 @kindex maint print architecture
33282 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33283 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33284 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33285
33286 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33287 @item maint print c-tdesc
33288 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33289 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33290 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33291
33292 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33293 @item maint print dummy-frames
33294 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33295
33296 @smallexample
33297 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33298 @dots{}
33299 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33300 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33301 58 return (a + b);
33302 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33303 @dots{}
33304 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33305 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
33306 (@value{GDBP})
33307 @end smallexample
33308
33309 Takes an optional file parameter.
33310
33311 @kindex maint print registers
33312 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33313 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33314 @kindex maint print register-groups
33315 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33316 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33317 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33318 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33319 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33320 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33321 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33322
33323 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33324 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33325 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
33326 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
33327 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
33328 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
33329 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
33330 and offsets in the `G' packets.
33331
33332 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
33333 write the information.
33334
33335 @kindex maint print reggroups
33336 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33337 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
33338 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
33339 information.
33340
33341 The register groups info looks like this:
33342
33343 @smallexample
33344 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
33345 Group Type
33346 general user
33347 float user
33348 all user
33349 vector user
33350 system user
33351 save internal
33352 restore internal
33353 @end smallexample
33354
33355 @kindex flushregs
33356 @item flushregs
33357 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
33358
33359 @kindex maint print objfiles
33360 @cindex info for known object files
33361 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
33362 Print a dump of all known object files.
33363 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
33364 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
33365 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
33366
33367 @kindex maint print section-scripts
33368 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
33369 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
33370 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
33371 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
33372 matching @var{regexp}.
33373 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
33374 and the full path if known.
33375 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
33376
33377 @kindex maint print statistics
33378 @cindex bcache statistics
33379 @item maint print statistics
33380 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
33381 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
33382 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
33383 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
33384 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
33385 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
33386 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
33387 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
33388 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
33389 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
33390 lengths.
33391
33392 @kindex maint print target-stack
33393 @cindex target stack description
33394 @item maint print target-stack
33395 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
33396 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
33397 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
33398 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
33399 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
33400 address.
33401
33402 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
33403 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
33404
33405 @kindex maint print type
33406 @cindex type chain of a data type
33407 @item maint print type @var{expr}
33408 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
33409 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
33410 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
33411 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
33412 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
33413
33414 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33415 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33416 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33417 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33418 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
33419 information.
33420
33421 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
33422 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
33423 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
33424 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
33425 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
33426 always see the disassembly form.
33427
33428 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
33429
33430 @smallexample
33431 (gdb) info addr argc
33432 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
33433 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
33434 @end smallexample
33435
33436 For more information on these expressions, see
33437 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
33438
33439 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33440 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33441 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33442 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33443 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
33444
33445 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
33446 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
33447 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
33448 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
33449 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
33450 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
33451 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
33452 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
33453 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
33454
33455 @kindex maint set profile
33456 @kindex maint show profile
33457 @cindex profiling GDB
33458 @item maint set profile
33459 @itemx maint show profile
33460 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
33461
33462 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
33463 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
33464 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
33465 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
33466 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
33467 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
33468 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
33469
33470 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
33471 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
33472
33473 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
33474 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
33475 @cindex hardware debug registers
33476 @item maint set show-debug-regs
33477 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
33478 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
33479 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
33480 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
33481 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
33482 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
33483
33484 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
33485 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
33486 @item maint set show-all-tib
33487 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
33488 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
33489 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
33490 command.
33491
33492 @kindex maint set target-async
33493 @kindex maint show target-async
33494 @item maint set target-async
33495 @itemx maint show target-async
33496 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
33497 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
33498 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
33499 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
33500
33501 @kindex maint set per-command
33502 @kindex maint show per-command
33503 @item maint set per-command
33504 @itemx maint show per-command
33505 @cindex resources used by commands
33506
33507 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
33508 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
33509
33510 @table @code
33511 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
33512 @itemx maint show per-command space
33513 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
33514 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
33515 took, following the command's own output.
33516 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33517 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33518
33519 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
33520 @itemx maint show per-command time
33521 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
33522 for each command.
33523 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
33524 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
33525 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
33526 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
33527 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
33528 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
33529 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
33530 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
33531 spent by the program been debugged.
33532 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33533 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33534
33535 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
33536 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
33537 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
33538 for each command.
33539 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
33540
33541 @enumerate a
33542 @item
33543 number of symbol tables
33544 @item
33545 number of primary symbol tables
33546 @item
33547 number of blocks in the blockvector
33548 @end enumerate
33549 @end table
33550
33551 @kindex maint space
33552 @cindex memory used by commands
33553 @item maint space @var{value}
33554 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
33555 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33556
33557 @kindex maint time
33558 @cindex time of command execution
33559 @item maint time @var{value}
33560 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
33561 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33562
33563 @kindex maint translate-address
33564 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
33565 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
33566 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
33567 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
33568 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
33569 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
33570 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
33571
33572 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
33573 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
33574 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
33575
33576 @end table
33577
33578 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
33579 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
33580
33581 @table @code
33582 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
33583 @kindex set watchdog
33584 @cindex watchdog timer
33585 @cindex timeout for commands
33586 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
33587 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
33588 reports and error and the command is aborted.
33589
33590 @item show watchdog
33591 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
33592 @end table
33593
33594 @node Remote Protocol
33595 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
33596
33597 @menu
33598 * Overview::
33599 * Packets::
33600 * Stop Reply Packets::
33601 * General Query Packets::
33602 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
33603 * Tracepoint Packets::
33604 * Host I/O Packets::
33605 * Interrupts::
33606 * Notification Packets::
33607 * Remote Non-Stop::
33608 * Packet Acknowledgment::
33609 * Examples::
33610 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
33611 * Library List Format::
33612 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
33613 * Memory Map Format::
33614 * Thread List Format::
33615 * Traceframe Info Format::
33616 * Branch Trace Format::
33617 @end menu
33618
33619 @node Overview
33620 @section Overview
33621
33622 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
33623 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
33624 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
33625 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
33626
33627 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
33628 transmitted and received data, respectively.
33629
33630 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
33631 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
33632 @cindex remote serial protocol
33633 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
33634 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
33635 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
33636 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
33637 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
33638
33639 @smallexample
33640 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33641 @end smallexample
33642 @noindent
33643
33644 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
33645 @noindent
33646 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
33647 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
33648 eight bit unsigned checksum).
33649
33650 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
33651 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
33652
33653 @smallexample
33654 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33655 @end smallexample
33656
33657 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
33658 @noindent
33659 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
33660 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
33661 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
33662
33663 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
33664 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
33665 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
33666 retransmission):
33667
33668 @smallexample
33669 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33670 <- @code{+}
33671 @end smallexample
33672 @noindent
33673
33674 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
33675 once a connection is established.
33676 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
33677
33678 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
33679 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
33680 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
33681 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
33682 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
33683 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
33684 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
33685
33686 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
33687 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
33688 exceptions).
33689
33690 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
33691 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
33692 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
33693 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
33694
33695 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
33696 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
33697 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
33698
33699 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
33700 @anchor{Binary Data}
33701 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
33702 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
33703 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
33704 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
33705 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
33706 binary data.
33707
33708 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
33709 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
33710 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
33711 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
33712 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
33713 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
33714 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
33715 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
33716 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
33717 (described next).
33718
33719 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
33720 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
33721 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
33722 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
33723 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
33724 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
33725 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
33726 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
33727 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
33728 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
33729 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
33730 3}} more times.
33731
33732 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
33733 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
33734 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
33735 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
33736 @samp{0*"00}.
33737
33738 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
33739 error number. That number is not well defined.
33740
33741 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
33742 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
33743 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
33744 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
33745 on that response.
33746
33747 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
33748 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
33749 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
33750 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
33751 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
33752 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
33753
33754 @node Packets
33755 @section Packets
33756
33757 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
33758 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
33759 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
33760 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
33761
33762 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
33763 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
33764 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
33765 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
33766 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
33767 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
33768 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
33769 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
33770 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
33771 @var{baz}.
33772
33773 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
33774 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
33775 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
33776 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
33777 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
33778 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
33779 pick any thread.
33780
33781 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
33782 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
33783 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
33784 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
33785 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
33786 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
33787 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
33788 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
33789 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
33790 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
33791 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
33792 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
33793 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
33794
33795 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
33796 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
33797 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
33798 more information.
33799
33800 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
33801 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
33802
33803 Here are the packet descriptions.
33804
33805 @table @samp
33806
33807 @item !
33808 @cindex @samp{!} packet
33809 @anchor{extended mode}
33810 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
33811 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
33812 debugged.
33813
33814 Reply:
33815 @table @samp
33816 @item OK
33817 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
33818 @end table
33819
33820 @item ?
33821 @cindex @samp{?} packet
33822 @anchor{? packet}
33823 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
33824 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
33825 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
33826
33827 Reply:
33828 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33829
33830 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
33831 @cindex @samp{A} packet
33832 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
33833 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
33834 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
33835
33836 Reply:
33837 @table @samp
33838 @item OK
33839 The arguments were set.
33840 @item E @var{NN}
33841 An error occurred.
33842 @end table
33843
33844 @item b @var{baud}
33845 @cindex @samp{b} packet
33846 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
33847 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
33848
33849 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
33850 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
33851 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
33852
33853 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
33854 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
33855 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
33856 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
33857 of view, nothing actually happened.}
33858
33859 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
33860 @cindex @samp{B} packet
33861 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
33862 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
33863
33864 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
33865 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
33866
33867 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
33868 @anchor{bc}
33869 @item bc
33870 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
33871 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33872
33873 Reply:
33874 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33875
33876 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
33877 @anchor{bs}
33878 @item bs
33879 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
33880 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33881
33882 Reply:
33883 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33884
33885 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
33886 @cindex @samp{c} packet
33887 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
33888 is omitted, resume at current address.
33889
33890 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33891 packet}.
33892
33893 Reply:
33894 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33895
33896 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
33897 @cindex @samp{C} packet
33898 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
33899 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
33900
33901 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33902 packet}.
33903
33904 Reply:
33905 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33906
33907 @item d
33908 @cindex @samp{d} packet
33909 Toggle debug flag.
33910
33911 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
33912 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
33913
33914 @item D
33915 @itemx D;@var{pid}
33916 @cindex @samp{D} packet
33917 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
33918 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
33919 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
33920
33921 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
33922 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
33923 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
33924 big-endian hex string.
33925
33926 Reply:
33927 @table @samp
33928 @item OK
33929 for success
33930 @item E @var{NN}
33931 for an error
33932 @end table
33933
33934 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
33935 @cindex @samp{F} packet
33936 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
33937 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
33938 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
33939
33940 @item g
33941 @anchor{read registers packet}
33942 @cindex @samp{g} packet
33943 Read general registers.
33944
33945 Reply:
33946 @table @samp
33947 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
33948 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
33949 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
33950 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
33951 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
33952 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
33953 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
33954
33955 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
33956 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
33957 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
33958 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
33959 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
33960 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
33961 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
33962 have been collected, and both have zero value:
33963
33964 @smallexample
33965 -> @code{g}
33966 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
33967 @end smallexample
33968
33969 @item E @var{NN}
33970 for an error.
33971 @end table
33972
33973 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
33974 @cindex @samp{G} packet
33975 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
33976 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
33977
33978 Reply:
33979 @table @samp
33980 @item OK
33981 for success
33982 @item E @var{NN}
33983 for an error
33984 @end table
33985
33986 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
33987 @cindex @samp{H} packet
33988 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
33989 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
33990 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
33991 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
33992 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
33993 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
33994 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
33995
33996 Reply:
33997 @table @samp
33998 @item OK
33999 for success
34000 @item E @var{NN}
34001 for an error
34002 @end table
34003
34004 @c FIXME: JTC:
34005 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34006 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34007 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34008 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34009 @c described. For example:
34010 @c
34011 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34012 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34013 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34014 @c
34015 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34016 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34017 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34018
34019 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34020 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34021 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34022 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34023 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34024 step starting at that address.
34025
34026 @item I
34027 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34028 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34029 step packet}.
34030
34031 @item k
34032 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34033 Kill request.
34034
34035 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34036
34037 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34038 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34039
34040 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34041
34042 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34043 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34044 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34045
34046 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34047 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34048 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34049
34050 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34051 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34052 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34053 (@pxref{? packet}).
34054
34055 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34056 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34057 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34058 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34059
34060 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34061 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34062 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34063 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34064 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34065 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34066 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34067 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34068
34069 Reply:
34070 @table @samp
34071 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34072 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34073 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34074 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34075 @item E @var{NN}
34076 @var{NN} is errno
34077 @end table
34078
34079 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34080 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34081 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34082 The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34083 hexadecimal number.
34084
34085 Reply:
34086 @table @samp
34087 @item OK
34088 for success
34089 @item E @var{NN}
34090 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34091 written).
34092 @end table
34093
34094 @item p @var{n}
34095 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34096 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34097 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34098 register value is encoded.
34099
34100 Reply:
34101 @table @samp
34102 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34103 the register's value
34104 @item E @var{NN}
34105 for an error
34106 @item @w{}
34107 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34108 @end table
34109
34110 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34111 @anchor{write register packet}
34112 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34113 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34114 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34115 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34116
34117 Reply:
34118 @table @samp
34119 @item OK
34120 for success
34121 @item E @var{NN}
34122 for an error
34123 @end table
34124
34125 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34126 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34127 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34128 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34129 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34130 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34131
34132 @item r
34133 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34134 Reset the entire system.
34135
34136 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34137
34138 @item R @var{XX}
34139 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34140 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34141 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34142
34143 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34144
34145 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34146 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34147 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
34148 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34149
34150 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34151 packet}.
34152
34153 Reply:
34154 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34155
34156 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34157 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34158 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34159 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34160 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34161
34162 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34163 packet}.
34164
34165 Reply:
34166 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34167
34168 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34169 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34170 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34171 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
34172 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
34173
34174 @item T @var{thread-id}
34175 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34176 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34177
34178 Reply:
34179 @table @samp
34180 @item OK
34181 thread is still alive
34182 @item E @var{NN}
34183 thread is dead
34184 @end table
34185
34186 @item v
34187 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34188 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34189
34190 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34191 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34192 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34193 The process ID is a
34194 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34195 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34196 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34197
34198 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34199 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34200 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34201 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34202 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34203 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34204 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34205 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34206
34207 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34208
34209 Reply:
34210 @table @samp
34211 @item E @var{nn}
34212 for an error
34213 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34214 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34215 @item OK
34216 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34217 @end table
34218
34219 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34220 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34221 @anchor{vCont packet}
34222 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34223 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34224 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34225 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34226 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34227 Specifying multiple
34228 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34229 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34230
34231 Currently supported actions are:
34232
34233 @table @samp
34234 @item c
34235 Continue.
34236 @item C @var{sig}
34237 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34238 @item s
34239 Step.
34240 @item S @var{sig}
34241 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34242 @item t
34243 Stop.
34244 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34245 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34246 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34247 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34248 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34249 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34250
34251 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34252 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34253 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34254 jumps to @var{start}).
34255
34256 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34257 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34258 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34259
34260 @end table
34261
34262 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34263 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34264 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34265
34266 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34267 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34268 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34269 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34270 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34271 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34272 as an implementation detail.
34273
34274 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34275 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34276 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34277 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34278 @var{thread-id}.
34279
34280 Reply:
34281 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34282
34283 @item vCont?
34284 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34285 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34286
34287 Reply:
34288 @table @samp
34289 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34290 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34291 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34292 @item @w{}
34293 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34294 @end table
34295
34296 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34297 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34298 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34299 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34300
34301 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34302 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
34303 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
34304 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
34305 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
34306 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
34307 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
34308 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
34309 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34310 packet is received.
34311
34312 Reply:
34313 @table @samp
34314 @item OK
34315 for success
34316 @item E @var{NN}
34317 for an error
34318 @end table
34319
34320 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34321 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
34322 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
34323 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
34324 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
34325 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
34326 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
34327 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
34328 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
34329 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
34330 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
34331 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
34332
34333
34334 Reply:
34335 @table @samp
34336 @item OK
34337 for success
34338 @item E.memtype
34339 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
34340 @item E @var{NN}
34341 for an error
34342 @end table
34343
34344 @item vFlashDone
34345 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
34346 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
34347 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
34348 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
34349 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
34350 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34351 request is completed.
34352
34353 @item vKill;@var{pid}
34354 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
34355 @anchor{vKill packet}
34356 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
34357 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
34358 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
34359 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34360
34361 Reply:
34362 @table @samp
34363 @item E @var{nn}
34364 for an error
34365 @item OK
34366 for success
34367 @end table
34368
34369 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
34370 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
34371 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
34372 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
34373 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
34374 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
34375 state.
34376
34377 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
34378
34379 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34380
34381 Reply:
34382 @table @samp
34383 @item E @var{nn}
34384 for an error
34385 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34386 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34387 @end table
34388
34389 @item vStopped
34390 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
34391 @xref{Notification Packets}.
34392
34393 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34394 @anchor{X packet}
34395 @cindex @samp{X} packet
34396 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
34397 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of bytes @var{length};
34398 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34399
34400 Reply:
34401 @table @samp
34402 @item OK
34403 for success
34404 @item E @var{NN}
34405 for an error
34406 @end table
34407
34408 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34409 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34410 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
34411 @cindex @samp{z} packet
34412 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
34413 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
34414 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
34415
34416 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
34417 separately.
34418
34419 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
34420 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
34421 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
34422 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
34423 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
34424 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
34425
34426 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34427 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34428 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
34429 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
34430 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
34431 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
34432
34433 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
34434 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
34435 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
34436 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
34437 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
34438 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
34439 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
34440 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
34441 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
34442 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
34443
34444 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
34445 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
34446
34447 @table @samp
34448
34449 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34450 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34451 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34452
34453 @end table
34454
34455 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
34456 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
34457 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
34458 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
34459 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
34460 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
34461 separators. Each expression has the following form:
34462
34463 @table @samp
34464
34465 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34466 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34467 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34468
34469 @end table
34470
34471 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
34472
34473 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
34474 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
34475 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
34476 target, is not defined.}
34477
34478 Reply:
34479 @table @samp
34480 @item OK
34481 success
34482 @item @w{}
34483 not supported
34484 @item E @var{NN}
34485 for an error
34486 @end table
34487
34488 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34489 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34490 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
34491 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
34492 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
34493 address @var{addr}.
34494
34495 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
34496 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
34497 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
34498
34499 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
34500 movement.}
34501
34502 Reply:
34503 @table @samp
34504 @item OK
34505 success
34506 @item @w{}
34507 not supported
34508 @item E @var{NN}
34509 for an error
34510 @end table
34511
34512 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34513 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34514 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
34515 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
34516 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34517 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34518
34519 Reply:
34520 @table @samp
34521 @item OK
34522 success
34523 @item @w{}
34524 not supported
34525 @item E @var{NN}
34526 for an error
34527 @end table
34528
34529 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34530 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34531 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
34532 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
34533 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34534 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34535
34536 Reply:
34537 @table @samp
34538 @item OK
34539 success
34540 @item @w{}
34541 not supported
34542 @item E @var{NN}
34543 for an error
34544 @end table
34545
34546 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34547 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34548 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
34549 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
34550 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34551 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34552
34553 Reply:
34554 @table @samp
34555 @item OK
34556 success
34557 @item @w{}
34558 not supported
34559 @item E @var{NN}
34560 for an error
34561 @end table
34562
34563 @end table
34564
34565 @node Stop Reply Packets
34566 @section Stop Reply Packets
34567 @cindex stop reply packets
34568
34569 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
34570 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
34571 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
34572 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
34573 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
34574 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
34575 @value{GDBN} source code.
34576
34577 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
34578 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
34579 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
34580 components.
34581
34582 @table @samp
34583
34584 @item S @var{AA}
34585 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34586 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
34587 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
34588
34589 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
34590 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
34591 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34592 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
34593 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
34594 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
34595 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
34596 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
34597
34598 @itemize @bullet
34599 @item
34600 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
34601 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
34602 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
34603 two-digit hex number.
34604
34605 @item
34606 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
34607 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34608
34609 @item
34610 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
34611 the core on which the stop event was detected.
34612
34613 @item
34614 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
34615 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
34616 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
34617 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
34618
34619 @item
34620 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
34621 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
34622 future.
34623 @end itemize
34624
34625 The currently defined stop reasons are:
34626
34627 @table @samp
34628 @item watch
34629 @itemx rwatch
34630 @itemx awatch
34631 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
34632 hex.
34633
34634 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
34635 @item library
34636 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
34637 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
34638 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
34639
34640 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
34641 @item replaylog
34642 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
34643 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
34644 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
34645 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
34646 for more information.
34647 @end table
34648
34649 @item W @var{AA}
34650 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34651 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
34652 applicable to certain targets.
34653
34654 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
34655 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
34656 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34657 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34658
34659 @item X @var{AA}
34660 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34661 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
34662
34663 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
34664 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
34665 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
34666 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34667
34668 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
34669 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
34670 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
34671 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
34672 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
34673
34674 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
34675 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
34676 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
34677 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
34678 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
34679 system calls.
34680
34681 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
34682 this very system call.
34683
34684 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
34685 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
34686 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
34687 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34688 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
34689 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
34690
34691 @end table
34692
34693 @node General Query Packets
34694 @section General Query Packets
34695 @cindex remote query requests
34696
34697 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
34698 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
34699 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
34700 sending information to and from the stub.
34701
34702 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
34703 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
34704 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
34705 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
34706 conventions:
34707
34708 @itemize @bullet
34709 @item
34710 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
34711 @item
34712 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
34713 letter.
34714 @item
34715 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
34716 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
34717 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
34718 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
34719 @end itemize
34720
34721 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
34722 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
34723 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
34724 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
34725 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
34726 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
34727 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
34728 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
34729 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
34730 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
34731 packet.}.
34732
34733 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
34734 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
34735 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
34736 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
34737 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
34738
34739 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
34740
34741 @table @samp
34742
34743 @item QAgent:1
34744 @itemx QAgent:0
34745 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
34746 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
34747
34748 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
34749 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
34750 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
34751 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
34752 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
34753 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
34754 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
34755 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
34756 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
34757 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
34758 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
34759
34760 @item qC
34761 @cindex current thread, remote request
34762 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
34763 Return the current thread ID.
34764
34765 Reply:
34766 @table @samp
34767 @item QC @var{thread-id}
34768 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
34769 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34770 @item @r{(anything else)}
34771 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
34772 @end table
34773
34774 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
34775 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
34776 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
34777 @anchor{qCRC packet}
34778 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
34779 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
34780 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
34781 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
34782
34783 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
34784 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
34785 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
34786 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
34787 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
34788 detect trailing zeros.
34789
34790 Reply:
34791 @table @samp
34792 @item E @var{NN}
34793 An error (such as memory fault)
34794 @item C @var{crc32}
34795 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
34796 @end table
34797
34798 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
34799 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
34800 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
34801 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
34802 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
34803 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
34804 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
34805 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
34806 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
34807 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
34808 randomization.
34809
34810 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34811
34812 Reply:
34813 @table @samp
34814 @item OK
34815 The request succeeded.
34816
34817 @item E @var{nn}
34818 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
34819
34820 @item @w{}
34821 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
34822 by the stub.
34823 @end table
34824
34825 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34826 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34827 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
34828 address space randomization.
34829
34830 @item qfThreadInfo
34831 @itemx qsThreadInfo
34832 @cindex list active threads, remote request
34833 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
34834 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
34835 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
34836 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
34837 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
34838 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
34839 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
34840 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
34841
34842 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
34843
34844 Reply:
34845 @table @samp
34846 @item m @var{thread-id}
34847 A single thread ID
34848 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
34849 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
34850 @item l
34851 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
34852 @end table
34853
34854 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
34855 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
34856 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
34857 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
34858 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
34859 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
34860 fields.
34861
34862 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
34863 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
34864 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
34865 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
34866 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
34867
34868 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
34869 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
34870 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
34871 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
34872 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
34873
34874 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
34875 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34876
34877 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
34878 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
34879 information associated with the variable.)
34880
34881 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
34882 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
34883 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
34884 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
34885 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
34886 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
34887
34888 Reply:
34889 @table @samp
34890 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34891 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
34892 local storage requested.
34893
34894 @item E @var{nn}
34895 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
34896
34897 @item @w{}
34898 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34899 @end table
34900
34901 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
34902 @cindex get thread information block address
34903 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
34904 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
34905
34906 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
34907
34908 Reply:
34909 @table @samp
34910 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34911 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
34912 thread information block.
34913
34914 @item E @var{nn}
34915 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
34916 address could not be retrieved.
34917
34918 @item @w{}
34919 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34920 @end table
34921
34922 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
34923 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
34924 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
34925 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
34926 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
34927 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
34928 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
34929
34930 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
34931
34932 Reply:
34933 @table @samp
34934 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
34935 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
34936 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
34937 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
34938 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
34939 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
34940 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
34941 @end table
34942
34943 @item qOffsets
34944 @cindex section offsets, remote request
34945 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
34946 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
34947 image.
34948
34949 Reply:
34950 @table @samp
34951 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
34952 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
34953 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
34954 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
34955 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
34956 segments by the supplied offsets.
34957
34958 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
34959 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
34960 to the @code{Bss} section.}
34961
34962 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
34963 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
34964 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
34965 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
34966 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
34967 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
34968 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
34969 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
34970 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
34971 @end table
34972
34973 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
34974 @cindex thread information, remote request
34975 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
34976 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
34977 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
34978 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
34979
34980 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
34981 (see below).
34982
34983 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
34984
34985 @item QNonStop:1
34986 @itemx QNonStop:0
34987 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
34988 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
34989 @anchor{QNonStop}
34990 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
34991 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
34992
34993 Reply:
34994 @table @samp
34995 @item OK
34996 The request succeeded.
34997
34998 @item E @var{nn}
34999 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35000
35001 @item @w{}
35002 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
35003 the stub.
35004 @end table
35005
35006 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35007 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35008 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
35009 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
35010
35011 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35012 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
35013 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35014 @anchor{QPassSignals}
35015 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
35016 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35017 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35018 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
35019 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
35020 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
35021 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
35022 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
35023 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
35024
35025 Reply:
35026 @table @samp
35027 @item OK
35028 The request succeeded.
35029
35030 @item E @var{nn}
35031 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35032
35033 @item @w{}
35034 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
35035 the stub.
35036 @end table
35037
35038 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
35039 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
35040 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35041 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35042
35043 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35044 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
35045 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
35046 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
35047 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
35048 Others should be silently discarded.
35049
35050 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
35051 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
35052 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
35053 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
35054 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
35055 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
35056 signals.
35057
35058 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
35059 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
35060
35061 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35062 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35063 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35064 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35065 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35066
35067 Reply:
35068 @table @samp
35069 @item OK
35070 The request succeeded.
35071
35072 @item E @var{nn}
35073 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35074
35075 @item @w{}
35076 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35077 by the stub.
35078 @end table
35079
35080 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35081 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35082 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35083 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35084
35085 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35086 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35087 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35088 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35089 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35090 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35091 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35092 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35093 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35094
35095 Reply:
35096 @table @samp
35097 @item OK
35098 A command response with no output.
35099 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35100 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35101 @item E @var{NN}
35102 Indicate a badly formed request.
35103 @item @w{}
35104 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35105 @end table
35106
35107 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35108 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35109 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35110 packets.)
35111
35112 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35113 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35114 @ifnotinfo
35115 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35116 @end ifnotinfo
35117 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35118 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35119 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35120 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
35121 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
35122
35123 Reply:
35124 @table @samp
35125 @item 0
35126 The pattern was not found.
35127 @item 1,address
35128 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35129 @item E @var{NN}
35130 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35131 @item @w{}
35132 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35133 @end table
35134
35135 @item QStartNoAckMode
35136 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35137 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35138 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35139 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35140
35141 Reply:
35142 @table @samp
35143 @item OK
35144 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35145 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35146 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35147 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35148 @item @w{}
35149 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35150 @end table
35151
35152 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35153 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35154 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35155 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35156 @anchor{qSupported}
35157 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35158 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35159 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35160 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35161 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35162 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35163 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35164 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35165 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35166 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35167 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35168 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35169 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35170 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35171
35172 Reply:
35173 @table @samp
35174 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35175 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35176 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35177 possible forms).
35178 @item @w{}
35179 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35180 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35181 @end table
35182
35183 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35184 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35185 are:
35186
35187 @table @samp
35188 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35189 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35190 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35191 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35192 @item @var{name}+
35193 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35194 need an associated value.
35195 @item @var{name}-
35196 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35197 @item @var{name}?
35198 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35199 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35200 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35201 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35202 @end table
35203
35204 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35205 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35206 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35207 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35208 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35209
35210 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35211 are defined:
35212
35213 @table @samp
35214 @item multiprocess
35215 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35216 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35217 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35218 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35219 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35220
35221 @item xmlRegisters
35222 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35223 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35224 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35225 description.
35226
35227 @item qRelocInsn
35228 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35229 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35230 instruction reply packet}).
35231 @end table
35232
35233 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35234 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35235 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35236 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35237 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35238 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35239 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35240 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35241 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35242 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35243 all the features it supports.
35244
35245 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35246 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35247
35248 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35249 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35250 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35251 form response.
35252
35253 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35254 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35255 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35256 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35257
35258 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35259 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35260 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35261 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35262 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35263
35264 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
35265
35266 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
35267 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
35268 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
35269 @item Feature Name
35270 @tab Value Required
35271 @tab Default
35272 @tab Probe Allowed
35273
35274 @item @samp{PacketSize}
35275 @tab Yes
35276 @tab @samp{-}
35277 @tab No
35278
35279 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
35280 @tab No
35281 @tab @samp{-}
35282 @tab Yes
35283
35284 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35285 @tab No
35286 @tab @samp{-}
35287 @tab Yes
35288
35289 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
35290 @tab No
35291 @tab @samp{-}
35292 @tab Yes
35293
35294 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35295 @tab No
35296 @tab @samp{-}
35297 @tab Yes
35298
35299 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
35300 @tab No
35301 @tab @samp{-}
35302 @tab Yes
35303
35304 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
35305 @tab No
35306 @tab @samp{-}
35307 @tab No
35308
35309 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35310 @tab No
35311 @tab @samp{-}
35312 @tab Yes
35313
35314 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
35315 @tab No
35316 @tab @samp{-}
35317 @tab Yes
35318
35319 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
35320 @tab No
35321 @tab @samp{-}
35322 @tab Yes
35323
35324 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
35325 @tab No
35326 @tab @samp{-}
35327 @tab Yes
35328
35329 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
35330 @tab No
35331 @tab @samp{-}
35332 @tab Yes
35333
35334 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
35335 @tab No
35336 @tab @samp{-}
35337 @tab Yes
35338
35339 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
35340 @tab No
35341 @tab @samp{-}
35342 @tab Yes
35343
35344 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35345 @tab No
35346 @tab @samp{-}
35347 @tab Yes
35348
35349 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35350 @tab No
35351 @tab @samp{-}
35352 @tab Yes
35353
35354 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35355 @tab No
35356 @tab @samp{-}
35357 @tab Yes
35358
35359 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
35360 @tab Yes
35361 @tab @samp{-}
35362 @tab Yes
35363
35364 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
35365 @tab Yes
35366 @tab @samp{-}
35367 @tab Yes
35368
35369 @item @samp{QNonStop}
35370 @tab No
35371 @tab @samp{-}
35372 @tab Yes
35373
35374 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
35375 @tab No
35376 @tab @samp{-}
35377 @tab Yes
35378
35379 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
35380 @tab No
35381 @tab @samp{-}
35382 @tab Yes
35383
35384 @item @samp{multiprocess}
35385 @tab No
35386 @tab @samp{-}
35387 @tab No
35388
35389 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
35390 @tab No
35391 @tab @samp{-}
35392 @tab No
35393
35394 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
35395 @tab No
35396 @tab @samp{-}
35397 @tab No
35398
35399 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
35400 @tab No
35401 @tab @samp{-}
35402 @tab No
35403
35404 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
35405 @tab No
35406 @tab @samp{-}
35407 @tab No
35408
35409 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
35410 @tab No
35411 @tab @samp{-}
35412 @tab No
35413
35414 @item @samp{QAgent}
35415 @tab No
35416 @tab @samp{-}
35417 @tab No
35418
35419 @item @samp{QAllow}
35420 @tab No
35421 @tab @samp{-}
35422 @tab No
35423
35424 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
35425 @tab No
35426 @tab @samp{-}
35427 @tab No
35428
35429 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
35430 @tab No
35431 @tab @samp{-}
35432 @tab No
35433
35434 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
35435 @tab No
35436 @tab @samp{-}
35437 @tab No
35438
35439 @item @samp{tracenz}
35440 @tab No
35441 @tab @samp{-}
35442 @tab No
35443
35444 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
35445 @tab No
35446 @tab @samp{-}
35447 @tab No
35448
35449 @end multitable
35450
35451 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
35452
35453 @table @samp
35454 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
35455 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
35456 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
35457 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
35458 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
35459 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
35460 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
35461 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
35462 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
35463 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
35464
35465 @item qXfer:auxv:read
35466 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
35467 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
35468
35469 @item qXfer:btrace:read
35470 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35471 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
35472
35473 @item qXfer:features:read
35474 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
35475 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
35476
35477 @item qXfer:libraries:read
35478 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
35479 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
35480
35481 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
35482 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35483 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35484
35485 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
35486 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
35487 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35488 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35489
35490 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
35491 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
35492 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
35493
35494 @item qXfer:sdata:read
35495 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
35496 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
35497
35498 @item qXfer:spu:read
35499 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
35500 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
35501
35502 @item qXfer:spu:write
35503 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
35504 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
35505
35506 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
35507 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
35508 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
35509
35510 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
35511 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
35512 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
35513
35514 @item qXfer:threads:read
35515 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35516 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
35517
35518 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
35519 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35520 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
35521
35522 @item qXfer:uib:read
35523 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35524 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
35525
35526 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
35527 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35528 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
35529
35530 @item QNonStop
35531 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
35532 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
35533
35534 @item QPassSignals
35535 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35536 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
35537
35538 @item QStartNoAckMode
35539 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
35540 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
35541
35542 @item multiprocess
35543 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
35544 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
35545 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
35546 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
35547 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
35548 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
35549 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
35550 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
35551 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
35552 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
35553 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
35554
35555 @item qXfer:osdata:read
35556 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
35557 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
35558
35559 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
35560 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
35561 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
35562 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
35563
35564 @item ConditionalTracepoints
35565 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
35566 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
35567
35568 @item ReverseContinue
35569 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
35570 (@pxref{bc}).
35571
35572 @item ReverseStep
35573 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
35574 (@pxref{bs}).
35575
35576 @item TracepointSource
35577 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
35578 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
35579
35580 @item QAgent
35581 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
35582
35583 @item QAllow
35584 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
35585
35586 @item QDisableRandomization
35587 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
35588
35589 @item StaticTracepoint
35590 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
35591 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
35592
35593 @item InstallInTrace
35594 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
35595 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
35596
35597 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
35598 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
35599 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
35600 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
35601
35602 @item QTBuffer:size
35603 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
35604 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
35605
35606 @item tracenz
35607 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
35608 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
35609 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
35610
35611 @item BreakpointCommands
35612 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
35613 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
35614 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
35615
35616 @item Qbtrace:off
35617 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
35618
35619 @item Qbtrace:bts
35620 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
35621
35622 @end table
35623
35624 @item qSymbol::
35625 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
35626 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
35627 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
35628 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
35629
35630 Reply:
35631 @table @samp
35632 @item OK
35633 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35634 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35635 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
35636 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
35637 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
35638 below.
35639 @end table
35640
35641 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
35642 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
35643
35644 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
35645 target has previously requested.
35646
35647 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
35648 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
35649 will be empty.
35650
35651 Reply:
35652 @table @samp
35653 @item OK
35654 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35655 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35656 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
35657 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
35658 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
35659 @end table
35660
35661 @item qTBuffer
35662 @itemx QTBuffer
35663 @itemx QTDisconnected
35664 @itemx QTDP
35665 @itemx QTDPsrc
35666 @itemx QTDV
35667 @itemx qTfP
35668 @itemx qTfV
35669 @itemx QTFrame
35670 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
35671
35672 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35673
35674 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
35675 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
35676 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
35677 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
35678 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
35679 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
35680 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
35681 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
35682 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
35683 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
35684 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
35685
35686 Reply:
35687 @table @samp
35688 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35689 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
35690 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
35691 the thread's attributes.
35692 @end table
35693
35694 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
35695 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35696 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35697 packets.)
35698
35699 @item QTNotes
35700 @itemx qTP
35701 @itemx QTSave
35702 @itemx qTsP
35703 @itemx qTsV
35704 @itemx QTStart
35705 @itemx QTStop
35706 @itemx QTEnable
35707 @itemx QTDisable
35708 @itemx QTinit
35709 @itemx QTro
35710 @itemx qTStatus
35711 @itemx qTV
35712 @itemx qTfSTM
35713 @itemx qTsSTM
35714 @itemx qTSTMat
35715 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35716
35717 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35718 @cindex read special object, remote request
35719 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
35720 @anchor{qXfer read}
35721 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
35722 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
35723 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
35724 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
35725 additional details about what data to access.
35726
35727 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35728 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35729 formats, listed below.
35730
35731 @table @samp
35732 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35733 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
35734 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
35735 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
35736
35737 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35738 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35739
35740 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35741 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
35742
35743 Return a description of the current branch trace.
35744 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
35745 packet may have one of the following values:
35746
35747 @table @code
35748 @item all
35749 Returns all available branch trace.
35750
35751 @item new
35752 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
35753 the last read request.
35754
35755 @item delta
35756 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
35757 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
35758 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
35759 used to stitch traces together.
35760
35761 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
35762 @end table
35763
35764 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
35765 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35766
35767 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35768 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
35769 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
35770 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
35771 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
35772
35773 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35774 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35775
35776 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35777 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
35778 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
35779 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35780 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35781
35782 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
35783 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
35784 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
35785
35786 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35787 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35788
35789 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35790 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
35791 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
35792 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
35793 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
35794 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
35795 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35796 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
35797
35798 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
35799 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
35800
35801 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35802 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35803
35804 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
35805 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
35806 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
35807 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
35808
35809 @table @code
35810 @item start=@var{address}
35811 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35812 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
35813 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
35814 chosen as the starting point.
35815
35816 @item prev=@var{address}
35817 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35818 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
35819 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
35820 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
35821 exists prior to the starting point.
35822
35823 @end table
35824
35825 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
35826 ignored.
35827
35828 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35829 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
35830 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
35831 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35832 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35833
35834 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35835 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35836
35837 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35838 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
35839
35840 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
35841 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
35842 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
35843 Action Lists}.
35844
35845 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35846 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35847 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35848
35849 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35850 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
35851 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
35852 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35853 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35854
35855 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35856 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35857 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35858
35859 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35860 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
35861 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35862 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
35863 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35864 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35865 in that context to be accessed.
35866
35867 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35868 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35869 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35870
35871 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35872 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
35873 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
35874 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35875 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35876
35877 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35878 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35879
35880 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35881 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
35882
35883 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
35884 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
35885 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35886
35887 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35888 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35889
35890 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35891 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
35892
35893 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
35894 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
35895
35896 This packet is not probed by default.
35897
35898 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35899 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
35900 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
35901 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
35902 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
35903
35904 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35905 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35906
35907 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35908 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
35909 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
35910 @xref{Operating System Information}.
35911
35912 @end table
35913
35914 Reply:
35915 @table @samp
35916 @item m @var{data}
35917 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
35918 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
35919 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
35920 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
35921 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
35922 request.
35923
35924 @item l @var{data}
35925 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
35926 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
35927 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
35928
35929 @item l
35930 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
35931 There is no more data to be read.
35932
35933 @item E00
35934 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35935
35936 @item E @var{nn}
35937 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
35938 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35939
35940 @item @w{}
35941 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
35942 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
35943 @end table
35944
35945 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35946 @cindex write data into object, remote request
35947 @anchor{qXfer write}
35948 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
35949 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
35950 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
35951 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
35952 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
35953 to access.
35954
35955 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35956 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35957 formats, listed below.
35958
35959 @table @samp
35960 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35961 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
35962 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
35963 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35964 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
35965
35966 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35967 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35968 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35969
35970 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35971 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
35972 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35973 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
35974 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35975 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35976 in that context to be accessed.
35977
35978 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35979 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35980 @end table
35981
35982 Reply:
35983 @table @samp
35984 @item @var{nn}
35985 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
35986 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
35987
35988 @item E00
35989 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35990
35991 @item E @var{nn}
35992 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
35993 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35994
35995 @item @w{}
35996 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
35997 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
35998 @end table
35999
36000 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
36001 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
36002 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
36003 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
36004 must respond with an empty packet.
36005
36006 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
36007 @cindex query attached, remote request
36008 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
36009 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
36010 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
36011 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
36012 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
36013 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
36014 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
36015
36016 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
36017 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
36018 the @code{quit} command.
36019
36020 Reply:
36021 @table @samp
36022 @item 1
36023 The remote server attached to an existing process.
36024 @item 0
36025 The remote server created a new process.
36026 @item E @var{NN}
36027 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36028 @end table
36029
36030 @item Qbtrace:bts
36031 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
36032
36033 Reply:
36034 @table @samp
36035 @item OK
36036 Branch tracing has been enabled.
36037 @item E.errtext
36038 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36039 @end table
36040
36041 @item Qbtrace:off
36042 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
36043
36044 Reply:
36045 @table @samp
36046 @item OK
36047 Branch tracing has been disabled.
36048 @item E.errtext
36049 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36050 @end table
36051
36052 @end table
36053
36054 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36055 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36056
36057 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
36058 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
36059 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
36060
36061 @menu
36062 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36063 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36064 @end menu
36065
36066 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36067 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36068
36069 @menu
36070 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36071 @end menu
36072
36073 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36074 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36075 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36076
36077 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36078
36079 @table @r
36080
36081 @item 2
36082 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36083
36084 @item 3
36085 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36086
36087 @item 4
36088 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36089
36090 @end table
36091
36092 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36093 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36094
36095 @menu
36096 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36097 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36098 @end menu
36099
36100 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36101 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36102 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36103
36104 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36105 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36106 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36107 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36108 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36109 most-significant -- least-significant.
36110
36111 @table @r
36112
36113 @item MIPS32
36114 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36115 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36116 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36117
36118 @item MIPS64
36119 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36120 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36121 as @code{MIPS32}.
36122
36123 @end table
36124
36125 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36126 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36127 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36128
36129 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36130
36131 @table @r
36132
36133 @item 2
36134 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36135
36136 @item 3
36137 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36138
36139 @item 4
36140 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36141
36142 @item 5
36143 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36144
36145 @end table
36146
36147 @node Tracepoint Packets
36148 @section Tracepoint Packets
36149 @cindex tracepoint packets
36150 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36151
36152 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36153 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36154
36155 @table @samp
36156
36157 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36158 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36159 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36160 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36161 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
36162 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36163 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36164 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36165 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36166 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36167 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36168 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36169 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36170 actions.
36171
36172 Replies:
36173 @table @samp
36174 @item OK
36175 The packet was understood and carried out.
36176 @item qRelocInsn
36177 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36178 @item @w{}
36179 The packet was not recognized.
36180 @end table
36181
36182 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36183 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
36184 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36185 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36186 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36187 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36188 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
36189
36190 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
36191 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
36192 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
36193 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
36194 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
36195 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
36196 tracepoint actions.
36197
36198 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
36199 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
36200 following forms:
36201
36202 @table @samp
36203
36204 @item R @var{mask}
36205 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
36206 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
36207 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
36208 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
36209 not fit in a 32-bit word.
36210
36211 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
36212 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
36213 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
36214 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
36215 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
36216 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
36217 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
36218
36219 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36220 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
36221 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
36222 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
36223 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
36224 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
36225 packet).
36226
36227 @end table
36228
36229 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
36230 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
36231 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
36232 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
36233 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
36234 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
36235 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
36236 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
36237
36238 Replies:
36239 @table @samp
36240 @item OK
36241 The packet was understood and carried out.
36242 @item qRelocInsn
36243 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36244 @item @w{}
36245 The packet was not recognized.
36246 @end table
36247
36248 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
36249 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
36250 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
36251 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
36252 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
36253 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
36254 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
36255 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
36256
36257 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
36258 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
36259 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
36260 fit in a single packet.
36261 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
36262 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
36263
36264 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
36265 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
36266 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
36267 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
36268
36269 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
36270 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
36271 query packets.
36272
36273 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
36274 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
36275 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
36276 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
36277 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
36278 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
36279 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
36280 be found.
36281
36282 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
36283 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
36284 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
36285 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
36286 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
36287 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
36288 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
36289 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
36290 mentioned in expressions.
36291
36292 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
36293 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
36294 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
36295 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
36296 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
36297
36298 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
36299 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
36300 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
36301 one of the following forms:
36302
36303 @table @samp
36304 @item F @var{f}
36305 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
36306 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
36307 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
36308
36309 @item T @var{t}
36310 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
36311 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
36312
36313 @end table
36314
36315 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
36316 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36317 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
36318 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
36319
36320 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
36321 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36322 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
36323 is a hexadecimal number.
36324
36325 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
36326 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36327 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
36328 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
36329 numbers.
36330
36331 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
36332 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
36333 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
36334
36335 @item qTMinFTPILen
36336 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
36337 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
36338 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
36339 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
36340 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
36341 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
36342 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
36343 arrange for that.
36344
36345 Replies:
36346
36347 @table @samp
36348 @item 0
36349 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
36350 @item @var{length}
36351 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
36352 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
36353 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
36354 regardless of size.
36355 @item E
36356 An error has occurred.
36357 @item @w{}
36358 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
36359 @end table
36360
36361 @item QTStart
36362 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
36363 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
36364 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
36365 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36366 instruction reply packet}).
36367
36368 @item QTStop
36369 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
36370 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
36371
36372 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36373 @anchor{QTEnable}
36374 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
36375 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36376 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
36377 of data from it will resume.
36378
36379 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36380 @anchor{QTDisable}
36381 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
36382 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36383 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
36384 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
36385
36386 @item QTinit
36387 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
36388 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
36389
36390 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
36391 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
36392 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
36393 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
36394 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
36395
36396 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
36397 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
36398 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
36399 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
36400
36401 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
36402 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
36403 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
36404 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
36405 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
36406 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
36407
36408 @item qTStatus
36409 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
36410 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
36411
36412 The reply has the form:
36413
36414 @table @samp
36415
36416 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
36417 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
36418 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
36419 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
36420
36421 @end table
36422
36423 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
36424 explanations as one of the optional fields:
36425
36426 @table @samp
36427
36428 @item tnotrun:0
36429 No trace has been run yet.
36430
36431 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
36432 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
36433 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
36434 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
36435 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
36436
36437 @item tfull:0
36438 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
36439
36440 @item tdisconnected:0
36441 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
36442
36443 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
36444 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
36445
36446 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
36447 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
36448 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
36449 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
36450 is hex encoded.
36451
36452 @item tunknown:0
36453 The trace stopped for some other reason.
36454
36455 @end table
36456
36457 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
36458 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
36459 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
36460 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
36461 trace.
36462
36463 @table @samp
36464
36465 @item tframes:@var{n}
36466 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
36467
36468 @item tcreated:@var{n}
36469 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
36470 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
36471
36472 @item tsize:@var{n}
36473 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
36474
36475 @item tfree:@var{n}
36476 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
36477
36478 @item circular:@var{n}
36479 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
36480 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
36481 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
36482 and may fill up.
36483
36484 @item disconn:@var{n}
36485 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
36486 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
36487 that the trace run will stop.
36488
36489 @end table
36490
36491 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
36492 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
36493 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
36494 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
36495 address @var{addr}.
36496
36497 Replies:
36498 @table @samp
36499 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
36500 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
36501 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
36502 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
36503 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
36504
36505 @end table
36506
36507 @item qTV:@var{var}
36508 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
36509 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
36510 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
36511
36512 Replies:
36513 @table @samp
36514 @item V@var{value}
36515 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
36516 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
36517 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
36518 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
36519 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
36520 program is running.
36521
36522 @item U
36523 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
36524 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
36525 was not collected.
36526 @end table
36527
36528 @item qTfP
36529 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
36530 @itemx qTsP
36531 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
36532 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
36533 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
36534 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
36535 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
36536 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
36537
36538 @item qTfV
36539 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
36540 @itemx qTsV
36541 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
36542 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
36543 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
36544 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
36545 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
36546 trace state variables.
36547
36548 @item qTfSTM
36549 @itemx qTsSTM
36550 @anchor{qTfSTM}
36551 @anchor{qTsSTM}
36552 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
36553 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
36554 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
36555 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
36556 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
36557 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
36558
36559 Reply:
36560 @table @samp
36561 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
36562 A single marker
36563 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
36564 a comma-separated list of markers
36565 @item l
36566 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36567 @item E @var{nn}
36568 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36569 @item @w{}
36570 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
36571 stub.
36572 @end table
36573
36574 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
36575 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
36576
36577 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36578 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
36579 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
36580 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
36581 @dfn{last}).
36582
36583 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
36584 @anchor{qTSTMat}
36585 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
36586 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
36587 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
36588 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
36589 tracepoint markers.
36590
36591 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
36592 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
36593 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
36594 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
36595 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
36596 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
36597
36598 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
36599 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
36600 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
36601 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
36602 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
36603 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
36604 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
36605 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
36606 available.
36607
36608 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
36609 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
36610 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
36611
36612 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
36613 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
36614 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
36615 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
36616 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
36617 use whatever size it prefers.
36618
36619 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
36620 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
36621 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
36622 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
36623 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
36624
36625 @end table
36626
36627 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
36628 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
36629 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
36630 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
36631 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
36632 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
36633 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
36634 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
36635 it had executed in the original location.
36636
36637 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
36638 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
36639 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
36640 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
36641 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
36642 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
36643 format of the request is:
36644
36645 @table @samp
36646 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
36647
36648 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
36649 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
36650 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
36651 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
36652 memory starting at @var{to}.
36653 @end table
36654
36655 Replies:
36656 @table @samp
36657 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
36658 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
36659 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
36660 @item E @var{NN}
36661 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
36662 relocating the instruction.
36663 @end table
36664
36665 @node Host I/O Packets
36666 @section Host I/O Packets
36667 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
36668 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
36669
36670 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
36671 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
36672 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
36673 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
36674 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
36675 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
36676 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
36677 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
36678 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
36679 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
36680
36681 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
36682 its arguments. They have this format:
36683
36684 @table @samp
36685
36686 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
36687 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
36688 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
36689 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
36690 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
36691 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
36692 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
36693 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
36694 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36695
36696 @end table
36697
36698 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
36699
36700 @table @samp
36701
36702 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
36703 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
36704 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
36705 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
36706 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
36707 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
36708 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
36709 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
36710 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
36711 @var{attachment}.
36712
36713 @item @w{}
36714 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
36715
36716 @end table
36717
36718 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
36719
36720 @table @samp
36721 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
36722 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
36723 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
36724 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
36725 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
36726 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
36727 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
36728
36729 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
36730 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
36731 -1 if an error occurs.
36732
36733 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
36734 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
36735 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
36736 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
36737 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
36738 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
36739 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
36740 @var{count} was zero.
36741
36742 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36743 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36744 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36745 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36746 some characters were escaped.
36747
36748 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
36749 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
36750 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
36751 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
36752 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
36753 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
36754 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
36755 error occurred.
36756
36757 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
36758 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
36759 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
36760
36761 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
36762 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
36763 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
36764
36765 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36766 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36767 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36768 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36769 some characters were escaped.
36770
36771 @end table
36772
36773 @node Interrupts
36774 @section Interrupts
36775 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
36776
36777 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
36778 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
36779 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
36780 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
36781
36782 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
36783 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
36784 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
36785 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
36786 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
36787
36788 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
36789 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
36790 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
36791 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
36792 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
36793 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
36794 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
36795 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
36796
36797 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
36798 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
36799 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
36800
36801 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
36802 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
36803 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
36804 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
36805 currently-executing threads and processes.
36806 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
36807 running program, it should send one of the stop
36808 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
36809 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
36810 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
36811 Interrupts received while the
36812 program is stopped are discarded.
36813
36814 @node Notification Packets
36815 @section Notification Packets
36816 @cindex notification packets
36817 @cindex packets, notification
36818
36819 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
36820 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
36821 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
36822 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
36823 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
36824 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
36825 is not a problem.
36826
36827 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
36828 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
36829 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
36830 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
36831 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
36832 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
36833 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
36834
36835 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
36836 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
36837
36838 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
36839 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
36840 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
36841 not they understand it.
36842
36843 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
36844 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
36845 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
36846 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
36847 recipients.
36848
36849 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
36850 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
36851 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
36852 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
36853 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
36854
36855 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
36856 @table @samp
36857 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
36858 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
36859 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
36860 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
36861 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
36862 @item @var{ack}
36863 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
36864 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
36865 @end table
36866
36867 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
36868 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
36869
36870 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
36871 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
36872 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
36873 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
36874 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
36875 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
36876 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
36877 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
36878 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
36879 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
36880
36881 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
36882 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
36883 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
36884 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
36885 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
36886 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
36887
36888 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
36889 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
36890 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
36891 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
36892 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
36893
36894 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
36895 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
36896 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
36897 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
36898 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
36899 normally.
36900
36901 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
36902 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
36903 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
36904 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
36905 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
36906 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
36907 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
36908 the process shall be repeated.
36909
36910 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
36911 following example:
36912 @smallexample
36913 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
36914 @code{...}
36915 -> @code{vStopped}
36916 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
36917 -> @code{vStopped}
36918 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
36919 -> @code{vStopped}
36920 <- @code{OK}
36921 @end smallexample
36922
36923 The following notifications are defined:
36924 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
36925
36926 @item Notification
36927 @tab Ack
36928 @tab Event
36929 @tab Description
36930
36931 @item Stop
36932 @tab vStopped
36933 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
36934 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
36935 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
36936 @value{GDBN}.
36937 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
36938
36939 @end multitable
36940
36941 @node Remote Non-Stop
36942 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
36943
36944 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
36945 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
36946 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
36947 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36948
36949 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
36950 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
36951 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
36952 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
36953 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
36954 probe the target state after a mode change.
36955
36956 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
36957 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
36958 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
36959 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
36960 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
36961 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
36962 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
36963 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
36964 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
36965 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
36966 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
36967
36968 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
36969 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
36970 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
36971 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
36972 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
36973 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
36974 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
36975 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
36976 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
36977 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
36978 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
36979 @samp{OK}.
36980
36981 @node Packet Acknowledgment
36982 @section Packet Acknowledgment
36983
36984 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
36985 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
36986 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
36987 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36988 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
36989 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
36990 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
36991
36992 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
36993 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
36994 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
36995 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
36996 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
36997
36998 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
36999 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
37000 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
37001 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
37002
37003 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
37004 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
37005 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
37006 @pxref{qSupported}.
37007 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
37008 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
37009 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
37010 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
37011 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
37012 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
37013 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
37014
37015 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
37016 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
37017 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
37018 connection.
37019 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
37020 new connection is established,
37021 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
37022 for the current connection, once disabled.
37023
37024 @node Examples
37025 @section Examples
37026
37027 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
37028 does not get any direct output:
37029
37030 @smallexample
37031 -> @code{R00}
37032 <- @code{+}
37033 @emph{target restarts}
37034 -> @code{?}
37035 <- @code{+}
37036 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37037 -> @code{+}
37038 @end smallexample
37039
37040 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
37041
37042 @smallexample
37043 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
37044 <- @code{+}
37045 -> @code{s}
37046 <- @code{+}
37047 @emph{time passes}
37048 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37049 -> @code{+}
37050 -> @code{g}
37051 <- @code{+}
37052 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
37053 -> @code{+}
37054 @end smallexample
37055
37056 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37057 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37058 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
37059
37060 @menu
37061 * File-I/O Overview::
37062 * Protocol Basics::
37063 * The F Request Packet::
37064 * The F Reply Packet::
37065 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37066 * Console I/O::
37067 * List of Supported Calls::
37068 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37069 * Constants::
37070 * File-I/O Examples::
37071 @end menu
37072
37073 @node File-I/O Overview
37074 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37075 @cindex file-i/o overview
37076
37077 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37078 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37079 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37080 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37081 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37082 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37083
37084 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37085 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37086 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37087 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37088 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37089
37090 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37091 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37092 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37093 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37094 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37095 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37096 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37097
37098 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37099 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37100 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37101 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37102 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37103
37104 @smallexample
37105 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37106 <- target requests 'system call X'
37107 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37108 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37109 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37110 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37111 @end smallexample
37112
37113 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37114 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37115 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37116 system are not supported by this protocol.
37117
37118 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37119
37120 @node Protocol Basics
37121 @subsection Protocol Basics
37122 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37123
37124 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37125 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37126 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37127 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37128 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37129 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37130 to call the appropriate host system call:
37131
37132 @itemize @bullet
37133 @item
37134 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37135
37136 @item
37137 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37138 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37139 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37140 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37141
37142 @end itemize
37143
37144 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37145
37146 @itemize @bullet
37147 @item
37148 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37149 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37150 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37151 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37152 packet.
37153
37154 @item
37155 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37156 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37157
37158 @item
37159 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37160
37161 @item
37162 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
37163
37164 @item
37165 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
37166 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
37167 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
37168 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
37169 packet.
37170
37171 @end itemize
37172
37173 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
37174 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
37175
37176 @itemize @bullet
37177 @item
37178 Return value.
37179
37180 @item
37181 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
37182
37183 @item
37184 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
37185
37186 @end itemize
37187
37188 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
37189 the latest continue or step action.
37190
37191 @node The F Request Packet
37192 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
37193 @cindex file-i/o request packet
37194 @cindex @code{F} request packet
37195
37196 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
37197
37198 @table @samp
37199 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
37200
37201 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
37202 This is just the name of the function.
37203
37204 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
37205 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
37206 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
37207 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
37208 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
37209 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
37210 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
37211
37212 @end table
37213
37214
37215
37216 @node The F Reply Packet
37217 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
37218 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
37219 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
37220
37221 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
37222
37223 @table @samp
37224
37225 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
37226
37227 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
37228
37229 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
37230 representation.
37231 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
37232
37233 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
37234 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
37235 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
37236
37237 @smallexample
37238 F0,0,C
37239 @end smallexample
37240
37241 @noindent
37242 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
37243
37244 @smallexample
37245 F-1,4,C
37246 @end smallexample
37247
37248 @noindent
37249 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
37250
37251 @end table
37252
37253
37254 @node The Ctrl-C Message
37255 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
37256 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
37257
37258 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
37259 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
37260 the target should behave as if it had
37261 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
37262 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
37263 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
37264 packet.
37265
37266 It's important for the target to know in which
37267 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
37268
37269 @itemize @bullet
37270 @item
37271 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
37272
37273 @item
37274 The system call on the host has been finished.
37275
37276 @end itemize
37277
37278 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
37279 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
37280 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
37281 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
37282 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
37283 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
37284
37285 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
37286 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
37287 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
37288 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
37289 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
37290 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
37291 or the full action has been completed.
37292
37293 @node Console I/O
37294 @subsection Console I/O
37295 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
37296
37297 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
37298 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
37299 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
37300 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
37301 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
37302 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
37303 conditions is met:
37304
37305 @itemize @bullet
37306 @item
37307 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
37308 @code{read}
37309 system call is treated as finished.
37310
37311 @item
37312 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
37313 newline.
37314
37315 @item
37316 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
37317 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
37318
37319 @end itemize
37320
37321 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
37322 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
37323 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
37324 is stopped at the user's request.
37325
37326
37327 @node List of Supported Calls
37328 @subsection List of Supported Calls
37329 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
37330
37331 @menu
37332 * open::
37333 * close::
37334 * read::
37335 * write::
37336 * lseek::
37337 * rename::
37338 * unlink::
37339 * stat/fstat::
37340 * gettimeofday::
37341 * isatty::
37342 * system::
37343 @end menu
37344
37345 @node open
37346 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
37347 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
37348
37349 @table @asis
37350 @item Synopsis:
37351 @smallexample
37352 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
37353 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
37354 @end smallexample
37355
37356 @item Request:
37357 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
37358
37359 @noindent
37360 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37361
37362 @table @code
37363 @item O_CREAT
37364 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
37365 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
37366 are concerned.
37367
37368 @item O_EXCL
37369 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
37370 an error and open() fails.
37371
37372 @item O_TRUNC
37373 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
37374 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
37375 truncated to zero length.
37376
37377 @item O_APPEND
37378 The file is opened in append mode.
37379
37380 @item O_RDONLY
37381 The file is opened for reading only.
37382
37383 @item O_WRONLY
37384 The file is opened for writing only.
37385
37386 @item O_RDWR
37387 The file is opened for reading and writing.
37388 @end table
37389
37390 @noindent
37391 Other bits are silently ignored.
37392
37393
37394 @noindent
37395 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37396
37397 @table @code
37398 @item S_IRUSR
37399 User has read permission.
37400
37401 @item S_IWUSR
37402 User has write permission.
37403
37404 @item S_IRGRP
37405 Group has read permission.
37406
37407 @item S_IWGRP
37408 Group has write permission.
37409
37410 @item S_IROTH
37411 Others have read permission.
37412
37413 @item S_IWOTH
37414 Others have write permission.
37415 @end table
37416
37417 @noindent
37418 Other bits are silently ignored.
37419
37420
37421 @item Return value:
37422 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
37423 occurred.
37424
37425 @item Errors:
37426
37427 @table @code
37428 @item EEXIST
37429 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
37430
37431 @item EISDIR
37432 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
37433
37434 @item EACCES
37435 The requested access is not allowed.
37436
37437 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37438 @var{pathname} was too long.
37439
37440 @item ENOENT
37441 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37442
37443 @item ENODEV
37444 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
37445
37446 @item EROFS
37447 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
37448 write access was requested.
37449
37450 @item EFAULT
37451 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
37452
37453 @item ENOSPC
37454 No space on device to create the file.
37455
37456 @item EMFILE
37457 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
37458
37459 @item ENFILE
37460 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
37461 has been reached.
37462
37463 @item EINTR
37464 The call was interrupted by the user.
37465 @end table
37466
37467 @end table
37468
37469 @node close
37470 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
37471 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
37472
37473 @table @asis
37474 @item Synopsis:
37475 @smallexample
37476 int close(int fd);
37477 @end smallexample
37478
37479 @item Request:
37480 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
37481
37482 @item Return value:
37483 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
37484
37485 @item Errors:
37486
37487 @table @code
37488 @item EBADF
37489 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
37490
37491 @item EINTR
37492 The call was interrupted by the user.
37493 @end table
37494
37495 @end table
37496
37497 @node read
37498 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
37499 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
37500
37501 @table @asis
37502 @item Synopsis:
37503 @smallexample
37504 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
37505 @end smallexample
37506
37507 @item Request:
37508 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37509
37510 @item Return value:
37511 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
37512 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
37513 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
37514
37515 @item Errors:
37516
37517 @table @code
37518 @item EBADF
37519 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37520 reading.
37521
37522 @item EFAULT
37523 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37524
37525 @item EINTR
37526 The call was interrupted by the user.
37527 @end table
37528
37529 @end table
37530
37531 @node write
37532 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
37533 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
37534
37535 @table @asis
37536 @item Synopsis:
37537 @smallexample
37538 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
37539 @end smallexample
37540
37541 @item Request:
37542 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37543
37544 @item Return value:
37545 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
37546 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
37547 is returned.
37548
37549 @item Errors:
37550
37551 @table @code
37552 @item EBADF
37553 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37554 writing.
37555
37556 @item EFAULT
37557 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37558
37559 @item EFBIG
37560 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
37561 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
37562
37563 @item ENOSPC
37564 No space on device to write the data.
37565
37566 @item EINTR
37567 The call was interrupted by the user.
37568 @end table
37569
37570 @end table
37571
37572 @node lseek
37573 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
37574 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
37575
37576 @table @asis
37577 @item Synopsis:
37578 @smallexample
37579 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
37580 @end smallexample
37581
37582 @item Request:
37583 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
37584
37585 @var{flag} is one of:
37586
37587 @table @code
37588 @item SEEK_SET
37589 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
37590
37591 @item SEEK_CUR
37592 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
37593 bytes.
37594
37595 @item SEEK_END
37596 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
37597 bytes.
37598 @end table
37599
37600 @item Return value:
37601 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
37602 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
37603 value of -1 is returned.
37604
37605 @item Errors:
37606
37607 @table @code
37608 @item EBADF
37609 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
37610
37611 @item ESPIPE
37612 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
37613
37614 @item EINVAL
37615 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
37616
37617 @item EINTR
37618 The call was interrupted by the user.
37619 @end table
37620
37621 @end table
37622
37623 @node rename
37624 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
37625 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
37626
37627 @table @asis
37628 @item Synopsis:
37629 @smallexample
37630 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
37631 @end smallexample
37632
37633 @item Request:
37634 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
37635
37636 @item Return value:
37637 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37638
37639 @item Errors:
37640
37641 @table @code
37642 @item EISDIR
37643 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
37644 directory.
37645
37646 @item EEXIST
37647 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
37648
37649 @item EBUSY
37650 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
37651 process.
37652
37653 @item EINVAL
37654 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
37655 of itself.
37656
37657 @item ENOTDIR
37658 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
37659 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
37660 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
37661
37662 @item EFAULT
37663 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
37664
37665 @item EACCES
37666 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37667
37668 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37669
37670 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
37671
37672 @item ENOENT
37673 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
37674
37675 @item EROFS
37676 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37677
37678 @item ENOSPC
37679 The device containing the file has no room for the new
37680 directory entry.
37681
37682 @item EINTR
37683 The call was interrupted by the user.
37684 @end table
37685
37686 @end table
37687
37688 @node unlink
37689 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
37690 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
37691
37692 @table @asis
37693 @item Synopsis:
37694 @smallexample
37695 int unlink(const char *pathname);
37696 @end smallexample
37697
37698 @item Request:
37699 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
37700
37701 @item Return value:
37702 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37703
37704 @item Errors:
37705
37706 @table @code
37707 @item EACCES
37708 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37709
37710 @item EPERM
37711 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
37712
37713 @item EBUSY
37714 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
37715 being used by another process.
37716
37717 @item EFAULT
37718 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37719
37720 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37721 @var{pathname} was too long.
37722
37723 @item ENOENT
37724 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37725
37726 @item ENOTDIR
37727 A component of the path is not a directory.
37728
37729 @item EROFS
37730 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37731
37732 @item EINTR
37733 The call was interrupted by the user.
37734 @end table
37735
37736 @end table
37737
37738 @node stat/fstat
37739 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
37740 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
37741 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
37742
37743 @table @asis
37744 @item Synopsis:
37745 @smallexample
37746 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
37747 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
37748 @end smallexample
37749
37750 @item Request:
37751 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
37752 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
37753
37754 @item Return value:
37755 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37756
37757 @item Errors:
37758
37759 @table @code
37760 @item EBADF
37761 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
37762
37763 @item ENOENT
37764 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
37765 path is an empty string.
37766
37767 @item ENOTDIR
37768 A component of the path is not a directory.
37769
37770 @item EFAULT
37771 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37772
37773 @item EACCES
37774 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37775
37776 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37777 @var{pathname} was too long.
37778
37779 @item EINTR
37780 The call was interrupted by the user.
37781 @end table
37782
37783 @end table
37784
37785 @node gettimeofday
37786 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
37787 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
37788
37789 @table @asis
37790 @item Synopsis:
37791 @smallexample
37792 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
37793 @end smallexample
37794
37795 @item Request:
37796 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
37797
37798 @item Return value:
37799 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
37800
37801 @item Errors:
37802
37803 @table @code
37804 @item EINVAL
37805 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
37806
37807 @item EFAULT
37808 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37809 @end table
37810
37811 @end table
37812
37813 @node isatty
37814 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
37815 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
37816
37817 @table @asis
37818 @item Synopsis:
37819 @smallexample
37820 int isatty(int fd);
37821 @end smallexample
37822
37823 @item Request:
37824 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
37825
37826 @item Return value:
37827 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
37828
37829 @item Errors:
37830
37831 @table @code
37832 @item EINTR
37833 The call was interrupted by the user.
37834 @end table
37835
37836 @end table
37837
37838 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
37839 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
37840 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
37841 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
37842 needed.
37843
37844
37845 @node system
37846 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
37847 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
37848
37849 @table @asis
37850 @item Synopsis:
37851 @smallexample
37852 int system(const char *command);
37853 @end smallexample
37854
37855 @item Request:
37856 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
37857
37858 @item Return value:
37859 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
37860 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
37861 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
37862 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
37863 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
37864 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
37865 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
37866
37867 @item Errors:
37868
37869 @table @code
37870 @item EINTR
37871 The call was interrupted by the user.
37872 @end table
37873
37874 @end table
37875
37876 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
37877 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
37878 the host is simplified before it's returned
37879 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
37880 is discarded, and the return value consists
37881 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
37882
37883 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
37884 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
37885 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
37886
37887 @table @code
37888 @item set remote system-call-allowed
37889 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
37890 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
37891 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
37892
37893 @item show remote system-call-allowed
37894 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
37895 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
37896 protocol.
37897 @end table
37898
37899 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37900 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37901 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37902
37903 @menu
37904 * Integral Datatypes::
37905 * Pointer Values::
37906 * Memory Transfer::
37907 * struct stat::
37908 * struct timeval::
37909 @end menu
37910
37911 @node Integral Datatypes
37912 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
37913 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37914
37915 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
37916 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
37917 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
37918
37919 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
37920 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
37921
37922 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
37923
37924 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
37925 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
37926
37927 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
37928
37929 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
37930 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
37931 byte order.
37932
37933 @node Pointer Values
37934 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
37935 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
37936
37937 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
37938 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
37939 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
37940 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
37941
37942 @smallexample
37943 @code{1aaf/12}
37944 @end smallexample
37945
37946 @noindent
37947 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
37948 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
37949 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
37950 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
37951
37952 @smallexample
37953 @code{123456/d}
37954 @end smallexample
37955
37956 @node Memory Transfer
37957 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
37958 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
37959
37960 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
37961 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
37962 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
37963 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
37964 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
37965 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
37966 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
37967
37968
37969 @node struct stat
37970 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
37971 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
37972
37973 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
37974 is defined as follows:
37975
37976 @smallexample
37977 struct stat @{
37978 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
37979 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
37980 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
37981 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
37982 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
37983 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
37984 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
37985 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
37986 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
37987 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
37988 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
37989 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
37990 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
37991 @};
37992 @end smallexample
37993
37994 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
37995 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
37996 structure is of size 64 bytes.
37997
37998 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
37999 range of values.
38000
38001 @table @code
38002
38003 @item st_dev
38004 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
38005
38006 @item st_ino
38007 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38008
38009 @item st_mode
38010 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
38011 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
38012
38013 @item st_uid
38014 @itemx st_gid
38015 @itemx st_rdev
38016 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38017
38018 @item st_atime
38019 @itemx st_mtime
38020 @itemx st_ctime
38021 These values have a host and file system dependent
38022 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
38023 support exact timing values.
38024 @end table
38025
38026 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
38027 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
38028 continuing.
38029
38030 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
38031 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
38032 get truncated on the target.
38033
38034 @node struct timeval
38035 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
38036 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
38037
38038 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
38039 is defined as follows:
38040
38041 @smallexample
38042 struct timeval @{
38043 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
38044 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
38045 @};
38046 @end smallexample
38047
38048 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38049 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38050 structure is of size 8 bytes.
38051
38052 @node Constants
38053 @subsection Constants
38054 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
38055
38056 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
38057 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
38058 values before and after the call as needed.
38059
38060 @menu
38061 * Open Flags::
38062 * mode_t Values::
38063 * Errno Values::
38064 * Lseek Flags::
38065 * Limits::
38066 @end menu
38067
38068 @node Open Flags
38069 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38070 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38071
38072 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38073
38074 @smallexample
38075 O_RDONLY 0x0
38076 O_WRONLY 0x1
38077 O_RDWR 0x2
38078 O_APPEND 0x8
38079 O_CREAT 0x200
38080 O_TRUNC 0x400
38081 O_EXCL 0x800
38082 @end smallexample
38083
38084 @node mode_t Values
38085 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38086 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38087
38088 All values are given in octal representation.
38089
38090 @smallexample
38091 S_IFREG 0100000
38092 S_IFDIR 040000
38093 S_IRUSR 0400
38094 S_IWUSR 0200
38095 S_IXUSR 0100
38096 S_IRGRP 040
38097 S_IWGRP 020
38098 S_IXGRP 010
38099 S_IROTH 04
38100 S_IWOTH 02
38101 S_IXOTH 01
38102 @end smallexample
38103
38104 @node Errno Values
38105 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38106 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38107
38108 All values are given in decimal representation.
38109
38110 @smallexample
38111 EPERM 1
38112 ENOENT 2
38113 EINTR 4
38114 EBADF 9
38115 EACCES 13
38116 EFAULT 14
38117 EBUSY 16
38118 EEXIST 17
38119 ENODEV 19
38120 ENOTDIR 20
38121 EISDIR 21
38122 EINVAL 22
38123 ENFILE 23
38124 EMFILE 24
38125 EFBIG 27
38126 ENOSPC 28
38127 ESPIPE 29
38128 EROFS 30
38129 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38130 EUNKNOWN 9999
38131 @end smallexample
38132
38133 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38134 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38135
38136 @node Lseek Flags
38137 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38138 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38139
38140 @smallexample
38141 SEEK_SET 0
38142 SEEK_CUR 1
38143 SEEK_END 2
38144 @end smallexample
38145
38146 @node Limits
38147 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38148 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38149
38150 All values are given in decimal representation.
38151
38152 @smallexample
38153 INT_MIN -2147483648
38154 INT_MAX 2147483647
38155 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38156 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38157 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38158 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38159 @end smallexample
38160
38161 @node File-I/O Examples
38162 @subsection File-I/O Examples
38163 @cindex file-i/o examples
38164
38165 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38166 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
38167
38168 @smallexample
38169 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
38170 @emph{request memory read from target}
38171 -> @code{m1234,6}
38172 <- XXXXXX
38173 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
38174 -> @code{F6}
38175 @end smallexample
38176
38177 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38178 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
38179
38180 @smallexample
38181 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38182 @emph{request memory write to target}
38183 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38184 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
38185 -> @code{F6}
38186 @end smallexample
38187
38188 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
38189 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
38190
38191 @smallexample
38192 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38193 -> @code{F-1,9}
38194 @end smallexample
38195
38196 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
38197 host is called:
38198
38199 @smallexample
38200 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38201 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
38202 <- @code{T02}
38203 @end smallexample
38204
38205 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
38206 host is called:
38207
38208 @smallexample
38209 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38210 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38211 <- @code{T02}
38212 @end smallexample
38213
38214 @node Library List Format
38215 @section Library List Format
38216 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38217
38218 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
38219 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
38220 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
38221 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
38222 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
38223 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
38224 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38225 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
38226 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
38227 are loaded.
38228
38229 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
38230 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
38231 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
38232 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
38233
38234 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
38235 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
38236 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
38237 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
38238 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
38239 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
38240
38241 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38242 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38243
38244 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
38245 offset, looks like this:
38246
38247 @smallexample
38248 <library-list>
38249 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
38250 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
38251 </library>
38252 </library-list>
38253 @end smallexample
38254
38255 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
38256 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
38257
38258 @smallexample
38259 <library-list>
38260 <library name="sharedlib.o">
38261 <section address="0x10000000"/>
38262 <section address="0x20000000"/>
38263 <section address="0x30000000"/>
38264 </library>
38265 </library-list>
38266 @end smallexample
38267
38268 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
38269
38270 @smallexample
38271 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
38272 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
38273 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38274 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
38275 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38276 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
38277 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38278 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
38279 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38280 @end smallexample
38281
38282 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
38283 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
38284 section for each library.
38285
38286 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38287 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38288 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38289
38290 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
38291 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
38292 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
38293 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
38294
38295 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
38296 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
38297 target, the following parameters are reported:
38298
38299 @itemize @minus
38300 @item
38301 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
38302 @code{struct link_map}.
38303 @item
38304 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
38305 (Thread Local Storage) access.
38306 @item
38307 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
38308 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
38309 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
38310 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
38311 @item
38312 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
38313 @end itemize
38314
38315 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
38316 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
38317 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
38318
38319 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38320 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38321
38322 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
38323 looks like this:
38324
38325 @smallexample
38326 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
38327 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
38328 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
38329 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
38330 l_ld="0x152350"/>
38331 </library-list-svr>
38332 @end smallexample
38333
38334 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
38335
38336 @smallexample
38337 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
38338 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
38339 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38340 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
38341 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
38342 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38343 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
38344 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
38345 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
38346 @end smallexample
38347
38348 @node Memory Map Format
38349 @section Memory Map Format
38350 @cindex memory map format
38351
38352 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
38353 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
38354 memory map.
38355
38356 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38357 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
38358 lists memory regions.
38359
38360 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38361 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
38362
38363 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38364
38365 @smallexample
38366 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38367 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
38368 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38369 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
38370 <memory-map>
38371 region...
38372 </memory-map>
38373 @end smallexample
38374
38375 Each region can be either:
38376
38377 @itemize
38378
38379 @item
38380 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
38381 bytes from there:
38382
38383 @smallexample
38384 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38385 @end smallexample
38386
38387
38388 @item
38389 A region of read-only memory:
38390
38391 @smallexample
38392 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38393 @end smallexample
38394
38395
38396 @item
38397 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
38398 bytes in length:
38399
38400 @smallexample
38401 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
38402 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
38403 </memory>
38404 @end smallexample
38405
38406 @end itemize
38407
38408 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
38409 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
38410 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
38411
38412 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
38413
38414 @smallexample
38415 <!-- ................................................... -->
38416 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
38417 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
38418 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
38419 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
38420 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
38421 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
38422 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
38423 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
38424 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
38425 and its type, or device. -->
38426 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
38427 start CDATA #REQUIRED
38428 length CDATA #REQUIRED
38429 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
38430 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
38431 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
38432 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38433 @end smallexample
38434
38435 @node Thread List Format
38436 @section Thread List Format
38437 @cindex thread list format
38438
38439 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
38440 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38441 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
38442 the following structure:
38443
38444 @smallexample
38445 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38446 <threads>
38447 <thread id="id" core="0">
38448 ... description ...
38449 </thread>
38450 </threads>
38451 @end smallexample
38452
38453 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
38454 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
38455 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
38456 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
38457 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
38458
38459 @node Traceframe Info Format
38460 @section Traceframe Info Format
38461 @cindex traceframe info format
38462
38463 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
38464 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
38465 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
38466 collected in a traceframe.
38467
38468 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38469 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
38470
38471 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38472 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38473
38474 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38475
38476 @smallexample
38477 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38478 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
38479 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38480 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
38481 <traceframe-info>
38482 block...
38483 </traceframe-info>
38484 @end smallexample
38485
38486 Each traceframe block can be either:
38487
38488 @itemize
38489
38490 @item
38491 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
38492 @var{length} bytes from there:
38493
38494 @smallexample
38495 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38496 @end smallexample
38497
38498 @item
38499 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
38500 collected:
38501
38502 @smallexample
38503 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
38504 @end smallexample
38505
38506 @end itemize
38507
38508 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
38509
38510 @smallexample
38511 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
38512 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38513
38514 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
38515 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
38516 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
38517 <!ELEMENT tvar>
38518 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
38519 @end smallexample
38520
38521 @node Branch Trace Format
38522 @section Branch Trace Format
38523 @cindex branch trace format
38524
38525 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
38526 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
38527 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
38528 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
38529
38530 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38531 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
38532
38533 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38534 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38535
38536 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38537
38538 @smallexample
38539 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38540 <!DOCTYPE btrace
38541 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
38542 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
38543 <btrace>
38544 block...
38545 </btrace>
38546 @end smallexample
38547
38548 @itemize
38549
38550 @item
38551 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
38552 and ending at @var{end}:
38553
38554 @smallexample
38555 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
38556 @end smallexample
38557
38558 @end itemize
38559
38560 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
38561
38562 @smallexample
38563 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
38564 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38565
38566 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
38567 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
38568 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
38569 @end smallexample
38570
38571 @include agentexpr.texi
38572
38573 @node Target Descriptions
38574 @appendix Target Descriptions
38575 @cindex target descriptions
38576
38577 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
38578 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
38579 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
38580 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
38581 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
38582 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
38583 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
38584
38585 @itemize @bullet
38586 @item
38587 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
38588 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
38589 @item
38590 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
38591 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
38592 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
38593 @item
38594 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
38595 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
38596 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
38597 @end itemize
38598
38599 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
38600 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
38601 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
38602 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
38603 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
38604
38605 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38606 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
38607
38608 @menu
38609 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
38610 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
38611 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
38612 descriptions.
38613 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
38614 @end menu
38615
38616 @node Retrieving Descriptions
38617 @section Retrieving Descriptions
38618
38619 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
38620 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
38621 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
38622 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
38623 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
38624 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
38625 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
38626 Format}.
38627
38628 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
38629 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
38630 specify a file are:
38631
38632 @table @code
38633 @cindex set tdesc filename
38634 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
38635 Read the target description from @var{path}.
38636
38637 @cindex unset tdesc filename
38638 @item unset tdesc filename
38639 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
38640 will use the description supplied by the current target.
38641
38642 @cindex show tdesc filename
38643 @item show tdesc filename
38644 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
38645 @end table
38646
38647
38648 @node Target Description Format
38649 @section Target Description Format
38650 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
38651
38652 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
38653 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
38654 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
38655 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
38656 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
38657 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
38658 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
38659
38660 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
38661 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
38662 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
38663 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
38664 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
38665
38666 Here is a simple target description:
38667
38668 @smallexample
38669 <target version="1.0">
38670 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
38671 </target>
38672 @end smallexample
38673
38674 @noindent
38675 This minimal description only says that the target uses
38676 the x86-64 architecture.
38677
38678 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
38679 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
38680 are explained further below.
38681
38682 @smallexample
38683 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38684 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
38685 <target version="1.0">
38686 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
38687 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
38688 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
38689 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
38690 </target>
38691 @end smallexample
38692
38693 @noindent
38694 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
38695 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
38696 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
38697 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
38698 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
38699 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
38700 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
38701 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
38702 the version mismatch.
38703
38704 @subsection Inclusion
38705 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
38706 @cindex XInclude
38707 @ifnotinfo
38708 @cindex <xi:include>
38709 @end ifnotinfo
38710
38711 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
38712 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
38713 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
38714 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
38715 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
38716
38717 @smallexample
38718 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
38719 @end smallexample
38720
38721 @noindent
38722 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
38723 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
38724 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
38725 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
38726 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
38727 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
38728 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
38729 original description.
38730
38731 @subsection Architecture
38732 @cindex <architecture>
38733
38734 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
38735
38736 @smallexample
38737 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
38738 @end smallexample
38739
38740 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38741 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38742
38743 @subsection OS ABI
38744 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
38745
38746 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38747 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38748
38749 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
38750
38751 @smallexample
38752 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
38753 @end smallexample
38754
38755 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
38756 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
38757
38758 @subsection Compatible Architecture
38759 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
38760
38761 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38762 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38763
38764 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
38765
38766 @smallexample
38767 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
38768 @end smallexample
38769
38770 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38771 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38772
38773 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
38774 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
38775 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
38776 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
38777 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
38778 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
38779 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
38780
38781 @smallexample
38782 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
38783 <compatible>spu</compatible>
38784 @end smallexample
38785
38786 @subsection Features
38787 @cindex <feature>
38788
38789 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
38790 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
38791 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
38792 has this form:
38793
38794 @smallexample
38795 <feature name="@var{name}">
38796 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
38797 @var{reg}@dots{}
38798 </feature>
38799 @end smallexample
38800
38801 @noindent
38802 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
38803 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
38804 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
38805 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
38806
38807 @subsection Types
38808
38809 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
38810 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
38811 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
38812 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
38813 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
38814
38815 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
38816 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
38817 Types must be defined before they are used.
38818
38819 @cindex <vector>
38820 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
38821 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
38822 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
38823 @var{count}:
38824
38825 @smallexample
38826 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
38827 @end smallexample
38828
38829 @cindex <union>
38830 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
38831 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
38832 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
38833 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
38834
38835 @smallexample
38836 <union id="@var{id}">
38837 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38838 @dots{}
38839 </union>
38840 @end smallexample
38841
38842 @cindex <struct>
38843 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
38844 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
38845 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
38846 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
38847 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
38848 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
38849 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
38850 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
38851
38852 @smallexample
38853 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38854 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38855 @dots{}
38856 </struct>
38857 @end smallexample
38858
38859 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
38860 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
38861
38862 @smallexample
38863 <struct id="@var{id}">
38864 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38865 @dots{}
38866 </struct>
38867 @end smallexample
38868
38869 @cindex <flags>
38870 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
38871 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
38872 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
38873 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
38874 are supported.
38875
38876 @smallexample
38877 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38878 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38879 @dots{}
38880 </flags>
38881 @end smallexample
38882
38883 @subsection Registers
38884 @cindex <reg>
38885
38886 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
38887
38888 @smallexample
38889 <reg name="@var{name}"
38890 bitsize="@var{size}"
38891 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
38892 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
38893 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
38894 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
38895 @end smallexample
38896
38897 @noindent
38898 The components are as follows:
38899
38900 @table @var
38901
38902 @item name
38903 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
38904
38905 @item bitsize
38906 The register's size, in bits.
38907
38908 @item regnum
38909 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
38910 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
38911 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
38912 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
38913 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
38914 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
38915 in order of increasing register number.
38916
38917 @item save-restore
38918 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
38919 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
38920 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
38921 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
38922 ABI.
38923
38924 @item type
38925 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
38926 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
38927 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
38928 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
38929 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
38930 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
38931
38932 @item group
38933 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
38934 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
38935 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
38936 in @code{info registers}.
38937
38938 @end table
38939
38940 @node Predefined Target Types
38941 @section Predefined Target Types
38942 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
38943
38944 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
38945 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
38946 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
38947 types. The currently supported types are:
38948
38949 @table @code
38950
38951 @item int8
38952 @itemx int16
38953 @itemx int32
38954 @itemx int64
38955 @itemx int128
38956 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
38957
38958 @item uint8
38959 @itemx uint16
38960 @itemx uint32
38961 @itemx uint64
38962 @itemx uint128
38963 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
38964
38965 @item code_ptr
38966 @itemx data_ptr
38967 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
38968 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
38969 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
38970 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
38971 may be marked as data pointers.
38972
38973 @item ieee_single
38974 Single precision IEEE floating point.
38975
38976 @item ieee_double
38977 Double precision IEEE floating point.
38978
38979 @item arm_fpa_ext
38980 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
38981
38982 @item i387_ext
38983 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
38984
38985 @item i386_eflags
38986 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
38987
38988 @item i386_mxcsr
38989 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
38990
38991 @end table
38992
38993 @node Standard Target Features
38994 @section Standard Target Features
38995 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
38996
38997 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
38998 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
38999 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
39000 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
39001 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
39002 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
39003 can recognize them.
39004
39005 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
39006 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
39007 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
39008 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
39009 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
39010 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
39011 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
39012 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
39013
39014 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
39015 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
39016 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
39017
39018 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
39019 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
39020 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
39021 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
39022
39023 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
39024 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
39025 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
39026
39027 @menu
39028 * AArch64 Features::
39029 * ARM Features::
39030 * i386 Features::
39031 * MicroBlaze Features::
39032 * MIPS Features::
39033 * M68K Features::
39034 * Nios II Features::
39035 * PowerPC Features::
39036 * S/390 and System z Features::
39037 * TIC6x Features::
39038 @end menu
39039
39040
39041 @node AArch64 Features
39042 @subsection AArch64 Features
39043 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
39044
39045 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
39046 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
39047 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39048
39049 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
39050 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
39051 and @samp{fpcr}.
39052
39053 @node ARM Features
39054 @subsection ARM Features
39055 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
39056
39057 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
39058 ARM targets.
39059 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
39060 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39061
39062 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
39063 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39064 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39065 and @samp{xpsr}.
39066
39067 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39068 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39069
39070 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39071 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39072 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39073 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39074
39075 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39076 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39077 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39078 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39079 halves of the double-precision registers.
39080
39081 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39082 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39083 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39084 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39085 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39086 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39087
39088 @node i386 Features
39089 @subsection i386 Features
39090 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39091
39092 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39093 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39094
39095 @itemize @minus
39096 @item
39097 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39098 @item
39099 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39100 @item
39101 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39102 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39103 @item
39104 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39105 @item
39106 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39107 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39108 @end itemize
39109
39110 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39111
39112 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39113 describe registers:
39114
39115 @itemize @minus
39116 @item
39117 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39118 @item
39119 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39120 @item
39121 @samp{mxcsr}
39122 @end itemize
39123
39124 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39125 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39126 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39127
39128 @itemize @minus
39129 @item
39130 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
39131 @item
39132 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
39133 @end itemize
39134
39135 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
39136 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
39137
39138 @itemize @minus
39139 @item
39140 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
39141 @item
39142 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
39143 @end itemize
39144
39145 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
39146 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
39147
39148 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
39149 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
39150 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
39151
39152 @itemize @minus
39153 @item
39154 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39155 @end itemize
39156
39157 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
39158
39159 @itemize @minus
39160 @item
39161 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39162 @end itemize
39163
39164 It should
39165 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
39166
39167 @itemize @minus
39168 @item
39169 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
39170 @item
39171 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
39172 @end itemize
39173
39174 It should
39175 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
39176
39177 @itemize @minus
39178 @item
39179 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39180 @end itemize
39181
39182 @node MicroBlaze Features
39183 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
39184 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
39185
39186 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
39187 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39188 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
39189 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
39190 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
39191
39192 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
39193 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
39194
39195 @node MIPS Features
39196 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
39197 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
39198
39199 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
39200 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
39201 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
39202 on the target.
39203
39204 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
39205 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
39206 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39207
39208 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
39209 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
39210 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
39211 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39212
39213 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
39214 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
39215 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
39216 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39217
39218 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
39219 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
39220 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
39221
39222 @node M68K Features
39223 @subsection M68K Features
39224 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
39225
39226 @table @code
39227 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
39228 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
39229 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
39230 One of those features must be always present.
39231 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
39232 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
39233 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
39234 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
39235
39236 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
39237 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
39238 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
39239 @samp{fpiaddr}.
39240 @end table
39241
39242 @node Nios II Features
39243 @subsection Nios II Features
39244 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
39245
39246 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
39247 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
39248 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
39249 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
39250 @samp{mpuacc}).
39251
39252 @node PowerPC Features
39253 @subsection PowerPC Features
39254 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
39255
39256 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
39257 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39258 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
39259 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39260
39261 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
39262 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
39263
39264 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
39265 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
39266 and @samp{vrsave}.
39267
39268 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
39269 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
39270 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
39271 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
39272 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
39273 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
39274
39275 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
39276 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
39277 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
39278 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
39279 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
39280 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
39281 user.
39282
39283 @node S/390 and System z Features
39284 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
39285 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
39286 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
39287
39288 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
39289 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
39290 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
39291 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
39292 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
39293 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
39294 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
39295 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
39296 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
39297
39298 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
39299 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
39300 @samp{fpc}.
39301
39302 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
39303 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
39304
39305 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
39306 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
39307 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
39308 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
39309 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
39310 32-bit wide.
39311
39312 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
39313 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
39314 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
39315
39316 @node TIC6x Features
39317 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
39318 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
39319 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
39320 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
39321 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
39322 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
39323
39324 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
39325 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
39326 through @samp{B31}.
39327
39328 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
39329 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
39330
39331 @node Operating System Information
39332 @appendix Operating System Information
39333 @cindex operating system information
39334
39335 @menu
39336 * Process list::
39337 @end menu
39338
39339 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
39340 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
39341 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
39342 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
39343 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
39344 on a different aspect of target.
39345
39346 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
39347 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
39348 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
39349 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
39350
39351 @node Process list
39352 @appendixsection Process list
39353 @cindex operating system information, process list
39354
39355 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
39356 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
39357 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
39358 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
39359
39360 An example document is:
39361
39362 @smallexample
39363 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39364 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
39365 <osdata type="processes">
39366 <item>
39367 <column name="pid">1</column>
39368 <column name="user">root</column>
39369 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
39370 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
39371 </item>
39372 </osdata>
39373 @end smallexample
39374
39375 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
39376 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
39377 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
39378 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
39379 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
39380 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
39381 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
39382
39383 @node Trace File Format
39384 @appendix Trace File Format
39385 @cindex trace file format
39386
39387 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
39388 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
39389
39390 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
39391 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
39392 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
39393 in the future.
39394
39395 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
39396 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
39397 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
39398 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
39399 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
39400 of this section.
39401
39402 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
39403
39404 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
39405 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
39406 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
39407 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
39408 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
39409 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
39410 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
39411 endianness.
39412
39413 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
39414
39415 @table @code
39416 @item R @var{bytes}
39417 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
39418 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
39419 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
39420 hexadecimal encoding.
39421
39422 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
39423 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
39424 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
39425 @var{length} bytes.
39426
39427 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
39428 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
39429 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
39430
39431 @end table
39432
39433 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
39434 of blocks.
39435
39436 @node Index Section Format
39437 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
39438 @cindex .gdb_index section format
39439 @cindex index section format
39440
39441 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
39442 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
39443 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
39444 description.
39445
39446 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
39447 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
39448 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
39449 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
39450 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
39451 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
39452
39453 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
39454
39455 @enumerate
39456 @item
39457 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
39458 unless otherwise noted:
39459
39460 @enumerate
39461 @item
39462 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
39463 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
39464 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
39465 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
39466 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
39467 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
39468 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
39469
39470 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
39471 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
39472 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
39473 currently not flagged as deprecated.
39474
39475 @item
39476 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
39477
39478 @item
39479 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
39480 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
39481 to the next offset.
39482
39483 @item
39484 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
39485
39486 @item
39487 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
39488
39489 @item
39490 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
39491 @end enumerate
39492
39493 @item
39494 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
39495 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
39496 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
39497 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
39498 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
39499 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
39500 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
39501 CU indices.
39502
39503 @item
39504 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
39505 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
39506 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
39507 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
39508
39509 @item
39510 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
39511 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
39512
39513 @enumerate
39514 @item
39515 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
39516
39517 @item
39518 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
39519 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
39520
39521 @item
39522 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
39523 @end enumerate
39524
39525 @item
39526 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
39527 the hash table is always a power of 2.
39528
39529 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
39530 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
39531 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
39532 constant pool.
39533
39534 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
39535 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
39536 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
39537
39538 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
39539 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
39540 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
39541 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
39542 index version:
39543
39544 @table @asis
39545 @item Version 4
39546 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
39547
39548 @item Versions 5 to 7
39549 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
39550 @end table
39551
39552 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
39553
39554 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
39555 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
39556 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
39557 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
39558 collision.
39559
39560 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
39561 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
39562 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
39563 the code.
39564
39565 @item
39566 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
39567 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
39568 strings.
39569
39570 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
39571 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
39572 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
39573 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
39574 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
39575 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
39576
39577 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
39578 @end enumerate
39579
39580 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
39581 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
39582 CU index+attributes value for each use.
39583
39584 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
39585 (bit 0 = LSB):
39586
39587 @table @asis
39588
39589 @item Bits 0-23
39590 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
39591 @item Bits 24-27
39592 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
39593 @item Bits 28-30
39594 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
39595
39596 @table @asis
39597 @item 0
39598 This value is reserved and should not be used.
39599 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
39600 with previous versions of the index.
39601 @item 1
39602 The symbol is a type.
39603 @item 2
39604 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
39605 @item 3
39606 The symbol is a function.
39607 @item 4
39608 Any other kind of symbol.
39609 @item 5,6,7
39610 These values are reserved.
39611 @end table
39612
39613 @item Bit 31
39614 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
39615
39616 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
39617 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
39618 @value{GDBN} sources.
39619
39620 @end table
39621
39622 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
39623 global/static attributes in the index.
39624
39625 @smallexample
39626 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
39627 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
39628 switch (die->tag)
39629 @{
39630 case DW_TAG_typedef:
39631 case DW_TAG_base_type:
39632 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
39633 kind = TYPE;
39634 is_static = 1;
39635 break;
39636 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
39637 kind = VARIABLE;
39638 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39639 break;
39640 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
39641 kind = FUNCTION;
39642 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
39643 break;
39644 case DW_TAG_constant:
39645 kind = VARIABLE;
39646 is_static = ! is_external;
39647 break;
39648 case DW_TAG_variable:
39649 kind = VARIABLE;
39650 is_static = ! is_external;
39651 break;
39652 case DW_TAG_namespace:
39653 kind = TYPE;
39654 is_static = 0;
39655 break;
39656 case DW_TAG_class_type:
39657 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
39658 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
39659 case DW_TAG_union_type:
39660 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
39661 kind = TYPE;
39662 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39663 break;
39664 default:
39665 assert (0);
39666 @}
39667 @end smallexample
39668
39669 @node Man Pages
39670 @appendix Manual pages
39671 @cindex Man pages
39672
39673 @menu
39674 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
39675 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
39676 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
39677 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
39678 @end menu
39679
39680 @node gdb man
39681 @heading gdb man
39682
39683 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
39684
39685 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
39686 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
39687 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
39688 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
39689 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
39690 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
39691 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
39692 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
39693 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
39694 @c man end
39695
39696 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
39697 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
39698 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
39699 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
39700
39701 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
39702 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
39703
39704 @itemize @bullet
39705 @item
39706 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
39707
39708 @item
39709 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
39710
39711 @item
39712 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
39713
39714 @item
39715 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
39716 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
39717 @end itemize
39718
39719 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
39720 Modula-2.
39721
39722 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
39723 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
39724 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
39725 by using the command @code{help}.
39726
39727 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
39728 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
39729 executable program as the argument:
39730
39731 @smallexample
39732 gdb program
39733 @end smallexample
39734
39735 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
39736
39737 @smallexample
39738 gdb program core
39739 @end smallexample
39740
39741 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
39742 to debug a running process:
39743
39744 @smallexample
39745 gdb program 1234
39746 gdb -p 1234
39747 @end smallexample
39748
39749 @noindent
39750 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
39751 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
39752 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
39753
39754 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
39755
39756 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
39757 @table @env
39758 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
39759 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
39760
39761 @item run [@var{arglist}]
39762 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
39763
39764 @item bt
39765 Backtrace: display the program stack.
39766
39767 @item print @var{expr}
39768 Display the value of an expression.
39769
39770 @item c
39771 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
39772
39773 @item next
39774 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
39775 function calls in the line.
39776
39777 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39778 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
39779
39780 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39781 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
39782
39783 @item step
39784 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
39785 function calls in the line.
39786
39787 @item help [@var{name}]
39788 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
39789 about using @value{GDBN}.
39790
39791 @item quit
39792 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
39793 @end table
39794
39795 @ifset man
39796 For full details on @value{GDBN},
39797 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39798 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
39799 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
39800 @end ifset
39801 @c man end
39802
39803 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
39804 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
39805 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
39806 encountered with no
39807 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
39808 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
39809 Many options have
39810 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
39811 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
39812 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
39813 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
39814 more usual convention.)
39815
39816 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
39817 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
39818 option is used.
39819
39820 @table @env
39821 @item -help
39822 @itemx -h
39823 List all options, with brief explanations.
39824
39825 @item -symbols=@var{file}
39826 @itemx -s @var{file}
39827 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
39828
39829 @item -write
39830 Enable writing into executable and core files.
39831
39832 @item -exec=@var{file}
39833 @itemx -e @var{file}
39834 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
39835 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
39836 dump.
39837
39838 @item -se=@var{file}
39839 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
39840 file.
39841
39842 @item -core=@var{file}
39843 @itemx -c @var{file}
39844 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
39845
39846 @item -command=@var{file}
39847 @itemx -x @var{file}
39848 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
39849
39850 @item -ex @var{command}
39851 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
39852
39853 @item -directory=@var{directory}
39854 @itemx -d @var{directory}
39855 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
39856
39857 @item -nh
39858 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
39859
39860 @item -nx
39861 @itemx -n
39862 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
39863
39864 @item -quiet
39865 @itemx -q
39866 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
39867 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
39868
39869 @item -batch
39870 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
39871 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
39872 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
39873 commands in the command files.
39874
39875 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
39876 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
39877 more useful, the message
39878
39879 @smallexample
39880 Program exited normally.
39881 @end smallexample
39882
39883 @noindent
39884 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
39885 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
39886
39887 @item -cd=@var{directory}
39888 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
39889 instead of the current directory.
39890
39891 @item -fullname
39892 @itemx -f
39893 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
39894 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
39895 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
39896 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
39897 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
39898 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
39899 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
39900 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
39901
39902 @item -b @var{bps}
39903 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
39904 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
39905
39906 @item -tty=@var{device}
39907 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
39908 @end table
39909 @c man end
39910
39911 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
39912 @ifset man
39913 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
39914 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
39915 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
39916
39917 @smallexample
39918 info gdb
39919 @end smallexample
39920
39921 @noindent
39922 should give you access to the complete manual.
39923
39924 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39925 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
39926 @end ifset
39927 @c man end
39928
39929 @node gdbserver man
39930 @heading gdbserver man
39931
39932 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
39933 @format
39934 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
39935 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
39936
39937 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
39938
39939 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
39940 @c man end
39941 @end format
39942
39943 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
39944 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
39945 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
39946
39947 @ifclear man
39948 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
39949 @end ifclear
39950 @ifset man
39951 Usage (server (target) side):
39952 @end ifset
39953
39954 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
39955 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
39956 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
39957 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
39958
39959 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
39960 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
39961 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
39962
39963 @smallexample
39964 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
39965 @end smallexample
39966
39967 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
39968
39969 @smallexample
39970 @ifset man
39971 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
39972 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
39973 @end ifset
39974 @ifclear man
39975 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
39976 @end ifclear
39977 @end smallexample
39978
39979 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
39980 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
39981 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
39982
39983 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
39984
39985 @smallexample
39986 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
39987 @end smallexample
39988
39989 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
39990 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
39991 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
39992 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
39993 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
39994 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
39995 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
39996 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
39997 print an error message and exit.
39998
39999 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
40000 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
40001
40002 @smallexample
40003 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40004 @end smallexample
40005
40006 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40007 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40008
40009 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40010 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
40011 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
40012 the program you want to debug.
40013
40014 @smallexample
40015 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40016 @end smallexample
40017
40018 @ifclear man
40019 @subheading Usage (host side)
40020 @end ifclear
40021 @ifset man
40022 Usage (host side):
40023 @end ifset
40024
40025 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
40026 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
40027 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
40028 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
40029 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
40030 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
40031 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
40032 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
40033 descriptor. For example:
40034
40035 @smallexample
40036 @ifset man
40037 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
40038 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
40039 @end ifset
40040 @ifclear man
40041 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
40042 @end ifclear
40043 @end smallexample
40044
40045 @noindent
40046 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
40047
40048 @smallexample
40049 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
40050 @end smallexample
40051
40052 @noindent
40053 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
40054 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
40055 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
40056 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
40057 `Connection refused'.
40058
40059 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
40060 described in
40061 @ifset man
40062 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
40063 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
40064 @end ifset
40065 @ifclear man
40066 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
40067 @end ifclear
40068 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
40069
40070 @smallexample
40071 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
40072 @end smallexample
40073
40074 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
40075 case.
40076 @c man end
40077
40078 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
40079 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
40080
40081 @itemize @bullet
40082
40083 @item
40084 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
40085
40086 @smallexample
40087 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40088 @end smallexample
40089
40090 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
40091 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
40092 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
40093 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
40094 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
40095 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
40096 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40097
40098 @item
40099 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
40100 program:
40101
40102 @smallexample
40103 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40104 @end smallexample
40105
40106 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
40107 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
40108 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
40109 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40110
40111 @item
40112 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40113
40114 @smallexample
40115 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40116 @end smallexample
40117
40118 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40119 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40120 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40121 debug several processes in the same session.
40122 @end itemize
40123
40124 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
40125
40126 @table @env
40127
40128 @item --help
40129 List all options, with brief explanations.
40130
40131 @item --version
40132 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
40133
40134 @item --attach
40135 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
40136
40137 @smallexample
40138 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40139 @end smallexample
40140
40141 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40142 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40143
40144 @item --multi
40145 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40146 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
40147 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
40148 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
40149
40150 @smallexample
40151 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40152 @end smallexample
40153
40154 @item --debug
40155 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
40156 process.
40157 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40158 the developers.
40159
40160 @item --remote-debug
40161 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
40162 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40163 the developers.
40164
40165 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
40166 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
40167 of debugging output.
40168 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
40169
40170 @item --wrapper
40171 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
40172 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
40173 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
40174 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
40175
40176 @item --once
40177 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
40178 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
40179 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
40180 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
40181
40182 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
40183
40184 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
40185 @c QDisableRandomization.
40186
40187 @end table
40188 @c man end
40189
40190 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
40191 @ifset man
40192 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40193 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40194 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40195
40196 @smallexample
40197 info gdb
40198 @end smallexample
40199
40200 should give you access to the complete manual.
40201
40202 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40203 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40204 @end ifset
40205 @c man end
40206
40207 @node gcore man
40208 @heading gcore
40209
40210 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
40211
40212 @format
40213 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
40214 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
40215 @c man end
40216 @end format
40217
40218 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
40219 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
40220 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
40221 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
40222 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
40223 running without any change.
40224 @c man end
40225
40226 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
40227 @table @env
40228 @item -o @var{filename}
40229 The optional argument
40230 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
40231 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
40232 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
40233 @end table
40234 @c man end
40235
40236 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
40237 @ifset man
40238 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40239 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40240 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40241
40242 @smallexample
40243 info gdb
40244 @end smallexample
40245
40246 @noindent
40247 should give you access to the complete manual.
40248
40249 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40250 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40251 @end ifset
40252 @c man end
40253
40254 @node gdbinit man
40255 @heading gdbinit
40256
40257 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
40258
40259 @format
40260 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
40261 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40262 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40263 @end ifset
40264
40265 ~/.gdbinit
40266
40267 ./.gdbinit
40268 @c man end
40269 @end format
40270
40271 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
40272 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
40273 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
40274 described in
40275 @ifset man
40276 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
40277 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
40278 @end ifset
40279 @ifclear man
40280 @ref{Sequences}.
40281 @end ifclear
40282
40283 Please read more in
40284 @ifset man
40285 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
40286 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
40287 @end ifset
40288 @ifclear man
40289 @ref{Startup}.
40290 @end ifclear
40291
40292 @table @env
40293 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40294 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40295 @end ifset
40296 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40297 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
40298 @end ifclear
40299 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40300 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
40301 See more in
40302 @ifset man
40303 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
40304 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
40305 @end ifset
40306 @ifclear man
40307 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
40308 @end ifclear
40309
40310 @item ~/.gdbinit
40311 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40312 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
40313
40314 @item ./.gdbinit
40315 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
40316 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
40317 See more in
40318 @ifset man
40319 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
40320 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
40321 @end ifset
40322 @ifclear man
40323 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
40324 @end ifclear
40325 @end table
40326 @c man end
40327
40328 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
40329 @ifset man
40330 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
40331
40332 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40333 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40334 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40335
40336 @smallexample
40337 info gdb
40338 @end smallexample
40339
40340 should give you access to the complete manual.
40341
40342 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40343 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40344 @end ifset
40345 @c man end
40346
40347 @include gpl.texi
40348
40349 @node GNU Free Documentation License
40350 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
40351 @include fdl.texi
40352
40353 @node Concept Index
40354 @unnumbered Concept Index
40355
40356 @printindex cp
40357
40358 @node Command and Variable Index
40359 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
40360
40361 @printindex fn
40362
40363 @tex
40364 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
40365 % meantime:
40366 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
40367 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
40368 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
40369 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
40370 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
40371 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
40372 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
40373 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
40374 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
40375 \page\colophon
40376 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
40377 @end tex
40378
40379 @bye
This page took 0.904524 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.